Coffee Guide 2012
Coffee Guide 2012
Coffee Guide 2012
THIRD EDITION
International Trade Centre 2011 The International Trade Centre (ITC) is the joint agency of the World Trade Organization and the United Nations. Street address: ITC 54-56, rue de Montbrillant 1202 Geneva, Switzerland ITC Palais des Nations 1211 Geneva 10, Switzerland +41-22 730 0111 +41-22 733 4439 itcreg@intracen.org http://www.intracen.org
Postal address:
Geneva 2011
ii
English, French, Spanish (separate editions) ITC, Palais des Nations, 1211 Geneva 10, Switzerland (www.intracen.org)
The designations employed and the presentation of material in this publication do not imply the expression of any opinion whatsoever on the part of the International Trade Centre concerning the legal status of any country, territory, city or area or of its authorities, or concerning the delimitation of its frontiers or boundaries.
Cover design and illustration: International Trade Centre, Kristina Golubic International Trade Centre 2011 All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, electrostatic, magnetic tape, mechanical, photocopying or otherwise, without prior permission in writing from the International Trade Centre.
P246.E/DMD/SC/11-XI
iii
FOREWORD
This third edition of The Coffee Exporters Guide marks the 20th anniversary of this popular publication. First published as Coffee - An exporters guide in 1992 and subsequently updated in 2002, this practical handbook has become the worlds most extensive and authoritative publication on the international trade of coffee. With neutral, hands-on information about the mechanics of trade in green coffee, the guide addresses value chain stakeholders in both coffee-producing and coffee-importing countries. A detailed overview of the world coffee trade is accompanied by advice on marketing, contracts, logistics, insurance, arbitration, futures markets, hedging, trade credits, risk management, quality control, e-commerce and more. This new edition addresses trends which were barely apparent in the coffee industry ten years ago, such as climate change adaptation and mitigation, as well as the important role of women in the sector. It also features a more detailed comparison of the leading sustainability schemes in addition to more established certication schemes for organic production and fair trade. Over the years, this guide has been used by ITC and many others to train both newcomers and more experienced people in the coffee industry, who use the information regularly both in daily routines and for major decisions. We wish to thank the many industry experts, companies and institutions that have contributed in various ways to the guide. We are particularly grateful for the support from the International Coffee Organization, which has shared its knowledge for all three editions of the guide, and also has cooperated with ITC in other coffee projects over the years. It is our hope that this guide, along with its companion website www.thecoffeeguide.org, will continue to serve as an essential training and knowledge-sharing tool to advance the interests of producers, exporters and those who support them in coffee-producing countries around the world.
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS
Hein Jan van Hilten is the principal author of this guide as well as the previous editions from 1992 and 2002. He has spent some 50 years in the coffee industry, rst as an exporter in East Africa and subsequently as an independent Coffee Development Consultant in numerous producing countries. Currently he serves on the Executive Board of the 4C Association, a mainstream sustainability initiative for the coffee industry, and moderates www.thecoffeeguide.org, ITCs electronic version of this guide. The guide was made possible through the valuable contributions of expertise, experience and time by the people, companies and organizations below, whose assistance is acknowledged with thanks and appreciation. Paul J. Fisher was also co-author of the 2002 edition of the guide. He has served many years in the coffee trading and roasting sectors. In recognition of his contribution to the industry, including his role in development of the widely used eCOPS (Electronic Commodity Operations Processing System), he was elected an Honorary Life Member of the Green Coffee Association (GCA) in 2011 and remains active in GCA affairs in an advisory capacity. Michael A. Wheeler served many years as Executive Director of the Specialty Coffee Association of Europe, He contributed extensively to both this and the 2002 edition of this guide. At the International Coffee Organization he currently serves as Overseas Representative for the Papua New Guinea Coffee Industry Corporation and has chaired a number of committees at ICO. Beatriz M. Wagner is a former Class A member of the Coffee, Sugar and Cocoa Exchange in New York and was a contributor also to the 2002 edition of the guide. Mrs. Wagner continues to lecture and consult on soft commodity trading issues. She is also co-author of ITCs guide on cocoa trade. Gerd Uitbeijerse is a Master Mariner and former Senior Cargo Care Expert with leading shipping lines. He remains actively involved in cargo care matters through the Global Cargo Consultancy Management enterprise in the Netherlands. Sunalini Menon is founder and CEO of Coffeelab Pvt. Ltd. in Bangalore, India. She is an internationally recognized coffee cupper and has contributed extensively to the chapters dealing with coffee quality, especially robusta. Captain Reinhard Diegner has many years experience in commodity marine insurance, physical risk management and loss assessment, primarily from many years with a leading rm of underwriting agents in Germany. Michael P Flynn is a past Chairman of the European Coffee Federations Contracts Committee. Currently he acts as an . adviser to the Committee and has contributed extensively on issues related to contracts and arbitration. Joost Pierrot has many years experience in the eld of organics and contributed to the guides sections on sustainability issues. He works as an Organic Development Consultant and has contributed to other publications in ITC. Roel Vaessen is Secretary-General of the European Coffee Federation and serves on many industry bodies. He has contributed extensively on European Union issues as food safety and cargo security rules. Morten Scholer, Senior Market Development Adviser in ITC, was responsible for overall management, coordination and strategic direction of the work in ITC. ITC also wishes to thank the following industry personalities and organizations who over the years have contributed to the different editions of the Coffee Guide, especially so Abba Bayer who contributed extensively to the 1992 edition and who today is an Honorary Life Member of the Green Coffee Association in the United States. Special thanks are also due to the International Coffee Organization in London for its unstinting assistance with information on coffee statistics and related matters for all three editions.
vi
Individual contributors Peter Baker, Romeo S. Barbara, Maurice Blanc, Carlos H.J. Brando, Ivan Carvalho, Renaud Cuchet, Robin Dand, Frans Douqu, Norbert Douqu, Reinier Douqu, Pablo Dubois, Stephen Dunn, Dick Engelsma, Gerrit van Elst, John Eustace, Massimiliano (Max) Fabian, Judith Ganes Chase, M.P Gathaara, Bernard Gaud, Gordon S. Gillett, Daniele Giovannucci, .H. Michael C. Glenister, Gabriel Cadena Gomez, Jeremy Haggar, Jos Harmsen, Hidetaka Hayashi, Clive A. van Hilten, Patrick F. Install, Birthe Thode Jacobsen, Phyllis Johnson, Rebecca L. Johnson, Sipke W. de Jong, Alexander Kasterine, Paul Katzeff, Soren Knudsen, Paula A. Koelemij, Karl Koer, Surendra Kotecha, David Landais, Ted Lingle, Kerstin Linne, Sandy McAlpine, Jan Meijer, Kerry Muir, Robert F. Nelson, Henry Ngabirano, Kif Nguyen, Doan Trieu Nhan, Ronald J. Onzima, Luis Norberto Pascoal, Alain Pittet, R. Price Peterson, Gloria Ins Puerta Quintero, Paul Rice, Mike Ritchie, Elodie Robin, David Roche, Aimee Russillo, Josefa Sacko, Jasper P van Schaik, John Schluter, Christian Schler, Garth Smith, Susie Spindler, . Dominic Stanculescu, Gerrit H.D. van der Stegen, Sren Sylvest, Joachim Taubensee, Panos Varangis, Rinantonio Viani, Martin Wattam, Joachim R. Wernicke, Birgit Wilhelm, Christian B. Wolthers, Eric C. Wood. Organizations The Coffee Quality Institute United States of America, the Coffee Science Information Centre United Kingdom, the European Coffee Federation ECF, the International Womens Coffee Alliance IWCA, the National Coffee Association of USA, Inc., NYSE Euronext Liffe United Kingdom, the Specialty Coffee Association of America SCAA, the Specialty Coffee Association of Europe SCAE. Dianna Rienstra copy edited the guide. Publication production and promotion was managed by Natalie Domeisen. Desktop publishing was done by Isabel Droste in ITC.
CONTENTS
FOREWORD .................................................................... iii ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS ................................................ v NOTE .............................................................................. xvi FACTORS INFLUENCING DEMAND ........................... 28 LIFESTYLE, DIET AND COMPETING DRINKS ........... 28 ADDING VALUE AN OVERVIEW................................ 29 Soluble coffee ........................................................... 29 Soluble coffee Outlook ......................................... 30 Soluble coffee Manufacturing methods............. 30 Decaffeinated coffee ............................................... 31 The decaffeination process .................................... 32 Roasted coffee .......................................................... 32 Ready-to-drink and extracts or concentrates ...... 33 TRADE PRICES, INVESTMENT COSTS AND TARIFFS ................................................................. 33 Imports and prices of roasted and soluble coffee ......................................................................... 33 Tariffs and taxes ....................................................... 34 Classication of coffee products traded internationally ........................................................... 34 Tariffs imposed on coffee and coffee products.... 34 PROMOTING COFFEE CONSUMPTION ................... 35
vii
CHAPTER 1
CHAPTER 3
37
CHAPTER 2
15
viii
TRADEMARKING AND GEOGRAPHICAL INDICATIONS IN COFFEE ............................................ 51 Trademarks and logos ............................................ 51 Trademarks versus geographical indications ..... 51 SUSTAINABILITY AND SOCIAL ISSUES IN THE COFFEE INDUSTRY ...................................................... 52 Sustainability, certication, verication, corporate guidelines ............................................... 53 Integrated farming systems .................................... 54 The European Retail Protocol for Good Agricultural Practice ................................................ 54 Codes of conduct ..................................................... 54 THE MAIN SUSTAINABILITY SCHEMES IN THE COFFEE SECTOR ................................................. 54 Fairtrade Label Organization ................................. 54 UTZ CERTIFIED ........................................................ 56 Rainforest Alliance .................................................. 57 The 4C Association Mainstreaming sustainability in coffee ............................................. 58 Other sustainability labels ...................................... 59 CERTIFICATION AND VERIFICATION ........................ 59 SUSTAINABILITY AND GENDER ................................. 61 Womens employment and ownership in the coffee sector................................................... 61 Womens associations in the coffee sector........... 61
Letters of credit ......................................................... 70 Destinations, shipment and shipping advice ....... 70 Delayed shipments .................................................. 71 The bill of lading ....................................................... 71 Title to and endorsement of a bill of lading .......... 71 Dispatching bills of lading ...................................... 72 Certicates ................................................................ 72 Missing and incorrect documents ......................... 73 STANDARD FORMS OF CONTRACT ......................... 73 Overriding principle ................................................ 73 European Coffee Federation contracts ................. 73 Green Coffee Association contracts ..................... 74 ECF AND GCA CONTRACTS ...................................... 75 UCP 600 IN SALES CONTRACTS................................ 80 Irrevocable and conrmed credits ........................ 80 Non-documentary requirements............................ 81 Time allowed to banks to examine the documents .......................................................... 81 Force majeure .......................................................... 81 INCOTERMS ...........................................................81 Two distinct classes of rules ................................... 82 Terminal handling charges..................................... 82 Rules for domestic and international trade .......... 82
CHAPTER 5
83
CHAPTER 4
63
CONTRACTS ................................................64
INTRODUCTION TO CONTRACTS ............................. 64 When things go wrong ............................................ 64 Mitigation of loss ...................................................... 64 Variations to standard forms of contract .............. 64 COMMERCIAL OR FRONT OFFICE ASPECTS ....... 65 Specifying quality: On description ...................... 65 Specifying quality: On sample basis .................. 65 The shipping period................................................. 66 Delivery commitment ............................................... 66 Ocean freight............................................................ 67 Weights ...................................................................... 67 Payment: conditions ................................................. 67 Alternative payment methods ................................ 68 Payment: credit policy ............................................. 68 Scope and validity of an offer................................. 69 Using intermediaries Who is who ....................... 69 DOCUMENTATION OR BACK OFFICE ASPECTS .... 70 Introduction to documentation ............................... 70
ix
Bulk containers: Lining and lling ......................... 96 Fixing the liner .......................................................... 96 CONTAINERS AT THE RECEIVING END .................... 97 Inland container stations ........................................ 97 Discharge .................................................................. 97 Quality and sampling .............................................. 98 Weights and supervision ......................................... 98 Container weights at shipment .............................. 98 Outlook ...................................................................... 99 Cost and convenience ............................................. 99 Container security at customs................................ 99 Receiving containers United States ................... 99 Receiving containers European Union ............ 100 Container seals ...................................................... 101 Container tracking and smart containers .......... 101 INSURANCE ................................................................. 102 Utmost good faith ................................................... 102 The risk trail to FOB ............................................... 102 The risk trail to FOB: Farm gate to processing .. 102 The risk trail to FOB: Warehousing and processing....................................................... 103 The risk trail to FOB: Transport to port ................ 103 Delivery to FOB: FCL (or CY) terms ..................... 104 Delivery to FOB: FCL (or CY) terms in bulk ........ 104 Delivery to FOB: LCL (or CFS) .............................. 104 Termination of risk.................................................. 105 Standard forms of contract .................................. 105 INSURANCE: THE COVER ......................................... 105 Insuring risk ............................................................ 105 Types of cover ......................................................... 106 Claims from receivers at destination .................. 107 WAR RISK INSURANCE IN SHIPPING ...................... 107
PAPERLESS TRADE ..................................................... 112 Taking the paper out of the coffee trade: An example ............................................................. 112 Birds eye view ........................................................ 113 The electronic environment .................................. 113 From B2B-exchange to e-marketplaces.............. 114 Centrally available data versus straight through processing ................................................ 114 Legal framework required .................................... 114 Contract and title registry ..................................... 114 Compliance, verication and settlement ............ 115 Secure transfer of data and documents ............. 115 SPECIFIC ASPECTS .................................................... 115 Security, common ground and dispute resolution................................................................. 115 Guaranteed originals and no mistakes .............. 116 What are the benets of e-commerce? ............... 116 Electronic trade execution in practice ................ 116 End result and outlook for paperless trade ...... 117 TECHNICAL QUESTIONS .......................................... 118 Who could use an electronic system?................. 118 Standards ............................................................... 118 Access ..................................................................... 118
CHAPTER 7
119
ARBITRATION .............................................120
THE PRINCIPLE OF ARBITRATION ........................... 120 Arbitration centres ................................................. 120 Types of dispute and claims ................................. 120 Common errors ...................................................... 121 Appointing arbitrators ........................................... 121 Awards..................................................................... 121 Failure to comply with an award.......................... 121 Variations to standards contracts ........................ 122 ARBITRATION IN THE UNITED KINGDOM .............. 122 The British Coffee Association ............................. 122 The arbitral proceedings ...................................... 122 Time limits for introducing arbitration claims .... 123 Clarity is essential .................................................. 123 Standard timetable for rst-tier proceedings .... 123 Provision of samples .............................................. 123 Awards made by a tribunal .................................. 123 Commencing appeal proceedings ..................... 123 Standard timetable for appeal proceedings ..... 124 Provision of samples .............................................. 124 Awards of interest .................................................. 124 Costs of the arbitration .......................................... 124
CHAPTER 6
109
ARBITRATION IN GERMANY ..................................... 124 The Deutscher Kaffeeverband e.V. ...................... 124 Technical arbitration by the DKV ......................... 124 Quality arbitration in Hamburg ............................ 125 ARBITRATION IN FRANCE ......................................... 126 The Chambre arbitrale des cafs et poivres du Havre .................................................................. 126 Documents to be submitted and time limits ....... 126 Arbitration panels .................................................. 126 ARBITRATION IN THE UNITED STATES ................... 127 The Green Coffee Association ............................. 127 Quality arbitrations ................................................ 127 Gross negligence and fraud ................................ 128 Technical arbitrations ............................................ 128 Practical considerations ....................................... 129 Costs and fees ........................................................ 130
Tenderable growths, packing, differentials and certication ..................................................... 139 Supervision by LCH ............................................... 139 Outlook for an electronic exchange .................... 140 BOLSA DE MERCADORIAS & FUTUROS BRAZIL ....................................................................... 140 Separate contracts for spot and futures ............. 140 Options .................................................................... 140 Clearing services, turnover and liquidity ............ 140 Turnover futures and options ............................. 141 SINGAPORE EXCHANGE LTD THE SGX ROBUSTA COFFEE CONTRACT ............................... 141 VIET NAM TWO EXCHANGES FOR ROBUSTA .... 141 THE MECHANICS OF TRADING IN FUTURES ........ 141 Floor procedure...................................................... 142 Delivery .................................................................... 142 Offsetting transactions .......................................... 142 Futures prices ......................................................... 142 Types of orders ....................................................... 143
CHAPTER 8
131
CHAPTER 9
145
xi
HOW TRADE HOUSES USE FUTURES .................... 154 Arbitrage ................................................................. 154 Arbitrage An example ........................................ 155 Trader speculation ................................................. 155 COMMODITY SPECULATION ................................... 155 Differences between hedging and speculation .. 155 Types of speculators .............................................. 156 Speculative strategies ........................................... 157 Straddling An example ...................................... 158 TECHNICAL ANALYSIS OF FUTURES MARKETS... 158 Open interest .......................................................... 159 Volume of operations ............................................. 159 Relationship between open interest, volume and price ................................................................. 159 Charting .................................................................. 160
Availability and cost of credit ............................... 174 Monitoring ............................................................... 174 RISK MANAGEMENT AND CREDIT .......................... 174 Risk management as a credit component ......... 174 Availability of credit is not static ........................... 175 Risk remains risk .................................................... 175 Warehouse receipts as collateral ........................ 176 Warehouse receipts Summary of pre-conditions......................................................... 176 TRADE CREDITS IN PRODUCING COUNTRIES ..... 176 Trade credit terminology and denitions ............ 176 Types of coffee trade nance ............................... 177 TRADE CREDIT AND ASSOCIATED RISKS ............. 177 Physical risk ............................................................ 177 Price risk or market risk ........................................ 178 Differential risk or basis risk ................................. 178 Currency risk .......................................................... 178 Performance risk .................................................... 178 Common errors and misconceptions.................. 179 LETTERS OF CREDIT .................................................. 179 Advance credit Three types ............................... 180 Uniform Custom and Practice for Documentary Credits UCP 600 ......................... 180 ALL-IN COLLATERAL MANAGEMENT ...................... 181 Functions of the collateral manager.................... 181 Modern collateral management facilitates credit ........................................................................ 181 Guarantees ............................................................. 182 TRADE CREDIT AND RISK SMALLHOLDERS ...... 182 Credit channels in the smallholder sector ......... 182 Providing collateral can prove difcult for smallholders ........................................................... 182 Risk management and smallholders .................. 183 Price risk management as pure insurance ........ 184 Price risk management as part of marketing .... 184 Micronance ........................................................... 185
CHAPTER 10
163
CHAPTER 11
187
COFFEE QUALITY......................................188
TWO SPECIES AND TWO PROCESSING METHODS .................................................................... 188 The denition of quality ......................................... 188 Quality and availability determine the target market...................................................................... 188 Processing: schematic overview .......................... 189
xii
QUALITY SEGMENTATION FOUR CATEGORIES ............................................................... 190 Exemplary quality .................................................. 190 High quality ............................................................. 190 Mainstream quality ................................................ 190 Undergrades or lowgrades .................................. 190 QUALITY AND PRODUCTION.................................... 191 Variety, soils and altitude ...................................... 191 Rain fed or irrigated............................................... 191 Wet or dry processed ............................................ 191 Cost and yield versus quality ............................... 192 Estate or smallholder grown ................................ 192 HIGH QUALITY ARABICA ........................................... 192 Preparing high quality arabica The basics ..... 192 Dening quality ...................................................... 193 High quality arabica (green) ................................ 193 High quality arabica (roast).................................. 199 High quality arabica (taste) .................................. 200 Mainstream quality ................................................ 202 ROBUSTA...................................................................... 203
The cup or liquor .................................................... 220 The coffee liquorer (the cupper) .......................... 221 CLASSIFICATION TERMS .......................................... 223 Glossary Green or raw coffee ........................... 223 Glossary Liquor or cup....................................... 224 Phenolic taste, Rio avour and fermented.......... 225
CHAPTER 13
227
CHAPTER 12
209
xiii
CHAPTER 14
243
TABLES
Table 1.1 World coffee exports, by value and volume, 19902010 ...............................................................2 Table 1.2 Crop years in producing countries ..........................3 Table 1.3 ICO qualiy groups....................................................4 Table 1.4 Illustration of a defect count for sun-dried (natural) coffee.........................................................6 Table 1.5 Overview of world production by type, coffee years 2006/072010/11 ...........................................6 Table 1.6 Domestic consumption in coffee producing countries, crop year 2010/11 ...................................7 Table 1.7 Overview of world exports by type, 2006/072010/11 .....................................................7 Table 1.8 Opening stocks by type, crop years 2006/072010/11 .....................................................8 Table 1.9 Consumption in importing countries/areas, 2006/072010/11 .....................................................9 Table 1.10 Membership of the ICO .........................................12 Table 1.11 World production by country, 1995/962010/11 ...13 Table 2.1 World gross and net imports, disappearance and inventories by form of coffee, 20052010 ......18 Table 2.2 Consumption of decaffeinated coffee as a percentage of total consumption, 2010 ................20 Table 2.3 Coffee consumption in North America, 2010 ........21 Table 2.4 Coffee consumption in Europe, 2010....................22 Table 2.5 Coffee consumption in selected countries in Asia and Australasia, 2010 ................................25 Table 2.6 Coffee consumption in selected countries, 2010 ..26 Table 2.7 Coffee consumption in selected origins, 2010 ......27 Table 2.8 Exports of soluble coffee by exporting countries, 20052010 .............................................................31 Table 2.9 Classication of coffee products traded internationally .........................................................35 Table 2.10 Tariffs for import of coffee in selected countries....36 Table 3.1 Total worldwide sales of FLO-certied coffee, 20042010 .............................................................55 Table 3.2 Fairtrade premiums ...............................................56 Table 3.3 Comparative overview of sustainability schemes for coffee ................................................60 Table 3.4 Womens employment in the coffee sector ...........61 Table 3.5 Womens ownership in the coffee sector ..............61 Table 5.1 Cost distribution between sellers and buyers .......87 Table 8.1 Annual turnover in futures compared with gross world imports, 19802010 .........................134 Table 8.2 Annual turnover in options and futures, 19902010 ...........................................................134 Table 8.3 Tenderable growths and differentials at ICE ........137 Table 10.1 Operational risks ..................................................172 Table 10.2 Transaction risks ..................................................172 Table 10.3 What a borrower must show ................................179
xiv
FIGURES
Figure 1.1 Figure 1.2 Figure 1.3 Figure 1.4 Figure 2.1 Figure 2.2 Figure 2.3 Figure 2.4 Figure 2.5 Share of coffee in total exports by value, 20052010.............................................................2 Annual arabica production, 1981/86 and 2006/11 .................................................................4 Annual robusta production, 1981/86 and 2006/11 .................................................................4 Total inventories in importing countries and prices, 1990-2010 ..........................................9 Leading coffee trading companies worldwide, 2010.....................................................................16 Leading coffee roasting companies worldwide, 2010 ..................................................18 World coffee imports, 19492010 .......................18 Consumption of soluble coffee 2000, 2005 and 2010 .............................................................19 Imports of roasted coffee by origin, average 20052010...........................................................33 Figure 9.1 Figure 2.6 Figure 2.7 Imports of soluble coffee by origin, average 20052010...........................................................33 Export value of soluble coffee from ICA producing countries compared with the ICA Composite Indicator Price, 19902010...............34 Export value of roasted coffee from ICA members compared with the ICA Composite Indicator Price, 19902010 .................................34 Example of a daily coffee futures price chart (December 2011); Coffee ICE, 4 November 2011..............................................161 Example of a monthly coffee futures price chart; Coffee ICE, 31 October 2011...............161
Figure 2.8
Figure 9.2
Figure 11.1 Processing of coffee cherries and green coffee beans ...........................................189
BOXES
Box 9.1 The selling hedge an example..........................148
Box 11.1 Screen sizes ........................................................197 Box 12.1 Persistent Organic Pollutants ..............................214 Box 13.1 The Kyoto Protocol ..............................................228 Box 13.2 Carbon footprints and sinks ................................231
xv
NOTE
Unless otherwise specied, all references to dollars ($) and cents (cts) are to Unites States dollars and cents. All references to tons are to metric tons. The term billion denotes 1 thousand million. The following abbreviations are used:
AA ACPC ASP B/L BM&F CAD CDM CFR CFTC CFC CFS CHIPS CIF CM COE COT CSCE CY DAF ECC eCOPS ECF EDK ETA EU EUREP EUREPGAP EWR FAO FAQ FCA FCL FCM FDA FOB FOT FLO GAP GBE GCA Against actuals Association of Coffee Producing Countries Applications service provider Bill of lading Brazilian Mercantile & Futures Exchange Cash against documents Clean Development Mechanism Cost and freight U.S. Commodity Futures Trading Commission Common Fund for Commodities Container freight station Clearing House Interbank Payment System Cost, insurance, freight Collateral manager Cup of Excellence Commitment of traders Coffee, Sugar and Cocoa Exchange (New York) Container yard Delivered at frontier European Contract for Coffee Electronic Commodity Operations Processing System (at ICE, New York) European Coffee Federation Ex dock Estimated time of arrival European Union Euro-Retailer Produce Working Group EUREP Good Agricultural Practice Electronic warehouse receipt Food and Agriculture Organization of the United Nations Fair average quality Free carrier Full container load Futures commission merchant U.S. Food and Drug Administration Free on board Free on truck/train Fairtrade Labelling Organizations Good Agricultural Practice Green bean equivalent Green Coffee Association (United States) UNCTAD USDA VSA WTO XML MFN NCA NCAD NCSE NGO NY 'C' OTA PTBF RTD SAS SCAA SCAE STC SURF SWIFT TEU THC UCP GHG GIS GP GPS GSP GTC HACCP ICA ICE ICO ICS IFOAM IPCC ISO ITC JIT LCH LCL L/C LIFFE Greenhouse gas Geographic information system General purpose (container) Global positioning system Generalized System of Preferences Good till cancelled Hazard Analysis Critical Control Point International Coffee Agreement Intercontinental Exchange (New York) International Coffee Organization Internal Control System (organic) International Federation of Organic Agriculture Movements Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change International Organization for Standardization International Trade Centre Just-in-time London Clearing House Less than container load Letter of credit London International Financial Futures and Options Exchange (NYSE Euronext Liffe) Most favoured nation National Coffee Association (United States) Net cash against documents New York Coffee, Sugar and Cocoa Exchange Non-governmental organization Coffee C Contract (at ICE, New York) Ochratoxin A Price to be xed Ready-to-drink Subject to approval of sample Specialty Coffee Association of America Specialty Coffee Association of Europe Said to contain Settlement Utility for Managing Risk and Finance Society for Worldwide Interbank Financial Telecommunication Twenty-foot equivalent unit (container) Terminal handling charges Uniform Customs and Practice for Documentary Credits United Nations Conference on Trade and Development United States Department of Agriculture Vessel sharing agreement World Trade Organization Extensible mark-up language
xvi
CHAPTER 1
THE IMPORTANCE OF COFFEE IN WORLD TRADE ...........................................................................................2 SUPPLY, PRODUCTION, STOCKS AND DOMESTIC CONSUMPTION .............................................................2 DEMAND, CONSUMPTION AND INVENTORIES.................................................................................................8 PRICES ...................................................................................................................................................................10 THE INTERNATIONAL COFFEE ORGANIZATION .............................................................................................10
average share of coffee exports in their total export earnings exceeded 10%.
Figure 1.1 Share of coffee in total exports by value, 2005 2010
Timor-Leste Burundi Ethiopia Rwanda Honduras Nicaragua Uganda Guatemala El Salvador Colombia U.R. of Tanzania Papua New Guinea Kenya Costa Rica Viet Nam Brazil Sierra Leone Cte d'Ivoire Peru Cameroon Panama Jamaica
9% 6% 5% 4% 3% 3% 3% 3% 2% 2% 2% 2% 2% 2% 21% 18% 17% 13% 28% 34% 62% 70%
Calendar year 1990 1995 2000 2005 2006 2007 2008 2009 2010
Source: ICO.
Some 70 countries produce coffee. Three countries alone have in recent years produced around 55% of the worlds coffee: Brazil (32%34%), Viet Nam (12%13%) and Colombia (8%9%). In 2010 the International Coffee Organization (ICO) estimated total coffee sector employment at about 26 million persons in 52 producing countries. See Doc. ICC 105-5 at www.ico.org. For many countries, coffee exports not only are a vital contributor to foreign exchange earnings, but also account for a signicant proportion of tax income and gross domestic product. For eight countries, the average share of coffee exports in total export earnings exceeded 10% in the period 20052010, although the importance of coffee in the economy of many countries is diminishing over time. This can be demonstrated by the fact that during the period 19952000, there were 15 countries which fell into this category, i.e. the
Source: ICO.
Exportable supply, however, is dened as supply minus domestic consumption and an amount deemed to be required for working stocks. Working stocks is not precisely dened. It relates to the volume of coffee required to maintain a steady and planned ow of exports to the market. It is generally perceived as the amount of coffee in the pipeline in an exporting country at any one time. Harvesting and export patterns vary from country to country. As a result, working stocks are not dened as a xed percentage or proportion of a countrys production or export capacity, but rather as an individual amount unique to every country. In many respects the calculation of working stocks is arbitrary, but it is generally based on historical data for each country. Exportable production is total annual production less domestic consumption in producing countries. Availability for export is equivalent to the carry-over stocks from the previous year plus exportable production of the current year. Any difference between exportable production and actual exports (surplus or shortfall) results in an adjustment up or down of the carry-over stocks to the following year. Crop year. Coffee is a seasonal crop. Seasons vary from country to country, starting and nishing at different times throughout the year. This makes statistics on worldwide annual production very difcult to collate: any single 12-month period may encompass a whole crop year in one country, but will also include the tail end of the previous years crop and the beginning of the next years crop in others. In order to compare supply aggregates as well supply with demand, where possible supply data has been converted from crop year to coffee year (which runs from October to September). It should be noted that this is not always possible.
Table 1.2
Crop years in producing countries Benin Cameroon Central African Republic Colombia Costa Rica Cte dIvoire Democratic Republic of the Congo El Salvador Equatorial Guinea Ethiopia Gabon Angola Bolivia (Plurinational State of) Brazil Burundi Ecuador Congo Cuba Dominican Republic Ghana Guatemala Guinea Honduras India Jamaica Kenya Liberia Mexico Nicaragua Nigeria Indonesia Madagascar Malawi Papua New Guinea Paraguay Haiti Philippines United Republic of Tanzania Panama Sierra Leone Sri Lanka Thailand Togo Trinidad and Tobago Uganda Venezuela (Bolivarian Republic of) Viet Nam
1 October30 September
1 April-31 March
1 July-30 June
Zambia
Source: ICO.
Table 1.3
ICO qualiy groups Producers Colombia, Kenya, United Republic of Tanzania Bolivia (Plurinational State of), Burundi, Costa Rica, Cuba, Dominican Republic, Ecuador, El Salvador, Guatemala, Haiti, Honduras, India, Jamaica, Malawi, Mexico, Nicaragua, Panama, Papua New Guinea, Peru, Rwanda, Venezuela (Bolivarian Republic of), Zambia, Zimbabwe Brazil, Ethiopia, Paraguay, Timor-Leste, Yemen Angola, Benin, Cameroon, Central African Republic, Congo, Cte dIvoire, Democratic Republic of the Congo, Equatorial Guinea, Gabon, Ghana, Guinea, Indonesia, Liberia, Madagascar, Nigeria, Philippines, Sierra Leone, Sri Lanka, Thailand, Togo, Trinidad and Tobago, Uganda, Viet Nam
GEOGRAPHICAL DISTRIBUTION
Coffee is indigenous to Africa, with arabica coffee reportedly originating from Ethiopia and robusta from the Atlantic Coast (Kouilou region and in and around Angola) and the Great Lakes region. Today, it is widely grown throughout the tropics. The bulk of the worlds coffee, however, is produced in Latin America and in particular in Brazil, which has dominated world production since 1840. Brazil is the worlds largest grower and seller of coffee. Viet Nam, which expanded its production rapidly throughout the 1990s, now holds the number two position, bringing Colombia into third place and Indonesia into fourth. The gures below demonstrate the shift of regional shares of arabica and robusta production since 1981.
Source: ICO.
Source: ICO.
Million bags
25
Preparation (maximum 6 defects per 300 g) and American Preparation (maximum 12 defects per 300 g). Ethiopia Jimma 5 Sun-dried (i.e. natural) arabica from the Jimma region. Type 5 refers to a grading scale based on screen, defect count and cup quality. Guatemala SHB EP Huehuetenango Strictly Hard Bean is from above 1,400 m. Scale includes ve altitude levels from below 900 m (Prime washed) to above 1,400 m. European preparation: above screen 15, allows maximum 8 defects per 300 g (American preparation: above screen 14, allows 23 defects). India Arabica Plantation A Washed arabica, screen 17. Classication is PB, A, B and C. Other classications apply to unwashed (naturals) and robusta. Indonesia Robusta Grade 4 The export grade scale goes from 0 (best) to 6. Grade 4 allows 4580 defects. Region or other details are sometimes specied as quality, e.g. EK-1 and EK-Special. Processing depends on the region (island). Kenya AB FAQ even roast clean cup Kenya arabica grade AB, fair average quality. Internal grading system (E, AA, AB, PB, C, TT and T) is based on bean size and density, further detailed by liquor quality into 10 classications. Top cupping coffees are mostly sold on actual sample basis. Mexico Prime Washed Europrep Prime Washed (prima lavado) from altitude between 600 m and 900 m, on a scale from 400 m to 1,400 m; Europrep is retained by screen 17 and allows maximum 15 defects per 300 g. Papua New Guinea (PNG) Smallholder Y1-grade Y1 is one of the grades on a scale covering bean size, defect count, colour, odour, roast aspects and cup quality; AA, A, AB, B, C, PB, X, E, PSC, Y1, Y2 and T. Viet Nam Robusta Grade 2 maximum 5% blacks and broken Grade 2 out of six grades: Special Grade and Grade 1 to 5, based on screen size and defects. (Descriptions are often supplemented with further details on moisture content, acceptable mix of bean types, bean size, etc.)
Table 1.4
DOMESTIC CONSUMPTION
Domestic consumption in producing countries is estimated to have risen from about 26 million bags in 2000/01 to over 41 million bags in crop year 2010/11. The bulk of this increase is attributed to growth in the internal market in Brazil, which has increased from 13 million bags to more than 19 million bags over the same period about half of all coffee consumed in producing countries. Industry sources point to the growth in real disposable incomes in Brazil and a policy of using better quality coffee for the internal markets as important factors behind this growth. Elsewhere in Latin America, consumption is constrained by relatively low urban income levels although there has been some growth in Mexico and consumption remains reasonably substantial in Colombia. By comparison consumption in Africa is negligible with the exception of Ethiopia, where there is a long and wellestablished tradition of coffee drinking. In Asia, total consumption is reasonably high in India, Indonesia and the Philippines, although per capita consumption levels are relatively low. See table 1.6.
1 black bean 2 sour or rancid beans 2 beans in parchment 1 cherry 1 large husk 23 small husks 3 shells 1 large stone/earth clod 1 medium-sized stone/earth clod 1 small stone/earth clod 1 large stick 1 medium-sized stick 1 small stick 5 broken beans 5 green or immature beans 5 insect damaged beans
Table 1.5
Overview of world production by type, coffee years 2006/072010/11 (in millions of bags) Coffee Year 2006/07 127.1 77.3 29.1 12.6 23.1 8.3 4.2 49.7 10.2 0.5 19.3 6.4 5.4 2.8 2.2 2.9 60.8 39.2 2007/08 127.8 80.1 30.3 12.5 24.2 8.7 4.4 47.7 10.7 0.4 16.5 6.9 5.3 2.6 2.6 2.7 62.7 37.3 2008/09 126.7 75.8 32.2 8.7 22.8 7.6 4.4 50.9 10.6 0.4 18.5 8.1 5.5 2.4 2.6 2.8 59.8 40.2 2009/10 128.6 77.8 32.5 9.0 21.8 9.6 4.9 50.8 10.9 0.4 18.0 8.6 6.2 1.9 2.4 2.4 60.5 39.5 2010/11* 131.1 80.8 33.6 9.2 23.2 10.3 4.4 50.4 12.7 0.3 18.5 6.8 4.9 2.2 2.2 2.8 61.6 38.4
World Arabicas Brazil Colombia Other Americas Africa Asia and the Pacic Robustas Brazil Other Latin America Viet Nam Indonesia Other Asia and Pacic Cte dIvoire Uganda Other Africa Shares (%) Arabicas Robustas
Source: ICO and USDA. * Preliminary.
Note: Totals may not add up owing to rounding. For more up-to-date statistics visit www.ico.org.
Table 1.6
Domestic consumption in coffee producing countries, crop year 2010/11 (estimated) (000 bags) 5 181 317 3 383 8 328 1 800 3 333 1 080 1 583 27 501 19 130 1 400 2 354 1 650 41 010
EXPORTS
Exports of coffee in all forms from producing countries have varied signicantly from year to year, reecting, by and large, the variations in world production. See tables 1.5 and 1.7.
Africa of which: Cte dIvoire Ethiopia Asia and the Pacic of which: India Indonesia Philippines Viet Nam Latin America of which: Brazil Colombia Mexico Venezuela (Bolivarian Republic of) Total
Source: ICO and own estimates. Note: Figures are rounded up to the nearest 000.
Table 1.7
Overview of world exports by type, 2006/072010/11 (000 bags) Coffee years 2006/07 98 388 59 908 24 067 10 586 17 063 5 633 2 559 31 111 1 571 236 18 066 2 934 2 243 1 807 2 144 2 110 204 7 165 3 313 1 941 885 1 026 60.9 31.6 0.2 7.3 2007/08 96 032 57 854 22 303 10 846 17 248 5 131 2 326 30 541 2 025 107 15 751 4 696 1 991 1 423 2 711 1 837 287 7 350 3 508 2 142 525 1 175 60.3 31.8 0.2 7.7 2008/09 97 433 58 630 27 318 8 072 16 397 4 777 2 066 32 263 1 377 339 17 381 5 905 2 067 1 122 2 407 1 665 255 6 285 2 849 1 926 414 1 096 60.2 33.1 0.3 6.4 2009/10 92 521 56 202 26 540 6 533 15 317 4 953 2 859 29 191 1 082 253 14 578 5 320 2 576 1 819 1 960 1 603 223 6 905 3 162 1 965 270 1 508 60.7 31.5 0.3 7.5 2010/11* 105 000 64 025 29 603 7 817 17 803 6 231 2 571 33 277 2 127 329 17 105 4 880 4 059 955 2 116 1 706 200 7 498 3 142 2 206 310 1 840 61.0 31.7 0.2 7.1
Total exports Arabicas of which from: Brazil Colombia Other Latin America Africa Asia and the Pacic Robustas of which from: Brazil Other Latin America Viet Nam Indonesia Other Asia and the Pacic Cte dIvoire Uganda Other Africa Roasted coffee Soluble of which from: Brazil Other Latin America Africa Asia Shares (%) Arabicas Robustas Roasted Soluble
Source: ICO. *July/June.
Furthermore, stock verications ceased in 1989 with the suspension of the quota system and although the gures produced from the verication exercise were questionable, they were the product of a reasonably rigorous procedure. Since then the gures have been based on national estimates and there has been no independent verication of the accuracy or otherwise of these gures. As a result, published statistics are subject to frequent revisions, some of which are substantial going back over a number of years. A degree of caution is therefore necessary when using these gures in any analysis. See table 1.7.
consumption as they do not take into account re-exports or changes in the level of stocks held in importing countries. To overcome this the ICO publishes gures on disappearance that take these factors into account, but it is still impossible to allow for changes in the level of unreported stocks held by traders, roasters and retailers. For countries, which are members of the ICO and for a few non-member countries where the relevant statistics exist, the gures relate to disappearance, whereas for the rest of the non-member countries they relate to net imports. Strictly speaking the two sets of gures are not the same, but are close enough to be incorporated in the table 1.9.
CONSUMPTION TRENDS
It is estimated that global consumption in coffee year 2010/11 will total 130.9 million bags. Of this total, 69.4 million bags were consumed in importing ICO member countries, 20.5 million bags were consumed in non-member countries, and the remaining 41.0 million bags were consumed in producing countries. Consumption has grown by an average of around 1.2% a year since the early 1980s. Probably the most spectacular growth has been witnessed in Japan, where consumption has grown by around 3.5% a year over the same period, although it appears to have reached a plateau over the last 10 years. Japan is now the third largest importer of coffee in the world.
Table 1.8
Opening stocks by type, crop years 2006/072010/11 (000 bags) Coffee years 2006/07 28 343 21 323 16 503 855 2 292 1 168 505 7 020 4 737 8 500 129 992 282 264 108 75.2 24.8 2007/08 27 722 19 076 15 200 819 1 314 1 253 490 8 646 6 639 4 833 24 812 124 120 90 68.8 31.2 2008/09 19 463 14 361 11 294 366 1 021 1 315 365 5 102 3 336 3 526 45 660 458 20 54 73.4 26.6 2009/10 20 489 13 376 10 714 25 791 1 383 463 7 113 3 942 4 640 541 535 970 23 458 65.3 34.7 2010/11 18 461 11 838 8 486 27 910 2 193 222 6 623 2 592 6 2 716 573 97 418 11 210 64.1 35.9
World Arabicas of which from: Brazil Colombia Other Latin America Africa Asia and the Pacic Robustas of which from: Brazil Other Latin America Viet Nam Indonesia Other Asia and the Pacic Cte dIvoire Uganda Other Africa Shares (%) Arabicas Robustas
Source: ICO.
There has been very little growth in coffee consumption in Europe over the last ve years, with consumption showing signs of stagnation and possibly even decline. The situation is only slightly better in the United States, where overall consumption, despite the boom in the specialty sector, has remained virtually unaltered over the past ve years. The gures for consumption in non-ICO member countries suggest that there has been a surprisingly large upsurge
in consumption in these countries since the turn of the century. On average, consumption has grown by over 6% per annum, although the recent economic turmoil has reduced coffee consumption in many of these countries possibly only temporarily. However, these gures should be read with some caution, as the data for exports and hence consumption in these countries is not necessarily always collected from the same source.
Table 1.9
Consumption in importing countries/areas, 2006/072010/11 (000 bags) 2006/07 92 619 23 994 21 199 42 780 5 581 9 082 5 840 6 195 12 908 7 265 6 742 2007/08 93 568 24 501 21 423 42 340 5 331 9 912 5 918 7 211 13 780 7 150 5 736 2008/09 92 922 24 901 21 656 39 874 5 329 8 409 5 752 7 589 14 280 7 330 6 270 2009/10 91 392 24 624 21 332 40 651 5 562 9 554 5 743 6 586 13 564 6 909 5 967 2010/11* 89 859 24 060 20 473 39 182 5 632 8 584 5 760 7 030 13 745 6 680 5 842
Importing countries/areas World North America of which: United States Western Europe of which: France Germany Italy Eastern Europe Asia and the Pacic of which: Japan Others
Source: ICO. * Preliminary estimate.
In the past, most analysts worked on the basis that around 8 million bags were required as consumer-held working stock. However, the adoption of the just-in-time stock management system by most of the worlds major roasters, together with the improvement in logistics, has meant that the volume that probably should now be considered working stock has been reduced to maybe as low as 4 million bags. The gure below shows the evolution of inventories since 1990 together with the composite indicator price.
Figure 1.4 Total inventories in importing countries and prices, 1990-2010
30 000 25 000 Million bags 20 000 15 000 10 000 5 000 0 160 140 120 100 80 60 40 20 0
Total
Prices
Source: ICO.
10
PRICES
There is no single price for coffee because coffee, being a product of nature, is not a homogeneous product. However, broadly speaking the international coffee-pricing scene can be divided up as follows: Physicals prices for green or physical coffee; Indicators prices that track broad groups of comparable coffees; Futures that project prices forward for standard qualities; Differentials a system linking physical prices to futures prices. Day-to-day physical coffee prices are determined by supply and demand. Price setting criteria are mostly quality (what is the quality of a given coffee or origin), and availability (how much or how little is being offered of a particular type of coffee). This conrms that not all coffee is the same. In fact each parcel of coffee is unique with regard to its characteristics, avour and quality and hence attracts a different price. Of course other factors play a role as well, for example market expectations, speculative actions, changes in currency exchange rates and so on. However, by grouping more or less comparable types of coffee together, average prices can be calculated and even traded. ICO indicator prices, published daily by the International Coffee Organization in London, represent and track the four main types of coffee available in the international market: (i) Colombian mild arabicas, (ii) Other mild arabicas, (iii) Brazilian and other natural arabicas, and (iv) Robustas. These indicator prices represent spot or cash prices, quoted in the market for coffee that is more or less immediately available (or within a reasonable time-span). The four categories enable the ICO to calculate market prices for these four broad groups and so monitor price developments for each. In addition, using an agreed formula, the ICO publishes a Daily Composite Indicator Price that combines these four into a single price representing all coffee. This probably represents the best indication of a current international price for coffee. This and other price information, also historical, is freely available at www.ico.org. For an overview of the ICO indicator pricing system itself see www.ico.org/coffee_prices.asp. Futures prices reect the estimated future availability and demand for coffee as a whole. Go to www.theice.com for arabica coffee futures prices in New York, and to www. euronext.com for robusta coffee futures prices in London. See chapter 8 for details of what average quality of coffee these futures markets represent. Price charts depict past price behaviour on these markets a good source is found at www.futures.tradingcharts.com. However, as mentioned, the ICO price indicators (which track prices) and the futures markets (which project prices) by necessity only do so for generally known, standard qualities of coffee. Futures markets are used to offset price risk in the green coffee market where different qualities of
coffee are traded. Traders therefore link individual prices with the futures price by establishing a price difference, the differential. Briey, this differential takes into account (i) differences between an individual coffee and the standard quality on which the futures market is based, (ii) the physical availability of that coffee (plentiful or tight), and (iii) the terms and conditions on which it is offered for sale. An example follows. By combining the New York or London futures price and the differential, one usually obtains the FOB (free on board) price for a particular type of green coffee. This enables the market to simply quote, for example, Quality X from Country Y for October shipment at New York December plus 5 (US cts/lb). Traders and importers know the cost of shipping coffee from each origin to Europe, the United States, Japan or wherever, and so can easily transform plus 5 into a price landed nal destination. The study of physical coffee prices is complicated by the variability in the quality and appeal of individual coffees, making it extremely difcult to monitor the daily behaviour of differentials and physical prices. However, for general research purposes the price information available from the International Coffee Organization and the futures markets of New York and London often sufces. Nevertheless, it is important to appreciate that physical coffee price differentials can be extremely volatile and that at the moment there is no established mechanism or tool that allows exporters or indeed importers to hedge the risk inherent in physical coffee price differential volatility.
11
To see the entire list of country codes and more on ICO Certicates of Origin go to www.ico.org, look under Documents By meeting Rules, where you can trace ICC 102-9. Coffee years run from 1 October to 30 September individual shipment numbers recommence at 0001 every year. The system allows easy identication of individual bags: the country of origin, the exporter, and the shipment number for that exporter. For shipments in bulk (see chapter 5), the shipping marks, including the ICO numbers, are marked directly on the container liner, making them visible when the container doors are opened. The container number itself is marked on the ICO Certicate of Origin, thereby completing the link.
Collect and publish economic, technical and scientic information, statistics and studies; Provide a forum for the understanding of structural conditions in international markets and long term production and consumption trends that result in fair prices to both producers and consumers; Promote training and the transfer of technology relevant to coffee to members; Encourage members to develop appropriate food safety procedures in the coffee sector; Develop and seek nance for projects that benet members and the world coffee economy; Facilitate the availability of information on nancial tools and services that can assist coffee producers. The ICOs headquarters are to remain in London, unless the Council decides otherwise. The ICO will continue to maintain the system of indicator prices. Certicates of origin will continue to accompany all exports. The preamble acknowledges the exceptional importance of coffee to the economies of many countries and to the livelihoods of millions of people, as well as the contribution that a sustainable coffee sector can make to the achievement of the Millennium Development Goals. It also recognizes that collaboration between members can foster an economically diversied coffee sector and contribute to its development, as well as recognizing that increased access to coffee related information and market-based risk strategies can help avoid imbalances that give rise to market volatility, which is harmful to both producers and consumers. Key events in the history of the International Coffee Agreement (ICA). (Based primarily on F.O. Licht. International Coffee Report, vol. 15. No. 21. See also www.ico.org/ico/ history.htm.) 1963: First ICA comes into force at a time of low prices, regulating supplies through an export quota system. 1972: Export quotas suspended as prices soar. 1980: Export quotas restored and producers agree in return to abandon attempts to regulate the market unilaterally. February 1986: Quotas suspended after a boom caused by drought losses to Brazils crop sends prices soaring above the ceiling of the ICAs US$ 1.20US$ 1.40 target range. October 1987: Quotas reintroduced. 4 July 1989: Indenite suspension of quotas after the system breaks down under the pressure of competing demands from exporters for market shares under the new ICA then being negotiated. Backed by the United States, Central American states and Mexico press for a much bigger slice of the market at the expense of Brazil (which resists this) and of African producers.
12
4 September 1989: Then-Colombian President Virgilio Barco writes to United States President George Bush appealing for help to bring back export quotas under a new ICA and receives an encouraging response on 19 September. 1 October 1989: ICA extension with its economic clauses suppressed takes effect. February 1990: President Bush at a Latin American drugs summit in Colombia reafrms commitment to a new ICA and a document is released setting out the Administrations thinking on its possible shape. December 1991: During talks with Cesar Gaviria (Colombias new President) Brazilian President Fernando Collor de Mello (elected in March 1990), agrees in principle to back efforts to restore quotas when the local industry given the lead role in formulating policy can agree a common position. March 1992: Brazil nally gives the go-ahead to the negotiation of a new ICA with economic clauses. June 1992: First round of the negotiations. 9 March 1993: Bill Clinton, victor in the November 1992 United States presidential elections, writes to President Gaviria supporting a new ICA, although with no sign of much enthusiasm. 31 March 1993: ICA negotiations collapse during the sixth round with little progress having been made and each side blaming the other for the impasse. September 1993: In Brazil, 29 countries sign a treaty establishing the Association of Coffee Producing Countries (ACPC) with powers to regulate supplies and prices. Citing this as a reason, the United States pulls out of the ICO.
September 1994: New administrative ICA without economic clauses (drafted in March) enters into force for ve years. March 1998: First talks open about the possibility of replacing the 1994 ICA. July 1999: ICA talks break down. September 1999: 1994 ICA extended for a further two years. During the rst year, it is agreed a further attempt will be made to draw up a replacement treaty. September 2000: Drafting of a new ICA completed. October 2001: ICA 2001 enters into force for six years. It has no provisions for price regulation. February 2005: The United States returns to full membership. January 2006: Negotiations to replace the ICA 2001 begin September 2007: A new 10-year International Coffee Agreement is approved and the 2001 ICA is extended, initially for one year, to enable ratication procedures to be completed. September 2010: The 2007 ICA is extended for a fourth year to provide further time for participating countries to complete their ratication procedures. September 2010: Japan ofcially withdraws from the Agreement. 2 February 2011: ICA 2007 nally comes into force.
Table 1.10 Membership of the ICO Exporting members Angola Brazil Burundi Central African Republic Colombia Costa Rica Cte d'Ivoire Cuba Ecuador El Salvador Ethiopia Gabon Ghana Guatemala Honduras India Indonesia Kenya Liberia Mexico Nicaragua Panama Papua New Guinea Philippines Sierre Leone Thailand Timor-Leste Togo Uganda United Republic of Tanzania Viet Nam Yemen Zambia Importing members European Community Austria Belgium/Luxembourg Bulgaria Cyprus Czech Republic Denmark Estonia Finland France Germany Greece Hungary Ireland Italy Latvia Lithuania Malta Netherlands Poland Portugal Romania Slovakia Slovenia Spain Sweden United Kingdom Norway Switzerland Tunisia Turkey United States of America
There are 11 countries (Benin, Bolivia (Plurinational State of), Cameroon, Democratic Republic of the Congo, Guinea, Madagascar, Malawi, Nigeria, Paraguay, Rwanda and Zimbabwe) which have all signed the new Agreement but had not completed the required procedures for full membership by November 2011.
13
Table 1.11 World production by country, 1995/962010/11 (000 bags) Average 1996/97 2000/01 TOTAL Arabica group North America Costa Rica Cuba Dominican Republic El Salvador Guatemala Haiti Honduras Jamaica Mexico Nicaragua Panama United States South America Bolivia (Plurinational State of) Brazil Colombia Ecuador Paraguay Peru Venezuela (Bolivarian Republic of) Africa Burundi Cameroon Democratic Republic of the Congo Ethiopia Kenya Malawi Madagascar Rwanda Uganda United Republic of Tanzania Zambia Zimbabwe Asia and the Pacic India Indonesia Lao Peoples Democratic Republic Papua New Guinea Philippines Sri Lanka Timor-Leste Yemen Robusta group America Brazil Ecuador Guatemala Guyana Trinidad and Tobago 106 623 70 757 20 034 2 347 306 641 2 241 4 653 433 2 379 42 5 472 1 127 190 203 40 117 170 25 074 11 102 539 30 2 203 999 6 538 363 133 88 3 224 1 297 64 44 261 340 525 52 147 4 068 1 855 790 145 1 138 54 7 n.a. 79 35 866 5 574 4 924 610 14 9 17 2001/02 2005/06 113 423 73 816 16 717 1 882 231 404 1 503 3 738 374 2 856 33 4 076 1 313 148 160 45 608 146 29 241 11 705 540 33 2 929 1 014 7 061 337 80 91 4 158 903 41 28 321 412 496 98 97 4 458 1 934 839 458 883 139 13 n.a. 193 39 578 7 965 7 600 325 24 3 14 2006/07 2010/11 128 257 78 364 17 542 1 544 108 498 1 489 3 855 347 3 714 30 4 240 1 520 159 129 47 320 141 30 510 10 382 492 24 3 658 1 114 8 924 279 84 63 6 170 727 19 29 317 598 573 37 29 4 486 1 563 1 677 50 959 35 10 39 193 49 892 11 416 11 021 377 10 3 5 2006/07 127 048 77 317 17 089 1 580 92 406 1 371 3 950 361 3 461 40 4 200 1 300 173 154 47 725 148 29 056 12 541 695 24 3 691 1 571 8 329 298 92 60 5 551 826 18 30 307 540 512 57 38 4 174 1 754 1 263 50 863 35 9 46 200 49 731 10 705 10 236 444 10 3 12 2007/08 127 835 80 110 18 504 1 791 84 510 1 621 4 100 359 3 842 20 4 150 1 700 176 151 48 459 137 30 290 12 504 515 25 3 468 1 520 8 725 299 87 67 5 967 652 21 30 291 650 578 55 28 4 422 1 561 1 628 50 988 35 10 36 150 47 725 11 142 10 742 386 10 3 1 Coffee years 2008/09 126 664 75 813 17 777 1 320 126 609 1 547 3 785 357 3 450 32 4 651 1 615 153 133 45 907 139 32 175 8 664 384 21 3 594 930 7 669 274 82 64 4 949 572 16 30 307 640 676 33 26 4 460 1 311 1 899 50 1 005 35 10 48 150 50 851 10 940 10 557 369 10 3 1 2009/10 128 610 77 820 16 674 1 462 115 463 1 065 3 500 350 3 527 30 4 200 1 686 170 106 46 564 141 32 454 9 000 437 25 3 657 850 9 613 230 76 68 6 931 750 20 30 350 600 494 26 38 4 969 1 593 2 139 50 992 35 10 47 150 50 790 11 324 10 881 420 10 3 10 2010/11* 131 144 80 778 18 148 1 589 122 500 1 840 3 950 307 4 290 30 4 000 1 300 120 100 47 946 139 33 577 9 200 427 23 3 880 700 10 279 293 83 56 7 450 833 19 25 328 560 603 15 14 4 405 1 595 1 457 50 945 33 10 64 315 50 366 12 967 12 691 264 10 2 0
14
Average 1996/97 2000/01 Africa Angola Benin Cameroon Central African Rep. Congo Cte d'Ivoire Democratic Republic of the Congo Gabon Ghana Guinea Liberia Madagascar Nigeria Sierra Leone Togo Uganda United Republic of Tanzania Asia and the Pacic India Indonesia Lao Peoples Democratic Republic Malaysia New Caledonia Papua New Guinea Philippines Sri Lanka Thailand Viet Nam
Source: ICO and USDA. * Provisional. n.a. = not available.
Coffee years 2006/07 2010/11 7504 30 0 680 82 3 2 370 330 1 26 403 29 584 45 54 157 2 392 319 30 973 3 100 7 346 375 716 1 20 417370 31 755 18 161 2006/07 7 860 35 0 744 87 3 2 847 317 1 29 473 53 587 51 31 134 2 160 307 31 167 3 404 6 367 400 500 1 25 331 33 766 19 340 2007/08 7 908 37 0 708 70 3 2 598 349 0 31 323 40 614 42 42 125 2 600 326 28 675 2 899 6 937 350 930 1 10 394 33 653 16 467 2008/09 7 856 26 0 667 79 3 2 353 335 1 27 394 30 726 51 87 138 2 560 380 32 055 3 060 8 093 350 952 1 10 382 32 675 18 500 2009/10 6 689 24 0 614 75 3 1 850 357 1 25 375 10 467 40 30 140 2 400 278 3 277 3 234 8 553 350 1 000 1 10 669 30 930 18 000 2010/11* 7 208 29 0 668 100 2 2 200 294 0 20 450 10 523 40 80 250 2 240 302 30 191 3 389 6 778 425 200 1 45 76 25 752 18 500
2001/02 2005/06 7 390 32 0 710 62 3 2 591 315 1 17 281 19 461 49 26 129 2 405 285 24 223 2 724 5 665 163 810 1 21 498 31 789 13 521
10 340 59 0 1 174 191 5 3 864 666 3 39 139 5 644 52 45 286 2 949 219 19 952 2 756 6 286 73 160 9 59 746 35 1 252 8 576
CHAPTER 2
THE STRUCTURE OF THE COFFEE TRADE .......................................................................................................16 STRUCTURE OF THE RETAIL MARKET ...............................................................................................................17 DEMAND .................................................................................................................................................................18 DEMAND BY GEOGRAPHICAL AREA..................................................................................................................20 FACTORS INFLUENCING DEMAND ....................................................................................................................28 LIFESTYLE, DIET AND COMPETING DRINKS ....................................................................................................28 ADDING VALUE AN OVERVIEW ........................................................................................................................29 TRADE PRICES, INVESTMENT COSTS AND TARIFFS ......................................................................................33 PROMOTING COFFEE CONSUMPTION .............................................................................................................35
16
Essentially, the coffee trade assists the ow of coffee from the exporting country to the roaster. Traders and dealers take responsibility for discharging the coffee from the incoming vessel and make all the necessary arrangements to have the coffee delivered to the roaster. Using the futures markets either for hedging or as a price guide, traders offer and provide roasters spreads of physical coffee for shipment one month to 18 months in the future. Many of these sales, especially for later shipment positions, are short sales: the seller will source the required green coffee at a later date. Such positions are typically sold at a premium or a discount (the differential) against the price of the appropriate delivery month on the London or New York futures markets (selling price to be xed PTBF see chapters 8 and 9 on futures markets and trading). This gives the roaster the right to x the price for each individual shipping position at their option, usually up to the rst delivery day of the relevant month. Some roasters might want a separate contract for each position, while others might have a single contract for six positions, for example July through December. Obviously selling so far ahead carries considerable risk. In some cases the coffee may not even have been harvested yet. To reduce their exposure, traders sometimes offer such forward positions as deliveries of a basket of acceptable coffees rather than committing to a single growth. This is becoming less common today than it was in the past, but it remains a signicant feature of the trade in many parts of the world. Typical examples of such baskets are given below. Guatemala prime washed, and/or El Salvador central standard, and/or Costa Rica hard bean, versus the appropriate delivery months of the New York futures market. Uganda standard grade, and/or Cte dIvoire grade 2, and/or Indian robusta AB/PB/EPB grades, versus the appropriate delivery months of the London futures market. These baskets represent coffees that are acceptable for the same purpose in many blends of roasted coffee; traders can full their delivery obligations by providing one of the specied growths. Any shipment would, however, still be subject to the roasters nal approval of the quality. Not all coffee is always immediately sold to a roaster. Before arrival an individual parcel of coffee may be traded several times before it is eventually sold to a roaster. This trading in physical coffee should not be confused with trading coffee contracts on the futures exchanges and terminal markets. Given the variability of supply, the coffee market is inherently unstable and is characterized by wide uctuations in price. The futures market therefore plays an important role in the coffee trade, as it does with other commodities, by acting
14 12 Million bags 10 8 6 4 2 0
The structure of the coffee trade in North America, most of Western Europe and Japan is very similar. Coffee is generally purchased from the exporting countries by international trade houses, dealers and traders. The very largest roasters in Europe also maintain their own in-house buying companies, which deal directly with origin. In the main, however, roasters tend to buy their coffee from international trade houses or from specialized import agents who represent specic exporters in producing countries. The international trade plays a vital role in the worldwide marketing and distribution of coffee. Coffee is generally sold FOB (free on board), but many roasters, especially in the United States, prefer to buy on an ex-dock basis. Small roasters often prefer to buy in small lots on a delivered in-store or ex-store basis. This allows plenty of scope for the various middlemen involved in the trade to operate and perform useful functions, although the increasing concentration at the roasting end of the industry has led to a substantial reduction in their number.
17
as the institution that transfers the risk of price movements to speculators and helps to establish price levels. These markets do not handle signicant quantities of physical coffee, although dealers do occasionally deliver coffee or take delivery of coffee in respect of contracts that have not been closed out. Participants in the industry use the futures markets primarily for hedging. The structure of the trade in other importing countries is broadly similar, although naturally there are variations. In some countries, such as the Nordic countries, there are no main traders or importers as such, but rather just roasters and brokers/agents. In others, such as in Eastern Europe, importers either import directly or increasingly via the international trade houses based in the main coffee centres of Hamburg, Antwerp, Le Havre and Trieste.
The United States market will of course continue to purchase in dollars and many, if not all, origins will oblige. If elsewhere coffee were traded in a different currency, this might possibly distort prices and add currency-based arbitrage to an already quite speculative coffee trade. One should also bear in mind that buyers will always protect themselves. If having to buy in a different currency means more risk or a disadvantage, then this will be priced into the transaction. Therefore, it is difcult for individual exporters or smaller producing countries to pursue this unless such a change was in the context of a general industry move, triggered by some external event or situation.
18
consumption generally account for 70% to 80% of the overall market. There are exceptions, especially in countries where there is a well-established catering trade and eating out is part of the countrys traditions, for example in Italy, Spain and Greece. Each segment accepts a wide range of products, the quality and taste of which depend largely upon the coffee growths that make up the blends, the degree of roast, the type of grind, and so on. Most small roasters tend to specialize in one segment, while larger and in particular multinational roasters usually service both. The major part of the retail market is, however, controlled by a handful of huge multinational roasters and the degree of concentration is increasing. Although this trend was temporarily halted by the growth in the specialty trade, it is once again accelerating with the rapid acquisition of small specialty roasters by the multinationals.
Figure 2.2 Leading coffee roasting companies worldwide, 2010
13.5 12.8 8.5 5.5 2.0 1.9 1.8 3.5 2.8
DEMAND
Coffee is one of the worlds most popular beverages. Gross imports of all types of coffee have quadrupled from 33 million bags in 1949 to 132 million bags in 2010. However, statistics on gross imports are a poor indicator of demand as they ignore re-exports. In 2010 re-exports accounted for some 38.9 million bags, although in the past they were not as important as they are today. Data on re-exports is not available prior to 1964, but gure 2.3 shows the growth in gross exports since 1949 and in total net imports since 1963. Net imports reect what is consumed in the country of importation plus any surplus that goes into inventories. A more accurate indicator of consumption is provided by statistics on disappearance, which take into account reexports and changes in the level of stocks held in importing countries. Table 2.1 shows world gross imports, net imports, disappearance and inventories by form of coffee over the period 20052010.
Figure 2.3 World coffee imports, 19492010
Million bag gs
M Million bags
2.7
2.4
Table 2.1
World gross and net imports, disappearance and inventories by form of coffee, 20052010 (in millions of bags) 2005 2006 121.7 93.3 12.3 16.1 30.6 8.9 11.6 10.1 91.1 84.4 0.7 6.0 90.2 19.1 2007 126.5 95.9 12.9 17.7 32.9 9.4 12.4 11.1 93.6 86.5 0.5 6.5 93.1 21.1 2008 130.1 98.2 14.0 17.9 35.6 11.7 13.6 10.4 94.5 86.5 0.4 7.5 94.8 21.4 2009 127.4 97.3 14.0 16.1 36.1 11.2 14.0 10.9 91.3 86.1 0.0 5.2 92.3 22.4 2010 131.6 99.4 15.2 17.0 38.8 12.2 15.1 11.5 92.8 87.2 0.1 5.5 93.6 18.4
A.
Gross imports Green Roasted Soluble Gross re-exports Green Roasted Soluble Net imports Green Roasted Soluble
116.3 89.7 10.9 15.7 28.9 8.3 10.4 10.2 87.4 81.4 0.5 5.5 88.2 20.2
B.
C.
19
2000 to 31.1 million bags in 2010, although as a percentage of overall consumption it has remained relatively at.
Figure 2.4 Consumption of soluble coffee 2000, 2005 and 2010
35 30 25 Million bags 20 15 10 5 0 Western Europe North America Japan Total Producing World total importing countries countries 2000 2005 2010
In Europe, growth in demand has been relatively modest at around 0.2% a year in recent years, which is considerably slower than the overall growth in consumption for all types of coffee. In the United Kingdom, where soluble coffee accounts for around 75% of total consumption, demand was beginning to show signs of actual decline, but has been revitalized in recent years by the growing interest in speciality instant coffees (such as instant cappuccino). Elsewhere in Europe, however, the introduction of new specialty instant coffee products also increased demand for soluble coffee, but the trend appears to have been short lived. The Deutscher Kaffeeverband estimate that the instant coffee share of demand in Germany rose from 6.2% to over 7.5% between 1998 and 2005 reecting this surge in demand for these speciality instant products, only to fall back to 4.1% in 2010. Much of the recent growth in soluble coffee consumption can be attributed to a rise in demand in Eastern Europe, and East and South-East Asia both regions where soluble coffee enjoys a high market share. In East and South-East Asia there has been tremendous growth in the demand for the product known as 3-in-1, a beverage that combines the convenience of soluble coffee with a non-dairy creamer and sugar, usually in single-serve sachets purchased one at a time. In 2010, just under 70% of the soluble coffee consumed in importing countries was processed into soluble coffee in those countries. The corresponding gure in 2000 was 83%, which suggests that producing countries may be seeing a signicant increase in their share of the soluble coffee market in importing countries. Imports of soluble coffee are often referred to as offshore powder. Consumption of instant coffee in producing countries themselves varies considerably. In the Philippines and Thailand instant coffee accounts for around 95% of coffee consumption. In Brazil, the largest exporter of soluble coffee, domestic consumption of instant coffee only accounts for around 5% of overall coffee consumption. In India most soluble coffee is also exported, although it does account for around 35% of local consumption. In Mexico the gure is about 47%.
20
Globally, Nestl and Kraft Foods account for just under 75% of the world market, with Nestl alone supplying around half the world demand for instant coffee.
DECAFFEINATED COFFEE
Decaffeinated coffee was developed in Europe, but achieved its rst broad market in the United States during the 1950s. World consumption of decaffeinated coffee is difcult to gauge owing to the lack of separate data on this type of coffee in many importing countries. In the United States, consumption of decaffeinated coffee was relatively stable from 2000 to 2005, accounting for 8% 9% of mainstream sales and about 20% of sales of specialty coffee. Sales thereafter increased signicantly, but fell back to 13% in 2011 (from 16% in 2009) according to the latest NCA Coffee Drinking Study. Consumption of decaffeinated coffee has been fairly static elsewhere since 2000, and in many countries low-caffeine coffee products are now an established part of the manufacturers range. These products are not caffeine free, but are either a mixture of regular coffee and decaffeinated coffee or blends of coffees with a naturally low caffeine content. These products are sold as light coffee.
Table 2.2 Consumption of decaffeinated coffee as a percentage of total consumption, 2010 % 7 4 8 Low 8 6 1 7 7 1 Italy Japan Netherlands Norway Portugal Spain Sweden Switzerland United Kingdom United States Country % 7 Low 12 Low 4 16 Low 4 10 13
arabicas towards Natural arabicas and robustas. A signicant proportion of this shifting supply pattern can be put down to changes in the availability and origin of supply and in particular to supply problems in Colombia and Central America but higher prices particularly in the last two to three years has accelerated the switch to these other coffees. In 2005, 48% of United States imports of green coffee from producing countries came from the Colombian Milds and Other Milds groups. By 2010 this was down to just 43%. Imports from Brazil vary from year to year and in 2010 increased to over 28% of green bean imports from 21% in 2005, while imports of robusta coffee (including estimated imports of robusta from Brazil) have increased marginally from just over 25% in 2005 to 27% in 2010. There is no doubt that the initial increase in the use of robusta reected the greater consumption of espresso blends containing robusta coffee, as well as its incorporation in many of the mainstream blends as a means of keeping prices lower. However, the somewhat constrained increase in robusta use is thought by some analysts to reect consumer resistance to the altered taste prole that the greater use of robusta created. Roast and ground (or regular) coffee: Over 85% of the coffee sold for home consumption is roast and ground coffee. By 2011, 85% of total consumption, based on cups consumed per person per day, takes place at home. According to the National Coffee Association of USA the drip coffee maker dominates American coffee preparation, although the single-cup brewing systems are growing. Specialty coffee: This sector has transformed and improved the image of coffee in the eyes of the American consumer. In 1991 it was estimated that there were just 500 gourmet or specialty coffeehouses, yet by 2010 there were an estimated 10,000-plus. This number excludes other coffee venues such as coffee carts, kiosks, vending machines and cafes in bookstores, sporting arenas and transportation facilities, which have also seen an explosion in numbers. Even so, brewed coffee remains the most popular type of coffee consumed in the United States in 2011, accounting for 92 out of every 100 cups of coffee consumed up from 85 cups per 100 in 2010. This reects the surge in the adoption of home-use single-cup lter brewing systems. Soluble coffee consumption on the other hand, which had witnessed something of a resurgence, now appears to be in decline and in 2011 accounted for around eight cups per 100 down from 11 cups in 2010. Similarly gourmet or specialty coffee beverages (both roasted and instant) appears to be in decline, accounting for 36 cups per 100 cups consumed in 2011, which is down from the 40 cups per 100 recorded in 2010, possibly reecting consumer reaction to the downturn in global economic activity. The coffee sector in the United States has undergone radical change in the last decade. Following the acquisition of Folgers and a sizable portion of Sara Lee/DE in the United States, J.M. Smucker is now the largest coffee roasted and manufacturer in America followed by Kraft Foods.
Country Australia Austria Belgium/Luxembourg Brazil Canada Denmark Finland France Germany Greece
21
Table 2.3
Country
United States
20.68
Canada
34
2.14
0.91
0.53
6.3
Source: ICO and other trade sources. Note: Green bean equivalents are used for roasted, soluble and per capita consumption gures.
Canada
The coffee market in Canada is estimated to have increased at a compound annual growth rate of 3.1% since 2004 with Kraft being the leading roaster. The market is fairly fragmented with a large number of smaller roasters, but is beginning to consolidate following a number of highprole mergers and acquisitions. Roast and ground coffee accounts for 72% of the total market.
individual EU member country statistics must, therefore, be treated with some caution. After deducting intra-EU trade, net total green bean imports into EU for 2010 work out at some 45.9 million bags. The ve largest suppliers were Brazil (33%), Viet Nam (20%), Indonesia (6%), Honduras (6%) and Peru (5%). Sustainability: Since 2003, the European industry has been working on a comprehensive concept to mainstream coffee on its way to sustainability, through an initiative known as the Common Code for the Coffee Community or 4C. This aims at establishing a scheme of continuous improvement of the social, ecological and economic principles in the production, processing and trading of mainstream coffee (which constitutes between 80%90% of all coffee traded). The 4C Association was formally established in early 2007 with its secretariat in Bonn, Germany. The rst 4C coffee became available in October 2007. See www.4c-coffeeassociation. org. Speciality: Although many Western European countries have traditionally consumed high-quality coffees, in recent years the speciality concept has gained considerable acceptance amongst European consumers. See also chapter 3, Niche markets, and www.scae.com. Summary data on the coffee imports of individual EU countries plus selected other European countries is shown in table 2.4. In this context, green coffee means not-decaffeinated and from all sources so also from other European countries. Green bean imports are identied by country of origin, but not all was necessarily imported directly from origin. The source for most import/export data for the EU countries that were members as at 31 December 2010, as well as for Norway and Switzerland, is the European Coffee Federations European Coffee Report 20102011, which itself draws on data provided by Eurostat and member associations. Other data are taken ex ICO and other trade statistics. Luxembourgs coffee statistics are combined with those for Belgium, although it is an EU member. The full ECF 2010 2011 Coffee Report and earlier issues can be viewed and downloaded from www.ecf-coffee.org.
EUROPE
The European Union has 27 member states with a population of 500 million. According to the European Commission, the EU is the largest barrier-free market in the world, bigger than the United States, Canada and Mexico together. In terms of green coffee imports, the 27 EU member states accounted for an estimated 51.3 million bags in 2010 (European Coffee Federation data), including intra-EU trade, and 45.9 million bags excluding intra-EU trade. The ICOs gures are 52.2 million bags and 46.9 million bags respectively. One consequence of the EUs single market is that there is no intra-EU import or export, only movement of goods. This is more than just terminology. It means that the vast majority of imports are declared at the point of entry into the EU and not at the point of destination. This tends to increase gross import gures for those countries with the major points of importation (in essence, the major ports). At the same time, the single market means that the earlier documentary requirements for cross-border trafc no longer exist. Operators are required to report cross-border trafc to the statistical bodies, but only above a certain value and/or volume. Eurostat, the EU statistical ofce, has developed models to extrapolate total intra-EU movement of goods on the basis of the reported data, but these models have their limitations. For these reasons, data on the movement of green as well as nished coffee within the EU have inevitably become less accurate. However, not only do many of the statistics for individual EU country coffee imports produced by both the EU authorities and the ICO not always present the total picture, but there are also differences between them. Most
22
Table 2.4
Country
European Union
Austria 8.4
0.55
0.25
0.11
Brazil 24% Viet Nam 22% Honduras 7% Unidentied via Germany 22% Brazil 28% Viet Nam 16% Honduras 10% Peru 7% Viet Nam 25% Indonesia 22% Brazil 10% Honduras 9% Brazil 92%
6.4
Germany is Austrias main trading partner in processed coffee taking 62% of its imports of processed coffee from Germany, but reexporting 30% of its output back to Germany. One roaster, Sara Lee / DE, accounts for around half of the market. Belgium also has many small roasters, particularly in the specialty sector. 99% of roasted coffee imports were ex EU sources, as were 69% of soluble imports. 98% of soluble imports were ex EU sources, as were 87% of roasted coffee imports. 99% of roasted coffee imports were ex EU sources, as were 87% of soluble imports. Imports of roasted coffee were almost exclusively ex EU sources with 77% coming from Sweden. The EU accounted for 82% of soluble imports. 92% of its green coffee imports are re-exported to the Russian Federation, similarly 40% of its reexports of soluble coffee go to the Russian Federation. Four roasters account for around 97% of the market; 96% of its imports are arabica and 4% robusta. Kraft Foods and Sara Lee/DE account for 60% or more of the roast coffee market by volume. Nestl accounts for almost two-thirds of the soluble market. Two roasters, Kraft Foods and Tchibo, account for about 55% of the market. The market share of single serve pods and espresso coffee now accounts for 21% of the overall market. Soluble coffee accounts for just over 45% of the market. 99% of roast coffee imports and 74% of soluble coffee imports come from EU countries. India and Brazil apart, soluble imports were almost exclusively ex EU sources.
Belgium/ Luxembourg
11
1.60
-0.37
-0.12
5.9
Bulgaria
7.5
0.38
-0.04
0.54
3.2
Cyprus
0.9
0.03
0.01
0.04
5.0
10
0.32
0.08
0.07
Brazil 27% Viet Nam 16% Indonesia 14% Brazil 14% Viet Nam 6% Uganda 5% Unidentied via Germany 55% Viet Nam 24% Brazil 20% Indonesia 12% Uganda 11% Brazil 45% Colombia 10% Nicaragua 7% Guatemala 6% Brazil 21% Viet Nam 11% Ethiopia 5% Honduras 4% Brazil 35% Viet Nam 19% Peru 7% Honduras 6%
2.7
5.5
0.66
0.11
0.09
9.5
Estonia
1.3
0.01
0.08
0.02
4.7
Finland
5.4
1.10
-0.06
0.04
12.1
France
63
4.28
1.62
-0.03
5.7
Germany
82
12.69
-2.24
-1.39
6.8
Greece
11
0.40
0.15
0.45
5.3
Hungary
10
0.21
0.09
0.09
All imports of green coffee come via the EU with Germany accounting for 92% of these imports
2.3
23
Country Ireland
Net imports (million bags) Green beans Roasted 0.02 Soluble 0.09
Main suppliers (green bean) Nicaragua 6% Colombia 5% Indonesia 5% unidentied via the United Kingdom 60% Brazil 34% Viet Nam 19% India 13% Indonesia 6%
Additional information Over two-thirds of total imports are processed coffee, 63% of which comes from the United Kingdom.
0.04
Italy
60
7.71
-2.06
0.15
5.8
Five roasters, of which Lavazza is the largest, account for around 70% of the market. The single serve segment, which is growing by 20% per annum, is changing the dynamics of the market. Italy re-exports 28% of what its imports reecting its success in marketing Italian espresso brands overseas. 99% of its imports of roasted coffee and 62% of its imports of soluble coffee come from the EU.
Latvia
2.2
0.05
0.02
0.03
Virtually all imports of green coffee come via the EU with 80% from Germany Virtually all imports of green coffee come via the EU with Germany accounting for 64% of these imports Indonesia 40% Costa Rica 40%
2.6
Lithuania
3.3
0.01
0.20
0.02
4.1
84% of re-exports of roasted coffee and 58% of re-exports of soluble coffee go to other EU countries, most notably Latvia.
Malta
0.4
0.00
0.01
0.01
1.8
Green bean imports are less than 1,000 bags and virtually no re-exports recorded. ECF data puts imports of green coffee almost double that of the ICO at 1.91 million bags, reecting the problems of collecting accurate import data for individual EU countries. 99% of its roasted coffee imports and 65% of its imports of soluble coffee originate in the EU.
Netherlands
17
0.99
0.22
0.12
4.8
Poland
38
1.65
-0.17
0.61
Viet Nam 4% Lao People's Democratic Republic 3% Unidentied via Germany 83% Viet Nam 19% Brazil 15% Uganda 10% Cameroon 9% Viet Nam 29% Indonesia 14% Brazil 13% Uganda 8% Brazil 27% Viet Nam 24% Ethiopia 17%
3.3
Portugal
11
0.76
-0.08
0.08
4.1
Nestls market share is around 33%, with approximately 70 roasters covering the balance, many operating in small, local niche markets. Over 99% of its imports of roasted coffee and 58% of its imports of soluble coffee are from the EU. Over half of its imports of roasted coffee is re-exported mainly to EU destinations; similarly 59% of its imports of soluble coffee are also re-exported mainly to the Czech Republic.
Romania
21
0.36
0.30
0.14
2.2
Slovakia
5.4
0.06
0.25
0.04
3.7
24
Country Slovenia
Net imports (million bags) Green beans Roasted 0.04 Soluble 0.03
Main suppliers (green bean) Brazil 46% Viet Nam 22% India 6% Unidentied via Italy 11% Viet Nam 35% Brazil 21% Uganda 6% Colombia 5% Brazil 44% Peru 10% Colombia 8% Ethiopia 7% Kenya 7% Viet Nam 19% Brazil 16% Indonesia 15% Colombia 12%
Additional information 72% of its imports of soluble coffee come from Austria, while 50% of its roasted coffee imports come from Italy. The top three roasters control about 60% of the market. Some 300 smaller roasters cover the remainder and dominate the out-of-home market, where espresso is in high demand. Dominating roasters are Kraft Foods with about 40% of the market, Zoegas 20%, Lofbergs Lila 15% and Arvid Nordquist 10%. A small number of roasters share the balance. Soluble coffee accounts for around 80% of the market, but tea still dominates the hot beverage market. Nestl accounts for around 50% of the soluble coffee market; Kraft Foods just over 20%. Almost 85% of the market is shared by six roasters, some of which are also importers. Roasted coffee is expanding rapidly and accounted for 29% of the market in 2010, but soluble still dominates; 40% of the instant coffee consumed in the Russian Federation is produced locally. The main roaster, Migros, accounts for around 45% of the market. The reexport of processed coffee continues to grow strongly with both roasted coffee and soluble coffee growing by around 20% over the year.
0.14
Spain
45
4.02
0.17
-0.95
4.3
Sweden
9.3
1.66
-0.46
0.01
7.9
United Kingdom
62
2.21
0.55
0.34
3.0
0.59
0.08
0.07
Brazil 46% Colombia 17% Guatemala 12% Viet Nam 37% Brazil 30% Indonesia 11%
9.2
Russian Federation
142
1.44
0.15
2.07
1.6
Switzerland
7.7
1.99
-0.48
-0.50
8.0
Source: ICO, ECF and other trade sources. Note: Green bean equivalents are used for roasted, soluble and per capita consumption gures.
Data on Eastern European countries mostly originate from the ICO and F.O. Lichts International Coffee Report.
25
However, over the last 10 years or so there has also been an explosion in the number of new American-style coffee bars opening up in all the major cities. Starbucks alone has opened more than 470 new shops in different cities throughout China since 1999, and other similar companies have also been expanding at the same rate. As a result, coffee is acquiring a more modern image and is becoming a very popular beverage with the young.
the explosion of speciality coffee shops, both local and overseas owned, and a denite shift towards espressobased coffee has helped to push consumption ahead very positively by around 7% annually over the past four years. Nevertheless, instant coffee still accounts for 85% of the total market, which a recent survey put at 22.8 billion cups of coffee or 452 cups for every Korean per year.
Japan
Demand for coffee continues to grow in Japan with average weekly consumption amounting to 10.9 cups in 2010 up from 10.0 cups in 2002. Instant coffee remains the most popular form of coffee accounting for 4.8 cups per week, while roasted coffee accounts for 3.3 cups, canned coffee 1.9 cups and liquid coffee 1.0 cups.
Republic of Korea
The Republic of Korea has had a thriving coffee market for a number of years based primarily on instant coffee, but
Table 2.5
Country Australia
China
1 338
0.08
0.09
0.13
0.03
Almost all production is exported, mainly to Germany and Japan. The United States is largest supplier of roasted coffee, 30%; Malaysia largest in soluble coffee, 32%. Consumption: 700 000 bags (est.).
Japan
127
6.84
0.11
0.31
3.4
Instant coffee sector is dominated by Nestl, 60%, and Ajinomoto, 30%. Largest suppliers of roasted coffee are UCC and Key Coffee.
Malaysia exports 1.8 million bags of instant coffee a year to the Philippines 34%, Singapore 21% and Indonesia 10%.
Malaysia
28
0.99
0.01
-1.49
1.3
New Zealand
4.4
0.16
0.08
0.09
3.5
Instant coffee dominates the market. Nestl accounts for +40% of all coffee sales.
Republic of Korea
49
1.73
0.08
-0.14
2.0
Exports of instant coffee exceed 278,000 bags to China 29%, Israel 14%, Russian Federation 13% and Australia 10%.
Source: ICO and other trade data. Note: Green bean equivalents are used for roasted, soluble and per capita consumption gures.
26
Table 2.6
Country Algeria
2.01
Argentina
40
0.50
0.01
0.9
Israel
7.6
0.45
0.03
4.4
Morocco
32
0.55
0.01
-0.09 Indonesia 25% Viet Nam 25% Guinea 17% Uganda 10% 0.03 Brazil 64% Viet Nam 18% India 10%
0.9
Serbia
7.3
0.51
0.01
4.0
South Africa
50
0.40
0.02
0.7
Tunisia
11
0.25
<0.01
0.05 Brazil 40% Cameroon 31% Viet Nam 11% Indonesia 10% 0.28 Brazil 98%
1.7
Turkey
73
0.30
0.02
0.5
Ukraine
46
0.10
0.29
1.9
Source: ICO and other trade data. Note: Green bean equivalents are used for roasted, soluble and per capita consumption gures.
27
PRODUCING COUNTRIES
Domestic consumption in producing countries is estimated to have totalled 41 million bags in 2010 up from just over 26 million bags in 2001. The bulk of this increase is attributed to growth in the internal market in Brazil, which is not only the worlds largest coffee producer, but also the worlds second-largest consumer, accounting for 19 million bags in 2010. The structure of Brazils domestic industry is relatively diverse, characterized by a large number of small to medium-sized roasters, possibly as many as 1,400. Nevertheless, concentration is a continuing process. The top ve roasters are, in order of importance: Sara Lee, Santa Clara, Marata, Melitta and Damasco. Roast and ground coffee dominates the market with over 90% of all sales and although the country is a large exporter of soluble coffee, instant coffee accounts for only approximately 5.5% of the overall domestic market in Brazil.
than that of the United States and more than double the low that Brazilian per capita consumption fell to in 1985 (2.3 kg). Consumption stagnated around this level until steps were taken in 1989 to improve the quality of coffee available on the domestic market. In particular, the industry introduced what became known as the Selo de Pureza or purity seal. This, together with an active marketing policy aimed at encouraging consumption by providing more information on the product, formed the basis of a successful push to increase consumption. Coffee products are only eligible for the Purity Seal if they comply with certain basic conditions. In addition, ABIC continues its Coffee Quality Program, aimed at educating consumers about aroma, body, avour, degree of roasting and grinding. Participating roasters display the Quality Seal on their retail packaging. ABIC also runs an internal accreditation programme for coffee shops, hotels and restaurants that use quality beans and in so doing helps promote the coffee culture in Brazil. Finally, the promotion of sustainability in the coffee chain is also actively pursued. Brazils success in raising domestic consumption is of interest to many other coffee producing nations hoping to raise their domestic use. In response the ICO commissioned A Step-by-step Guide to Promote Coffee Consumption in Producing Countries, which uses the Brazilian experience and that of a few other countries to create a methodology to promote consumption. See www.ico.org/promoting_ consumption.asp.
Consumption in Brazil
The industry association (ABIC) puts domestic consumption in Brazil at approximately 6.0 kg per person in 2010, whereas the ICO puts it at 5.8 kg. This is now considerably higher
Table 2.7
Country Brazil
Ethiopia India
83 1 171
7.45 4.98
0 0.38
0 <0.01
0 0.01
2.3 0.1
Indonesia
240
8.86
0.20
0.01
0.31
0.9
Mexico
113
4.00
0.50
<0.01
0.10
1.2
Viet Nam
87
18.50
0.05
<0.01
0.05
1.1
Source: ICO and other trade data. Note: Green bean equivalents are used for roasted, soluble and per capita consumption gures.
28
Elsewhere in Latin America, consumption is constrained by relatively low urban income levels although there has been some growth in Mexico and consumption remains reasonably substantial in Colombia. By comparison, consumption in Africa is negligible with the exception of Ethiopia, where there is a long and well-established tradition of coffee drinking. In Asia, total consumption is high in India, Indonesia and Viet Nam, although per capita consumption levels are still relatively low.
is to be drunk or not. It is interesting to note that coffee is more likely to be consumed at breakfast, lunch or dinner if these are taken as family meals rather than eaten alone. However, as meals are becoming less formal and structured in many countries, more coffee is being consumed out of home, although the home remains the most popular place to consume coffee. The type of food consumers prefer may also have an effect on the amount of coffee they drink. Either through habit or taste, coffee seems to complement some foods more than others. This might explain why coffee is generally less popular in restaurants serving Asian foods than in those serving traditional Western European cuisine. Competition from other beverages has also been an important factor affecting the demand for coffee. Over the last 30 years or so, soft drinks have become more popular, invariably at the expense of coffee, especially among young people. However, the situation is far from static and the new American-style coffee bars appear to reversing this trend, although the situation varies from country to country. Consumption of soft drinks in the United States has shown rapid growth since the mid-1960s: the percentage of the population drinking soft drinks grew from 47% in 1975 to 58% in 2011. It does, however, appear to have reached a plateau as very little growth has been achieved over the last four years. However, In Germany coffee remains the most popular beverage and although the consumption of herbal teas, fruit juices and mineral water is rising, it does not appear to be doing so at the expense of coffee. In Japan coffee is gaining ground at the expense of other beverages, but more slowly than in the early 1980s. Price may be a major factor in the change to alternative beverages, but health worries and advertising also provide strong motives to switch to other beverages. Over the years a number of studies have suggested that coffee in fact invariably caffeine, but the stigma attaches to coffee rather than to all beverages containing caffeine is linked in some way to some cancers and other diseases. The publicity given to the ndings of these studies has contributed signicantly to the decline in the consumption of coffee in some developed markets. A number of the cola drinks on the market contain high levels of caffeine but not as high as most coffees. Studies have found that coffee may have some benecial health effects, e.g. helping to relieve stress and inhibiting the viruses that cause cold sores, measles and polio, as well as preventing some types of cancer and possibly delaying the onset of Parkinsons disease. Unfortunately, this positive information does not gain wide publicity and does not yet appear to counteract the effects of the adverse publicity. The Institute for Scientic Information on Coffee (ISIC) is highlighting some of these benets of coffee through its Positive Communication on Coffee Programme. Visit www.coffeeandhealth.org and see also ICOs www.positivelycoffee.org.
29
many producing country markets as well. In addition there is often a third large supplier in each main market. For example in the United States Procter & Gamble enjoys a reasonably large share of the market, while the Ueshima Coffee Company (UCC) is of some signicance in Japan. The larger companies manufacture soluble coffee in their own plants and rarely obtain soluble coffee from outside suppliers. Nestl also operates a small number of soluble processing plants in producing countries, primarily aimed at supplying the domestic market, but also nearby regional markets. The scope for outside manufacturers lies in supplying product for: Secondary (own label) brands that have no manufacturing facilities (although this market tends to be rather sluggish); Specialist packers of own label coffee in consuming countries. Most supermarket chains prefer to buy from a specialist packer rather than direct from origin, and usually insist that bulk supplies are repacked in retail jars. For all practical purposes, an origin supplier seeking to enter the own label market would be best advised to trade through a specialist packer in a consuming country, especially as in most cases the nished retail product is a blend of coffee from several sources. There are several specialist packers of soluble coffee for own label product in consuming countries. Some operate their own processing plants, but also often purchase soluble coffee for blending from other sources to full contracts that are beyond their capacity, or when imported soluble is cheaper than their own product. Other specialist packers have no processing capacity of their own and merely blend and repack products from other sources. The retail market for soluble coffee has three general segments: Premium brands of freeze-dried soluble. Nestl and Kraft Foods dominate in this segment, but there is some signicant participation by other brands, particularly supermarkets own labels. Both Brazil and Colombia supply freeze-dried soluble coffee to this market, which is still growing. Although not the most popular form of soluble coffee, in general freeze-dried is gaining market share in every consuming country at the expense of other types of soluble coffee. It has obtained 40% to 45% of the soluble coffee market in Japan, the United States and the United Kingdom and a little over 30% in Spain and Australia. Extra premium blends of freeze-dried coffee composed solely or mainly of arabica and sometimes from a single origin are also marketed in this sector. Standard brands of spray-dried soluble. These generally consist of coffee that has been agglomerated. Agglomeration is a process that not only improves solubility, but also transforms the coffee powder into more attractive granules. Agglomerated coffee is the most popular form of soluble coffee. It accounts for more
SOLUBLE COFFEE
The soluble coffee market is dominated by two multinational rms: Nestl and Kraft Foods. One or the other or both have a presence in every main consumer market and probably in
30
than half the sales in the majority of consuming markets, although it is losing market share to freeze-dried coffee. Cheap blends of spray-dried powder. This is often soluble coffee that has been imported from origin and repacked. Considerable excess manufacturing capacity has resulted in extreme price competition and although this is by far the cheapest type of soluble coffee available in many markets, it is losing market share to all other types of instant coffee. It does, however, constitute the larger share of the market in the Russian Federation and many other Eastern European and Asian markets as well as in producing country markets. The total market for soluble coffee is showing signs of strong growth after being relatively at in the 1990s. Estimated consumption in countries that do not produce coffee was 21 million bags GBE in 2010, of which 30% was manufactured in producing countries.
Soluble coffee is also produced in Malaysia for use in regional markets and in the Philippines for domestic consumption.
31
Table 2.8
Exports of soluble coffee by exporting countries, 20052010 (in bags, green bean equivalent) 2005 2006 5 547 293 627 111 622 731 4 380 1 528 089 599 174 54 478 1 665 0 409 397 760 430 176 60 795 0 222 25 368 0 2 957 191 2 948 212 43 8 933 3 434 900 165 113 0 89 192 029 31 0 0 35 314 16 1 657 408 40 243 2007 6 845 865 585 465 583 173 2 292 2 286 563 749 271 241 1 605 1 851 0 829 496 1 823 624 842 53 523 0 61 23 848 2 3 384 918 3 372 692 43 12 183 0 588 918 381 343 236 78 149 283 21 0 2 32 105 0 703 313 24 834 2008 7 217 775 697 653 696 494 1 159 2 192 170 746 025 51 2 679 1 510 0 770 263 2 091 601 930 42 593 0 1 653 23 375 0 3 366 521 3 364 816 43 1 650 12 961 522 340 017 0 225 602 804 86 0 140 4 435 23 58 576 13 158 2009 6 244 132 585 451 584 461 990 2 256 260 659 875 108 2 535 0 52 937 587 1 840 610 151 39 511 0 237 4 416 0 2 881 018 2 881 018 0 0 0 519 838 350 922 0 48 154 005 0 0 0 6 656 15 53 607 7 532 2010 7 124 876 613 004 603 390 9 614 2 750 631 806 744 404 2 337 600 702 1 205 765 2 484 687 671 43 583 0 302 39 0 3 226 267 3 226 267 0 0 0 534 973 276 775 0 22 234 201 58 0 0 6 338 2 468 660 16 449
Total Colombian Milds Colombia United Republic of Tanzania Other Milds Ecuador El Salvador Guatemala Guyana Haiti India Jamaica Mexico Nicaragua Peru Panama Venezuela (Bolivarian Republic of) Zimbabwe Brazilian Naturals Brazil Nepal Paraguay Yemen Robustas Cte dIvoire Guinea Ghana Indonesia Lao People's Democratic Republic Madagascar Nigeria Philippines Sierra Leone Sri Lanka Trinidad and Tobago Viet Nam
6 121 305 632 648 626 690 5 958 1 451 597 597 189 458 23 394 0 338 377 586 444 319 57 481 14 8 12 714 34 3 547 915 3 525 169 43 22 703 0 489 145 192 755 0 139 223 384 0 182 160 33 636 31 300 692 37 866
DECAFFEINATED COFFEE
Caffeine is a natural substance found in the leaves, seeds or fruits of more than 60 plant species worldwide. The level of its presence in non-decaffeinated coffee depends on a number of factors: different types of coffee contain
varying levels of caffeine. Factors determining this include the variety of the coffee tree itself and where grown, soil, altitude, climate etc. The decaffeination process is applicable to both soluble coffee (spray-dried and freeze-dried) and roasted coffee. Decaffeinated coffee enjoyed a considerable rise in
32
popularity during the 1980s, especially in the United States, but its performance in the market during the 1990s has not been very strong. Decaffeinated coffee is seen as having to compete with other specialty coffees and although consumers of decaffeinated coffee tend to be very loyal to the product, caffeine no longer appears to be an issue that most consumers are particularly concerned about. Despite technological improvements in the decaffeination process over the last 15 years, and in particular the development of what many see as better processes which use water and carbon dioxide rather than methyl chloride, the product is losing market share. It is estimated that decaffeinated coffee currently accounts for around 10% of all coffee sales. Usually, it commands only a small premium over non-decaffeinated coffee and frequently is sold for the same price. Consequently the economics of the decaffeination are tight. In 2010, trade sources estimated that the cost of the process ranged from US$ 0.50/kgUS$ 0.65/kg of green bean, for the cheapest process using methyl chloride, to about double that for the more expensive methods. Incidentally, there is a substantial market for extracted, crude caffeine in industries such as pharmaceuticals and soft drinks.
The following decaffeination agents are allowed in the European Union: methylene chloride, ethyl acetate, carbon dioxide and watery coffee extract from which the caffeine is removed by active carbon. All conventional decaffeination methods have undergone intensive scientic examination and are considered safe. In the European Union the absolute caffeine content in roasted, decaffeinated coffee may not exceed 0.1%, or 0.3% in soluble coffee. In the United States, decaffeinated is generally taken to mean that the caffeine content has been reduced by 97%, or to less than 3% of the original content.
ROASTED COFFEE
The market for roasted coffee is somewhat less concentrated than that for soluble coffee. Although market concentration in the roast and ground sector increased signicantly, particularly during the 1980s and in the late 1990s, the development of the specialty sector has slowed the trend and the number of small roasters operating worldwide did increase signicantly again for a while. Small roasters rarely buy direct from origin, but make their purchases through importers who are able to offer some security of supply and cost savings for small lots. In many cases importing direct from origin involves buying a full container load of around 300 bags (18 tons), which is simply too large an order for most small roasters. As a result of the development of the specialty and gourmet sectors in many countries, single origin roasted coffee is now widely available. However, blends of roasted coffee from different origins remain the most predominant roasted coffee product in the overall market today and this makes it difcult for producers to enter the retail market on their own. The trade in roasted coffee from origin is limited: in 2010 only 222,500 bags were exported from origin in roasted form compared to 7.1 million bags GBE of soluble and 89.3 million bags of green coffee. In total, roasted coffee accounted for just 0.23% of all coffee exports, but the published statistics on this trade are notoriously inaccurate with reported imports from producing countries greatly exceeding reported exports from those origins. Even so, and perhaps hardly surprisingly, Brazil was recorded as the largest exporter of roasted coffee in 2010, a position it has held undisputed for the past ve years, although prior to that the Dominican Republic and occasionally Colombia vied with Brazil for the top place. There are several obstacles to exporting roasted coffee from origin. None of them are insurmountable, but together they form a signicant barrier to this trade. Roasted coffee rapidly loses its avour unless it is vacuum packed or gas ushed. A supplier wishing to export must therefore install an appropriate packing facility. Furthermore, consumers are becoming increasingly sophisticated and demand high quality packaging that requires a signicant level of investment. Additionally,
33
legislation in importing countries frequently insists that packs are marked with a sell by or use by date. Transporting the product to market from origin can take a considerable amount of time and this puts the exporter at a disadvantage compared to a local roaster that is able to offer the retailer a product with a longer shelf life. Exporters of roasted coffee therefore need to develop speedy distribution systems in order to minimize this disadvantage. This usually requires the active collaboration of agents or specialized importers or roasters in the target market(s).
Producer
Others
Source: ICO.
These seven countries account for the bulk of the imports of both roasted and soluble coffee. And as can be seen, with the exception of the United States and France, imports of roasted coffee from producing countries barely register on the chart. Imports of roasted coffee into the United States have been increasing signicantly from 2005 to 2010, with a noticeable increase in imports of roasted coffee from Mexico, Colombia and more recently Viet Nam. Imports of soluble coffee from producing countries are clearly more signicant and form a larger share of the trade in the United States, Germany, Japan and the United Kingdom.
Figure 2.6 Imports of soluble coffee by origin, average 20052010
1,800,000 1,600,000 1,400,000 1,200,000 1,000,000 800,000 600,000 400,000 200,000 200 000 0
Bags (GBE)
Producer
Others
Source: ICO.
The average export unit-value of soluble coffee is compared with the ICO composite indicator in gure 2.7. Generally the export unit value tracks the indicator, usually at a lower level, but occasionally at a premium. However, because of intense competition, the value added, on an FOB basis, is less than popularly supposed.
34
Figure 2.7 Export value of soluble coffee from ICA producing countries compared with the ICA Composite Indicator Price, 19902010
160 140 120 100 80 60 40 20 0
for example in Article 24 of the 2007 International Coffee Agreement). Signicant progress in reducing tariffs and taxes on coffee imports into consuming countries has been made through the various rounds of the General Agreement on Tariffs and Trade (GATT) and more recently through negotiations under the auspices of the World Trade Organization. However, while most tariff barriers have been removed for green coffee, there remain a number of tariffs imposed on processed coffee that continue to act as a barrier to importation of processed coffee into consuming countries. In addition, there are also a number of non-tariff barriers still in place, such as quantitative restrictions and internal taxes that continue to inhibit consumption.
Cents/lb
Source: ICO.
Export unit-value statistics show that the prices of Brazilian soluble are generally lower than both the New York market prices for Brazilian green coffee and, at times, the London market prices for robustas. On the other hand, Colombian prices correspond more closely with New York prices, although the unit-value of exports of Colombian soluble (an aggregate of spray-dried and freeze-dried) remains for the most part just slightly above the quoted green coffee price. One of the reasons for producing countries to continue with this is that coffee transformed in the country of origin does not have to possess all quality characteristics of coffee which can be exported in green form. The transformation into soluble may therefore allow the use of lower grades. Nevertheless, the value added by the manufacture of soluble at origin is likely to be, at best, marginal and a run of low prices may not allow the speedy recovery of costs of new installations. As is seen in gure 2.8, roasted coffee sells at a premium over both the ICO composite indicator and the New York market for Other milds, but this trade is more specialized and export prices may include the provision of retail packs. Nevertheless, the trade remains negligible.
Figure 2.8 Export value of roasted coffee from ICA members compared with the ICA Composite Indicator Price, 19902010
400 350 300 250 200 150 100 50 0
Cents/lb
Source: ICO.
35
Value added tax (VAT) is levied on both roasted and soluble coffee sales by most European countries with the percentage ranging from 3% in Luxembourg to 25% in Denmark and Hungary. Of course these are internal taxes and do not directly concern exporters, but it is nevertheless useful to know. Excise duties are also levied by Belgium, Denmark, Germany, Latvia and Romania. For a full list see the ECF 2010/11 Annual Report as well as www.exporthelp. europa.eu.
campaigns had very positive effects on consumption in both countries. By 2011 the ICO no longer had the funds to nance such campaigns. The ICO does offer A Step-by-step Guide to Promote Coffee Consumption in Producing Countries, which uses primarily the Brazilian experience and methodology on how to promote consumption in producing countries and any emerging coffee market. This comprehensive guide can be downloaded from www.ico.org. The annual United States Winter Coffee Drinking Study is a good example of a survey on coffee consumption. See www.ncausa.org for details.
Classication of coffee products traded internationally HS code CN code 0901 10 00 0901 11 00 0901 11 10 0901 11 20 0901 11 90 0901.12 0901 12 00 0901 12 10 0901 12 20 0901 12 90 0901.20 0901.21 0901.22 0901.90 0901.90 2101.11 2101.12 0901 20 00 0901 21 00 0901 22 00 0901 90 00 0901 90 00 2101 11 xx 2101 12 xx 07113 07132 07131 07131 07120 07112 SITC Rev.4 07110 07111
Coffee in green form (not roasted) Not decaffeinated Not decaffeinated, arabica Not decaffeinated, robusta Not decaffeinated, other Decaffeinated Decaffeinated, arabica Decaffeinated, robusta Decaffeinated, other Roasted coffee Not decaffeinated Decaffeinated Coffee husks and skins Coffee substitutes containing coffee Extracts, essences and concentrates of coffee (Various CN codes for a range of sub-products) Preparations with a basis of these extracts, essences or concentrates or with a basis of coffee (Various CN codes for a range of sub-products)
0901.10 0901.10
36
Table 2.10 Tariffs for import of coffee in selected countries (in percentage unless otherwise indicated) Product code 0901.11.00 Description Green coffee not decaffeinated Category MFN GSP LDC General MFN GSP LDC General MFN GSP LDC General MFN GSP LDC General MFN GSP LDC General MFN GSP LDC General 2101.11.00 Extracts, essences and concentrates of coffee MFN GSP LDC General EU 0 0 0 0 8.3 4.8 0 0 7.5 2.6 0 0 9 3.1 0 0 0 0 0 0 11.5 8 0 0 9 3.1 0 0 11.5 8 0 0 Norway 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Switzerland 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 SwF 63/100 kg 0 0 0 SwF 63/100 kg 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 SwF 70/100 kg 0 0 0 SwF 182/100 kg 0 0 0 SwF 80.8 SwF 123.45/100 kg SwF 0 SwF 79.45/100 kg 0 0 Japan 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 12 10 0 20 12 10 0 20 0 0 0 0 12 0 0 20 8.8 24 0 0 12.3 16 15 29.8 + 1 159/kg 0 0 12.3 35 + 1 363/kg United States 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 10 US cts 1.5/ kg US cts 1.5/ kg 0 US cts 6.6/ kg 0 0 0 0 8.5 10 0 10 0 10 0 10
0901.12.00
0901.21.00
0901.22.00
0901.90.10
0901.90.90
2101.12.00
Preparations with a basis MFN of extracts, essences or concentrates or with a basis of coffee GSP LDC General
Note: The tariff headings contain several sub-categories hence the range of tariffs is given. The Generalized System of Preferences (GSP) is a specic additional measure aimed at the lowering of tariffs for imports from developing countries. It formally exempts WTO member countries from so-called most favoured nation (MFN) for the purpose of lowering tariffs for developing countries, without also doing so for developed countries. The preferential GSP tariff rates are benecial but still present a barrier in the majority of coffee importing countries. LDC refers to least developed country.
CHAPTER 3
THE SPECIALTY MARKET .................................................................................................................................... 38 ORGANIC COFFEE............................................................................................................................................... 43 MAPPING TECHNOLOGY IN COFFEE MARKETING: GPS AND GIS ............................................................ 49 TRADEMARKING AND GEOGRAPHICAL INDICATIONS IN COFFEE ............................................................ 51 SUSTAINABILITY AND SOCIAL ISSUES IN THE COFFEE INDUSTRY ........................................................... 52 THE MAIN SUSTAINABILITY SCHEMES IN THE COFFEE SECTOR ............................................................... 54 CERTIFICATION AND VERIFICATION ................................................................................................................ 59 SUSTAINABILITY AND GENDER ......................................................................................................................... 61
38
39
Sell to the leading roasters (through the usual trade channels) if volume sales are required and the coffee sold lacks the avour characteristics necessary to be marketed on its own. Sell to specialty roasters either direct or through importers or agents. The latter in most cases is the more realistic option as these importers or agents have a wide coverage of the small roasters and other retail outlets, which are too small to import direct. Focus on specialty coffee retailers either by selling direct (for roasting in store) through specialty wholesalers or by selling through specialty roasters. However, the number of specialty coffee retailers importing direct is extremely small. Premiums for specialty coffee can be considerable at the retail level, but the premiums available for producers are inevitably much lower, although they can still be signicant. It is sobering to realize that mainstream qualities, including robusta, account for an estimated 85%90% of world coffee consumption, while the share of exemplary and high quality coffee is no more than 10% or perhaps 15% of the world market. This suggests that for many producers it would be inadvisable to ignore the mainstream market altogether. Instead, they should concentrate on both: specialty for their top quality and mainstream for the remainder of their production. A further point to note is that sales to small roasters are mostly on extended credit terms, something only an importer can easily afford. Inventory costs, late payment costs and even the risk of payment defaults are therefore part of the cost equation. Also, most roasters purchase subject to approval of the quality on delivery. This means the importer will be left with any coffee that does not meet the roasters expectations. In other words, the premium for specialty coffee at the wholesale level includes many more factors than just the quality.
40
An exclusive arrangement generally means roasters will be spending marketing dollars in introducing the coffee to their clients, i.e. a roaster will promote this particular coffee rather than just blend it. Promotional dollars behind the coffee mean increased consumer awareness, which can lead to longer term loyalty. Exclusivity creates a certain sense of loyalty and communication between the producer and the importer/ roaster that may otherwise not be possible. It is also in the best interest of the receiving company that the quality is optimal as such it may provide technical help and other assistance that would otherwise not have been available to the producer.
necessarily use very good coffee, and some contain very little coffee indeed. Also, there is no universal agreement on what constitutes specialty coffee, and it frequently means different things to different people. But without a clear understanding of what is really specialty coffee, an accurate market assessment becomes extremely difcult. In the United States the Specialty Coffee Association of America (SCAA www.scaa.org) describes true specialty grade coffee as having maximum ve defects in a standard sample with all cups free of all taints and showing distinctive positive characteristics. Go to www.scaa.org and/or www. coffeeinstitute.org/scaa.html for more on the SCAAs denition of what constitutes specialty grade coffee, defect counts, etc. On the above basis we would estimate that no more than 5% of green coffees could make specialty grade. If we were to include what the SCAA calls high-end premium coffee (eight defects, clean cup) then maybe the specialty market is 10% of all of the green coffee business in the United States, a percentage that many trade sources consider realistic. On the other hand, Daviron and Ponte in their book The Coffee Paradox (ISBN 1 84277 456 5 hb ISBN 1 84277 457 3 pb, published by www.zedbooks.co.uk) estimated the total size of the specialty market in the United States in calendar year 2000 at 17%. The National Coffee Associations National Coffee Drinking Survey 2011 puts Gourmet coffee beverages at 36% of the market, including both roasted coffee and specialty instant coffee products. But the difculty with specialty or gourmet coffee is to properly dene it. For example, is average Starbucks quality specialty coffee or is it high-quality mainstream coffee? In Western Europe many countries have traditionally consumed high quality coffees, at least equal to the good premium types that are produced by mainstream roasters. This is perhaps why the Speciality Coffee Association of Europe (SCAE www.scae.com) describes specialty (or speciality) coffee as an end product, rather than as a green bean product, by saying that speciality coffee is dened as a crafted coffee-based beverage, which is judged by the consumer (in a limited marketplace at a given time) to have a unique quality, a distinct taste and personality different from, and superior to, the common coffee beverages offered. The beverage is based on beans that have been grown in an accurately dened area, and which meet the highest standards for green coffee, and for its roasting, storage and brewing. This interpretation then places the emphasis more on the fact that specialty coffee is not only expected to be different, but also a more luxurious and superior product with a certain element of exclusivity. It also suggests that the term specialty coffee is really a generic label covering a range of different coffees, which either command a premium price over other coffees, or that are perceived by consumers as being different. In Europe, the term often tends to be associated with coffee for the American market, and the name also conjures up images of avoured coffees.
41
Therefore, until such time as there is general agreement on what constitutes specialty coffee it is not possible to accurately quantify how much is produced, or how much is consumed. The general consensus appears to be that specialty coffee in all its different forms may account for around 10% of world consumption. It certainly is gaining market share fairly rapidly, but of course world consumption as a whole is rising as well, which makes it likely that the 10% will probably remain the upper limit for some time to come.
quality may not always be there, but the coffee is fresh. Some such chains have also started importing roasted beans direct from some producing countries in partnership with roasters at origin. Major restaurant chains such as McDonalds and Dunkin Donuts are now offering specialty coffees and this line appears to be enjoying good sales growth. Given this strong industry growth and the accompanying proliferation of specialty coffee products, the SCAA together with the Coffee Quality Institute (CQI www.coffeeinstitute.org) has created the Q Grading System, which effectively establishes a standard for certied specialty coffee. See details in chapter 12, Quality control. The aim is to provide producers, exporters, importers, roasters and retailers of specialty coffee with the means to have the quality and authenticity of their product independently certied. The programme builds on the existing SCAA Green Coffee Classication System and Grading Chart; see www.scaa.org and www.coffeeinstitute. org.
42
specialty roasters exist and ourish. Many of these buy readymade, ready-to-roast green coffee blends from the specialty importers, especially for the strong espresso segment. But many of these smaller roasters are facing strong competition from the larger and medium sized roasters through the introduction of the singleserve pod systems that have been growing at an annual rate of around 20% over the last four years. Larger specialty roasters, such as Lavazza and Illy, export substantial quantities of Italian espresso blends all over Europe and the United States, so the sales opportunities for specialty type coffee that meets the quality requirements for the espresso trade are quite substantial. For a review of those requirements and how they differ from traditional specialty coffee see the section on coffee tasting in chapter 12, Quality control.
43
average latte one does not require top-grade coffee. A simple blend will do. To complicate matters further there is also no denying that the output of some of the larger European roasters has always included top-quality coffees, often far superior to the average specialty coffee. Yet such roasters are usually classied as mainstream because of their size and the conventional marketing methods most employ. Their products are not perceived as being different. At the same time, other retail products elsewhere may be classied as specialty even though they may be based on averagequality or mainstream-type coffee. The specialty market itself is divisible in three sub-segments: Exemplary coffees, usually presented as single origin or single source, High quality coffees that may include blends, and Average quality coffee that is presented differently, for example lattes. Therefore, one should probably classify individual roasters by the products they market, rather than by the type of coffee they may be buying. The Nespresso Company combines technical innovation (special home brewing equipment) with high-quality coffees. It stands alone from the Nestl Group, and both the company and its products should denitely be classied as being part of the specialty segment. In a way, the Starbucks Company does the same because it relies on innovative retail and presentation methods that have set it apart from other roasters/retailers. This includes the constant promotion of high-quality origin coffee, but it is increasingly selling blends as well as its new instant coffee brand Via. However, the company rmly belongs to the specialty segment because it is marketing specialty type coffees. The Swedish roaster Gevalia is a different example. The company ranks amongst the major specialty sellers (mostly by mail order) in the United States, yet is owned by the multi-national mainstream roaster Kraft Foods.
generally, but varies widely for different product groups. The United States remains the largest single market for organic products, followed by Germany. Consumption growth rates have been slowing since 2008 in some countries, especially in the organic sector in the United Kingdom. However, the United States is continuing to grow (almost 10% to US$ 27 billion in 2010, which is about 4% of all food and beverage sales in that market).
ORGANIC COFFEE
Organic products have come a long way since small groups of consumers started buying organic food directly from farms or from small health food shops, where quality was secondary as long as the products were organic. But then in the early 1990s supermarket chains started paying systematic attention to organic food. Year after year they have taken over market share from the specialized shops, to the point where they drive most of the growth in the market share of organic food today. It is estimated that almost 10 million hectares of land in Europe is cultivated organically. Austria is leading with as much as 20% of the total farm area under organic cultivation. The market share for organic products in Western countries ranges between 0.5% and 8% for food
44
coffee can be marketed as organic only when it is certied as such by a recognized organization or certier, based on regular inspection of all stages of production, processing, transporting and roasting of the coffee. The rst organic coffee cultivation was recorded at the Finca Irlanda in Chiapas, Mexico (1967). The rst organic coffee to be imported into Europe from a small farmers cooperative came from the UCIRI cooperative in Oaxaca, Mexico (1985).
be called natural coffee and, to the surprise of many, the industry looks upon this as non-sustainable production. This is because in the long run the soil will be depleted by natural production, which is often referred to also as passive cultivation or organic by default. To achieve sustainable production it is necessary to make active use of various organic agriculture techniques, including the composting of organic material, mulching of the soil under the trees with organic material, use of biological pest control, and investing in shade regulation. The principle of sustainable agriculture is that a value corresponding to that harvested should be returned to the soil. All possible methods have to be used to enhance the fertility of the soil. This is why passive production of coffee, even when no chemicals are used, is viewed as non-sustainable and not as organic. Usually, a producer may simultaneously grow both conventional and organic coffee, although this is not recommended. There must be a clear separation between the two types and adequate barriers to prevent contamination with agro-chemicals from neighbouring elds. Coffee may normally be sold as organic only once organic cultivation has been practised for at least three years before the rst marketable harvest. This also means three years of inspection. These years are called the conversion period. In specic cases, depending on previous agricultural practices, this conversion period may be reduced, but only after approval of the certifying organization, which in turn has to report such a decision to the authority granting the required import permit. For a producer who can prove that no agrochemicals have been used in the past, it is important to try to reduce the conversion period. If a producer can document that no agro-chemicals have recently been used, it is certainly worthwhile discussing the possibility with the certier.
WHY BUY OR GROW ORGANIC COFFEE? Why do consumers choose organic coffee?
Health considerations. Many consumers perceive organic foods as healthier. However, this motive is less important for coffee than it is for some other crops in that roasted coffee hardly ever contains harmful residues. But there is also a growing number of consumers whose health worries extend to the workers who have to work with the chemicals that are used in the traditional production system. Demand for specialty coffee. Although the quality of organic coffee is not necessarily better than that of conventional coffees, the market for organic coffee is increasingly demanding higher quality, which is why organic coffees are often positioned in the specialty segment. The rst organic coffees to appear on the market in the 1980s were good quality arabicas from Mexico, but nowadays organic robusta, as well as lower grades of organic arabica are also available. Some quality estates or exporters have their coffees certied as organic to underline their quality, hoping it will be perceived as truly special. Environmental concerns. Other consumers are concerned about the negative impact of agro-chemicals on the environment. They are not necessarily concerned only about health issues, but primarily want to be sure that the products they buy are produced in an environmentally friendly way in order to prevent pollution, erosion and soil degradation.
45
The avouring of roasted coffee is permitted when natural avouring substances or preparations are used. For packaging roasted coffee, ushing with nitrogen or carbon dioxide is permitted. For the decaffeination of coffee, chemical solvents (e.g. methylene chloride) are not permitted, but the water method or the supercritical carbon dioxide method (the CO2 method) may be used.
org for more information on this accreditation programme and for links to other publications, e.g. the differences between European Union and United States regulations for organic agriculture. In the third development phase, different countries or states (e.g. Germany, California) developed laws on organic agriculture and processing, which were eventually incorporated in formal EU or United States regulations. Today (late 2011), the bulk of organic coffee is certied against one of the following standards: Council Regulation (EC) No. 834/2007 of 28 June 2007 on organic production and labelling of organic products and repealing Regulation (EEC) No. 2092/91 that came into force 1 January 2009 for the European Union; National Organic Program for the United States (NOP); Japan Agricultural Standard (JAS).
Organic regulations
In the initial development stages there was no legal denition of organic food and so farmers organizations and others formulated their own standards and issued certicates and seals to offer consumer guarantees. The next phase was when IFOAM united these different standards into its Basic standards for organic production and processing. These standards provide a framework for certication bodies and standard-setting organizations worldwide to develop their own certication standards. In an effort to harmonize standards and certication, and to provide a universal quality seal for organic products, IFOAM also has an accreditation programme for certication organizations. See www.ifoam.
46
specications. For example, the use of sodium nitrate is permitted by some non-EU certiers, but is prohibited under EU regulations. The proposed certier can certify directly against EU regulations because a certier may certify against a number of different standards. Importation and inspection. Aspiring exporters should satisfy themselves that the proposed importer is fully aware of and follows the required EU customs documentation, i.e. that importer is certied against EU regulations. But exporters must also be aware of the fact that for each shipment EU customs will demand to see an original inspection or control certicate (formerly called transaction certicate) for verication and endorsement. Therefore, exporters must apply for these on time because without such documentation EU customs will only clear a shipment as conventional coffee. Inspection certicates are issued by the certifying body and this is where the earlier inspection of production capacity comes in, i.e. the master certicate that was issued by the certier to conrm the sellers authenticity and capacity. At the end of a year it can then be seen whether the total exports for which inspection or control certicates were issued correspond with the production capacity stated in the master certicate. Once cleared through EU customs the organic product enjoys free movement to other member states. But when all or part of a consignment is to be re-exported as organic to a destination outside the EU then, depending on the country of destination, the original EU importer may have to obtain a new inspection certicate from a competent EU certifying organization. This is by law, but because the market requires it. EU organic production logo. Most certifying bodies have their own quality labels. As a result, many different labels exist in the European Union for the designation of organic products. Increasing trade in roasted coffee within the European Union therefore forces roasters to display several labels on their retail packets, an arrangement that does not provide the clarity one would expect. Regulation EC 834/2007 now stipulates that the EU organic production logo shall be obligatory for all organic prepackaged food produced within the European Community. However, the simultaneous use of national or private logos shall not be prevented. For more information on organic certication and regulations in the EU, in addition to www.ifoam.org, also visit to www. intracen.org/exporters/sectors. Click on Organic Products and then Certication. The site also provides a useful glossary of organic certication concepts.
As a result, there were no guarantees that organic meant the same thing from state to state, or even locally from certier to certier. Consumers and producers of organic products therefore jointly sought to establish national standards to clear up confusion in the marketplace, and to protect the trade against mislabelling or fraud. As required by the Organic Foods Production Act (OFPA), the National Organic Standards (part of the National Organic Program, NOP) became effective on 21 October 2002. OFPA itself was adopted in 1990 to establish national standards for the production and handling of foods labelled as organic. Today organizations that are fully NOP-compliant (certied) may label their products or ingredients as organic, and may use the USDA Organic Seal on organic products in the United States, irrespective of whether they are produced domestically or are imported. As a result of NOP there is a , single national label in the United States to designate organic products, thereby avoiding the label confusion that exists in Europe. A list of accredited certifying agents can be found on the websites of the United States Department of Agriculture, www.ams.usda.gov/nop and the Independent Organic Inspectors Association, www.ioia.net. Like the European Union, the United States also requires a control or transaction/export certicate for each shipment, showing date, weight/quantity, and origin. However, unlike to European Union, NOP does not require the master certicate for the processing unit. Information on trade in organic products can also be found at www.ota.com, the website of the Organic Trade Association look for about/sectorcouncils/coffee/index.html.
47
by the fact that few consuming countries register organic coffee imports separately. To note also that the 27 EU member countries increasingly report coffee imports as a single market, making provision of individual country data even more difcult. Nevertheless, indications are that consumption of certied organic coffee in North America and Europe has been growing fairly strongly since 2005, with growth gures averaging 5% to 10% annually, although this has slowed in the last couple of years. A 2010 study by ITC (Trends in the Trade of Certied Coffees by J. Pierrot, D. Giovannucci and A. Kasterine; March, 2011 See www.intracen.org/exporters/organic-products Information and Technical Papers) puts 2009 imports at around 1.7 million bags or almost 1.4% of the 126 million bags of 2009 world gross imports (excluding re-exports). Of this, 45% went to Europe, 41% to North America and 14% to Asia and elsewhere. Estimates for 2010 suggest that the market might have grown by around 3% to 1.75 million bags. Peru remains by far the leading exporter, with exports of 406,000 bags in 2009 and 423,000 bags in 2010. Other leading producers include Colombia, El Salvador, Ethiopia, Guatemala, Honduras, Indonesia and Mexico, with Ethiopia, Honduras and Mexico currently each exporting over 100,000 bags annually. However, it should be noted that ofcial or recorded export gures are not always complete as not all exporting countries provide the necessary data, making it difcult to be precise. Growth in Japan is very much linked to quality: organic coffee of excellent quality generates increasing consumer interest, something that augurs well for further growth in this segment. Growth potential for average quality organic coffee on the other hand is limited. North American growth is also linked to quality. The fact that prot margins on certied products as organic usually are higher plays a role as well, so mainstream roasters and retail chains are showing increasing interest. Almost half of all Fairtrade certied coffee is certied organic as well, whereas certication by both the Rainforest Alliance and Utz Certied is not only growing strongly, but also includes a substantial amount of certied organic. On the production side there remains the mistaken belief amongst some that organic coffee does not need to show quality. As a result, some organic production simply cannot nd premium buyers and ends up being exported uncertied, i.e. as conventional coffee. Nevertheless, premia for decent quality organic coffee have probably stabilized somewhat and, under normal market conditions, may range from about 10% upward, however always depending on quality. Therefore, moving into organic coffee continues to remain out of bounds for producers who are unable to provide the required quality, or who underestimate the cost (fees, learning costs, workload and sometimes lower yields, at least in the rst few years) that go with making the move.
48
considerably and it is therefore advisable to review in detail which inspection and certication organization offers the best service at the lowest price. Some charge a fee per hectare, others a percentage of the export value. As a norm, the cost of inspection and certication should not exceed 3%4% of the sales value of the green coffee, although it should be noted that some grower organizations pay more than this. Local certiers (i.e. those established in the same producing country or region) are usually, but not always, cheaper than the international agencies. However, local certicates are not necessarily or easily recognized by importing countries, so their validity has to be carefully checked. A number of international certiers have branch ofces in producing countries and locally employed staff carry out inspections at lower expense than external personnel. Another option for international certiers is to use a recognized local inspection body with which they have a cooperation agreement. Also to be taken into account are increased production costs and sometimes a fall in the yield per hectare. So, not only does the producer have to bear the inspection and certication costs, but production might also fall, at least for a couple of years. Some sources suggest yields may fall by some 20%. Inspection costs tend to be higher in the initial phase as the certiers need time to get to know the producer and to register elds and facilities. To overcome the start-up problems during the conversion period, coffee growers in a number of countries can have access to funds to nance the costs of certication. Nevertheless, if the average annual inspection and certication cost for example comes to US$ 5,000 or more there is little nancial point in converting to certied organic if the annual exportable production amounts to only two or three containers. These costs are extremely difcult to assess because they depend entirely on the nature and intensity of the conventional cultivation practices before the conversion to organic agriculture. A further cost and a real problem for the producer is the conversion period from conventional to full organic production. During this time the coffee cannot be sold as organic and so does not realize any premium. Meanwhile, premiums for organic coffee are difcult to indicate because they depend on the quality of the coffee and on the market situation at a given moment. In recent years premium quotations have ranged from 10 cts/lb to as high as 75 cts/lb, depending on quality and availability. As a rule of thumb, however, the potential producer premium (FOB) for the organic version of a particular coffee compared to the equivalent non-organic quality can probably be put at 10% to 20%. This compares with consumers generally accepting to pay retail prices of around 20% more for organic coffee than they do for conventional coffee. Some exceptional coffees realize higher premiums ,but there is a strong feeling in trade circles that, realistically, this is the maximum that should be expected. Consumer interest tails off rapidly if premiums go beyond this unless the coffees quality is absolutely outstanding.
The high of 20% is an indication only. Actual producer premiums uctuate alongside coffee prices as a whole: high coffee prices probably reducing the premium percentage and, conversely, low coffee prices probably encouraging somewhat higher premium percentages. It remains to be seen therefore whether or how the much higher coffee prices ruling in early 2011 may alter this picture (Fairtrade offers a xed premium for organic coffee over its minimum guaranteed price for conventional coffee that meets Fairtrade criteria). See table 3.2 for details. Contrary to popular belief the liquor of organic coffee is not necessarily better than that of its conventional equivalent. Where it is not, the premium over conventional coffee has to be justied purely by the organic aspect and is therefore strictly limited by supply and demand unless and until the quality is such that the organic coffee in question can achieve a true stand-alone position in the market its own niche. Then the premium potential becomes entirely demand driven, just as is the case for some well-known conventional specialty or gourmet coffees, and such organic brands achieve premiums of 25% or even higher over conventional coffee. But as the supply of organic coffee grows, so growers should be more cautious when venturing into this eld. Just as producers of conventional specialty coffee have experienced, it is equally difcult to launch new stand-alone brands of organic coffee. Organic coffees that do not offer quality as such, or that are available in large quantities, will sell at much lower premiums over their conventional equivalent, perhaps as low as 5% because, just like any other standard type coffee, they end up as bulk blenders. Chapter 11, Coffee quality, makes it clear that to produce good quality coffee of any kind takes much work and strict management. Organic certication will always complement such efforts, but cannot replace hard work and integrity. Remember: Check which certier is the most acceptable and the most appropriate for the target export market. If possible, determine which certier the prospective buyer(s) may prefer. Make sure the preferred certier is accredited and approved in the target market. Obtain quotations from various certiers and ask for clear conditions (especially how many days will be charged) and timelines. Conditions are usually negotiable. Remember certiers are offering a service, not favours, and should serve their clients, not the other way around. Ensure your potential export production warrants the conversion cost, i.e. calculate the opportunity cost of converting to organic production. Information on costs and current sales prices for comparable coffees is available on many websites and can relatively easily be compared.
49
land management enable both governments and the donor community to plan ahead in the ght against poverty. A number of governments, most notably in the coffee sector in Brazil and Colombia, combine satellite imagery information with data collected regularly from a large number of ground stations in order to reduce the margin of error in their coffee crop estimates. Apart from coffee, satellite imagery also assists in the collection of information on soya, maize, rice, sugar cane, citrus, wheat and cotton crops.
Actual projects
The United States Agency for International Development (USAID) is funding projects in Peru, Guatemala, Costa Rica, the Dominican Republic and some African countries that use the following approach to address these issues. The physical location of each farm (longitude, latitude and altitude) is mapped and recorded by project extension agents using a global positioning system (GPS) unit. Data are collected on how producers grow their coffee including varieties, altitude, application of pesticides, and other details that may be important for marketing or certifying. Extension agents also collect data on practices and quality and whatever else denes the uniqueness of the coffee at the farm, farmers group, or appellation zone levels. Socio-economic data are collected as well. This information (production and location) is entered into a spatial database or geographic information system (GIS). This works like a more traditional database, but includes location information for each record.
50
Maps are created showing not only where the farms are located, but also whatever characteristics are of interest about each farm and the coffee produced on that farm. These projects are implemented by the US Geological Surveys National Center for Earth Resources and Science (EROS), national coffee agencies and agricultural research institutions, and the Tropical Agricultural Centre for Training and Research (CATIE) for Costa Rica. The initiative is called GeoCafe due to its combination of geographic and coffee information. The GeoCafe systems being developed lead to better overall production management; promote the establishment of mechanisms that facilitate coffee monitoring and trace-back; and facilitate access to information over the Internet on coffee production, processing and marketing. At the same time, they provide information about the coffee to potential buyers, thereby assisting the marketing effort. For example: Where is a particular type of coffee produced and by whom? Which farms are located at a certain altitude? What are the climatic and soil conditions on these farms? What forest cover is there? Although for individual small farmers the need for such systems is limited, it is a very useful information and management tool for farmers organizations, cooperatives and estates, particularly those promoting their coffee under specic logos or appellations. The results of the GeoCafe projects can be viewed on the Internet. Any user can look at the maps, zoom in and out to see details, or even ask to see all of the farms meeting some criteria (e.g. show me all farms in this zone growing arabica at an altitude over 1,000 m). Visit the sites below to view actual maps and other information: www.dominicancoffee.com, www.guatemalancoffees.com, www.edcintl.cr.usgs.gov/ip/geocafe. The technology behind GeoCafe is well known and mature. GeoCafe is fully customizable and no complex programming is needed to operate and maintain a basic application. The costs of implementation are not high, since the technological platform has been already developed, and most of the data acquisition is done by partner agencies using internal resources (when available). With minor adaptations, the GeoCafe system can be adapted to other crops or other uses (e.g., watershed management and conservation, and environmental monitoring). The website of the US Government Geological Survey, www. usgs.gov, provides information on a large number of different applications that are of interest to those working with GPS and GIS.
(specic non-spatial information). These data are entered into the device and downloaded into the database at the end of each day or week. Ongoing initiatives open the way for online querying, information access, and mapping projects in other agricultural areas and sectors, not only in Latin America but also elsewhere, for example in Africa. And also for products as cocoa, cashew nuts, or bananas to name a few. In the area of authentication proving that a coffee or a product actually comes from a specic area or source technologies such as smart tags are also being developed. Such tiny computerized tags, attached to each bag or container, can contain any set of information required to meet the markets authentication requirements, and could even be tracked by satellite if such control was necessary. Remote sensing and spatial mapping today provide information on natural vegetation, watersheds, landcover, land-use, forestry and other crop areas, etc. But of course, the benets are not limited to agriculture. The same technologies assist with urban development and town planning, infrastructure verication, protection of wetlands, and mapping of informal settlements. The list is almost endless and covers matters of interest to developed and developing countries alike. As an example see www.geospace.co.za. For more information, a search on Google using the words Geographic Information Forum produces a lengthy list of relevant websites like, for example, www.ppgis.net the Open Forum on Participatory Geographic Information Systems and Technologies. Advanced users of mapping technology and related subjects will nd www.registry.gsdi. org/index.php of interest.
51
In most countries, institutions such as the National Mapping or Geographical Survey Service and others, including some government departments, already use GPS equipment and should be able to offer advice on local experience and preferences. Especially for use in remote areas, simplicity and durability of the equipment are of paramount importance. In other words, do not invest in unnecessarily sophisticated features that are unlikely to be used. GIS software for creating a spatial database and mapping is primarily used by groups of cooperatives and large estates. See ESRI at www.esri.com as an example.
claimed your proposed mark or name. Searches can be made over the Internet on the sites below that also provide information on procedures and regulations pertaining to trademarking and related matters generally in the EU, the United States and Japan: European Union: www.oami.europa.eu United States: www.uspto.gov Japan: www.jpo.go.jp The EU and US sites also provide information on the Madrid Agreement that deals with the International Registration of Marks. Information on trade related aspects of intellectual property rights (TRIPS) generally is found at www.wto.org look for TRIPS under trade topics, then Intellectual property. For the registration of both trademarks and geographic indications (or appellations of origin, which is possibly more appropriate for coffee) an application will have to be led rst of all with your national authorities. These authorities will also be able to advise whether anyone else has already registered what you wish to protect because you cannot register the same (or even a similar) mark or name that someone else may have registered before you. This principle of prior verication applies to foreign countries as well. Eventually one will have to employ a legal rm to conduct a search of existing registrations. Note also that the degree of protection offered by trademark legislation varies from country to country. These considerations suggest that trademarking should be considered only where the product warrants it, and where the degree of protection is such as to make the effort and cost worthwhile. But certainly, where a producer goes to the trouble and cost to create an appellation for their coffee and backs it up with registration in a GIS database, then trademarking of the name will complete the safeguarding process.
52
Almost all countries in the world register and protect trademarks by maintaining a register of trademarks. Trademarks may be one or a combination of words, letters and numerals. They may consist of drawings or logos, symbols, three-dimensional signs such as the shape and packaging of goods, etc. A geographical indication (GI) provides an indication of where something comes from. It can be used on goods or services that have a specic geographic origin and that possess qualities or a reputation that are intrinsically due to that place of origin. As we know, all agricultural products typically have qualities that derive from their place of production and are inuenced by specic local factors, such as climate and soil but some have acquired a certain distinctiveness and recognition. As such, GIs may be used for a wide variety of agricultural products, such as for example Tuscany for olive oil produced in a specic area in Italy; or Champagne for sparkling wines from a welldened region in France, or Jamaica Blue Mountain for its coffee. A geographic name itself is not necessarily a GI. In order for a geographic name to function as a GI, it must indicate more than just origin; it must communicate that the product from this region has a particular quality or has a particular reputation that is specically connected to the noted region. Appellation of origin is a special kind of geographical indication. It is used for products that have a specic quality that is exclusively or essentially due to the geographic environment in which the products are produced. The concept of geographical indications encompasses appellations of origin. Wines from France are maybe the products most frequently associated with appellations, e.g. AOC Alsace means Appellation dOrigine Controle Alsace. This certies that the wine is from the Alsace region.
to obtain ofcially sanctioned approval for the application from a relevant governmental or semi-governmental body from the target geographic region, area or district. Another approach could be to use a graphic (i.e. decorative) logo that refers to the area, and which would be used by many in that area subject to specied requirements. Rather than a geographic word mark, the graphic trademark is then led as a collective mark for goods produced from that area, by members of the area. For a complete overview on the subject of geographical indications, including several coffee case studies, look for ITCs Guide to Geographical Indications on the ITC website www.intracen.org/publications where the book can be downloaded free of charge in pdf format. Presentations made during a seminar on Geographical Indications for Coffee held at the International Coffee Organization in May 2008 can be viewed at www.dev.ico. org/event_pdfs/gi/gi.htm.
53
growing interest in and support for environmental causes in importing countries generally, this has led to the introduction of terms such as responsibly produced or environmentfriendly or environmentally sustainable coffee. For a good introduction to the subject go to www.conservation.org, the website of Conservation International, and look for the Conservation Principles for Coffee Production, which are listed as sustainable livelihoods for coffee producers; ecosystem and wildlife conservation; soil conservation; water conservation and protection; energy conservation; waste management; and pest and disease management. All these and related aspects gained considerable public interest during the years 2001-2005 when the ICO Composite Indicator Price fell below 50 cts/lb. This period of shockingly low producer prices became known as the Coffee Crisis and motivated the appearance of new initiatives as, for example, the 4C Coffee Association that promotes a mainstream verication standard As a result differentiation of coffee products through sustainable certication labels now comes in many forms, but the main agencies are as follows: Fair Trade; www.fairtrade.net Rainforest Alliance; www.rainforest-alliance.org Utz Certied; www.utzcertied.org The Common Code for the Coffee Community (4C Association) www.4c-coffeeassociation.org These various initiatives are rapidly gaining market share and by 2010 it was estimated that they represented around 5% of the total world trade in coffee.
biodiversity presumably one may consider that it sustains rather than harms the environment. If so, and when linked with consideration for social and ethical issues, this concept presents a broad alternative for the more directly focused objectives of some individual labels. Sustainability in itself, of course, does not need the guarantee of a certication or verication. Often, producers are already improving performance and efciency signicantly through the use of good agricultural practices (GAP) and/or good management practices (GMP). Certainly, this does not imply the need for an audit procedure. Nevertheless, consumers generally wish to be able to place a certain trust in claims such as this is an environmentally friendly or socially responsible product. Hence, the existence of different ways and means to provide such guarantees to roasters and retailers alike that allow them to offer what is sometimes also called no-worry coffee. Certication guarantees (through a certicate) that specic rules and regulations of voluntary standards are met in a certain environment (e.g. individual producer, producer group, cooperative or even region). These producers have to meet certain requirements social, economical, environmental and certication calls for independent third-party conrmation of this status, conducted by an accredited auditor. Mostly, certications have to be renewed on an annual basis. Roasters buying certied coffee benet from the guarantee provided by the certicate and by using the logo and related information on their retail packaging. Certication protects both buyer and supplier, often also resulting in better marketing opportunities because there is a specic demand for certied products. Verication also ensures that certain agreed criteria and practices are met, but does not use a certicate to market the claim to the nal consumer. Instead, company standards or internal supply chain standards rely on verication processes that are not as rigid and costly as a certication process that has to be conducted by appointed auditors. Instead, local third-party actors such as NGOs or even second-party actors may be asked to verify adherence to specic criteria. In addition, the timing between repeat verications may be signicantly less onerous than an annual re-certication process. In the coffee sector the most prominent example of a verication scheme is the 4C Association the Common Code for the Coffee Community. 4C offers guidelines for better coffee farming that link up with GAP and GMP while aiming at continuous improvement. , The claims 4C makes are therefore not as specic as those of certication schemes and it refrains from using an onpack (retail) logo. Corporate guidelines or buying standards broadly pursue the same objectives and also set standards that aim at improving sustainability. Different from open certication and verication schemes, corporate guidelines or standards are company-specic. That is, retail credit can
54
only be claimed by the buyer that initiated the standard. By far the best-known examples of such standards are the Starbucks C.A.F.E. Practices Program and the Nespresso AAA Sustainable Quality both of which, in addition to the usual sustainability issues, also deal with coffee quality. For more on this see: www.scscertied.com/retail/rss_ starbucks.php and www.nespresso.com. The quest for sustainability does not end with coffee production. The end objective for the coffee industry is to extend sustainability throughout the entire supply chain. In this respect it is noteworthy that in March 2011 the wellknown roaster Illycaff (www.illy.com) in Trieste, Italy, was formally awarded the certication of Responsible Supply Chain Process by the certiers DNV Business Assurance, a unit of Det Norske Veritas (www.dnv.com). The event marked the 20th anniversary of the introduction of the Ernesto Illy Brazil Award for Coffee Quality. The certication marks the organizations ability to provide a sustainable approach to processes and stakeholder relations all along the production chain, and specically in the supply chain.
consumer-driven and provides an assurance of basic good agricultural practices and social conditions. Work was completed in 2004 to allow green coffee supplies to be brought under the same principles, more appropriately called a code of conduct or a code of practice. See www. eurep.org/newdesign/index_html.
CODES OF CONDUCT
Codes of conduct or codes of practice such as Eurepgap are a good example of how purchasing power translates into change at the producing end. The retailer demands certain assurances of the roaster, who in turn requires their suppliers to conform. This is not to say that all this has come about entirely spontaneously. The 1990s saw a number of food scares that have undoubtedly focused consumer attention on the how and what of the food and drink they consume. But even so, as in some other industries, one can probably mark the 1990s as a turning point for the policies of the larger roasters with respect to social responsibility. Pressure through lobbying and campaigns may have contributed to this attitude change. An increasing number of individual companies and associations such as the Specialty Coffee Associations of America and of Europe are engaged in a variety of activities related to what may broadly be called codes of conduct or initiatives which address social accountability, i.e. the Starbucks Coffee Company C.A.F.E. Practices, the Nespresso AAA Sustainable Quality Program, and some of the initiatives undertaken by Coffee Kids Organization. For further information on social accountability issues (SA8000 framework) see www.sa-intl.org, the website of Social Accountability International. See also www. saiplatform.org.
55
The Max Havelaar Foundation was established in the Netherlands in 1988, and since then another 25 countries have followed suit. In 1997 the different national institutions established an umbrella organization known as the Fairtrade Labelling Organizations International (FLO) with ofces in Bonn, Germany. Their objective is to provide the necessary instruments to assist and enable small growers to take their development into their own hands. This is achieved by incorporating in the producer price not only the cost of production, but also the cost of providing basic necessities such as running water, healthcare and education, and the cost of environmentally-friendly farming systems. Consumer support for this more equitable trading is then linked to participating growers through the Fairtrade labels on retail packaging in consuming countries. Simply put, the higher prices consumers pay for Fairtrade products reach the growers organization through a combination of guaranteed minimum prices and premiums. The FLOs role is to: Promote Fairtrade coffee in consumer markets (this is done by the national labelling initiatives); Identify and assist eligible groups of small growers to become inscribed in the FLO coffee producers register, i.e. to obtain FLO certication; Verify adherence by all concerned to the Fairtrade principles, thus guaranteeing the labels integrity; Fairtrade is a certication programme that all smallholders organizations and roasters who satisfy the criteria can join. But in the end success in the retail market depends on consumer support. The Fairtrade labels aim to make the initiative and the growers behind it visible and therefore marketable on a sustained basis. The labels enable FLO and others to provide sustained publicity and support where it counts most in the consuming countries for example, by building a public
image of quality, reliability and respect for socio-economic and environmental concerns that consumers recognize and appreciate. Fairtrade does not aim to replace anyone in the traditional marketing cycle and works on the basis that there is a place for each, provided all accept the Fairtrade goal of selling the largest possible volume of smallholder coffee at a fair price: fair for growers and consumers alike. The labels provide a guarantee to the consumer of adherence to this principle while leaving production, purchasing, processing, marketing and distribution where it belongs, in the coffee industry.
Table 3.1
Total worldwide sales of FLO-certied coffee, 20042010 (60 kg bags) Not comparable to new (green bean) data 2004 2005 352 065 210 685 1 650 2 165 566 565 2006 429 915 430 600 4 765 2 450 867 730 2007 521 065 504 565 7 500 3 685 1 036 815 New and comparable 2008 767 300 578 567 18 500 5 833 1 370 200 2009 855 717 636 917 26 567 6 533 483 403 700 1 526 216 Estimated 2010 950,000 700,000 35,000 7,300 600 1 692 900
NB: Due to reporting differences, the data for 2008 and 2009 are green bean equivalent and comparable with other certications. However, 2004-2007 are not. 2010 gures are estimates based on extrapolated growth rates. Calculations are based on FLO consumer country sales rather than coffee exported from origin with average distribution being roasted (97%) and soluble coffees (3%) converted to GBE.
56
differentiated according to the type of the coffee. If the reference price is below the Fairtrade minimum price level, then the Fairtrade minimum price applies. These prices (either reference price or minimum price) shall then be increased by a xed premium of 20 cts/ lb (of which at least 5 cts for productivity and/or quality improvements). For certied organic coffee with ofcially recognized certication, that will be sold as such, a further organic differential of at least 30 cts/lb per pound of green coffee will be due. This calculation took effect on 1 April 2011.
Table 3.2 Fairtrade premiums Fairtrade minimum price regular or conventional cts/lb 1.40 1.35 1.05 1.01
will actually be monitored. (Look for Generic Fairtrade Standards for Small Farmers Organizations on the same website.) Criteria include: Minimum entry requirements, which all must meet when joining Fairtrade, or within a specied period; Progress requirements, i.e. show improvement over the longer term.
Application procedure
The applying organization directs its request to FLO International. The certication unit of FLO sends an application pack to the applicant containing general information on FLO and the Fairtrade market, FLO standards, detailed information on the initial certication process and the application form. If the rst evaluation, based on the application form, is positive, the applying organization will be visited by an FLO inspector who will examine the organization on the basis of the minimum requirements of FLO. All relevant information is then presented to the FLO Certication Committee charged with the certication of new producer groups. Once approved the certication will be formalized by means of a signed producer agreement with FLO and a certicate indicating the duration of validity of the certication (to be renewed every two years).
Type of coffee
The Fairtrade price formula can effectively be summarized as (a) the Fairtrade minimum price or, if market prices are higher, the relevant futures market price (plus or minus the normal differential that would apply to that coffee) plus (b) the Fairtrade premium (listed in the above table) plus (c) any differential that might be applicable for organic coffee.
UTZ CERTIFIED
UTZ CERTIFIED Good inside (UTZ) was until early 2007 known as Utz Kapeh = good coffee in a Maya language from Guatemala. UTZ is one of the largest sustainability programmes for responsible coffee production and sourcing in the world. Founded as a producer-industry initiative, UTZ is an independent organization. By setting a decency standard for coffee production and helping growers to achieve it, UTZ recognizes and supports responsible producers. The UTZ sustainability programme is centred on the UTZ CERTIFIED Code of Conduct. This Code is based on international production standards and contains a set of strict product specic criteria for socially and environmentally appropriate coffee growing practices and economically efcient farm management. Independent third-party auditors are engaged by UTZ CERTIFIED to check whether the producers meet the code requirements. UTZ CERTIFIED believes that increasing sustainability should also reinforce the independent position of farmers, which is why farmers are trained in the professionalization of their agricultural practice and operational management to improve the quality, volume and value of their crops. UTZ certication is available to any interested parties, roasters and growers alike. Interested growers (individuals or groups) receive technical assistance to help them implement the changes necessary to achieve certication.
Minimum tonnage
Mention has already been made of the difculty of shipping small lots that do not ll an entire container. FLO itself does not impose minimum volumes on grower organizations, but for practical reasons shipments must be in container size lots, meaning a minimum exportable production of about 18 tons. In practice, small producer groups in some countries do manage to combine shipments so as to ll a container, for example by establishing an umbrella organization to coordinate this and other activities to achieve the necessary economies of scale. FLOs start-up requirements also serve a developmental objective. Taking into account membership and other characteristics, producer groups should at least have the potential to reach a volume of business that will achieve sustainable development impact.
57
A web-based system, the traceability system, monitors the UTZ CERTIFIED coffee throughout the coffee chain, allowing roasters and brands to always trace back where and how their coffee was produced. The UTZ certication provides roasters with the assurance that coffee they have purchased was grown and harvested in a responsible way. In 2011 UTZ CERTIFIED joined the 4C Association with the aim of increasing cooperation and aligning the two organizations codes of conduct in order to create a mechanism or means of support to enable producers to step up from the 4C baseline standard to the UTZ CERTIFIED level. Different from some other certication schemes, UTZ CERTIFIED offers a way forward towards a type of marketdriven recognition that is open to all who can qualify, that is available to both mainstream and specialty coffee, and that precludes no one from participating. As a result, the agency is increasing its penetration and in 2010 over 121,000 metric tons of UTZ CERTIFIED coffee was sold by registered UTZ CERTIFIED companies in 42 countries. This represents an increase of almost 50% in the volume sold the previous year. By the end of 2010, a total of 162 individual producers (in groups mostly smallholders) and 476 others (estates and others) had been certied by the agency in 23 origin countries. Visit www.utzcertied.org for more information.
Water Conservation. All pollution and contamination must be controlled, and waterways must be protected with vegetative barriers. Fair Treatment and Good Conditions for Workers. Agriculture should improve the well being and standards of living for farmers, workers and their families. Occupational Health and Safety. Working conditions must be safe, and workers must be trained and provided with the appropriate equipment to carry out their activities. Community Relations. Farms must be good neighbours to nearby communities, and positive forces for economic and social development. Integrated Crop Management. Farmers must employ Integrated Pest Management techniques and strictly control the use of any agrochemicals to protect the health and safety of workers, communities and the environment. Soil Conservation. Erosion must be controlled, and soil health and fertility should be maintained and enriched where possible. Integrated Waste Management. Farmers must have a waste management programme to reduce, reuse and recycle whenever possible and properly manage all wastes. SAN standards are based on an internationally recognized IPM model, which allows for some limited, strictly controlled use of agrochemicals. Farmers certied by the Rainforest Alliance do not use agrochemicals prohibited by the US Environmental Protection Agency and the European Union, nor do they use chemicals listed on the Pesticide Action Networks Dirty Dozen list. RA considers that by following the standards, farmers can reduce costs, conserve natural resources, control pollution, conserve wildlife habitat, ensure rights and benets for workers, improve the quality of their harvest, and earn the Rainforest Alliance Certied seal of approval. The seal allows producers to distinguish their coffee. This is helpful in establishing long-term marketing relationships because the certication guarantees that the farm is managed according to the highest social and environmental standards. The certication process includes: (i) preliminary site visit by SAN technicians to determine the changes necessary to achieve certication (diagnostic); (ii) a comprehensive audit of farm operations (certication audit); (iii) based on an evaluation report, the certication committee determines whether the farm merits certication; and (iv) a contract that governs and monitors the use of the Rainforest Alliance Certied seal of approval, the handling of certied products and marketplace promotion. In 2010, sales of RA-certied coffee were 114,884 metric tons green bean and are the culmination of phenomenal annual growth for the past eight years. RA-certied coffee is now produced on 44,648 coffee farms around the world For more information on RA and SAN visit www.rainforestalliance.org.
RAINFOREST ALLIANCE
In terms of environmental and sustainability requirements the Rainforest Alliance (RA) certication scheme is certainly amongst the more ambitious. Based on multi-crop farm management guidelines continuously developed since 1992 by the Sustainable Agriculture Network, or SAN, a coalition of independent NGOs, its work has attracted considerable support, including substantial grant funding from the United Nations Development Program. Rainforest Alliance coffee production standards incorporate the ten Social and Environmental Principles of the Sustainable Agricultural Network: Social and Environmental Management System. Agriculture activities should be planned, monitored and evaluated, considering economic, social and environmental aspects and demonstrate compliance with the law and the certication standards. Planning and monitoring are essential to efcacious farm management, protable production, crop quality and continual improvement. Ecosystem Conservation. Farmers promote the conservation and recuperation of ecosystems on and near the farm. Wildlife Conservation. Concrete and constant measures are taken to protect biodiversity, especially threatened and endangered species and their habitats.
58
Through the continuous improvement concept of its Code Matrix and the Support Services, 4C helps farmers of all sizes, particularly also smallholders, and their business partners to access a baseline level of economic, environmental and social sustainability. The 4C Standard is a pure business-to-business concept for the coffee supply chain, offering an entry level sustainability baseline for producers from which they might step up towards more demanding sustainability standards. Conceptualized as a business-to-business standard and not as a consumer label, the 4C Association is pre-competitive and does not provide a label to market 4C Compliant Coffee towards the nal consumer on the coffee pack. Instead, 4C industry members may communicate their commitment and membership using a membership statement on coffee packs. The membership statement does not refer to the quality or quantity of roasted coffee, but is a means for 4C industry members to emphasize their support of the 4C Sustainability Approach. Except on coffee packs, the logo of the 4C Association may be used widely in publications, websites, brochures etc. 4C Units are the suppliers of 4C Compliant Coffee. The 4C Association believes that sustainability is not in the hands of coffee farmers alone all actors along the chain need to join forces to make sustainability happen. Therefore, 4C verication is performed at the 4C Unit level and a 4C Unit may be established at any stage of the coffee chain, from producer/producers groups to roaster level. 4C Units have to be located in producing countries. The managing entity of the 4C Unit assumes responsibility and coordinates the implementation of 4C with its individual suppliers. This mechanism actually allows the 4C Association to also address and include the manifold unorganized smallholders who would otherwise not have access to the market for sustainable coffee. Everyone in the coffee market chain from producers to transporters, collectors and warehouses, millers and processors, traders and exporters, roasters, and retailers can register as a 4C Unit. 4C Verication is the backbone of credibility for the 4C system. In the 4C system, 4C Verication checks compliance against the baseline standard of 4C, consisting of 28 parameters that represent a mix of environmental, social and economic considerations. All dened 10 Unacceptable Practices must be excluded and at least a minimum level of compliance (called average yellow) is required within each dimension of sustainability to successfully pass verication. All 4C verication is conducted by independent third party verication or certication organizations that have successfully participated in 4C verier training and are accredited to ISO/ Guide 65. 4C and other standards are benchmarking that benets the coffee industry. Being designed as a baseline standard for the mainstream sector, and therefore complementary to more demanding standards, the 4C Association aims at benchmarking with other standards in order to reduce the burden of multiple certication/verication for producers, while also directing its support services to those producers
59
that are not certied. The rst benchmarking was achieved with the Rainforest Alliance in mid-2008. The 4C Code of Conduct being a baseline standard, benchmarking with the Rainforest Alliances Sustainable Agriculture Network (SAN) standard is non-reciprocal. This means that holders of the Rainforest Alliance Certicate may apply for a 4C License without additional costs or verication procedures, whereas 4C License holders need to step up to SAN standards in order to become Rainforest Alliance certied. Being 4C Compliant of course makes it easier for such growers to make the move upwards. As a result of the 2008 benchmarking exercise, 4C members holding Rainforest Alliance certication are now being offered an additional marketing window because they can sell any surplus production as 4C Compliant Coffee. As mentioned earlier, UTZ Certied began the process of benchmarking in 2011.
the certication is used to ensure market access. This is because the label proves to the end-user that producers subscribe to good agricultural and management practices; protect the environment; practice safe pesticide use; and engage in resource protection generally. Thus, the product is accepted as both safe and environmentally friendly. For coffee the situation is rather different because coffee growers in the main provide green coffee to overseas roasters who in turn produce and retail the nished product. Therefore, in most instances the identity of the producing countries, let alone the individual producer, is not known to the end-user. Consequently there is much less consumer awareness of the production process and whether certication (or verication) by itself enhances a coffees marketability, is therefore a pertinent question. In the coffee industry, certication schemes also guarantee that specic rules and regulations of voluntary standards are met. On-pack labels then make this known to the end-user on the producers behalf and, often, the end-user is expected to pay a premium to recompense the grower for this specic effort. Verication similarly ensures that certain agreed criteria and practices are met, but does not use certicates or on-pack claims to market this to the end-user. Typically a mainstream market tool that offers market access rather than premia, verication is meant to improve efciency, sustainability and protability for growers on the one hand, whilst enabling buyers to make more informed decisions on the produce they purchase and process. Currently, the mainstream market accounts for between 85% and 90% of all green coffee exported from producing countries. Over time, it may be expected that buyers of mainstream coffee will increasingly insist on certain guarantees as regards the manner in which the coffee they buy is produced, perhaps to the gradual exclusion of those producers unable or unwilling to provide them. Verication would appear to be the most likely tool for this, in many cases enhanced by certication for a particular type of niche market. It should also be noted that the scope for premium priced coffee, purely based on quality, is in theory unlimited because it has direct and universal appeal to many more end-users. The market for quality or specialty (gourmet) coffee is increasing constantly, i.e. this market segment is demand driven and is showing strong growth. However, the scope for premium prices based on certication rather than on quality is limited because of demand reasons. This is so because for many if not a majority of end-users the intrinsic quality of a product is of more importance than is certied compliance with a code of conduct or standard. Therefore, the potential for certied coffees that require to be sold at a premium mostly lies in niche markets. However, the supply of such coffees is not necessarily always demand driven and over time some may be subject to oversupply. While certication denitely adds to a coffees image and may enhance its value, in the longer term certication by itself (so without the quality) is no guarantee for premium prices. But it can add to a coffees marketability.
60
Fairtrade
Fixed premium always assured (but overall level of demand not always in tandem with production).
Rainforest Alliance*
No assured premium (but 5 to 8 cts range was common in 2011).
UTZ CERTIFIED
No assured premium paid (but 2 to 5 cts was common in 2011).
Common Code 4C
No assured premium (but may be paid in certain circumstances if seller/buyer so agree)
Only indirect (and possibly positive) impact on yields and quality (through higher income, thus increased possibility of purchasing inputs and hiring labour). Higher labour inputs linked to collective processes such as coordination, meetings etc. Possible indirect impact through wider trade networking offering possibility of selling other Fairtrade products. Access to well-established, reliable market; technical assistance from Fairtrade importers. Access to trade nancing and traditional credit sources due to Fairtrade membership and improved nancial position of cooperatives. Increased organizational capacity of participating farmers; access to training; better organizational ability to serve members; community projects. Limited environmental benets.
Possibly positive through improved farming and processing methods. Moderately higher labour inputs.
Labour inputs
Possibility of selling other organic products from the farm; income diversication.
Increasing visibility of UTZ may improve conditions of trade. Number of buyers and markets increasing steadily. Potentially better extension services from supportive NGOs and some buyers, but limited support from public extension services. Strengthening organizational capabilities (if registration is done via farmer groups rather than as individuals). Limited environmental benets through the gradual elimination of inappropriate farming and processing methods. Potential for some reduced pest management and social risk; planning may improve.
Buyers and markets increasing steadily. More effective agro-forestry extension from supportive NGOs, but limited support from public system. Mutual support amongst farmers for forest management.
Potentially easier access to large segment of the mainstream market. Potential support from 4C-support platform and participating buyers; limited support from public extension services. Strengthening of organizational capabilities through potential assistance from 4C-support platform; access to training. Limited environmental benets through the gradual elimination of inappropriate farming and processing methods. Better planning and reduced risk through improved market access may be possible.
Possibly more effective extension from eld staff supported by NGOs and some buyers, but limited support from public system.
Potential increase in mutual support among farmers to solve farming management problems.
Environment
Potential adoption of new farming techniques to improve soil fertility as well as drought and erosion resilience.
Risk reduction through reduced external inputs; no mono-cropping; improved soil resilience; planning may improve.
Better planning for coffee production, personal and household needs; guaranteed price reduces risk.
Source: Based on original work and further input from Daniele Giovannucci and Stefano Ponte; 4C table by Jan van Hilten. * Also applies to most shade grown coffee. For more information on these and other standards visit ITCs www.standardsmap.org.
61
Table 3.5
Womens ownership in % of total (including co-ownership) Land used for coffee production including user rights Coffee when harvested Coffee when traded domestically Companies in the coffee sector (exporters, laboratories, certiers, transportation, etc.)
Women in the workforce in % of total Field work Harvest Trading in-country Sorting Export Other (certications, laboratories, etc.)
62
The Coffee Quality Institute, CQI, www.coffeeinstitute.org offers a leadership programme with mentors (from the Unites States) and fellows primarily in Central America and South America. Availability depends on funding which, currently, is restricted. A few countries have small national or in-country regional associations or womens groups in the coffee sector, for example in Mexico, Colombia, Peru, Kenya and India. Worth mentioning here is also the valuable work done by Grounds for Health (GFH), www.groundsforhealth.org. GFH is a not-for-prot organization founded to provide healthcare services to women in coffee-growing communities. GFH offers cervical cancer screening and treatment in several Latin American countries and more recently in East Africa.
CHAPTER 4
CONTRACTS
INTRODUCTION TO CONTRACTS .....................................................................................................................64 COMMERCIAL OR FRONT OFFICE ASPECTS ................................................................................................65 DOCUMENTATION OR BACK OFFICE ASPECTS............................................................................................70 STANDARD FORMS OF CONTRACT ..................................................................................................................73 ECF AND GCA CONTRACTS...............................................................................................................................75 UCP 600 IN SALES CONTRACTS ........................................................................................................................80 INCOTERMS .................................................................................................................................. 81
64
CHAPTER 4 CONTRACTS
CONTRACTS
INTRODUCTION TO CONTRACTS
International trade in coffee would not be possible without general agreement on the basic conditions of sale. Otherwise it would endlessly be necessary to repeat each and every contract stipulation for a proposed transaction, essentially very time consuming and open to mistakes. To avoid this the coffee trade has developed standard forms of contract of which the most frequently used are those issued by the European Coffee Federation (ECF www. ecf-coffee.org) in the Netherlands and the Green Coffee Association (GCA www.greencoffeeassociation.org) in the United States. Although many individual transaction details must be still agreed before a contract is concluded, the basic conditions of sale, unchanging conditions that apply time and time again, can be covered simply and easily by stipulating the applicable standard form of contract. Even so, an offer to sell (or a bid to buy) must stipulate the quality, quantity and price, the shipment period, the conditions of sale, the period during which the offer or bid is rm (valid), and so on.
MITIGATION OF LOSS
When loss is likely, both the seller and the buyer are required to mitigate the loss as much as possible: that is, they must keep the loss to a minimum. Regardless of who is liable to pay, both parties are responsible to keep the loss to a minimum. A good example is when documents are lost. Yes, it is the responsibility of the seller to trace and present them as soon as possible. Yet, the buyer cannot just let the coffee sit on the dock incurring late penalties (demurrage, container charges, etc.). The buyer is required to take all reasonable action necessary to keep the late charges to a minimum and when claiming damages has to prove both the reasonableness of the claim and that all possible action was taken to keep the loss to the unavoidable minimum.
CHAPTER 4 CONTRACTS
65
In this case the term rst class shipper can be added to the description, thereby implying that a reputable exporter will ship the coffee. But the term rst class is open to interpretation as well and so the contract may instead stipulate the names of exporters of whom the buyer approves, one of whom must eventually ship the coffee. Large roasters are quite exible about the origin of standard or commercial grade coffee, and to widen their purchasing options often leave the seller, often a trade house, free to deliver an agreed quality from one of a number of specied origins and shippers. Subject to approval of sample (SAS): This is one way to eliminate most of the quality risk inherent in buying unseen coffee from unknown shippers, as buyers are not obliged to accept any shipment that they have not rst approved. SAS obliges the exporter to provide an approval sample before shipment. There are three generally recognized possibilities: SAS, no approval no sale. If the sample is not approved the contract is automatically cancelled. SAS, repeat basis. If the rst sample is rejected, a second or even a third sample may be sent. Sometimes the contract will mention how many subsequent samples can be submitted. This option provides maximum quality security without immediately jeopardizing the contract, and works well in long-standing relationships. SAS, two or three samples for buyers choice. When the buyers quality requirements are very specic, and in order to save time, multiple samples may be submitted at the same time. To avoid confusion such contracts should stipulate whether repeat samples may be sent or whether no approval means no sale. Theoretically, an exporter who feels aggrieved by what seems to be an unreasonable (intentional) rejection and cancellation could declare a dispute and proceed to arbitration (chapter 7). However, the chance of success would be extremely slim if not non-existent, not least because an arbitration panel might rule it has no jurisdiction over what was in essence a purely conditional contract that never became binding (because the buyer did not approve a sample). Exporters should therefore be fairly selective when agreeing to sell subject to approval of sample. Stock-lot sample: Selling on stock-lot sample avoids potential approval problems. The sample represents a parcel that is already in stock so there should be no discrepancy between the sample and the shipment, including the screen size (even if the screen size was not stipulated). Day-to-day business would become too cumbersome if one insisted on stock-lot samples for all deals, but for newly established exporters or for those wishing to break into a niche market or to trade top quality coffees, stock-lots usually are the best route. Once a satisfactory delivery has been made, an exporter may wish to sell a similar quality again. Rather than send new samples, the exporter may offer quality equal to stock-lot X; this guarantees that the coffee is of comparable quality, suitable for the same end-use as the original purchase. The words equal to must be used because the sample was not
66
CHAPTER 4 CONTRACTS
drawn from the new lot of coffee. If the exporter feels that the quality is very similar, but that a little latitude is needed as to the coffees bean size or green appearance, they may say quality about equal to stock-lot X. Usually, such business is only between parties in a long-standing relationship who know each other well. Type: Once a few transactions have been satisfactorily concluded, buyer and seller may decide to make the quality in question into a type. Both parties are now condent that the quality will be respected and business can proceed without samples (although some roasters will still insist on pre-shipment samples). Usually the quality of a type (like a recipe) is kept condential between shipper and buyer. Top or exemplary coffees are mostly sold on sample or type basis, whereas medium and standard qualities are more often traded on description.
(named vessel, immediate or prompt shipment, rst half of a month) is a marketing handicap.
DELIVERY COMMITMENT
Offers and contracts must stipulate the point at which the exporter will have fullled its commitment to deliver, that is, the point at which risk and responsibility are transferred to the buyer. Free on board (FOB): the goods will be loaded at the sellers expense onto a vessel at the location stipulated in the contract, e.g. FOB Santos. The sellers responsibilities and risk end when the goods cross the ships rail, and from then on the buyer bears all charges and risk. Under the ECC contract the price to seller is expressed as FOB, but the buyer is currently responsible for insuring the goods from the last place of storage ahead of loading on board, e.g. the port warehouse, which is not the case under the GCA FOB contract. Most coffee contracts stipulate the price to the sellers in terms as FOB, but the ECC can be described as an ill-dened cost and freight contract. The use of FCA contracts seems to be on the increase. Free carrier (FCA): in landlocked countries the sale is often FCA, with buyers themselves arranging transport to the nearest ocean port and onward carriage by sea. International transporters, usually linked with shipping lines, often offer one-stop services, taking the goods in hand in Kampala, Uganda, and delivering them to Hamburg, Germany, for instance, using a single document known as a combined bill of lading covering both inland and maritime transportation. Risk of loss is transferred when the coffee is delivered to the freight carrier at the place of embarkation. All freight charges, including loading onto an ocean vessel, railcar, trailer or truck (combined bill of lading), are payable by the buyer. The exporter provides the customs clearance documentation. Unless special arrangements have been made with the carrier, such shipments must be re-stuffed at the port of shipment if an LCL (less than container load) bill of lading is required. Cost and freight (CFR, previously called C&F): the seller is responsible for paying costs and freight (but not insurance) to the agreed destination. Cost, insurance, freight (CIF): the seller is also responsible for taking out and paying the marine insurance up to the agreed point of discharge. Very rarely used nowadays. In all cases it is the sellers responsibility to deliver the shipping documents to the buyer. When a parcel is loaded on board ship, a mates receipt is issued to the ships agent. This is the legal basis for the bill of lading, which should be prepared and issued immediately. Shippers are entitled to the bill of lading as soon as the goods have been loaded. Some agents release them only once a vessel has sailed, but this is incorrect and causes unnecessary cost.
CHAPTER 4 CONTRACTS
67
The International Chamber of Commerces Guide to Incoterms 2010 contains a more detailed description of these and other shipping terms. However, the standard contracts used in the coffee trade all state or imply that also under an FOB sale the seller is responsible for booking freight space, arranging shipment and producing a full set of shipping documents. These stipulations in standard coffee contracts differ from, and supersede, the Incoterms denition of FOB.
plant. However, shipping in bulk has greatly reduced weight loss and as a result such a franchise has been reduced to a minimum (0.5% under both the ECC and the GCA contracts). Net shipped weights: the weights established at the time of shipment are nal, subject to the stipulations of the underlying standard form of contract. Under an FCA contract the parties can also agree that the net delivered weight be nal together with the procedures and conditions that shall apply. Net delivered weights or net landed weights: the goods will be reweighed upon arrival and nal payment will be made on the basis of the weights then established. If buyers are suspicious about the accuracy of the shipping weights they may require an independent weigher to supervise the weighing. Sellers may stipulate the same when selling basis net delivered weights or when weights are disputed and reweighing is ordered.
OCEAN FREIGHT
Most coffee contracts are effectively FOB in that the receivers pay the freight. Receivers prefer this because they can negotiate rates of freight that individual exporters or producing countries may be unable to obtain. For this reason, bills of lading do not always indicate the freight charge, or simply state freight as per agreement. As they are liable to pay the freight, receivers consider that they should also negotiate the rates (and argue, indirectly, that they are in fact better placed to do so). This may be so, but whenever the freight from a particular port increases buyers adjust their cost calculation for the origin in question as they calculate the cost of all coffee on the basis landed port or roasting plant of destination. If the freight rate from a particular country increases, the prices bid for coffee from that origin will eventually compensate for this if freights from comparable origins have not also risen. This is because the market compares like with like, that is, the landed cost. Ultimately therefore it is the producers who pay the freight charges. However, without the current arrangements some freight rates would likely be higher. See also chapter 5, Logistics. Terminal handling charges (THC): are an important part of container transport costs and can vary considerably between shipping lines, sometimes to the point where an apparently attractive rate of freight is in fact not attractive at all. Shippers should keep themselves informed of the THC raised directly or indirectly by individual shipping lines at the ports they load from as they can face unexpected costs if buyers specify a line whose freight is low (buyers advantage) but whose THC are high (shippers disadvantage).
PAYMENT: CONDITIONS
Usually, and advisedly so, the conditions of payment will have been agreed in advance and will therefore already be known to both parties, especially if the business relationship has existed for some time. But when offering to a new buyer the payment conditions must be specied. Letters of credit Uniform Customs and Practice. In the context of this guide a letter of credit is a contract between a bank and a seller whereby the bank undertakes to pay the seller an agreed sum against delivery of an agreed set of shipping documents. Terms and conditions governing letters of credit are laid down in what is known as the Uniform Custom and Practice for Documentary Credits, issued by the International Chamber of Commerce. The most recent version, the UCP 600 became effective from 1 July 2007. Because of its importance, UCP is discussed at the end of this chapter. Payment against letter of credit (L/C) requires the buyer to establish an L/C before shipment is effected. A letter of credit is an undertaking from the buyers bank to the exporters bank that payment will be made against certain documents such as the invoice, certicate of origin, weight note, certicate of quality and bill of lading (for sea transport) or waybill (for road or rail transport). The exporter should check that the documents specied in the letter of credit are obtainable. Sometimes buyers require verication of documents by an embassy or consulate not located in the exporters country, or they may include documents the exporter is not contractually required to provide. The timing of letters of credit is very important. The L/C must be available for the exporters use from day one of the agreed shipping period, and it must remain valid for negotiation for 21 calendar days after the last date that shipment is permitted to be made. Watch the timing very carefully: once the expiry
WEIGHTS
Most standard forms of contract stipulate that natural loss in weight exceeding a certain percentage is to be refunded by the sellers. This is known as the weight franchise. Coffee is hygroscopic, which means that it attracts or loses moisture depending on climatic conditions. It may therefore lose a little weight during storage and transport. To counter this weight loss, a number of exporters have traditionally packed a little more per bag than they invoice. This helps to ensure that arrival weights are as close to the agreed shipping weight as possible. Buyers know from experience what losses in weight to expect from most origins and take this into account when calculating the cost landed destination or roasting
68
CHAPTER 4 CONTRACTS
date has passed, the letter of credit is only as good as the buyers willingness to extend it. If the terms and conditions of an L/C are not met, the exporters bank will not pay the exporter until the buyer has conrmed that all is in order. This may involve sending the documents abroad without payment. If at that stage the buyer refuses to make payment, the exporter may be left with an unpaid shipment in some foreign port. The importance of conforming to all the conditions in a letter of credit cannot be stressed enough. Exporters should always consult their bankers before they assume that a letter of credit is acceptable. An ordinary (i.e. revocable) or unconrmed letter of credit is nothing more than an uncertain promise to pay if certain documentation is submitted. However, the UCP 600 have moved away from revocable credits, i.e. with effect from 1 July 2007 all credits became by default irrevocable. An irrevocable letter of credit cannot be cancelled once established. The exporter can be certain that funds will be available if valid documents are presented. Even so, the exporters bank may pay the exporter only when it has received the funds from the bank that established the letter of credit. This can create problems if, for example, the buyer argues that the documents are not correct or the buyers bank is slow in making payment. Under a conrmed and irrevocable letter of credit the exporters bank conrms that payment will be effected upon the timely presentation of valid documents without reference to the establishing bank. By adding its conrmation, the exporters bank therefore guarantees payment. If the negotiating bank discovers a minor discrepancy in the documents, such as a spelling error, it may still negotiate them providing the exporter signs a guarantee that in case of refusal by the buyer, the exporter will refund the payment received until the matter is settled. Whenever exporters feel that letters of credit are required, they should insist that they are conrmed and irrevocable. Even then, extreme care must always be taken to ensure that all details are respected, even to the spelling of words and shipping marks.
19(d), European Free Carrier Contract for Coffee (EFCACC) 18(c) and the relevant section in the GCA contract. In this way, the documents remain within the banking system until payment has been received, thus ensuring that the exporter does not lose control of the goods. If the exporter is in need of prompt payment it can ask their own bank to advance them all or part of the invoice value. This is known as negotiation of documents. The exporter remains responsible for the transaction if the buyer does not pay, the exporters bank will demand its money back. Documents in trust. Assuming the exporters bank does not object, documents may also be sent direct to the buyer with the request to make payment upon receipt of the documents. This is known as sending documents in trust. As the term implies, the decision to do this depends entirely on the trust the two parties place in each other. Payment net cash against documents upon arrival: payment is due when the goods arrive at the port of destination. When selling on this basis an exporter should always stipulate that payment must be made after expiry of a certain period, whether the goods have arrived or not. Otherwise there will clearly be problems if for some reason the goods arrive six months late or do not arrive at all because the vessel has been lost. Contracts should therefore always stipulate payment net cash against shipping documents upon arrival of the goods at [destination] but not later than 30 [or 60] days after date of bill of lading.
CHAPTER 4 CONTRACTS
69
establish letters of credit, and those that do establish them calculate the cost and inconvenience involved. Ultimately it is the grower who pays for such bureaucratic attitudes.
Counter offers: if a buyer counter bids a lower price against a rm offer this automatically releases the seller. The offer is no longer binding, because the buyer has rejected it by counter offering. If the seller rejects the counter offer the buyer cannot subsequently revert to the original offer: when they countered, that rm offer lapsed unless of course the seller agrees to reinstate it.
70
CHAPTER 4 CONTRACTS
be immediately available in the main import markets. Larger, more vertically integrated trade houses usually handle more easily traded coffees, standard qualities that are relatively widely bought and sold. Some of the very large houses at times almost operate as market makers in that their pricing becomes a reference point, even for origin, as shown below. First and second hand. Coffee sold direct from origin is rst hand (there were no intermediate holders). If the foreign buyer then re-offers that same coffee for sale, the market will know it as second hand. But international traders also offer certain coffees for sale independent of origin: in so doing they are going short in the expectation of buying in later at a prot. To achieve such sales they may actually compete with origin by quoting lower prices than the producers themselves. Market reports then refer to second hand offers or simply the second hand. Traders can buy and sell matching contracts many times, causing a single shipment to pass through a number of hands before reaching the end-user, a roaster. Such interlinked contracts are known as string contracts.
LETTERS OF CREDIT
Where payment against a letter of credit is stipulated the seller should obtain full details of the buyers letter of credit as soon as possible. This is to ensure that the required documentation is in fact obtainable, that there will be sufcient time to obtain such documentation, and that there are suitable shipping opportunities to the named port of destination within the stipulated period of shipment. The European Contracts for Coffee only require a full and complete letter of credit to be available for use from the rst day of the contractual period for shipment, even though the letter of credit may well contain stipulations on what must be done before loading. Therefore, it may be wise to provide specically in the contract for earlier receipt of the full and complete letter of credit. Sellers should also ensure that the letter of credit remains valid for the negotiation of documents for at least 21 days after the date of shipment. See also chapter 10. Both ECF and GCA stipulate this. If the length of validity is not carefully checked one could full all the L/C conditions only to nd it has lapsed. Buyers calculate all costs (from FOB through to delivery at nal destination) to arrive at the nal cost price landed roasting plant, taking into account any extra costs. For example, an origin that habitually delivers documents late (i.e. after the vessel has arrived) is penalized as the buyer will provide for this eventuality in the calculation to landed plant. In fact the importer actually saves money by not having to nance the goods for the expected period of time, but should the goods arrive before the documents then serious trouble will arise. If a letter of credit is demanded, the bid price will be lowered correspondingly to cover the costs. Such a bid would also be lower than that for similar coffees from other origins that do not require a letter of credit.
CHAPTER 4 CONTRACTS
71
The coffee must be shipped on a port to port or a combined transport bill of lading issued by a shipping line which, using one or more vessels, will carry the goods throughout the voyage without further intervention by seller or buyer. The line issues a bill of lading at the port of origin to cover the entire voyage, enabling the buyer to see the details of shipment on the rst vessel and to claim the coffee at nal destination from a subsequent vessel. See also chapter 5, Logistics. Transshipment: the rst vessel discharges at an intermediate port and the goods are reloaded onto another vessel to the nal destination. This is increasingly frequent as shipping companies rationalize operations and container vessels become larger. In particular, the use of containers has encouraged the development of shipping hubs: larger or more central ports that are fed containers from outlying ports by smaller or feeder vessels for loading onto large container vessels. Shipping advice: as soon as the required information is available, the seller must advise certain specic details of the shipment. However, note that under the ECFs FCA contract sellers have just two calendar days to transmit advice of delivery. For a shipment on terms other than CIF (which the seller insures), the shipping advice enables the buyer to insure the shipment and either to make the necessary arrangements to receive it at the port of destination or (where the bill of lading allows such a choice) to declare an optional port of destination in time for the shipping company to arrange discharge there. A series of time limits in ECC are designed to ensure that these objectives are met, and to give the buyer the freedom to procure a replacement parcel elsewhere if no shipment is forthcoming. The details to be included in the advice of shipment or delivery are listed in the ECF contracts. The buyer is entitled to receive such advice, or an advice of delayed shipment/ delivery, or an advice of force majeure. Failure to receive an advice theoretically entitles the buyer to take the drastic step of cancelling the contract and claiming recompense for any loss suffered. More stringent security measures at ports of entry in both the United States and the European Union require shippers to provide more detailed shipping advices. For example, GCA states that for FCA, FOB, CIF, CFR or EDK shipment contracts the shipping advice must include all U.S. Food and Drug Administration (FDA) required information.
If a problem of a much wider scope and of a more serious nature arises that prevents the seller, as well as other shippers, from shipping within the contracted period then, in addition to sending the notication of delayed shipment immediately this becomes evident, under certain circumstances the seller may be able to claim force majeure. Under ECF contracts the effect of both an advice of delayed shipment (or delivery) and an advice of force majeure is initially to extend the period allowed for shipment. Cancellation of the contract follows if the problem continues after that period (although cancellation would be rather unusual). However, GCA does not specify any extension and explicitly excludes events taking place before arrival of the goods at port of shipment. Experienced exporters know that quick and frank admission of shipping problems usually helps them to reach an amicable settlement with their buyers. Failure to ship is bad enough, but failure to keep buyers informed is even worse as it prevents them from making alternative arrangements in time.
DELAYED SHIPMENTS
The seller must advise the buyer of delayed shipment as soon as, for example, they become aware that a vessel may not load within the contracted period due to problems connected with the operations of the vessel itself such as a delay on the inbound voyage. Sellers must also show, using independent documentary proof, that a late shipment is not their fault.
72
CHAPTER 4 CONTRACTS
shipment. A bill of lading made out to a named consignee can be endorsed only by that consignee, not the shipper. Once a consignee has been named the original shipper no longer has any power to alter the bill of lading in connection with title to the shipment. If the consignee is not known at the time the shipper instructs shipment on a particular vessel then the bills of lading may also be made out to order. In this case, only the party to whom they are endorsed with the words deliver to or deliver to the order of can take delivery. This endorsement is made by the shipper who is named on the bill of lading. Occasionally buyers stipulate in their shipping instructions that the goods be consigned to order. A bill of lading is a negotiable instrument and can be passed from a shipper through any number of parties, each party endorsing it to assign title to the next party. The only condition is that title can be assigned only by the party shown on the bill as having title at the time. Any failure to respect this condition breaks what is known as the chain of title; all purported assignments of title after such a break are invalid. Before paying for documents a buyer will therefore carefully examine the bill of lading to see that they are named on it as consignee, either on the face or on the reverse in an endorsement. In the latter case, the buyer will also make sure that the endorsements show an unbroken chain of title through to them. There is one exception to the general rule that a consignee must be named on a bill of lading to take delivery of a shipment. This is when the bill is a bearer bill. In this case, anyone holding (or bearing) the bills (or one bill of the set) can take delivery. Bills are considered bearer bills when the word bearer is entered in the space marked consignee when the bills are rst made out. Alternatively a title-holder endorses the bills with the words deliver to bearer, or a named title-holder endorses the bills in blank, i.e. by stamping and signing them without naming any other party in his endorsement. Although this may be simple and convenient, it means that anyone who obtains all or any of the originals (including a thief or a buyer who has not yet made payment) can take delivery of the shipment. Bills of lading are therefore usually made out to or endorsed to a named consignee. The greatest security of all is afforded by issuing or endorsing a bill to a buyer nominated bank with an instruction to the bank to endorse and hand the bill over to the buyer when, and only when, payment has been made.
of lading. Many exporters use courier services and send all documents at once.
CERTIFICATES
ICO certicates of origin are issued for every international shipment of coffee from producers to consumers (whether the importing country is an ICO member or not), and are used to monitor the movement of coffee worldwide. The forms contain details of identity, size, origin, destination and time of shipment of the parcels in question. ICO certicates were particularly important when ICO export quotas were in force as they were also used to enforce the quota limits for individual exporting countries. The certicates are now less important and some consumer countries no longer insist on them. But it is in the interest of exporting countries to comply with ICO regulations on certicates of origin as they enable the ICO to monitor coffee movements and produce accurate statistics on each countrys exports. Moreover, all ICO exporting members are required to ensure that all coffee issued with certicates of origin complies with the minimum quality standards indicated by ICO resolution 407. See also chapter 11, Coffee quality. Preferential entry certicates: Countries that levy duties or taxes on coffee imports sometimes grant duty exemptions to certain exporting countries. Entitlement to remission of duty or tax is obtained by submitting an ofcial certicate of exemption (EUR1, GSP and others). Individual sales contracts often state that an exemption certicate must be provided where appropriate. This certicate must accompany the shipping documents, failing which the buyer is entitled to deduct the duty difference from the invoice and pay only the balance. The seller will be able to obtain refund of the shortfall by submitting the required certicate retroactively, but only if the buyer in turn is able to obtain this within the applicable time limit from the authorities in the country of importation. Sellers who are in doubt about whether such a certicate is required should ask their local chamber of commerce or trade authority. Note also that under ECC a buyer may stipulate a country of importation other than that of the port of destination. Insurance certicates: Under a CIF contract the seller must provide an insurance certicate, issued by a rst-class insurance company, showing that insurance has been taken out in accordance with the terms of the sales contract. The certicate must enable the buyer to claim any losses directly from the insurance company. The certicate entitles the holder to the rights and privileges of a known and stipulated master marine insurance policy that may cover a number of shipments. The certicate represents the policy and is transferable with all its benets by endorsement in the same manner as bills of lading. Other certicates: There are an increasing number of other certicates available for special contractual requirements. Some, such as weight and quality certicates, are supplied by recognized public or private organizations in the country
CHAPTER 4 CONTRACTS
73
of origin, and have various formats. Others, such as health, phytosanitary and non-radiation certicates, are often supplied on application by government bodies, in a set format prescribed by local law and regulations. The variety of formats available for special purpose certicates is so great that it is not practical or useful to discuss them here. Shippers should be familiar with the format of local certicates and should investigate their availability and cost before entering into any contractual obligation. Otherwise they may be unable to supply a document at all or may require a price increase to cover costs.
invalidate a document or affect its reliability, the document is regarded as a missing document and a guarantee can be submitted in its place. The seller then returns the document itself for re-issue or amendment.
OVERRIDING PRINCIPLE
The standard forms of contract set out generally accepted rules, practices and conditions in the international trade in coffee for which the terminology and precise meaning have been standardized under the aegis of leading coffee trade bodies (for Europe the ECF, and for the United States the GCA). The GCA contracts are also available in an electronic or XML (extensible mark-up language) version, together with a price xing letter, a price x rolling letter and a destination declaration letter. The data les are available, free of charge, from the GCA at www.greencoffeeassociation.org. For more information on using the XML versions exporters should contact their American buyers or agents. Both ECF and GCA publish a number of contracts dealing with different types of transactions. Most coffee is traded using these standard contracts. Others exist but are rarely used. All ECF and GCA contracts state expressly that no contract shall be contingent on any other and that each contract is to be settled between buyers and sellers without reference to any other contracts covering the same parcel. Although intended to cover string contracts this also means exporters cannot claim inability to ship because someone else, say an interior supplier, let them down. (Traders sometimes buy and sell matching contracts many times, causing a single shipment to pass through a number of hands before reaching an end-user. Such contracts are called string contracts.)
74
CHAPTER 4 CONTRACTS
Contract for Spot Coffee (ECSC) and the European Delivery Contract for Coffee (EDCC). While important for importers and traders they are of little direct interest to exporters. Go to www.ecf-coffee.org for the full contracts. ECC and EFCACC cover both coffee shipped in bags and coffee shipped in bulk using lined containers. Note that although hardly any bagged coffee is still shipped without the use of containers, ECC does not stipulate that containers must be used. It allows it, provided the bill of lading states that the shipping company is responsible for the number of bags. Parties wishing to conclude individual transactions on a different basis must therefore ensure that the sales contract stipulates on what basis containerization shall be permitted. EFCACC on the other hand stipulates that delivery of coffee in bags shall be made in containers, under LCL/FCL conditions, whereby the carrier is responsible for the number of bags and the condition and suitability of the containers. Incoterms. Both ECF and GCA contracts make no reference to these, not because of any disqualication or disagreement, but because Incoterms are a general (i.e. not coffee-specic) set of international trade denitions. The exclusion is purely to safeguard the stand-alone status and clarity of the ECF and GCA contracts that have been written by and for the trade in coffee. See Exclusions in this chapter and go to www.iccwbo.org/ incoterms/understanding.asp for more on Incoterms. The main implication of this exclusion is that, as for CFR or CIF contracts, under an FOB contract the seller is acquitted of responsibility only once the goods pass the ships rail. This is the same for GCA contracts. Under ECC the stipulation means that any buyer wishing to impose the use of a particular shipping line or vessel must make this known at the time of concluding the contract. But under GCA this has already been formalized in that the standard GCA conditions state that for FCA and FOB sales the buyer reserves the right to nominate the carrier. EFCACC also stipulates that buyers shall nominate the carrier.
Health and Safety in the Importation of Green Coffee into the United States from the National Coffee Association of USA. If coffee is refused entry under a contract that does not bear this over-stamp, in addition to having to refund payment as above the seller may also be required to make a replacement delivery within 30 days. Effective 1 January 2006, contracts should stipulate whether they cover Commercial Grade or Specialty Grade coffee. This will determine the type of arbitration that would be held if nothing is specied, then the contract is automatically assumed to cover Commercial Grade coffee. There are nine GCA contracts. Four of them deal with coffee that is sold outside of the country of destination, four deal with coffee sold inside the country of destination, and one deals with coffee delivered at the border or frontier. The main distinction between the contract types is based on how cost and risk are allocated between the parties. Go to www. greencoffeeassociation.org for the full contracts. Free carrier (FCA). Risk of loss is transferred when the coffee is delivered to the freight carrier at place of embarkation. All freight charges, including loading onto an ocean vessel, railcar or trailer, are payable by the buyer. Free on board (FOB). Risk of loss is transferred when the coffee crosses over the ships rail. Terminal handling costs at the place of loading are for account of the shipper. Free on railcar (FOR) and free on truck or trailer (FOT) are variations of FOB, the only difference being the type of conveyance. The buyer pays the freight charges. Cost and freight (CFR). As for FOB except that freight is included in the price and paid by the seller. Cost, insurance and freight (CIF). As for CFR, but the seller also pays marine insurance and provides a certicate of insurance. Delivered at frontier (DAF). Under DAF contracts, risk of loss is transferred when the coffee is delivered to a named point at the frontier. Delivery takes place on arriving means of transport (trailer, truck, rail car), and is cleared for export, but not cleared for import. Ex dock (EDK or xDK). When coffee is sold ex dock, risk of loss transfer takes place on the dock at port of destination, after all ocean freight and terminal handling charges are paid, and customs entry and all government regulations have been satised. Ex warehouse (EWH or xWH), delivered (DLD) and spot (SPT) contracts are outside the scope of normal export business and not discussed here. Price to be xed (PTBF). This does not feature in ECC but GCA stipulates that such contracts shall specify the differential (value) that is added to or subtracted from an agreed price basis. When applicable the number of lots of coffee futures should also be mentioned, as well as whether buyer or seller has the right to execute the xation. If there is margin payable
CHAPTER 4 CONTRACTS
75
between time of xation and time of shipment/delivery, it must be determined at time of contract. Finally, the earliest and the latest xation date shall be specied at time of contract. Any changes are to be by mutual agreement and in writing.
Weights at shipment
Weight franchise of 0.5% on coffee sold net shipped weight in ECC and EFCACC. Any weight loss on arrival in excess of 0.5% is to be refunded by the seller. Until the end of 1997 the tolerance was 1%. The present gure is a direct consequence of the growth in bulk shipments, in the sense that there should hardly be any weight variation if coffee is correctly shipped in lined and sealed containers. Shippers of bagged coffee often include a small tolerance (excess weight) per bag to avoid claims. GCA standard contracts state that for coffee sold on a shipped weight basis, and unless otherwise specied on the contract, the franchise is 0.5%. Independent evidence of weight. The shipping weight shall be established at the time and place of shipment, or at the time and place of stufng if the coffee is stuffed into the shipment containers at an inland location. In either case, sellers shall provide independent evidence of weight. This stipulation in both ECC and EFCACC provides buyers with some independent evidence that a container for which the bill of lading or waybill states said to contain in fact does hold a certain amount of coffee. This does not alter the shippers responsibility in any way unless the parties agree that shipping weights shall be nal (together with the procedure and conditions that shall apply). GCA does not make this stipulation. The requirement to provide independent evidence of shipping weights applies equally to coffee sold delivered weights. Supervision by buyers representatives (independent weighers). Buyers can demand this under both ECC and GCA provided they give due notice and pay the costs. The seller is obliged to provide the certicate together with the shipping documents but the buyer cannot withhold payment if the seller does not provide it. It is possible that the supervising weigher failed to hand the certicate to the
Packing
ECC and EFCACC state that the coffee shall be packed in sound uniform natural bre bags suitable for export and in conformity with the legal requirements for food packaging materials and waste management within the European Union valid at the time of conclusion of the contract. This is important and exporters must know what types and quality of bags are acceptable, not only in the European Union but also in other countries. Be careful not to confuse port of destination with country of destination as the two may not always be the same. To read the EU Packaging and Packaging Waste Disposal Directive go to www.europa.eu (ofcial publications, use EUR-Lex). See also the Draft Code of Hygienic Practice for the Transport of Foodstuffs in Bulk and Semi-Packed Foodstuffs of the Codex Alimentarius Commission at www.codexalimentarius. net and chapter 12, Quality control.
76
CHAPTER 4 CONTRACTS
GCA stipulates that coffee bags shall be made of sisal, henequen, jute, burlap or similar woven material, without any inner lining or outer covering. Bulk coffee shall be in a bulk container liner. Depending on the contract so-called super sacks (jumbo bags) made of synthetic bre may also be used. Soluble coffee is commonly shipped in cardboard cartons with a plastic liner. All forms of packaging must conform to food grade packaging standards at the country of destination.
carrier for transport. The place of embarkation or point of delivery must always be clearly noted on the bill of lading or carriers receipt. Port of destination. If this is not advised when the contract is concluded, the buyer must declare it at the latest by the deadline stipulated by either ECC or GCA. Otherwise a buyer could simply refuse to declare a port of destination and so frustrate the execution of a contract (for example, if the price had become unfavourable due to change in the market). Note that the ECC text states that the deadline is met when the declaration is made at the buyers place of business, i.e. all the buyer has to do is send the declaration by cable, fax, e-mail, telex or other means of written electronic communication. The shipper cannot declare the buyer in default simply because no declaration has been received; if a declaration is overdue, the shipper should make inquiries rather than just let events unfold. GCA does not say this but clearly the same principle of due diligence applies. However, whereas ECC sets a clear deadline for lodging a technical claim, GCA sets a limit of one year from the date the issue arises. Note also that ECC Article 27 states that communication by fax, e-mail or other means of written electronic communication is at the parties own risk (basically because proof of dispatch and receipt is not automatic). Sometimes by the time the declaration (of destination) falls due the coffee has not yet been sold on and the buyer may not be in any position to declare a nal destination. In the past the buyer would then declare a range of ports (e.g. Rotterdam, option Bremen/Hamburg), called options or optional ports. Then the goods would be stowed on board in such a way as to make discharge possible at any of the named ports, with the cost or option fees for buyers account. But on modern container vessels such stowage is difcult if not impossible. Exporters should satisfy themselves therefore that the shipping line will in fact accept such cargo before they agree to ship to optional ports. Transshipment is a much more frequently used option but current transshipment practices often make it difcult to conrm the nal vessel. Shipping advices against FOB contracts, and indeed bills of lading, can only mention the vessel that rst loads the goods, leaving tracking of the goods to the buyer. Note also that bills of lading may stipulate the place of delivery as CFS (a container freight station) at or associated with the port of destination, regardless of the port of discharge. NB: To note that GCA also states that, in the case of a contract for forward shipment, if the buyer fails to declare the destination then the seller may ship to New York. ECC does not include any such provision. What this means in fact is that where a buyer fails to declare the destination in time, this GCA clause offers the seller the choice whether to make shipment or not, always provided that such shipment is made within the contracted period. The underlying philosophy is to give a shipper an alternative if the buyer totally refuses to cooperate. The shipper will then ship to New York and, if the buyer refuses to honour
Quality
The quality of the coffee must be strictly as per contract. If there is a difference and the resultant claim cannot be settled amicably then it will go to arbitration. A buyer cannot lodge any formal claim before paying for the shipping documents. Effective 1 January 2006, GCA contracts should stipulate whether they cover Commercial Grade or Specialty Grade coffee. This will determine the type of arbitration that would be held if nothing is specied, then the contract is automatically assumed to cover Commercial Grade coffee. Claims are usually settled by granting an allowance that the seller must pay, together with the buyers costs and expenses. But if the coffee is unsound or the quality is radically different from that specied then the buyer may seek to have the contract discharged by invoicing back the coffee. In awarding invoicing back the arbitrators shall establish the price bearing in mind all the circumstances concerned. Basically this means they may order the contract cancelled and instruct the sellers to refund the entire cost of the coffee plus any relevant damages. Note that an excessive moisture level is one factor towards declaring a coffee unsound. See also chapters 5 and 12. Under GCA all quality issues FCA, FOB, CFR, CIF and DAF are settled by allowance, except gross negligence and fraud. In the latter case the arbitration will be a technical arbitration that might convene a quality panel to verify negligence or fraud.
Freight
Where coffee is sold CFR/CIF the costs of bringing the goods to the port of destination are for the account of the seller. If the rate of freight increases between the time of sale, and the time of shipment then the increase is for the sellers account. Only increases that enter, into force after the shipment took place shall be for the buyers account. This is indicative of the trades wish to control freights and shipping through the use of FOB contracts. Exporters who have to use national ag carriers therefore also have to accept they are potentially liable to pay for such freight increases. Place of embarkation. ECC does not speak of this, but GCA states that for FOB, CFR and CIF contracts this shall be dened as the named seaport of the country of origin; for both the GCA and ECF FCA contracts it is dened as the place where custody of the coffee is turned over to the
CHAPTER 4 CONTRACTS
77
the documents, the goods are sold in the open New York market. The shipper then sends an invoice to the original buyer for any loss. If the buyer refuses to settle the shipper then goes to arbitration and wins a judgment that will be relatively easy to enforce in the Unites States, based on New York law. When a buyer refuses to give a destination, contract performance becomes secondary to legal action. New York is a coffee market with major liquidity and the assumption is that just about any coffee can be sold there. However, with the exception of Japan and Canada, little coffee is traded on the GCA contract to non-American destinations. The entire procedure is a last resort, but it gives possible nality to an argument that otherwise could go on forever.
parties. Again, GCA leaves the matter of the shipment basis to the parties to the contract. LCL, or less than container load: the shipping line accepts responsibility for the number of bags. FCL, or full container load: the line accepts responsibility only for the container, not for the contents, by stating for example, STC (said to contain) 300 bags of coffee on the bill of lading. See also chapter 5, Logistics and insurance.
Shipment in bulk
Unless otherwise agreed, shipment shall be made under FCL/FCL conditions. This reects the move from break bulk to almost universal containerization. Unless otherwise stated, FCL/FCL is now the norm. This means that bulk is increasingly, if not always, loaded and weighed under independent supervision, but shippers still have to pass on to the shipping line all relevant instructions received from buyers, and in case of damage may be asked to provide proof of having done so. GCA leaves the matter entirely to the parties, who must stipulate the agreed shipping basis in the contract.
Shipment
Shipment must be made at the vessels last scheduled call at the port of shipment before commencing the nal voyage. This is reminiscent of when traditional break bulk vessels used to discharge and load cargo at a range of ports in the same region and in so doing might call at the same port on the way in and on the way out. Modern container vessels rarely if ever do so but the stipulation is nevertheless a valid one and applies to both ECC and GCA. Shipment must be made by conference line or other acceptable vessel (ECF), or metal-hulled, self-propelled vessels which are not over 20 years of age and not less than 1,000 net registered tons, classed A1 American Record or equivalent, operating in their regular trade (GCA). This prevents shippers from using any old tramp vessel that happens to be available. (Tramp vessels make irregular port calls to discharge and look for new cargo, i.e. the exact opposite of liner vessels.) Note also that at some future stage European Union authorities may introduce legislation covering the type, class, condition and age of ships that may enter European Union ports. Information on vessel registration and vessels themselves is available at www.lloydslistintelligence.com, by subscription only. Shippers will pass on to the shipping line all relevant instructions received from buyers. These apply equally to shipment in bags in containers, and to shipments in bulk. This is important in case of subsequent problems shippers may be asked to furnish proof they did so.
Delay in shipment
Sellers shall not be held responsible if they are able to prove their case. The most important point this article makes is that the buyer must be kept informed at all times without undue delay. This is absolutely essential. Delays in shipment usually affect buyers adversely and they must be enabled to take measures to protect themselves. Failing to respect this clause not only is entirely unprofessional but can also result in unforeseen consequences, possibly even cancellation of the contract.
On-carriage of containers
Buyers may discharge containers at inland destinations. The point of containerization is to minimize handling and the only object of this clause is to permit receivers to bring the coffee without unnecessary handling as near to its nal destination as possible, for example a roasting plant. In case of weight claims buyers have to prove weighing took place under independent supervision. GCA permits the same. In addition it denes the port of entry as all dock and warehouse facilities within a 50-mile radius of ships berth that are used for the discharge of ships cargo (or all freight facilities within a 50mile radius of a border crossing).
Shipment in bags
Shipment in containers, suitable for the transport of coffee, shall be permitted under LCL/FCL conditions, whereby the shipping company is responsible for the number of bags and the condition and suitability of the containers. However, shipping lines increasingly discourage LCL/FCL (or LCL/LCL) and in future shippers may not always be able to satisfy buyers wishes in this regard. In this case their only option will be to effect weighing and stufng under independent supervision at their expense as all other shipments in containers shall require agreement of the
Advice of shipment
Both ECC and GCA require that advice of shipment must be transmitted as soon as known. In practice only gross negligence could explain why one would not advise buyers as soon as possible, which only leaves the question of whether or not the advice actually reaches them promptly. But ECC and GCA approach this question very differently. ECC considers it may not be within the sellers control and so, in theory, it sufces if buyers receive the notice before the vessel arrives at the port of destination. Only someone with
78
CHAPTER 4 CONTRACTS
no interest in good business relationships would consider this normal practice, however. EFCACC on the other hand stipulates that advice of delivery must be transmitted within two calendar days of the date of delivery. There is an important provision in the ECC articles dealing with advice of shipment and/or delivery. If a shipping or delivery advice is not received by noon on the fourteenth calendar day after the expiry of the contractual shipping or delivery period, and if there has been no notication of a delay and no force majeure has been pleaded, then damages may be claimed or the buyer may cancel the contract altogether. This could leave a forgetful exporter with an unsold and most likely uninsured shipment. See Article 13(d) of the ECC and Article 12(d) of the EFCACC for full details. GCA on the other hand states that for FCA, FOB, CFR, CIF and EDK contracts, written advice with all details must be transmitted not just as soon as known, but not later than on the day of arrival of the vessel at destination and/or ve business days from bill of lading date, whichever is later. The advice may be given verbally with e-mail or fax conrmation to be sent the same day. This is included because of the close proximity of many Latin American producing countries to the United States, but it applies to all contracts.
the ultimate warehouse or other place of storage at the port of shipment. This is because it can be extremely difcult to determine at what point the marine insurer became liable for any damage or loss incurred once the goods have left the ultimate place of storage. If after leaving the ultimate place of storage but before crossing the ships rail the goods were destroyed by re, or fell into the water, then the seller might receive no bill of lading at all and would be unable to submit shipping documents for the buyer to pay. This is why ECC also states that the sellers have the right to the benet of the policy until the documents are paid for. In the above example the buyer would have to claim the loss or damage under their insurance cover on the sellers behalf. But even if a vessel sinks immediately after loading the seller will receive a bill of lading and the buyer will have to pay for it. Until payment is made, the benet of the insurance cover remains contractually vested in the sellers. GCA on the other hand relies instead on the transfer of risk stipulation that applies for each contract: shippers and buyers must cover insurance accordingly. EFCACC stipulates that insurance shall be covered prior to the contractual delivery period, that sellers shall have the right to the policy until the documents are paid for, and that insurance shall extend from the time the coffee is delivered to the carrier for an amount 5% above the contract price. (Prior to delivery insurance is of course sellers responsibility). See also chapter 5.
Shipping documents
Sellers must provide shipping documents in good time (including a full set of clean on board bills of lading, i.e. bills stating that the goods were received on board ship in apparent good order), enabling the buyer to clear the goods upon arrival. Failure to provide documents in time will incur demurrage and other costs, and could even lead to cancellation of the contract under both ECC and GCA. Delivery documents under EFCACC are to be made available promptly but latest within 14 days of the carriers receipt, otherwise penalties or in extreme cases cancellation may apply. ECC Article 18 and EFCACC Article 17 stipulate the documents buyers are entitled to receive and those they are entitled to request.
Export licences
Under both ECF and GCA contracts the exporter is not only responsible for obtaining export licences but also for the consequences if such a licence is later cancelled or revoked. Similarly, buyers are responsible for obtaining any import licences required.
Insurance
The vast majority of the trade in coffee today is on FOB terms. In this regard ECC Article 15 contains three extremely important stipulations. In the case of CFR and FOB contracts the buyers have to cover the insurance ahead of the contractual shipment period. Without this stipulation the coffee might be loaded without any insurance cover in place, leaving the exporter at risk. In case of doubt an exporter should insist on proof of insurance. The current (late 2011) version of the ECC stipulates that the insurance shall commence from the time the coffee leaves
CHAPTER 4 CONTRACTS
79
(The United States and Canada do not levy import duties or taxes on green coffee.)
do not constitute force majeure. Disputes dealing with force majeure will by nature be technical and as such are subject to a one-year ling time limit (see also chapter 7).
Payment
The coffee remains the property of the sellers until it has been paid for in full. No third party can lay claim to any coffee that has not been paid for. This is important when documents are sent in trust. If a buyer is declared insolvent after the documents are received but before they have been paid, then the judicial authorities (or liquidators) have no claim to the goods, although in some countries national insolvency law takes precedence over individual contract stipulations. How far sellers can enforce this clause in European Union and other importing countries therefore depends on local law. In the United States there are no doubts in this respect. When invoked, bankruptcy law (11 USC 365 (e)(1) overrides all GCA terms and conditions. Most coffee is sold on payment terms in the United States and Canada and the risks are great. Selling net 30 days from delivery means the seller is granting the buyer possession 30 days before payment. If the buyer goes bankrupt, the seller may lose the value of the coffee. There can even be problems with payments that are made within the 90 days prior to a bankruptcy. This is called the preference period and if the liquidator or trustee can show that the payments were not normal (i.e. extraordinarily late or extraordinarily early), then a supplier might be forced to return the payments to the bankruptcy pool. ECF and GCA contracts both state that letters of credit must conform exactly to the contract, must be available for use from day one of the agreed shipping period, and must remain valid for negotiation for 21 calendar days after the last date shipment can be made. This allows time for the seller to obtain all the required documents and possible consular visas.
Force majeure
Partial performance, non-performance or delayed performance of a contract can be justied only as a result of unforeseeable and insurmountable occurrences, but only if these arise after the conclusion of the contract and before the expiry of the performance period allowed by the contract. And furthermore only if the seller informs the buyer as soon as the impediment arises, provides evidence and keeps the buyer fully informed of developments. In other words, make sure your buyer knows what you know yourself. Under ECF contracts a successful plea of force majeure can extend the performance time limit by up to a maximum of 45 calendar days, after which the contract lapses. Disputes have to be settled by arbitration. GCA follows the same principle but does not specify any extension. It also states that in no case shall the seller be excused by any such causes intervening before arrival of the affected portion of the coffee at the point of embarkation of the original shipment. Thus, delays within producing countries
Default
Default occurs if one of the parties does not execute its part of the contract. After declaring the offending party to be in default the injured party can claim discharge of the contract with or without damages (but excluding any consequential, i.e. indirect, damages). If the offender fails to pay these or disputes them then the matter shall be decided by arbitration. The default clause is stipulated separately in the ECF contracts, mainly because the notion of a claim assumes an incorrectly executed contract. Default on the other hand deals with the cost and damage to the injured party of the total and possibly wilful non-execution of a contract.
80
CHAPTER 4 CONTRACTS
As in the case of invoicing goods back for a radical difference in quality, there are no xed rules for determining default damages. In the European Union the process depends on the arbitral body under whose jurisdiction the arbitration is held. The GCA contracts provide for arbitration in different American locations provided a location other than New York has been specied in the contract. If no location is specied then arbitration will automatically be held in New York with the arbitrators setting the damages if any are awarded.
Arbitration
Any dispute that cannot be resolved amicably shall be resolved through arbitration at the place stated in the contract. Unless a different American location has been specied in the contract, the GCA contracts automatically place arbitration in New York, to be held in accordance with the law of New York State. However, the ECF is the umbrella body for a number of national coffee associations in sovereign countries, quite a few of which have their own arbitral bodies, rules and legal systems (see chapter 7, Arbitration). In this context the most important are the United Kingdom (London), Germany (Hamburg) and France (Le Havre), followed by Italy (Trieste), Belgium (Antwerp) and the Netherlands (Amsterdam). All ECF contracts provide that disputes shall be resolved by arbitration but the actual commercial contract must state where this shall take place. If not then arbitration will be delayed while the ECF Contracts Committee determines where it will be held and the defending party may nd itself having to deal with arbitration proceedings in a location it is not familiar with.
Communications
Article 27 of ECC (26 in EFCACC) lists the Notices that are required to be given under different Articles and how they can be given (fax, e-mail etc.) and should be recorded. GCA allows fax and e-mail or equivalent electronic message.
Exclusions
The following laws and conventions do not apply to ECF standard forms of contract: The Uniform Law on Sales and the Uniform Law on Formation to which effect is given by the Uniform Laws on International Sales Act 1967; The United Nations Convention on Contracts for the International Sale of Goods of 1980; and The United Nations Convention on Prescription (Limitation) in the International Sale of Goods Act 1974 and the amending protocol of 1980. GCAs Legal Framework and Contract Rulings simply state that The UN Convention on Contracts for the International Sale of Goods shall not apply to this contract.
CHAPTER 4 CONTRACTS
81
NON-DOCUMENTARY REQUIREMENTS
It is a common occurrence for documentary credits to contain instructions that are not expressly attached to a document that needs to be tendered. However, if for example the credit stipulates shipment on a vessel of a particular class, but does not require the tender of a classication certicate, then under UCP 600 the bank is under no obligation to inquire as to the age of the vessel named in the bill of lading. This means that if a buyer is particularly anxious to ensure that payment is only made if the bank is satised, say, that the vessel carries a particular classication, the buyer should: Stipulate in the sale contract for the tender of a copy of the classication certicate under the letter of credit; and Stipulate for the tender of the same document in the letter of credit. In this way, the buyer ensures, rst, that the seller cannot complain that the letter of credit requires more documents than does the sale contract and, second, that the seller will only be paid on tender of a conforming classication certicate. The seller needs to consider, when agreeing the terms of the contract, whether he or she will be in a position to satisfy the obligation the buyer is seeking to impose upon him. For example, how easy will it be to get hold of a copy of such a classication certicate?
FORCE MAJEURE
This Article (36) is largely unchanged although express reference is now made to terrorism. The stipulation that under UCP the expiry date of a credit is not extended as a result of force majeure remains unchanged, i.e. a credit will simply expire even though force majeure may prevent the seller from utilising it. But something sellers may not always be aware of is that documents under letters of credit may also be presented for payment at the issuing bank (as well as any nominated bank) see Article 6a. This can be important if the nominated bank is affected by force majeure and, for example, may be closed.
INCOTERMS
Incoterms are standard international trade denitions used every day in countless numbers of contracts for the sale of good both domestic and international. ICC model contracts facilitate trade especially for smaller companies that may lack access to adequate legal advice on issues relating to the writing of contracts. However, they do not apply to the standalone standard forms of contract for green coffee shipments of the ECF and the GCA of New York. Nevertheless, there are exporters who prefer to apply at least some of the denitions used by Incoterms to their green coffee shipments (for which they of course require the buyers agreement) whereas the ECF/GCA standard forms of contracts do not cater for the export of manufactured goods such as roasted and packaged coffee. It is therefore appropriate to provide at least an introduction to Incoterms. The Paris-based International Chamber of Commerce was established in 1919. Since then, it has expanded to become a world business organization with thousands of member companies and associations in around 120 countries representing every major industrial and service sector. Todays ICC is also the main business partner to the United Nations and its afliated agencies in matters of international trade. ICC publishes various sets of internationally recognized rules and standards since 1936. The most well known to the coffee trade are probably Incoterms themselves, and UCP 600 or the Uniform Customs and Practice for Documentary Credits. The Incoterms rules have been developed and maintained by experts and practitioners brought together by ICC and have become the standard in international business rules setting. They help traders avoid costly misunderstandings by clarifying the tasks, costs and risks involved in the delivery of goods from sellers to buyers. Incoterms rules are recognized by the United Nations Commission on International Trade Law (UNCITRAL) as the global standard
82
CHAPTER 4 CONTRACTS
for the interpretation of the most common terms in foreign trade. UNCITRAL (www.uncitral.org) is the Commission that formulates and regulates international trade in cooperation with the World Trade Organization (WTO). The terms are updated from time to time the latest version (Incoterms 2010) came into effect on 1 January 2011. However, parties to a contract could agree to continue using an earlier version. In this case they should specify which one the contract is based on, for example Incoterms 2000. The full set of Incoterms 2010 rules can be obtained from the ICC website: www.iccwbo.org/incoterms. Guidance Notes explain the fundamentals of each Incoterms rule, such as when it should be used, when risk passes, and how costs are allocated between seller and buyer. The Guidance Notes are not part of the actual Incoterms 2010 rules, but are intended to help the user accurately and efciently steer towards the appropriate Incoterms rule for a particular transaction. The ICC also offers a helpful wall chart that illustrates the obligations of each party under different delivery conditions.
CHAPTER 5
BASIC SHIPPING TERMS..................................................................................................................................... 84 SHIPPING IN CONTAINERS................................................................................................................................. 91 CONTAINERS AT THE RECEIVING END ............................................................................................................ 97 INSURANCE......................................................................................................................................................... 102 INSURANCE: THE COVER ................................................................................................................................. 105 WAR RISK INSURANCE IN SHIPPING .............................................................................................................. 107
84
SHIPPING SERVICES
Liner services: are regular, scheduled shipping services between xed groups of ports that operate regardless of cargo availability. Tramping vessels, however, make irregular, opportunistic calls at ports when cargo is available. In theory
SHIPPING HUBS
Shipping hubs and container feeder vessels are becoming increasingly important as the shipping industry evolves to meet the demands of globalization and the proportion of bigger vessels in world eets is growing. Already some vessels can carry as many as 11,000 to 15,000 TEU (20-foot
85
equivalent units) and some major shipping lines announced in 2011 having placed orders for a new class of container vessel that will carry 18,000 TEU. These ships will be longer and wider than anything ever built before but it is stated that their revolutionary design and propulsion systems would considerably reduce costs and cut CO2 emissions per container carried. This latter aspect ts well with the increasing interest in green supply chain management and forecasts are that still larger vessels may become operational in the foreseeable future. However, such mega-vessels will call only at ports with the required deep water and offering both the cargo and the mechanized capability to handle it quickly and efciently. As a result, smaller ports increasingly feed cargo to the nearest regional hub, in rather the same way as airlines have been doing for years. In some origins this practice is already well established, but elsewhere it is creating some problems for the industry, also because the supply of smaller feeder vessels is not necessarily keeping up with the growing number of very large container ships (VLCS). It is not uncommon for receivers of coffee to have proper advice of shipment, within contract terms, but still not know the name of the vessel that will deliver at the nal port of discharge. This is because the name of the transshipment or mother vessel is not always known at the time of loading. Internet-based track and trace services offer solutions provided the shipping advice includes the container numbers (which shippers are obliged to provide in the shipment advice). Larger receivers working on the just-in-time supply system require carriers to inform them direct by e-mail, within a given time limit, of all transshipment arrangements, including the name of the mainline vessel and its estimated time of arrival (ETA) at destination. Not immediately obvious perhaps, but other issues can arise when authorities in a transshipment port impose certain conditions on cargo that is to be transshipped there. For example, in late 2006 Panama directed that any vents on containers carrying green coffee for transshipment in Panamanian ports (Balboa and Manzanillo) must be secured with insect-proof netting and must be accompanied by a phytosanitary certicate. A green placard with the words GREEN COFFEE in capital letters also has to be afxed to all four container walls. This is to safeguard against Broca (borer) infestation being transmitted from other coffee producing countries. Non-compliance means a container will not be allowed to be discharged for onward shipment, a potential cause of considerable logistical and nancial problems.
by the shipping line and cost included in the freight rate) or FCL/FCL. The cost of loading and discharging containers varies between container terminals and between shipping lines, sometimes considerably, and can be an important cost item. Ocean freight includes variable elements beyond the control of shipping companies. The most important are the cost of fuel and exchange rate uctuations. If a European shipping line agrees a freight rate expressed in United States dollars, movement in the rate of exchange of the dollar against the euro will be reected in its income. To avoid having to speculate on potential uctuations in fuel prices or currencies, freight contracts instead allow for price adjustments whenever notable changes occur. Surcharges: due to adjustment of fuel costs are called bunker surcharge (BS) or bunker adjustment factor (BAF). They are usually applied as a sum per container. A surcharge due to currency uctuations is called currency adjustment factor (CAF), expressed as a percentage of the freight sum. BS or BAF is applied to the basic rate of freight and CAF to the resulting sum. Contracts may also provide for surcharges when other costs change, such as port usage charges or tolls on seaways and canals. Shipping lines may also levy special increases on freight from or to ports where congestion causes excessive delays to vessels. All in rates of freight are also available, particularly to large shippers and receivers. These remain xed for specic periods during which no BAF or CAF surcharges can be applied. War risk: is another potential cause for surcharging freights as ship owners pass on higher insurance premiums for vessels operating on difcult or dangerous trade routes. Such unforeseen costs are a result of force majeure and may be passed on to shippers or receivers, usually at a at rate per container. More about insurance later in this chapter. Other surcharges may be levied as well, depending on the carrier and the voyage. These may include cargo documentation/customs fees, piracy surcharge, stacking charges, transshipment fee etc. Freight charges are of great importance to producing countries, because for the roaster the real cost of coffee is the price landed roasting plant. If coffees bought from country A and from country B are used for the same purpose, the two qualities are substitutional and should therefore be priced the same. If for example the freight from country A is notably higher than freight from B, then As asking price has to be lower to match the landed cost of B. And if freight rates from country B were to fall then the FOB price or differential for that coffee will eventually rise accordingly if freight rates elsewhere do not follow suit. Freight rates uctuate all the time and are also negotiable. It is very likely that different companies will apply different rates during the same time period, making it pointless to list actual rates in this guide. It is much more important to have a good grasp of the general principles governing freights.
86
Freight rates are often governed by factors more numerous and complex than, for example, the distances involved. Currently, the dominant practice is for shippers and receivers to negotiate individual freight agreements with shipping lines, sometimes on a worldwide basis. As a result, actual freight rates for many receivers are not general knowledge with many bills of lading simply stating freight as per agreement or freight payable at destination. It remains advisable, however, for industry bodies, both in exporting as well as importing countries, to meet on a regular basis with individual shipping lines that are important in the transport of coffee to review issues of mutual interest. These include shifts in coffee production and demand, port developments in origin and at destination, technical and physical issues (such as hygiene and food safety), and other topics relating to coffee logistics and levels of service. Freight portals on the Internet: can match available cargo with available space, and vice versa. Trucking and freight rates can be sought and offered so large shippers and receivers can relatively easily ask transporters and shipping lines to tender for certain land and sea cargoes. These are fast moving developments that enable large users of sea and land transportation to strike competitive deals. Increasing security concerns place more and more emphasis on the creation of an audit trail by the tracing and tracking of all containerized cargo, including coffee. As a result, the importance and range of functions of freight portals is growing, also as part of the general move towards seamless electronic documentation and information sharing in transport and the bulk commodity trade in general. For an example go to www.inttra.com or to any major shipping line website.
87
Under a combined transport bill of lading the carrier accepts responsibility, subject to the normal stipulations in the bill of lading, for the whole carriage, inland and marine: from door to door, or from door to container yard or container station. The carrier arranges both the marine and the inland transport, but it should be noted that marine and overland transport are governed by different international conventions. This can have an effect on the settlement of claims the nancial liability of the carrier for inland carriage is not necessarily the same as it is for the marine voyage (on board ship, i.e. from tackle to tackle). Usually the carrier will assist in any claims procedure initiated by the receiver and/or insurance company, but will not necessarily accept responsibility for settlement if the damage occurred during the overland stage. For example, a truck is stopped at gunpoint and the driver is asked to disappear: no liability. Or an accident occurs because of driver negligence: liability may exist depending on local jurisprudence. Obviously, large receivers will nd it easier to solve such matters than will smaller companies. Note that for FCA contracts (also known as free on truck in some origins) it is the buyers responsibility to lodge the necessary claims under their insurance policy, and insurance cover should therefore commence at the inland point of loading. Whether a bill of lading is of port-to-port or combined transport depends on whether the box place of receipt (or place of delivery) has been lled in.
Under present-day FOB contracts it is nearly always the buyer who arranges the contract of carriage and who is liable for all costs and risk from that point onwards. Nevertheless, ECC clearly states that it should in fact be considered as an illdened cost and freight contract even though the price may be dened in FOB terms, i.e. the freight being for account of the buyers. The exporters contractual responsibility effectively still ends only when the coffee crosses the ships rail. ECC also states that the buyer is responsible for insuring the goods from the time the goods leave the ultimate warehouse or other place of storage at the port of shipment. This is important because it is increasingly difcult to establish the precise time a container leaves the stack on the quayside and is transferred across the ships rail. Under GCA contracts the risk of loss transfers upon crossing of the ships rail and exporters must insure accordingly. FCA free carrier. The sellers obligations are fullled when the goods, cleared for export, are handed to the carrier or the carriers ofcial agent(s) at the named place or point of handing over. (Sometimes also called free in container or free in warehouse.) The buyers responsibility starts here and they are liable to pay all and any inland transportation costs as well as the cost of loading at the port of shipment. The total freight cost takes all this into account. Not everyone is willing to purchase on the basis of FCA though, especially if the goods are not handed over at the carriers own premises or at a recognized container lling station. Remember that inland and marine transports are covered by different international conventions and even though a shipping line may arrange for the inland transport it will not necessarily accept liability for events occurring before the goods reach the port of shipment or cross the ships rail. CIF cost, insurance and freight (or CFR cost and freight). The shipper arranges and pays the contract of carriage but otherwise the transfer of risk is as under FOB.
Table 5.1 Cost distribution between sellers (S) and buyers (B) FOB Loading at sellers premises Inland transport (from the named place) Trade documentation at origin Customs clearance at origin Export charges Loading terminal handling charges (THC) Ocean freight Unloading terminal handling charges (THC) S S S S S S B B CIF/ CFR S S S S S S S B FCA S B S S S B B B
In the United States, a considerable amount of business is transacted FCA (or perhaps also FOT) because of the coffee imported from Mexico through the land border between the two countries (around 2 million bags a year). Seller and buyer should be clear on the difference between the two terms.
88
Basically, in the case of FCA risk of loss transfers to the buyer the moment the goods are received by the carrier, whether for overland or maritime transport, whilst in the case of FOT (or FOR) that risk transfers to the buyer when the goods are placed on the truck or railcar. Customs documentation charges or Cargo declaration fees. These are a new type of charge, introduced by shipping lines to cover the cost of complying with maritime cargo security regulations now in force for both the United States and the European Union. Cargo that does not comply with these regulations may not be loaded and the lines have to ensure only correctly documented cargo is loaded. Whilst there is no denying that there is an administrative and IT cost to this, many exporters consider these charges to be linked to importation and therefore should be paid by the receiver. However, so far the general consensus on the receiving side is that these charges are part of the cost of bringing cargo to FOB, i.e. they form part of the export charges and as such are to be paid by shippers.
for containers to be stuffed at the sellers premises at their expense, under the supervision of the carrier or the carriers appointed agent. A higher rate of freight will still apply than for an FCL shipment, but this arrangement is nevertheless of great value to smaller shippers or to those who are still relatively unknown. Importers and their bankers increasingly check on the credibility of exporters, including the documentation they supply, and do not accept unknown FCL bills of lading. For some exporters and origins, the stufng and weighing of containers under independent supervision is now the order of the day, not only for LCL shipments, but also for FCL in order to satisfy the legitimate security concerns of all involved in the coffee trade. Such services are often provided by collateral managers who verify correct procedure in an exporters operations on behalf of the bank that nances the business, sometimes right through to delivery at the receiving end. See also chapter 10. Claims on shipping lines have dropped as a result of these services, suggesting that past discrepancies in containerized cargo were at least partly the result of inadequate supervision during stufng. The main cause of claims on containerized coffee in bags has, however, always been condensation damage, which is much less likely to occur when coffee is shipped in bulk. The term LCL is something of a misnomer in that containers are nearly always full and freight is charged per container, not by weight. The reason the term is often used is that it permits marine insurers and/or receivers to lodge insurance claims directly on shipping lines. But just as roasters argue that roasting and distribution is their core business, not the transporting, storing and nancing of green coffee stocks, so shipping companies consider their business is to carry sealed containers safely and efciently from A to B, and not to be concerned with the contents. Shipping lines have to eliminate the LCL bill of lading entirely, in time. This in turn will see increased use of independent weighers and supervisors, although the reliability of such services will still vary from port to port, and from country to country. If after such inspections weight or quality claims still arise there will be serious differences of opinion between shipper and receiver. This is mainly because it is not always understood that providing a certicate of weight or quality does not absolve the shipper from contractual obligations.
89
Rotterdam Rules dene a Contract for Carriage as one that may combine carriage by sea and other modes of transport. These conventions dene a carriers obligations, for example such as having to exercise due diligence to make the vessel seaworthy and to care for the cargo. In general the Rotterdam Rules strengthen the rights of shippers and owners of cargo but of course this type of convention covers many aspects and some of the texts may even be open to different interpretations. However, in terms of who has to prove what, it still remains for the claimant to prove any loss or damage is due to the carriers failure to adequately perform its duties. Shippers and receivers alike should be familiar with the numerous clauses and conditions contained in the ne print on bills of lading, but this is not always the case. This means a shipping company will accept responsibility only if it can be conclusively proven that damage to the goods occurred during transit, i.e. en route while the goods were under its control. However, unless the cause of such damage is obvious it may be very difcult to prove the point and exporters can fully expect that receivers of damaged goods will hold them responsible. But at the same time receivers are duty bound to preserve and exercise all rights against third parties. They must also always lodge claims with the shipping company, with their underwriters and any other involved party. There is more information on marine insurance and claims later in this chapter. Nevertheless, the burden of proof rests with the exporter/ shipper, unless there is concrete evidence that the loss or damage was due to an external event, an event that took place after the container was handed over for shipment. Of course, if an FCL shipment is lost or destroyed in its entirety then in most instances everyone will have little option but to accept the exporters declaration as to the original contents and their condition. However, if upon discharge containerized goods are found to be damaged without any obvious link to an external event then the burden of proof can become very heavy. On a separate but related issue: If really serious damage occurs en route, due to unforeseen events beyond anyones control force majeure or Acts of God then under the contract of carriage (bill of lading) a shipping company may decide to declare what is known as General Average. Such a declaration will result in proportional claims being lodged against all the owners/receivers of all the goods that were on board at the time the event took place. This kind of situation can become extremely complicated and may at times result in lengthy litigation.
whereas transshipment routings may also become more diverse. Increased transshipment also means that ever more strict instructions must be given, in writing, as to the type of cargo care that is required whereas details of the shipments routing must be known and agreed in advance. From some origins it is now not at all unusual for shipments to be transshipped three times, in some instances even four times. For example, from the local port by feeder vessel via a larger national port to a regional shipping hub where the large mother vessels call. Or, from the national port to the regional hub and then transshipment again abroad, for example discharge at Antwerp and onward shipment to Helsinki. This means increased transit times, particularly if a feeder vessel is late and misses the mother vessels slot at the hub port. Modern container vessels spend the vast majority of time at sea days in port are kept to a minimum and late cargo simply gets left behind. Such events make it difcult for importers to guarantee on time delivery to their roaster clients and causes additional costs (particularly nancing), which they will wish to recoup. However, because most, if not nearly all, green coffee shipped from origin is sold basis FOB (free on board) or FCA (free carrier) the exporters responsibility usually ends when the goods cross the ships rail or are handed to the stipulated carrier. Naturally this presupposes that shipment is made in accordance with the terms and conditions of the contract, i.e. those of the under-lying standard form of contract as well as those that may have been stipulated by the buyer, including any cargo care notes. But, of course, quality and other claims always remain a possibility. See also chapter 4, Contracts. Even though selection of the carrying vessels is sometimes left up to the exporter, especially FOB buyers should also engage with the process by being well informed about shipping opportunities from a particular port and by insisting that the most suitable options and routings are chosen. Once the goods are on board ship they have become the buyers responsibility in the sense that he or she has to ensure the goods are insured, will have to settle the freight and, of course, will have to take delivery. If any claims arise after loading due to delays and/or damage then it is for the buyer to lodge these with the shipping company if he or she thinks there is a case for doing so. However, the exporter is duty-bound to make sure that he keeps the buyer informed of all and any changes to the shipping process, also when information reaches him about changes in transshipment dates, vessels or schedules after the goods were shipped. All parties to a transaction must always exercise due diligence: that is, they must be able to prove that at all times they acted correctly. The shipping agents at origin should monitor transshipment cargo and keep their principals fully informed this is not always the case though. Nevertheless, in the vast majority of cases it is the buyer who, at least initially, is liable to cover any extra costs although, where appropriate, an exporter might
TRANSSHIPMENT ISSUES
The growing size and capacity of container vessels to already up to 15,000 TEU, and in future rising to as many as 18,000, is resulting in increased incidences of transshipment
90
perhaps be asked to assist with the lodging of claims etc. It would make good sense to assist where possible. NB: Once a buyer realizes that shipping delays are becoming a regular occurrence for goods shipped from a particular port then the buyer will adjust his cost calculation from FOB origin port of shipment to Ex Dock at destination accordingly. On a case-by-case basis, usually it is the buyer who suffers the consequences but, in the longer run, it is always exporters who bear the cost because they will receive lower bid prices. Which of course are passed on to the grower. Unfortunately, there are no magic solutions to the transshipment issue. A port can drop off the international schedules of the major shipping companies, i.e. main or mother vessels no longer call there, for example due to insufcient deep water; insufcient cargo on offer; or inefcient cargo handling. If so, then that port and everyone utilizing it will have to adjust and make the best of it through improved efciency and other cost saving measures. For example: Keep up to date and make sure your buyer knows not only what you know, but also as soon as you come to know it. Ensure you choose the right shipping agent. One who will not simply book on friendly vessels, but who will offer the most efcient routing and transshipment connections. Make sure all appropriate cargo care details are stated in the cargo booking. Do not rely on the shipping agent to take care of this. Demand the origin shipping agent monitors the cargo all the way, keeping you informed. Liaise closely with the shipping companies, both coastal/regional and international. Usually, this is best achieved through the forum of an exporters association, a coffee authority, a chamber of commerce or other such body that brings together a number of parties with individual but similar interests. Conduct regular reviews of recent shipping experiences, highlight buyers concerns and claims/comments, etc. Stress the fact that, in the nal analysis, all extra costs come off the producer price, meaning this is an industry issue not just one concerning exporters.
technology today allows even very small grower groups to produce quality coffee. But if this cannot be marketed successfully, then what is the point? The Cup of Excellence programme, www.cupofexcellence. org (see chapter 6), and the specialty industry as a whole have identied many pockets of excellent quality in different countries but the logistics of getting small lots from A to B are daunting. Few if any carriers today will even quote freight rates per ton, let alone accept mini-lots. Simply put: on container vessels there is no room for break bulk or loose cargo, only for containers. Within modern shipping there are few alternative options and it is true to say that transport now represents the one great limitation on smaller producers wishing to access the specialty market.
91
Pay for dead freight. Some buyers or shippers sometimes simply absorb the cost of dead freight (the cost of any empty space in a container) especially when the coffee in question is of high value. How much dead freight can be absorbed will vary from transaction to transaction but there is little doubt that producers of very small quantities stand little chance of becoming regular exporters if they cannot consolidate with others. It does not really make sense to ship a container FOR 25 or 50 bags. Air freight. Alternatively, if a small lot of expensive exemplary coffee can bear the cost of paying freight for a full container then it may sometimes be just as cost effective to use airfreight instead. However, Customs and security issues play a role here coffee is not normally exported/imported in this way and so airlines and airfreight companies do not always know how to handle the attendant administrative procedures. Finally, yet another problem facing shippers of small lots of top quality coffee is that quality can be lost if transit times are too long, for example due to multiple transshipments.
SHIPPING IN CONTAINERS
Bagged coffee in 20-foot dry containers (and today even in 40-foot containers) is a major improvement over the old break bulk method, but still involves extensive handling and does not fully exploit a containers carrying capacity. This is important as transport and freight costs are charged per container rather than by weight. The cost of handling bagged cargo is also escalating continuously, especially in importing countries. When correctly lined with cardboard or sufciently strong Kraft paper, and if properly stuffed, standard 20-foot dry containers are suitable for transporting bagged coffee. This is not to suggest they are suitable for prolonged storage of coffee, because they are not. Some receivers do specify ventilated containers for shipments from certain areas. These provide ventilation over their entire length, usually top and bottom, but not all shipping lines offer them. They are expensive, and at the same time more and more coffee is shipped in bulk instead. Bulk shipments were rst experimented with in the early 1980s. After a period of exhaustive trials, mostly on coffees from Brazil and Colombia, the conclusion was that standard containers are perfectly suitable for the transportation of coffee in bulk. But they must be tted with appropriate liners (usually made of polypropylene) and the coffees moisture content must not exceed the accepted standard for the coffee in question. Some container facts: TEU stands for twenty foot equivalent unit: maximum total weight 30.48 tons, maximum gross payload 28.28 tons (i.e. including the weight of packaging, liners, etc.).
FTE stands for forty foot equivalent unit: maximum total weight 30.4 tons, maximum payload 26.4 tons. Newer and somewhat taller FTEs have a slightly higher payload at maximum 27.5 tons. FTEs are becoming more common in the carriage of bagged coffee as they are easier to stow on board ship. However, shippers should bear in mind that as yet not all end-receivers are equipped to handle FTEs. GP in the United States stands for general purpose container the European Union equivalent is DC or dry container, i.e. both are the same. The net load of a standard, general-purpose, steel TEU container is on average about 21,000 kg green coffee. However this varies, depending on the type of coffee being shipped. Large beans can be as low as 19,000 kg small beans perhaps as much as 24,000 kg. It is impossible to use the entire theoretical payload capacity of a TEU because coffee is relatively bulky and so space is the limiting factor here. For a FTE the limitation is not space but the maximum permissible weight. Ocean freight for coffee shipments is always charged per container. As such it is entirely up to the shipper to decide how much of the available space to use and respectively how much space to leave empty (dead space). Wooden container oors (where tted) must have been treated against infestation details of the treatment method is found on the CSC (Container Safety Convention) plate on the container door. This is important because of rules on Wood Packaging Material (WPM) that is used in international shipments. See for example www.aphis.usda. gov Importation of Wood Packaging Material. Note also that materials other than wood for use as container ooring are under development. When making a booking with a shipping line always give the instruction stow away from heat, cool stow and sun/ weather protected or stow in protected places only/away from heat and radiation, i.e. no outer or top position. Stow under deck or under waterline is not appropriate with modern container vessels, since the fuel tanks are often situated in the hull and can radiate heat. Abbreviations also used are AFH = Away From Heat and KFF = Keep From Freezing. See also www.containerhandbuch.de (version in English).
92
gure of 12.5% simply represents a known technical point at which the risk of damage from condensation and growth of mould during storage and transport becomes unacceptably high. Shippers who normally ship their coffee at moisture percentages below 12.5% should denitely continue to do so. NB: In certain areas there are shippers who habitually ship at higher moisture contents. but this guide is not in a position to express an opinion on this. An increasing number of buyers now include maximum permissible arrival moisture content in purchasing contracts. Increasing preoccupations with food health and hygiene in consuming countries suggest strongly that exporters will be well advised therefore to acquaint themselves with their buyers requirements in this regard. Coffee is often loaded in tropical or otherwise warm areas for discharge at places where the temperatures are very much lower. Warm air holds more water vapour than cold air; when warm, moist air cools down to dew point, then condensation occurs. Dew point is the temperature at which a sample of saturated air will condense. Put differently: coffee travelling from producing countries during the Northern Hemisphere summer experiences much less temperature change than when travelling during the Northern Hemisphere winter. Vessels may then arrive when snow and ice conditions are prevalent, particularly in Northern Europe. Of course such conditions are entirely beyond anyones control, including the shipping company. On other routes cargo may experience multiple climate zones during transit. For example from the Pacic Ocean ports of Guayaquil (Ecuador) and Buenaventura (on Colombias West Coast) to the East Coast (Atlantic Ocean) of the United States. When passing Cape Hatteras in the State of North Carolina on the East Coast vessels may in winter sometimes experience a drop in outside temperature of up to 20 C (36 F) in just four hours. During transit the temperature outside the container gradually cools down and the steel container allows the chill to conduct from the outside of the panels through to the inside. On arrival the container has cool roof and side panels, and moist warm air in the space above the cargo and within the stow. Most of the moisture will have been given up by the coffee beans themselves. When the temperature of the panels falls below the dew point of the air inside the container, condensation starts and will continue until the dew point of the interior air falls to that of the air outside. Apart from making sure that the coffees own moisture content is acceptable, condensation cannot really be avoided and all one can do is try to prevent the condensation falling onto the coffee as droplets. If temperature changes are gradual and enough time passes then the coffee beans will absorb the excess moisture from the air within the container and the container will again be dry. But temperature differences of 8 C to 10 C over short periods of time almost inevitably will
result in condensation taking place. In severe cases water droplets, mostly consisting of dislocated moisture from the coffee itself, form on the interior roof and side panels, and then drip on to the cargo causing water damage and mould. Correct stowage does mitigate against the air above the cargo reaching dew point. This can be supported by adding a drying agent or desiccant always provided these are approved for use with foodstuffs and are accepted by the nal receiver. For more on this see for example www. stopak.com, www.dessicantsonline.com, or www.dry-bag. nl. In summary, differences in temperature plus the time factor and the speed of events combine to release moisture from the coffee. Given enough time the coffee surface will reabsorb the moisture. If events unfold too fast or there is too much moisture, then the coffee cannot reabsorb what it gave up and condensation will continue as long as the temperature difference between the steel of the container and the air inside it is greater than 8 C. A simple demonstration: a glass of cold liquid sweats because its temperature is below the dew point of the surrounding air. The moisture on the outside of the glass comes from the surrounding air, not from the liquid or the glass itself. When the glass warms up, its temperature eventually reaches that dew point, which causes the moisture on the outside to dry again: it evaporates back into the surrounding air. In producing countries condensation occurs when containers are stuffed at high altitude locations with high temperatures during the day that fall rapidly at night, leading to the same scenario. The risk is increased if full containers are left outside in the radiant heat of the sun, so containers should not be stuffed too far ahead of the actual time of shipment. The only answer to all such weather-related events is to exercise the utmost care when lining and stufng containers, and to ensure correct stowage on board ship. See also www.tis-gdv.de of the Transport Information Service of the German Insurance Association. Alternatively, contact your local shipping company representative for information on container stufng and related issues.
Container vessel in Finland during winter, covered in snow. Photograph courtesy Maersk Line Cargo Care.
93
Type
G Right side wall panel G Left side wall panel G Yes _________ % G Foreign smell like
Container number: _______________________________________ Container approved by: _______________________________________________________________________________________ Date and venue Name in capital letters Signature
NB: Before entering a container check that there are no labels attached indicating it may previously have carried dangerous goods or, in the case of fumigation, what kind of substance was used. Before entering such a container also check that it has been properly de-gassed.
94
When ordering a container from the carrier, specify in writing that the container must be suitable for the carriage of coffee beans, i.e. foodstuffs, that you reserve the right to reject any container you detect to be unt, and that you will claim compensation for losses resulting from unsuitable containers. This is no guaranteed protection, but it will alert the carrier. Even so, you remain fully liable for the selection of a suitable container, so rmly reject any suspect container irrespective of who supplies it. Note that where the shipping line delivers the empty container to the shippers premises (carrier haulage) and it is validly rejected, then the line will have to pay for replacing it. But if the shippers transporter collects it from the shipping line (merchant haulage) and it is subsequently rejected, then the shipper will be liable for the cost thereof. Use a container approval form like the example on the previous page. This will serve as a guideline for the personnel in charge of loading and will also remind them to pay the necessary attention. A copy could be left inside the container to demonstrate that you did pay the necessary attention. The basic premise is that condensation cannot always be avoided but it is possible to avoid the condensed water vapour coming back into the coffee. It is important to consider the following: Containers must be technically impeccable: dry, clean, odourless and watertight; free of corrosion on the roof and sides; intact door locks, rubber packing and sealing devices. If possible check the moisture content of the oor. At least insist on a dry container that has not been washed recently. Note that it takes a long time for the oor to dry out and that without an instrument (Penetro meter) you have no reliable means of checking the oors moisture content which, ideally, should not exceed 12% for bagged cargo. Up to 14% place extra protection (cardboard/Kraft paper) if over 14% to 16% use plastic with cardboard/ paper on it for this. Above this use dry pallets, but note that containers with a oor moisture content above 18% are basically not suitable for bagged coffee. When stufng takes place at the shippers or at CFS premises (in LCL status) the shipping line must inspect the containers. An inspector, acting on behalf of the shipping line, should go inside the container and close the doors. If any daylight is visible the container must be rejected immediately. When stufng takes place at the shippers premises (in FCL status) the shipper or its representative should inspect the containers as above and of course conduct the goods tally. The inspector should also particularly check for obnoxious smells by remaining inside the closed container for at least two to three minutes. There are occasional incidents of coffees arriving with a strong phenolic smell which renders them unt for use. A phenolic smell or taste is reminiscent of disinfectant or an industrial cleaning agent such as carbolic acid. Inspectors should reject containers that show evidence of a prior load of chemical cargo or that have an IMCO/
IMO dangerous cargo sticker or label afxed. For more information on the International Maritime Dangerous Goods Code (IMDG) and dangerous cargo labels go to www.imo.org, the website of the International Maritime Organization. Note that coffees tainted by chemical contamination or smell will attract claims on arrival ranging from 50% to 100%, to which must be added the costs of destruction. Wooden container oors (where tted) must have been treated against infestation details of the treatment method is found on the Container Safety Convention (CSC) plate on the container door. This is important because of the already-mentioned rules on Wood Packaging Material (WPM) that are used in international shipments. The actual stufng of the container should take place under cover, just in case there is a rain shower. Bags should be sound: no leaking, slack or torn bags; no wet bags; and no stained bags. The number of bags loaded is to be tallied and signed for by both warehouse staff and loading supervisor (in case of LCL shipments representing the shipping line). The container should never be lled to absolute capacity in that there should always be some room above the stow. (Applies equally to bulk cargo.) Best practice for bagged cargo is to line the container with cardboard or two layers of Kraft paper, preferably corrugated with the corrugation facing the steel structure, so that no bag comes in contact with the metal of the container. When stufng is complete a double layer of Kraft paper should be tted on top of the bags all the way to the oor in the doorway. This will ensure that the paper will at least partly absorb any possible condensation from the roof. In a fully lined container there will be cardboard or Kraft paper also between the bags and the corner posts, in the junction between the upright walls and the oor, at the back of the container and at the doors, and covering the top of the stow as well. Cardboard is stronger and preferable to Kraft paper Desiccants or dry bags are sometimes used. They are meant to avoid the air in the container reaching dew point (100% relative humidity) during the voyage. The need depends on local circumstances but desiccants should only be used with the express prior permission of the receiver. Many receivers do not permit their use under any circumstances and it is up to the exporter to determine their acceptability. Other materials that can help manage conditions inside a closed container also exist, but fall outside the scope of this guide. Liners for bulk coffee should be 100% sound, which means no pinholes etc. If condensation forms and drips from the roof it may collect in puddles on the liner and soak through if pinholes exist, which means a claim can be made. Under International Maritime Dangerous Goods Code (IMDG) rules coffee still being under fumigation or not yet properly aired should be booked, documented, labelled and handled for shipment as IMO Classied (Class 9 UN no. 3359 fumigated unit).
95
Stowage complete.
Transit time: Experience shows that most of the condensation problems encountered during maritime transport are caused at origin (containers are stuffed too early ahead of actual shipment or not properly lined), or immediately after ofoading (particularly for containers arriving in winter). It is therefore of the utmost importance to limit transit times (by using dedicated sailing/routings) and the dwell periods and land legs of the transit as much as possible. Note that without knowing the exact stowage position of a container it is very difcult to prove that the cause of damage was wrong positioning of the container on board the ship. The damage might already have happened on shore, before loading. In any event, improper stufng of a container (bags touching the roof or bulk coffee not levelled) can never be compensated for by demanding special care from the carrier.
One way.
96
licensed liners for coffee shipments. Shippers should check with their United States buyers what brands of liners are licensed under present patents. Most shipping companies and freight forwarders will be able to provide information on the availability and cost of liners, but it may be advisable to obtain your buyers agreement before choosing any particular type or make. Note also that coffee should only be shipped in bulk with the buyers prior consent.
97
inlet could cause tearing and the load must be as evenly levelled as possible. The liners roof must not sag, but must be tight so at no time will the inlet or roof rest on the coffee after loading. Ideally, built-in reinforced straps in the liners front panel (bulkhead) will prevent bulging when the container is full, thus allowing for easy closing of the doors. (Strapping ropes can also be used.) There should not be any pressure on the doors when closed after loading. The liner must be properly fastened to the containers interior, also at the far end: at the point of discharge the container is tilted to enable the coffee to slide out of the liner, rather than the lled liner sliding out of the container. Containers can be lled in two ways. One method is to take the coffee from the silo with the aid of a blower or to empty individual bags into the blowers reception hopper. Blowing air into the liner makes it align itself with the walls, roof and oor of the container. Once the liner ts correctly inside the container, the blower then spews the coffee into the now fully-lined container. During this process the displaced air must be able to escape. Some types of piping may cause static electricity build-up and should preferably be earthed. Do not blow a heap into the centre, leaving space at the rear and the doors, but ll the liner evenly. To ensure the coffee stays away from the hot container roof, avoid as much as possible contact between the stow and the liners roof panel, preferably by a margin of about 70 cm. Some receivers stipulate that there must be space between the liners roof panel and the top of the coffee load. Another way is to ll the container using a telescopic conveyor belt that extends into the lined box. This eliminates the need for air pressure and therefore the risk of damage to the beans.
DISCHARGE
Technology and mechanization are constantly improving supply chain management and an increasing number of bulk containers go directly from the quay or container station to the roasting plant. Here they are discharged, automatically and by a single person (sometimes the driver of the vehicle). At the roasting plant or silo storage facility the container truck is backed onto a reception pit where the seals are checked and cut. The doors are opened, the liner is cut and the container is then gradually angled upwards by the
Bulk coffee in liners an example. Photograph courtesy Maersk Line Cargo Care.
98
lorrys tilt-chassis, causing the coffee to pour out. The tilting mechanism is plugged into the computerized reception mechanism, which then controls the rate of tilt and hence the rate of pour. Once the discharge is complete the liner is removed and put away for dispatch to a recycling plant. This is much more efcient than when bags had to be unloaded, cut open and tipped out manually
because many containers travel long distances to the coast from inland lling stations. But the underlying reasoning is that coffee in bulk does not dry out to any noticeable extent and so should not incur any noticeable loss in weight either. Experience suggests that 90% to 95% of bulk containers discharge within the laid down weight tolerance of 0.5% and that any loss exceeding 0.2% is likely to be due to incorrect lling. There is therefore no particular reason for shippers to add a little extra weight to avoid weight claims (as is sometimes done for bagged coffee). Note though that large receivers seldom bother to claim for small weight differences, preferring to simply strike a recurrent offender off their list of approved suppliers. Some receivers use the weighing mechanism in the container gantry crane to establish whether the gross weight of a container appears to be within acceptable limits. Should an individual container present cause for concern it will be discharged and weighed under independent supervision. This is not feasible in arrival ports but is possible by special arrangement at inland container yards. But, the container can only be discharged into the electronic weighing system of the roasting plant or silo park operation. This makes the term supervision somewhat theoretical, because all that will be produced is a computer print-out and verication of the container and seal numbers. Of course, the supervisor could certify that the weighing system had been correctly and formally calibrated in accordance with the laws of the country where it is situated. The operators of such weighing installations should be able to produce a valid calibration certicate on demand.
99
containers and spend little time in port. Schedules are very strict and interruptions are unacceptable. In some ports containers are loaded using the ships own gear (lifting equipment), for example if port equipment is in short supply. Such on-board equipment is not necessarily tted with weight indicators. So far the conclusion has been that checking container weights during loading is not a viable proposition unless someone is prepared to incur, possibly substantial, costs. However, in recent years evidence has come to light of shippers overloading and under-declaring container weights (probably not coffee containers) to the point where vessel security becomes compromised as evidenced by a number of incidents at sea and in port. In December 2010, the World Shipping Council www.worldshipping.org therefore asked the International Maritime Organization www.imo. org to establish an international legal requirement that all export containers must be weighed before they are loaded. Weighing containers is by itself not difcult the issue is how to avoid interrupting the regular ow so as not to interfere with yard, port and ship operations. This may mean changes in the way containers are brought into the port or container yard, or how they are handled there. One potential way is to t mobile container positioning equipment with weight indicators and to record the results with exceptions being directed away from the regular ow. Another would be for accredited third party veriers to provide accurate container weights before entry into port or yard. Whatever the case may be, as and when it materializes, the weighing of loaded containers immediately ahead of shipment should be an added security advantage to coffee shippers and receivers alike.
As mentioned, most large modern roasting plants no longer accept bagged coffee and producing countries or exporters that persist in using bags will see much of their cargo transiting through silo parks at destination. Here the bagged coffee is de-bagged and transferred into silos for subsequent delivery in bulk, sometimes after blending. This is both costly and time consuming and will increasingly render uncompetitive those mainstream suppliers who cannot or will not do bulk.
OUTLOOK
Today (late 2011), the carriage of coffee in containers, whether in bags or in bulk, has become universal and it is unlikely that much if any coffee is still shipped internationally as break bulk or loose cargo. Furthermore, estimates are that as much as 70% of all mainstream coffee is now shipped in bulk. Because mainstream coffee makes up over 90% of all coffee traded, this makes it likely that not less than 65% of all coffee traded internationally is shipped in bulk. But the real gure could be (much) higher. Exact data on the amount of coffee carried in bulk versus that in bags are not available and this information is based on feedback from coffee shipping and trading sources. Large mainstream roasters are the major receivers of bulk coffee and a number of them today accept nothing else into their plants. But for importers and medium to small roasters, especially specialty roasters, the proportion of bulk is much less because medium to small roasters are more likely to blend by bag count instead of container count.
100
concerns, the U.S. Food and Drug Administration (FDA) has introduced a Food Bioterrorism Regulation that requires all those handling food products, including green coffee, to be registered with it. See www.cfsan.fda.gov and www.ncausa. org. See also the information on HACCP and the United States in chapter 12. In addition, US Customs have initiated C-TPAT (CustomsTrade Partnership against Terrorism), a government-business programme to strengthen overall supply chain and border security. For more on this search for C-TPAT on www.cbp. gov. C-TPAT is more extensive where US Customs review company security and control systems. It is voluntary, but once an importer has been registered costs will be lower as there will be fewer customs inspections. Foreign companies shipping to the United States that may not have links with a C-TPAT registered importer can make use of an Agency Service offered by the National Coffee Association of USA. The NCA C-TPAT programme is to help the industry partner with the United States Government to enhance homeland security while easing potential burdens on commerce. The NCA has partnered with the Global Security Verication (GSV) cross sector industry initiative (www.importsecurity. com) and Intertek (www.intertek.com) to develop the industrys shared information platform designed to facilitate importers and exporters participation and compliance with C-TPAT requirements. The platform will be a registry of foreign suppliers and their C-TPAT related security practices. Industry importers that are current members and/or seeking C-TPAT membership can utilize the NCA C-TPAT shared information platform for efcient and cost-effective means of collecting and maintaining necessary documentation. In addition to the supplier registry, the platform is designed to provide valuable information and tools to users to facilitate application to the C-TPAT program. Visit www.ctpat.ncausa. org which also describes the registration process itself. Under the Container Security Initiative (CSI) all high-risk cargo is to be inspected before loading at origin and to this end US Customs have established a presence in a number of foreign ports. For food shipments US Customs now require advance notice, no more than ve days before arrival and no later than noon the day prior to arrival for discharge. In addition, the 24 Hour Advance Manifest Rule obliges shipping companies to transmit cargo manifest details to US Customs 24 hours prior to a vessels ETA at the port of loading. Cargo for which the required details have not been transmitted as per this rule will not be loaded. Should a certain shipment be considered suspect then US Customs will issue a DNL message: Do Not Load. See more on www.cbp.gov.
Security Initiative screening programme to all EU states. Since then, the European Commission has adopted Commission Regulation (EC) No. 1875/2006 of 18 December 2006 aimed at increased security for shipments entering or leaving the EU and providing greater facilitation for compliant operators. The Regulation has implemented four measures as follows: A risk management framework ensuring customs control of goods crossing the EU. An Authorized Economic Operator (AEO) Certicate will be granted to reliable economic operators. Traders will have to supply customs authorities with advance information on goods brought into, or out of, the EU. Customs authorities will be required to exchange information electronically on exports between the Customs ofces involved in the procedure (export control system). A copy of the Regulation can be downloaded from the following link: www.eur-lex.europa.eu/LexUriServ/site/en/ oj/2006/l_360/l_36020061219en00640125.pdf. The following offers a brief explanation of what this means: Authorized Economic Operator. Reliable and compliant traders will benet from simplications in the customs procedures and/or from facilitation with regard to customs controls relating to safety and security under the Authorized Economic Operator (AEO) certication scheme. The AEO concept should ensure a safer and more secure end-to-end supply chain. Being recognized as an AEO will constitute an added value for the operator as it demonstrates compliance with solid security criteria and controls. This will provide a competitive advantage to participating companies. Information on goods prior leaving or entering the EU territory. Traders will have to supply customs authorities with advance information on goods brought into, or out of, the EU (entry and exit summary declarations). This will enable customs authorities to carry out better risk analysis, e.g. before goods arrive in the customs territory, and to focus on high risk cargo due to the availability of risk information at an early stage. It will also allow quicker processing and release upon arrival, resulting in a benet for traders. NB: This is of particular importance to coffee exporters in that the advance information on shipments must be sent to the EU Customs at the rst point of arrival 24 hours before the loading of a container on the vessel. See Annex 30A of the Regulation for further details. Different time limits apply to various modes of transport but the 24-hour requirement covers virtually all coffee shipments. What is now known as the European Union (EU) Advance Cargo Declaration Regime entered into force on 1 January 2011. For further information visit www.ecsa.eu/publications/101.pdf or www.ecsa.eu (look under Publications). See also the FAQ section at wwwec.europa.eu/ecip/help/faq/index_en.htm
101
Export control system. Customs authorities will be required to exchange information electronically on exports between the Customs ofces involved in the procedure. This constitutes the rst step in the full computerization of the EU Customs; the so-called electronic Customs project (IP/05/1501). Once all Member States are connected to the export control system then EU exporters will receive the proof of export immediately after the exit of goods, enabling all related processes (VAT refunds, etc.) to be speeded up. Further information on the security aspects of the Customs Code can be found at: www.ec.europa.eu/taxation_customs/ customs/policy_issues/customs_security/index_en.htm Most shipping lines are well aware of, and well versed in, the application of the different directives in the United States and the European Union and are mostly dealing with them by electronic means. They are more or less forced to do so on shippers behalf because potentially they are liable for substantial nes where no or incorrect advance information is provided. Because of this additional administrative workload some shipping lines have introduced a new category of fees to cover the cost as explained at the beginning of this chapter.
Modern seals incorporate increasingly sophisticated technology that makes undetected tampering much more difcult. But physical verication is still required. Seals by themselves cannot prevent containers being opened they are not a deterrent but rather a means of verication. Even so, seals are no better than the person who places them. If that person cannot be trusted then one cannot be sure the seal was really placed at all, i.e. that it was not faked. It is not for this publication to explain different ways in which the placing of seals has previously been faked. Instead, one solution is to use clear seals that show the mechanism, with the number printed on the inside under a clear elevation that works as a magnifying glass. However, even intact seals prove only that the cargo seems not to have been interfered with after the seals were afxed. Bulk containers have been known to be attacked by forcing a pipe through the rubber door seals and into the liner, after which coffee is simply siphoned out. This is easily prevented by placing a plank upright on the oor inside and in front of the doors before shutting them. However, there have also been instances where containerized cargo has disappeared during inland transit to port, yet doors and seals were perceived as intact. Where this occurs with any regularity shippers really only have one option: invest in security measures such as having trucks travel in escorted convoys, only allowing night stops in authorized locations, etc. If a containers seal and seal number are sound and correct on arrival of an FCL shipment, but the condition or weight of the coffee is not, then the receiver will claim from the shipper/ exporter, also if stufng took place under supervision. When goods are shipped FCL, the responsibility lies with the person supplying them unless the bill of lading shows the container was accepted as sound but at destination it is delivered damaged. To repeat, the burden of proof always lies with the shipper. For goods shipped on an LCL basis, shipping lines can be held responsible only for the number and the apparent good order and condition of the bags, Therefore, if on arrival the seal and seal number of a container shipped on an LCL basis are sound and correct, but the condition or number of the bags is not, then the receiver will claim from the shipping line.
CONTAINER SEALS
Apart from locks, the rst defence against tampering are the numbered seals the shipping company provides to seal a containers doors. If a seal is broken or damaged then it may well be that the container has been tampered with. But instances have been recorded where traditional seals have been broken and replaced without any visible sign of this having occurred. Because of this some exporters add locks of their own to physically secure container doors. Containers and their seals must also be physically checked each time a container changes hands, for example from origin terminal to ship, from ship to arrival terminal, from arrival terminal to truck, and from truck to roasting plant. Ideally, each time a Container Interchange Receipt should be established that records the seals condition, the seal number, and the exterior condition of the container itself. Should there be something wrong with any of these then the receipt trail could show under whose responsibility this happened, in turn enabling a claim to be lodged if necessary. The last check takes place just before the container will be opened. Shipping lines also use these receipts to claim redress for any physical damage to the actual container itself. Security of containers is not just to protect the coffee. In recent years, illegal drugs have also been found in coffee containers (as a result of port to port conspiracies, unconnected with the coffee trade). The international coffee trade and the shipping community are actively working with customs authorities worldwide to help stop the use of coffee shipments as a vehicle for illegal drugs. Obviously, container seals are the rst line of defense in this battle.
102
shippers, receivers and clearing agents interact with carriers by providing access through a single platform. Other service tools will include sailing schedules, container bookings, bill of lading information and event notications. Large shippers/receivers can have direct (authorized) access to such portals and may for example operate entirely with electronic information, including bills of lading. Eventually, such portals will also interact with both e-commerce and paperless trading systems. For more on this go to www. inttra.com Smaller or occasional shippers and receivers mostly still rely on hard copy (printed) bills of lading, but the portal can arrange to print the document at the most appropriate location. This saves time and minimizes the risk of mail being lost. However, as mentioned in chapter 6, more widespread use by the coffee trade of electronic documentation probably depends on major shipping lines generally moving to electronic bills of lading. Depending on their sophistication, modern container seals can record and transmit all actions that might occur during a voyage, particularly also the opening/closing of container doors. Using technologies such as Radio Frequency Identication (RFID) passive devices are read by scanning whereas active devices (battery powered) can themselves transmit information. These are useful tools for keeping track of cargo and facilitating cross-border trade, for example by reducing customs formalities in Europe. But security concerns are also placing electronic seals in the forefront of anti-terrorism activities. Until fairly recently, a container load of simple food items like bottled water, our or sugar did not pose any major security risk, as theft was unlikely. But today there is a real risk of terrorist action (contamination, poisoning, etc.) and also low-value food cargo requires high levels of security. The Smart Container pilot project by US Customs represents another potential approach, but whichever direction is taken, electronic seals or smart containers, one or both will become an integral part of coffee logistics. Although the cost of active (able to report) electronic seals is coming down and re-usable ones are increasingly available, cost still remains an obstacle, not least because of the massive number of container shipments that take place daily.
payment of a fee. The owner of the commodity must practice risk avoidance, just as the insurance company must make good legitimate losses. Insurance is the most obvious and the oldest form of risk management, and has been practiced since long before futures markets and other risk management instruments came into being. It is beyond the scope of this guide to go into the precise detail of what constitutes a good insurance policy. There are almost endless variations on a very basic theme: if the loss was unavoidable then the cover should stand. But insurance cover is only as good as what is stated in the policy document. One view is that only what is expressly included is covered. Another and more attractive view is that anything that is not specically excluded is covered.
INSURANCE
UTMOST GOOD FAITH
All insurance contracts are subject to the principle of utmost good faith. The insured must truthfully inform the underwriter of every material fact that may inuence the insurer in accepting, rating or declining a risk. This duty of disclosure continues throughout the life of the policy. Insurance is in effect a partnership between the owner of the commodity who wishes to avoid or minimize the risk of loss or damage and the insurance company that will take on that risk against
103
104
Remember, the climate in most shipping ports is far from ideal for coffee. In high temperatures and high humidity coffee absorbs moisture, possibly to a level where permissible limits for safe transportation are exceeded and where severe condensation and mould may become unavoidable. Exporters should bear in mind that at all times the coffee travels and is stored at their risk. There is also the obligation to deliver a particular quality and quantity at a given time and place. Poor management of the risks to FOB may ruin any chance of claiming a mishap on force majeure (i.e. as unforeseeable events beyond anyones control see chapter 4, Contracts).
Such weight or supervision certicates do not provide an ultimate safeguard because only the veriable facts at destination count. This does not prevent shippers from employing trustworthy persons with good knowledge to control and verify what is being done their simple presence may already be enough to avoid manipulations. But, unless expressly agreed, such inspectors or inspection companies seldom assume any nancial liability arising from their work.
105
said to weigh Y kg. The carrier accepts responsibility for the number of bags but not the contents or the weight. The exporters liability is reduced, but not eliminated, because again, the carrier can only be blamed if the cause of any arrival discrepancies can be proved to be external.
TERMINATION OF RISK
Depending on the terms of the contract of sale contract, risk may terminate at different stages of the shipping process. FCA (can be either CY or CFS). The buyer or their agent takes delivery at an inland place, probably at the sellers mill or warehouse, the receiving station or on the carriers truck. No risk of physical damage or destruction attaches to the exporter after this point, but the exporter remains responsible for errors or omissions that occurred while the goods were under their care and responsibility. In other words, if you deliver an FCL container that is unsuitable (e.g. tainted) then you remain responsible for all the consequences. The same goes for short weights beyond the permitted tolerance. But if the container is stolen after it leaves the premises, then the loss is not the responsibility of the exporter. FOB (and CFR). As discussed in chapter 4, Contracts, there are differences between FOB according to Incoterms and FOB as per the ECC and GCA contracts for coffee. In insurance terms, the following applies: Incoterms. FOB means that you must bring the goods safely and in sound condition on board ship at your risk and expense. See www.iccwbo.org/incoterms. ECC. FOB means that the risk, or rather the obligation to keep the goods insured, passes to the buyer when the coffee leaves the ultimate warehouse or place of storage at the port of shipment. This certainly does not mean that the entire inland haulage or storage is at the buyers risk all it means is the very short time span from the last place of storage immediately before shipment. (This stipulation removes any uncertainty regarding insurance cover being in place for FOB shipments. The sellers contractual responsibility ends when the goods cross the ships rail, but for insurance purposes it is difcult to establish when exactly this happens.) In the case of container shipments it means the removal of the container from the stack in the port of shipment for direct placing under ships tackle not the removal of the coffee from the warehouse for stowing it into containers. ECC then goes on to state that the sellers shall have the right to the benet of the policy until the documents are paid for. This ensures that the exporter has recourse to the buyers insurance policy in case the goods or the container itself are damaged, destroyed or stolen between the time the container is placed in the export stack in the port and its receipt on board.
GCA: Under GCA contracts, however, title to the goods is transferred when they cross the ships rail and the shipper is therefore obliged to insure up to this point. The structure of the American coffee trade is different from that in Europe. The vast majority of American roasters buy coffee ex dock so it is the trade house or importer that deals with marine insurance matters whereas in Europe many roasters buy basis FOB. CIF. In addition to paying the ocean freight the shipper must also arrange and pay for an insurance that must be in conformity with the stipulation of the ECC: warehouse to warehouse, all risks including SRCC (strikes, riots, civil commotions commodity trade) risk, and war risks at a value of CIF + 5%. Very few CIF sales take place nowadays as is seen earlier in this chapter.
106
Alternatively the scope of cover may be reduced or even cancelled entirely. It is therefore in the exporters own interest to avoid losses and claims, that is, to practice loss avoidance. Finally, parties taking out insurance should always determine whether or not the cover they purchase includes loss as a result of terrorist action. If this is not specically mentioned in a policy document then it may not be covered.
minimize losses recoverable under the insurance, and (ii) to ensure that all rights against third parties (warehousemen, transporters, port authorities, etc.) are properly preserved and exercised.
Loss in weight
One matter clearly not covered under all risks is loss in weight that does not result from obvious theft or torn bags. Exporters wishing to cover potential weight losses, for example when shipping coffee in bulk, must expressly apply for such cover. Carefully check rst whether it would not be better instead to ensure that the correct quantity is always shipped, possibly even with a small excess or tolerance.
Duration of cover
There will be a clear stipulation from which moment until which moment cover is granted. Read that part of the policy or certicate very carefully; if you experience a loss outside that given timeframe, you are not covered. Note too that warehouse to warehouse does not mean any warehouse that may be suitable it is always a warehouse at the stated place of destination. This may well be different from the nal destination the goods may travel to.
Exclusions
The policy or certicate may contain exclusion of particular risks, for example the nuclear energy exclusion clause. Another likely exclusion is for war on land, not to be confused with coverage against SRCC risks (strikes, riots, and civil commotion). There will also be other exclusions, sometimes based on the location of a particular risk.
Deductibles or franchises
It may well be that the underwriter does not cover all of the risk and only agrees to insure 80%. Alternatively, the rst thousands of dollars of any claim will not be paid. Indirectly, this is the same thing. The objective of such stipulations is to ensure that the client, the insured, makes every effort to avoid claims occurring, that is, they practice risk avoidance. Agreeing to deductibles also called franchises will also save some premium, but avoid a situation where in case of a major disaster the total amount of such deductibles could put the companys nancial health at risk.
Premiums
The policy will stipulate the amount of premium to be paid, how the monthly declarations shall be made to the underwriters, and the way and time limit within which invoices need to be paid. Remember that unpaid premiums can result in cover lapsing. Underwriters usually view single risks as more speculative and more expensive to administer than declarations under an open cover or declaration policy.
Risk avoidance
It is the duty of the insured and whoever is acting on their behalf (i) to take all reasonable measures to avoid or
107
Rates under open covers are generally much lower than those for single risks.
may not be expert in transport matters) would be a useful exercise in collaboration between coffee trade associations in producing and consuming countries. In any case, when a notication of a potential claim is received, it is best to react with all due haste and in particular the following: Inform your own insurance company, and the carrier, as a matter of course. Obtain the fullest information about the extent of the loss or damage. If necessary request someone (your agent for example) to visit the site. If things appear to be serious, appoint a qualied surveyor to attend on your behalf, always keeping your own underwriters informed.
Appointment of surveyors
Appointment of surveyors is an often-heard term. Lloyds agents is another. But the trade in coffee is increasingly specialized, and the burden of proof is increasingly placed on the exporter, including for health-related issues. It is unlikely that the average insurance surveyor will have the required expertise in condensation issues, for example. In some countries this kind of specialized expertise is more easily obtained than in others; if shippers consider they might be at risk they could be well advised to determine in advance whom they could call on to represent them in case of claims. Compiling information for different importing countries on qualied, professional surveyors and other available coffee experts (surveyors may not understand quality issues for example and a coffee quality expert
108
to be a war risk zone. Individual insurance companies then determine what level of additional premium to apply this calculation will depend on their assessment of the situation as well as the reinsurance arrangements they have in place. The implementation of such a move, i.e. the levying of higher insurance premiums for war risk, was previously arranged jointly by the underwriters concerned that then advised the relevant shipping conferences. Usually, this resulted in a standard, across-the-board charge applicable to all shipping lines. Today, this is no longer the case, mostly as a result of the introduction of strict anti-cartel legislation that forbids joint price setting by underwriters and shipping companies alike. See the beginning of this chapter for an explanation of shipping Conferences. Other clauses relevant to the trade in coffee are (i) the Institute Commodity Trades Clauses (A), dealing with loss/damage to goods, general average and salvage charges, and liability under the both to blame collision clause which appears in some bills of lading; and (ii) the Institute Strikes Clauses (Commodity Trades) dealing with loss/damage caused by strikers, locked-out workers or people taking part in labour disturbances, riots or civil commotions, and any terrorist or person acting from a political motive in addition to general average or salvage charges connected with the foregoing. Individual shipping companies, faced with demands for additional premium on vessels sailing through or passing the declared danger zone, basically have three options: Purchase the additional insurance cover; Cover it themselves through their in-house insurance pool; or Do nothing and take the risk. Within all three options a commercial decision then has to be made on whether or not to charge war risk as a separate, additional freight cost to shippers or receivers. This is done with bunker (fuel) surcharges, for example. By quoting freight and surcharge together the war risk issue in question automatically becomes part of the contract of carriage, the bill of lading. However, insuring cargo against war risk is not the responsibility of the shipping company: the conditions of the contract of carriage rmly place the onus on the owners of the goods. Thus, the additional premium mentioned here is that payable for the insurance of the vessel. A premium paid by the shipping company that may result in a surcharge on the ocean freight it in turn charges to shippers. Of course the owners (receivers) of the cargo most likely also have to pay additional war risk insurance to cover the goods they ship. If all these additional costs become substantial it is inevitable that prices will suffer: new costs or cost increases that are introduced between production
and landing of the goods abroad in the end usually fall on producers in the form of lower prices. Finally, the foregoing only provides a brief overview of what usually takes place between declaring that war risk exists, and shippers or receivers being asked to pay a surcharge for this. The legal denitions and interpretations of what constitutes war risk are extremely complicated and cannot be explained here, nor can the level of surcharges individual companies might apply be easily estimated. The unprecedented increase in piracy attacks emanating from the Somali coast affects East and Central African coffee producers in that war risk surcharges on their main export routes have been driven to very high levels indeed, with as much as US$ 200 per TEU reportedly being charged by some shipping lines in 2011. Fortunately, coffee prices had risen substantially by then, but over the longer term there can be little doubt that such surcharge levels, together with the increased premiums receivers have to pay for insuring their goods, in the end directly impact on the economies of the countries concerned. These additional charges of course apply to all their maritime import and export cargo, not just coffee. For more information on piracy threats and counter measures visit www.imo.org and go to their Knowledge Centre.
CHAPTER 6
E-COMMERCE AND COFFEE .............................................................................................................................110 INTERNET AUCTIONS .........................................................................................................................................112 PAPERLESS TRADE .............................................................................................................................................112 SPECIFIC ASPECTS ............................................................................................................................................115 TECHNICAL QUESTIONS ...................................................................................................................................118
110
111
with using it to provide the critical mass necessary to make it viable. Electronic market platforms, we suggest, allow buyers and sellers of a particular product to make contact and exchange information, after which some might proceed to initiate actual transactions directly, i.e. not via the platform. See for example www.leatherline.org, also operated by the International Trade Centre (ITC). Electronic market places on the other hand would allow them to also enter into and execute legally binding transactions, requiring much more complex and demanding systems to deal with electronic B2B trades. Examples of platforms offering coffee linkages include www.eFresh.com and www.koffeelink.com. 2. Efcient commerce comes rst. Supply chain management is not e-commerce instead of electronic marketplaces, what is required rst of all is standardization of the way in which industry or a group of companies operate. Before we can have successful e-commerce in coffee, we need efcient commerce, and this is where the Internet offers huge potential that is increasingly being exploited. Prime examples already operating in the coffee industry include the London LIFFE CONNECT futures trading system, the GCAs XML contract, the eCOPS system, shipping portals and logistics tracking systems. These are widely used by many participants in the coffee trade. However, one of the original expectations of electronic documentation was that such systems could eventually link all or at least most actors along the entire coffee chain. And that the logical outcome of such a process would, over time, facilitate the emergence of electronic market places where buyers and sellers of green coffee would meet. Electronic documentation has developed into something quite different from the original vision. In todays coffee trade most such systems with automatic database updates generate internal documents only. They then e-mail or send conrmations to third parties. These third party documents must then be entered manually into the database of the party receiving them. The problem for fully automated documentation systems is twofold. Experience has shown that (i) few in the coffee trade are (yet?) willing to pay a third party for document generation, and (ii) individual companies want to maintain their own database. Documents that update a communal database might save duplicating data entry, but in the coffee trade the communal database concept is still perceived as less than secure. Many large coffee companies today employ electronic databases and documentation systems but these are used internally. They are seldom linked to other parties in the coffee trade and certainly play no role when it comes to trading green coffee. This then relegates the concept of electronic market places for green coffee still further into the future. However, electronic documentation systems are here and they are being used extensively although not as fully as one would have expected. To date one of the main stumbling blocks also appears to be a reluctance to move to negotiable
electronic bills of lading, resulting in the continued physical transfer of shipping documents against payment. As mentioned in chapter 5, some receivers use sea way bills, whereby cargo is deliverable only to the party specied at the time of loading. Such bills are not negotiable and eliminate the need to transmit paper documentation to obtain delivery at destination. But this can only work between closely linked parties and other documents might still be in paper form. However, should major shipping lines decide to make a general move to electronic bills of lading then it is logical the coffee trade would adapt and fully edged electronic documentation systems for physical coffee transactions would come into their own. It is important to understand how such systems can or should work.
112
However, as mentioned previously, the eCOPS system too has not been able to transform itself into a true B2B electronic market place. For more on eCOPS and updates on further developments go to www.theice.com and look for eCOPS.
America (SCAA). The rst auction was held in Brazil in 1999. The idea has subsequently been developed into the Cup of Excellence programme, owned by the non-prot Alliance for Coffee Excellence. Since 1999, more than 60 COE auctions have taken place in Bolivia (Plurinational State of), Brazil, Colombia, Costa Rica, El Salvador, Guatemala, Honduras, Nicaragua and Rwanda. Similar Internet auctions have also been held in other countries, outside the COE programme. Although the individual lots sold may mostly be very small, the auctions generate enormous publicity and interest. The coffees and their stories do put a country and an area on the quality map, and there is an increasing number of success stories where individual coffee growers have subsequently been able to create sustained follow-up business at very good prices with some of the auction buyers. The logistics of hosting an Internet auction are complex and involve developing a suitable portal that can handle real time dened bids from different sources. The process of signing up international buyers and importers is also a difcult and time-consuming task, as is establishing a tasting panel of recognized cuppers who select the best coffees in a competition among hundreds of candidates. Origins interested in hosting a Cup of Excellence Internet auction may contact the organizers at www.cupofexcellence. org. Note that such auctions focus on the small exemplary segment of the specialty market and do not lend themselves to broader-based selling of coffee.
PAPERLESS TRADE
TAKING THE PAPER OUT OF THE COFFEE TRADE: AN EXAMPLE
Today, larger companies in particular have automated back ofce systems that link in with shipping portals and, sometimes, selected suppliers and/or buyers. Nevertheless, as also explained in chapter 5, nearly the entire coffee trade still uses paper documentation in its dealings. Actual negotiations are conducted by phone, fax, and e-mail, but nal agreements such as contracts, delivery orders, bills of lading, letters of credit and other vital documents require an original signature and mostly continue to be presented physically to the respective parties. Furthermore, the quality and type of shipping documentation that circulates can be quite variable and delays may be considerable when faulty documents have to be returned and resubmitted, or cargo release is delayed because the documents are not available, causing signicant and unnecessary cost. Banks and others in the trade chain are very interested both in electronic security and the standardization of trade documentation. Taken together, if clear and enforceable
INTERNET AUCTIONS
There is growing interest in Internet auctions for selling specialty coffee. The concept and many of the legal, technical and practical aspects were developed under the auspices of the ICO/ITC/CFC Gourmet Coffee Project and involved the Brazilian Specialty Coffee Association (BSCA) working in association with the Specialty Coffee Association of
113
standards apply, these would provide the certainty that the shipping documentation submitted is valid and negotiable, which is not always the case today. For many exporters the time lapse between actual shipment and receipt of payment, executed through physical transmission of paper documents, can take as much as 15 to 25 days. In a truly paperless electronic system, the transfer of documents, transfer of title and nancial settlement can be reduced to four days or even less, depending on the complexity of the business process. Typical traditional document ow Day 1 Day 2 Day 3 Day 4 Day 5 Day 6 Day 7 Day 8 Day 9 Day 10 Day 11 Day 12 Day 13 Day 14 Day 15 Day 16 Day 17 Coffee loads Carrier prepares bill of lading Shipper receives bill of lading (can be much later in some coffee producing countries) Shipper processes bill of lading to bank Bank receives bill of lading Non-working day Non-working day Bank processes documents Documents in transit to selected European bank Documents in transit to selected European bank The European bank receives documents The European bank sends documents to buyers Non-working day Non-working day Buyer receives and processes documents Payment effected Shipper receives payment
adopted by the international green coffee trade, but it is and remains an option which is why this overview is provided.
Typical electronic documentation ow Day 1 Coffee loads, bill of lading raised by carrier Bill of lading instantly transmitted to shipper Shipper uses bill of lading to generate other documents Shipper transmits to selected European bank Documents received and processed by bank Bank transmits to buyer Buyer processes documents and effects payment Shipper is credited with the payment
Clearly the benets will vary from country to country, but that they are potentially substantial is obvious, especially when credit is tight and expensive, and when exporters depend on fast turn-around of their capital. However, as explained, the coffee trade has as yet not fully accepted to use truly paperless systems and appears to be satised with partial solutions. Nevertheless, it is good to understand how truly paperless systems really function also because the increasing demand for rapid and accurate advance security information on coffee shipments is bringing ever more coffee trade players into the eld of electronic information sharing. This is not to say that the electronic documentation process described in the sections that follow will be rapidly
114
advantage individual companies may have developed over the years? Various global shippers have focused their efforts on providing browser-based information services on contracts, delivery orders, shipments and quality. These initiatives have played a meaningful role in the process of automation and creation of supply chain visibility. But in the long run they are probably not a sustainable solution because they do not allow for efcient, industry-wide data integration. Two mainstream solutions have now evolved: e-marketplaces for commodity trading and secure messaging platforms to allow for data integration within the supply chain.
messaging of the data, between participants or via the e-marketplace. If the electronic data are in a standard format, which can be recognized by participating systems, information can be transferred directly from computer to computer. This is also known as straight through processing. This means the data do not have to be intercepted by users for verication and subsequent re-entry in the system often the origin of errors. They can be integrated directly into the individual users application or database. When combined with the central functions provided by the e-marketplaces, straight through processing allows for efciencies and cost savings at all functional levels of the supply chain. Administrative tasks are reduced and supply chain visibility and efciency between trade chain partners is increased.
115
IdenTrust. This is a certication authority and scheme that enables digital signatures to be deployed by applications. SWIFT provides network and interface services to IdenTrust. See www.identrust.com. GS1 US. Previously Transora, GS1 US is a supply chain standard development and information sharing platform, linking multiple sectors and businesses. See www.gs1us. org. Transactions must be handled through a provider or trustee that furnishes depository services. That is to say, all those wishing to use electronic transfer of original documents will have to be linked to a provider of depository services, at least until individual providers can themselves be linked to each other and carry out each others deliveries, adhering to the strictest standards of integrity and verication of the documentation. The international banking community has been using protocols and systems for many years: SWIFT (Society for Worldwide Interbank Financial Telecommunication) and CHIPS standards (Clearing House Interbank Payments System). Today these systems handle approximately 95% of all international United States dollar payments. Bolero and IdenTrust are based on similar principles and are logical extensions of the original considerations that led to SWIFTs formation. SWIFT is one of the founders of Bolero and IdenTrust and manages the technical operations of the Bolero system under contract, thus linking Bolero directly into the international banking system. According to its 2010 report there are 9,700 live users in 209 countries transmitting over 4 billion messages a year with peak trafc at over 18 million in a single day. Details at www.swift.com.
SPECIFIC ASPECTS
SECURITY, COMMON GROUND AND DISPUTE RESOLUTION
The trade in coffee would not be possible without security, some form of common ground and the effective, neutral resolution of disputes. The existing trade execution system has been developed and ne-tuned over many decades. Electronic systems will have to satisfy the same concerns and meet if not surpass the same standards to address the new issues arising from the use of electronic documents. In the paperless chain, security will be provided primarily by the legal framework, exactly as is the case with SWIFT, CHIPS, IdenTrust and others. Common ground will be provided by the multilateral contract with the main operator acting as trustee for the entire operation. As in the traditional coffee trade, rules
116
and regulations will have to be clearly dened and would preferably be overseen by the system users themselves, coming together rather as the coffee trade comes together in the GCA and the ECF.
Sellers have better control. So do importers and roasters, who can trace both coffee and documents. In some consuming countries special arrangements permit coffee to be cleared through customs ahead of arrival, resulting in direct dispatch from ship to nal destination. This could bring many exporters closer to participation in the just-in-time supply systems of larger roasters.
117
the warehouse and the agency supervising weighing and stufng. The foregoing presupposes that all of those involved, including customs, have updated their electronic back-ofce systems using data obtained from a web interface or using their own document management software. Bill of lading. Using details from the booking and document instructions received earlier, the carrier issues an electronic bill of lading and registers it under the network title registry for release to the exporter. The exporter is notied through the system and will endorse the bill of lading to the appropriate party, usually the bank that nanced the goods, which is then registered as pledgee on the bill of lading. Alternatively, the bill of lading can also be issued directly in a banks favour. Shipment advice. This is sent via the network using the XML standard for electronic shipping advices. Dispatch. The exporter combines the commercial invoice with the other export documents received from the different service providers and authorities and packages these into a network message that the network forwards to either the buyer or the bank. Verication. The documents are veried electronically with the instructions registered under the L/C undertaking. If there is any discrepancy the system noties all parties and asks for refusal or acceptance of the documents. Presentation of documents. If the documents are correct they are transmitted for inspection and/or approval (as per the L/C protocol) to the importers bank or, in the case of CAD (payment cash against documents on rst presentation) directly in trust to the importer. When the importers bank makes payment, the electronic documents are released automatically to the importer. Alternatively, the L/C opening bank, which was acting as pledgee on the bill of lading, will endorse the bill of lading to the importer once the electronic funds transfer has been conrmed through the SWIFT clearing system. At the receiving end. Before or upon arrival of the vessel, the carrier noties all concerned (importer, clearing agent, Customs, inland roasting plant, etc.) of the vessels ETA, followed by a notice of arrival, using XML. The importer settles the freight, releases the bill of lading to the carrier or shipping agency at the port of destination, and copies the bill of lading together with the commercial invoice to the clearing agent, all through the electronic network system and all at the same time. Again, each party knows instantaneously who said what to whom. Final delivery. If the coffee is going to an inland roasting plant, notications of cargo arrival, sample orders and delivery orders will pass electronically between the importer and the roaster. If the roaster operates on a vendor managed inventory basis then the importer will place the coffee either at the roasting plant, or at an intermediate container station,
or in a warehouse or silo park pending nal delivery. All this is done through network instructions to the clearing agents, trucking company and warehousemen. Again, everyone knows what is happening, and the roaster can see where the coffee is. Finally, the importer issues an XML invoice and delivery order to the roaster, copied to the clearing agents, truckers and warehousemen. Upon payment this delivery order acts as transfer of title as per the conditions determined in the ECF or GCA standard form contract.
118
TECHNICAL QUESTIONS
WHO COULD USE AN ELECTRONIC SYSTEM?
A local IT infrastructure and legal framework must be in place rst. If they are, anyone with Internet access, or whose bank, coffee authority or IT provider is linked into the system, can access it, either as a full member or by buying the service on a retail basis. In practice only those countries whose customs and possibly coffee industry authorities have accepted the system and have installed the necessary capability will benet. It seems likely that larger producing countries will be more interested because for them the potential economies of scale are tremendous. The roasting sector will also participate more and more because of the control and information the network provides, which will permit some to move from justin-time systems to vendor managed inventory systems. Even if a roaster is not linked into the system, the importer can surrender the electronic documents and have them replicated as paper originals by the original issuing authority, for instance the carrier or warehouse. For the buyer it is essential, however, that the exporter is linked into the system. Given the cost savings and reduced working capital requirements the system provides, this linkage can become an important issue when considering the viability of any particular transaction or business relationship with an origin country or an individual exporter.
ACCESS
The system as described is not an actual IT application or browser, but rather provides an electronic highway between the different parties in the electronic community. In short, it is open platform technology. Like CHIPS or SWIFT, such a system can keep track of all documents transmitted on its system (platform). It can provide proof of who said what to whom and when, and it can conrm that messages, contracts, shipping instructions, sampling orders, documents, delivery orders and so on were received in a timely manner and in good order. To access such an electronic highway participants would probably use accredited application providers and possibly middleware companies, using software that can be implemented as stand-alone document packages, or integrated with back-ofce systems or enterprise resource planning systems. Different parties have different needs, so different applications will have to be available for banks, carriers, traders, processors and others in the trade chain. Different solutions also apply to different sizes of companies. Bigger operations will need packages to be integrated with their existing software, while smaller companies may not have the need, the knowledge or the means to acquire sophisticated software. In future, even the smallest exporter will probably be able to link into the electronic highway, either through an e-commerce site or by simply buying into an appropriate service through a bank or other service provider. This will certainly be the case in countries with well-developed and easy Internet access, provided Customs and other government authorities are in agreement and the necessary legal steps have been completed. Banks in coffee producing countries are likely candidates to take a direct interest as they then could retail the service to individual clients on a user fee basis. Note that any electronic document handling system will have to be able to link up with the electronic bill of lading solutions that major shipping companies may eventually come up with.
STANDARDS
Easy communication of data and documents within the coffee supply chain requires certain standards for contracts and contract amendments, pricing, optional conditions, declarations and so on. Standards are also needed for the electronic documents for contract execution, such as sample and delivery orders, bills of lading, warehouse receipts and warrants. Electronic standards have been developed for the United States coffee industry in collaboration with the membership of the GCA, the National Coffee Association of USA and ICE. These use XML (extensible mark-up language) format so both humans and computers can read them and they allow electronic transfer and integration into back-ofce systems (straight through processing). The GCA electronic contract includes additional options: price x letter, price x rolling letter and a destination declaration letter. The technology provides both simplication and an optimal number of choices when creating a contract, transmitting a delivery order or shipment advice, or presenting a commercial set of documents.
CHAPTER 7
ARBITRATION
THE PRINCIPLE OF ARBITRATION.................................................................................................................... 120 ARBITRATION IN THE UNITED KINGDOM....................................................................................................... 122 ARBITRATION IN GERMANY ............................................................................................................................. 124 ARBITRATION IN FRANCE ................................................................................................................................. 126 ARBITRATION IN THE UNITED STATES ........................................................................................................... 127
120
CHAPTER 7 ARBITRATION
ARBITRATION
THE PRINCIPLE OF ARBITRATION
A contract becomes nal and binding when buyer and seller agree on a transaction: verbally, by e-mail, by fax or otherwise. For this to be possible all standard terms and conditions must have been agreed to previously, including how possible disputes will be resolved. Arbitration provides a neutral, specialized platform to resolve a dispute when amicable settlement proves impossible. The international trade in coffee is complex by nature and so dispute resolution can be quite complicated as well: it requires experience and insights not easily found outside the coffee trade itself. Disputes also need to be resolved quickly and fairly, preferably amicably, with buyer and seller agreeing to a mutually acceptable solution. But if this proves impossible then arbitration provides the means to resolve the matter in an impartial manner without involving a court of law where proceedings could be subject to delays (possibly holding up disposal of the goods) and where expert knowledge may not be easily accessible. Also, the exercise could be very costly. This is the main reason why the European Coffee Federation (ECF) and the Green Coffee Association (GCA) standard contracts expressly exclude recourse to the law for the settlement of disputes, stating instead that this shall always be through arbitration. Go to www.ecf-coffee.org and www. greencoffeeassociation.org for the full contract texts. Arbitration rules have been set by the professional coffee associations in importing countries. The most important arbitration centres in Europe are London, Hamburg and Le Havre. Other arbitration centres are Amsterdam, Antwerp, Genoa, Rome and Trieste. In the United States arbitrations have always been held in New York but since 2006 they can also be held in other locations as approved by the GCA. Interested parties should contact their US connection or the GCA for an up to date list of GCA-approved locations. interpretation, custom and national law governing arbitration in different localities, for example between London and Trieste. It is therefore important that the place where any arbitration will be held is agreed ahead of concluding a transaction, and is so stipulated in the contract. This will also avoid having to be a party to proceedings in an unfamiliar environment and, possibly, language. United Kingdom The British Coffee Association, London Website: www.britishcoffeeassociation.org Germany Deutscher Kaffeeverband e.V., Hamburg Website: www.kaffeeverband.de France Chambre arbitrale des cafs et poivres du Havre 115, rue Desram, 76600 Le Havre Telephone: +33 2 35216161 Fax: +33 2 35218060 United States of America Green Coffee Association, New York Website: www.greencoffeeassociation.org Netherlands Royal Netherlands Coffee and Tea Association, Rijswijk Website: www.knvkt.nl Belgium Union professionelle du commerce anversois dimportation de caf (UPCAIC), Antwerp E-mail: bvdaki-upcaic@skynet.be Italy Associazione Caff Trieste, Trieste Website: www.assocaffe.it
ARBITRATION CENTRES
Under GCA rules arbitrations are held in New York unless a different GCA-approved location has been specied in the contract. Appeals are always heard in New York. Under ECF contracts arbitrations can be held in different countries, something that could make a difference. Even though there is one single European Contract for Coffee (ECC), there will always be subtle differences in
Quality disputes resolved through quality arbitration; Technical disputes (any other dispute) resolved through technical arbitration. Because quality disputes affect the fate of a parcel of coffee (delays are costly and at the same time the quality deteriorates) the rules and time limits for lodging a claim are different from those for technical disputes: ECF contracts. Quality claims must be lodged within 21 calendar days from date of nal discharge at port of
CHAPTER 7 ARBITRATION
121
destination. All other claims (technical): not later than 45 calendar days from discharge provided the documents were available to the buyer, or from the last date of the contractual shipping period if the coffee has not been shipped. GCA contracts. Quality claims must be lodged within 15 calendar days after discharge or within 15 calendar days after all government clearances have been received. All other claims (technical): no time limit for lodging the claim, but a demand for technical arbitration must be lodged within one year from the date the issue rst arose. Either party to a contract can lodge a claim, preferably in writing, by notifying the other party within the stipulated time limits that a dispute has arisen. Should amicable settlement prove impossible then the claimant can proceed to arbitration. Suppliers must carefully consider their handling of claims. It is almost inevitable that forcing a claim to be settled through arbitration will signal the end of the relationship with the buyer in question. Buyers are most likely to claim on matters of quality, weight, delayed or non-shipment, incorrect or missing documentation, etc. Suppliers claims are more likely to center on late, incomplete or even non-payment or, for example, frustration of a contract by a buyer that fails to provide shipping instructions. Fewer and fewer quality claims make it to arbitration because the supplier/shipper does not want to risk the relationship, whereas especially larger buyers do not bother to pursue relatively minor claims, preferring to simply strike the offending supplier off their register, sometimes even without notication.
Remember also that those who see the coffee trade from only one side, such as exporters, do not always appreciate why and how certain actions or lack of action can cause their counterpart to suffer loss or damage, and it is not uncommon for some to feel subsequently that they have been treated unfairly in the arbitration proceedings. Look for local assistance because local representatives usually have more experience with the arbitration system and can guide an exporter through some of the details. A local representative might not know exactly how an arbitration award was decided, but he or she should clearly understand the proceedings and be able to explain more or less how the outcome was determined. This is very helpful for an exporter in deciding whether or not to appeal against an award.
APPOINTING ARBITRATORS
Appointing an arbitrator does not mean acquiring a defender who will advance one side of a dispute no matter what. Arbitration means that the arbitrators impartially consider and pronounce on the merits of a case, irrespective of by whom they were appointed. Only well known, experienced and respected members of the coffee trade can become arbitrators. They are selected by their peers to serve on their associations panel of arbitrators. As per his or her particular sphere of expertise, an arbitrator may serve on the quality panel, the technical panel or both. Depending on the rules of the association concerned arbitrators can be appointed by the parties to the dispute, or by the association itself. Where the parties to a dispute appoint their own arbitrators, usual practice is that these arbitrators themselves then select a third, the umpire.
COMMON ERRORS
The buyer is not the enemy. Keeping buyers informed usually means that most if not all of a problem can be resolved amicably. Hiding bad news on the other hand guarantees trouble. Knowingly shipping sub-standard quality demonstrates disregard for contract integrity, or a lack of quality knowledge, or both. Not reporting that a shipment may be delayed can cause much greater damage than may immediately be obvious. Buyer and seller are partners in a transaction. Both are obliged to play their role to ensure the successful completion and to minimize the impact of potentially harmful situations. Keeping the buyer informed of any problems enables timely corrective action to be taken, thereby saving costs and damages. Arbitrators will take this into account when it comes to making an award. And if a claim is received, deal with it. Promptly and efciently. Do not ignore a claim in the belief that it will go away. And if a claim does result in arbitration proceedings being initiated, cooperate fully because otherwise the exercise will proceed without your input.
AWARDS
An award is the verdict of the arbitrators, arrived at in accordance with the arbitration rules of their local arbitral body and national law. Under GCA contracts arbitrations always take place in the United States. However, under ECF contracts they can be held in different countries, something that could make a difference. Most awards are subject to appeal, within the time limits set by the arbitral body at the place where the arbitration was held. The limits and procedures are different for each arbitral body whose rules should therefore be consulted.
122
CHAPTER 7 ARBITRATION
or having an interest in coffee. Each of the recipients of such notication may in turn bring it to the notice of its own members or otherwise publicise it. In addition, in order to enforce an arbitration award, a party may also have direct recourse to the courts of the place where the defaulting party is established. GCA rules allow 30 days for an award to be satised, after which a comparable procedure kicks in if the party in whose favour the award was given so requests.
appeal proceedings. The seat of all arbitral proceedings is London, England. Parties to proceedings have the right to apply to the courts to determine questions as to the substantive jurisdiction of the arbitral tribunal or board of appeal but in the latter case only if the original objection had already been made in the rst-tier proceedings. Tribunals and boards of appeal may seek legal advice from or allow an independent legal adviser to attend at the hearing of any oral evidence or oral submissions. Tribunals and boards of appeal may also seek expert opinion from and/or allow an independent expert or assessor to attend at the hearing of any oral evidence or oral submissions for the purpose of providing expert opinion. All written statements must be in English and supporting evidence in other languages must be accompanied by an independent translation. All written correspondence, submissions and notices are communicated in legible form by a prompt method of communication, including e-mail or fax unless otherwise directed by either tribunal or board of appeal. Each party to proceedings (both tribunal and board of appeal) have the right upon application in writing to the BCA to require the BCA to remove one arbitrator only in which event a substitute arbitrator shall be appointed by the BCA. A party seeking to exercise this right is not required to give reasons for doing so. This right must be exercised within three London working days of the date of the appointment of the arbitrator which that party seeks to have removed. In accordance with its general duty a tribunal or board of appeal has the power to order on its own initiative or on the application of a party: that the arbitral proceedings shall be consolidated with other arbitral proceedings; or that concurrent hearings shall be held; A party may be represented in the arbitral proceedings by a representative (which expression shall include legal practitioners) except that: (i) at a hearing of oral evidence and/or oral submissions a party may not be represented by one or more legal practitioners unless permitted by the tribunal or board of appeal; and (ii) at a hearing of oral evidence a natural person ordered or permitted to give oral evidence may not give that oral evidence by way of a representative and must give that oral evidence in person. It is the general duty of a tribunal or board of appeal to: (a) act fairly and impartially as between the parties, giving each party a reasonable opportunity of putting its case and dealing with that of its opponent; and (b) adopt procedures suitable to the circumstances of the particular case, avoiding unnecessary delay or expense, so as to provide a fair means for the resolution of the matters falling to be determined. NB. If without showing sufcient cause a party after due notice fails to attend or be represented at hearings or fails to submit written evidence or make written submissions, then a tribunal or board of appeal may continue the proceedings in
CHAPTER 7 ARBITRATION
123
the absence of that party or, as the case may be, without any written evidence or submissions on that partys behalf, and may make an award on the basis of the evidence before it.
evidence, within the following deadlines: (a) the claimants claim submissions: within 21 days from the date the rst-tier proceedings were commenced; (b) the respondents defence submissions and counterclaim submissions (if any): within 21 days from the date the respondent received the claimants claim submissions from the BCA; (c) the claimants reply submissions and defence to counterclaim submissions (if any): within 21 days from the date the claimant received the respondents defence submissions and counterclaim submissions (if any) from the BCA; (d) the respondents reply to defence to counterclaim submissions: within 21 days from the date the respondent received the claimants reply submissions and defence to counterclaim submissions from the BCA.
PROVISION OF SAMPLES
If a claimant wishes a tribunal to examine any sample, the claimant ensures receipt by the BCA of the sample, together with a concise statement of the purpose for which the sample is being provided, at the same time as receipt by the BCA of the claimants application for arbitration. If a respondent wishes a tribunal to examine a sample the respondent ensures receipt by the BCA of the sample, together with a concise statement of the purpose for which the sample is being provided, no later than at the same time as receipt by the BCA of the respondents defence submissions. If a party wishes to submit a sample at a later stage in rst-tier proceedings for examination by a tribunal that party does so only with the permission of the tribunal.
CLARITY IS ESSENTIAL
Claimants should provide a clear statement of the problem, how it arose and the remedy sought. It is not sufcient for example to simply state We claim an allowance. If an allowance is sought then it must be quantied, e.g. US$ 4 per 50 kg is claimed on quality grounds. The statement must be in writing and must be supported by copies of all relevant documentation, including copies of exchanges between the parties. All should be catalogued, numbered and presented in chronological order. If the dispute concerns quality the arbitrators will give directions on the production of the necessary samples. Respondents should provide all relevant documentation to all concerned and should specically address the points raised by the claimant.
124
CHAPTER 7 ARBITRATION
The application for appeal should: (a) name the other party or parties (each a respondent) to the intended appeal proceedings; and (b) identify the tribunals award against which the appellant wishes to appeal; and (c) request the BCA to appoint a board of appeal. It shall be accompanied by: evidence that the appellant has transmitted a copy of the application for appeal to each respondent; and a copy of the tribunals award against which the appellant wishes to appeal. Upon receipt by the BCA of both the non-returnable fee and the application for appeal, the appeal proceedings are deemed to have been commenced and the BCA shall: (a) forward a copy of the application for appeal to each respondent; and (b) appoint ve arbitrators to form a board of appeal (unless already appointed as per above); and (c) forward to the board of appeal: a copy of the application for appeal; and a copy of the tribunals award against which the appellant wishes to appeal.
AWARDS OF INTEREST
A tribunal or board of appeal may award simple or compound interest from such dates, at such rates and with such rests as it considers meets the justice of the case.
ARBITRATION IN GERMANY
THE DEUTSCHER KAFFEEVERBAND E.V.
The Deutscher Kaffeeverband e.V. (DKV) in Hamburg is the umbrella organization for the German coffee trade and industry. The court of arbitration of the Deutsche Kaffeeverband e.V. at the Hamburg Chamber of Commerce (HCC) deals with principal arbitration cases on technical disputes. Proceedings are administrated by the HCC. Quality disputes are dealt with by the Association of Hamburg Coffee Import Agents.
PROVISION OF SAMPLES
If a party wishes the board of appeal to examine a sample not submitted for examination during the rst-tier proceedings that party can do so only with the permission of the board of appeal.
CHAPTER 7 ARBITRATION
125
an umpire. If they cannot agree on the umpire, then the umpire will be appointed by the Hamburg Chamber of Commerce. The Chamber will also appoint an arbitrator for the defendant, if the defendant fails to do so himself. The panel can be enlarged by two additional arbitrators on the demand of any party. Remember that arbitrators in a dispute are not partial to any side they are neutral members of the ofcial arbitration board. Requests for arbitration must be made in writing to the arbitration board of the DKV at the Hamburg Chamber of Coffee and shall state the grounds for the dispute, a precise claim and proof of agreement regarding the competence of the arbitration board. The plaintiff also has to provide the name and address of the plaintiffs arbitrator and his declaration of assent. HCC informs the other party of the claim, requesting a written response that must include the name of the arbitrator who will act for the defendant and his declaration of assent. Unlike some other markets, there is no xed time limit within which the defendant must respond. Instead it is left to the discretion of HCC to set the limit for the rst response, but once the arbitration panel is constituted then it sets all subsequent time limits. All submissions must be in writing in ve copies. Hearing and award. The date and the organization of the hearing are arranged by the umpire and HCC noties the parties in writing. Arbitrators examine the written submissions and may invite further voluntary evidence from outside witnesses and experts. Both parties to the dispute are also summoned for oral pleading of their case. A legal adviser from the HCC has to attend all meetings and participates in the deliberations but has no vote. Decisions are reached by simple majority vote and the award, setting out the grounds for the verdict, is delivered in writing through the HCC. Appeal. There is no appeal as such against a DKV award. An award can be submitted to the Hamburg Hanseatic High Court which is competent for all judicial rulings and functions required in accordance with German civil process law (ZPO). If the court disafrms the award on formal legal grounds then the arbitration must be repeated, with the same arbitrators and umpire ofciating unless the court specically ruled otherwise. Costs and fees are linked to the value of the dispute: up to EUR 10,000 the fee is EUR 1,000. Then an additional 10% for the next EUR 5,000; 9% for the next EUR 10,000; 8% for the next EUR 15,000; 7% for the next EUR 25,000; 6% for the next EUR 35,000; 5% for the next EUR 200,000; 4% for the next EUR 700,000; and 2% for the next EUR 1,000,000. For disputed sums over EUR 2,000,000 the additional fee is 0.5% of the amount in excess of EUR 2,000,000. In addition to the above the HCC shall charge a at-rate sum in the amount of 15% of these fees with a maximum of EUR 20,000.
Value added tax (VAT), where applicable, comes on top of all said fees, as well as necessary expenses of the arbitrators and the HCC. On submitting the statement of claim, the plaintiff has to make a security payment amounting to the anticipated costs of the proceedings.
126
CHAPTER 7 ARBITRATION
The question of fraud or negligence can be pursued only if the claimant requests this. In this type of case the arbitrators and three umpires are limited to pronouncing a suspicion of fraud and gross negligence and to xing an adequate allowance. The claimant may contest this and demand a technical arbitration to order annulment of the contract rather than payment of an allowance. The panels reasoning must therefore be provided in writing by the umpires for possible use in such an arbitration. Costs and fees. 11,000 bags: EUR 100 per arbitrator/ umpire. For each additional 1,000 bags or portion thereof: an additional 100 EUR per arbitrator/umpire.
Technical disputes
Statement of the matters in disputes and claims made; All relevant documents (contracts, invoices, bills of lading, certicates, etc.). The request for arbitration must be lodged within 30 days as above, to be followed by the complete dispute le in ve copies, including statements of facts and claims, within a further 10 days. The other party must lodge their defence within 30 days from the date CACPH transmits the dispute le to them. The plaintiff then has 15 days to respond after which the defendant has a further 15 days to make a nal response. Failure to respond will result in the arbitration proceeding without any input from the defendant.
ARBITRATION IN FRANCE
THE CHAMBRE ARBITRALE DES CAFS ET POIVRES DU HAVRE
The Chambre arbitrale des cafs et poivres du Havre (CACPH) is the main arbitral body for coffee and brings together arbitrators from both the French and the Swiss coffee trade. CACPH conducts both quality (arbitrage de qualit et expertise) and technical arbitrations (arbitrage de principe). Linked quality and technical issues within the same dispute can be dealt with simultaneously in a joint arbitration (arbitrage mixte). Requests for arbitration must be made in French or in English on the ofcial form provided. If legal counsel is to be involved this must be indicated on the request form. The rules provide for a two-tier system of adjudication: arbitration at the rst instance and an appeals procedure. All time limits are calendar days and run from the date material is forwarded, including 72 hours deemed necessary for transmission. Late delivery automatically extends the time limit according to the delay involved.
ARBITRATION PANELS
All arbitrators are designated by CACPH and their names are made known to the parties. Arbitrators may not have any connection with the matter in dispute. If they nd that they do then they must withdraw unless the parties agree that they can continue. For quality arbitrations and appeals: three arbitrators, appointed by the board of directors. For technical arbitrations: in the rst instance three arbitrators and on appeal ve, again appointed by the CACPH board. Parties to a dispute may challenge arbitrators only on grounds which arose, or became apparent, after they were appointed and must do so within three days of the event, failing which the panel shall stand as nominated. All arbitration hearings are private but in technical arbitrations the parties may be present or may be represented by legal counsel. They can also be represented by a member of the coffee trade but only with the prior approval of the panel.
CHAPTER 7 ARBITRATION
127
NB: Awards are pronounced in French to enable the parties to obtain execution by the Tribunal de Grande Instance du Havre. Awards can however be translated by sworn translators. Costs and fees are set by the arbitrators, who also stipulate who shall be liable for them. No arbitration procedure will be initiated unless the required deposit for costs and fees (determined by CACPH for each individual case) has rst been made.
experience of each individual, and determines for which list he or she is qualied. These lists form the pool of names from which the GCA secretary then chooses arbitrators by lot. The secretary must also be vigilant not to select arbitrators who may have a conict of interest because of relationships with either party to a dispute. Once the arbitrators are selected, the arbitration is entirely under their control as stated in the GCA Rules of Arbitration: The Association does administer and interpret the arbitration procedure and these Rules and it designates the arbitrators. It is, however, the arbitrators who conduct the hearings, determine and decide the issue, and they alone have the power and authority to make an award. Arbitrators shall be in complete charge of the arbitration. They shall conduct the same with the purpose of establishing equity and fair dealings in matters of trade and commerce. All GCA arbitrations are monitored by the legal staff of the IntercontinentalExchange (ICE) to ensure they are run efciently and that the results are both impartial and in full compliance with the laws of the land. Since 1999 the administration of the GCA has fallen under the auspices of the Exchange (now ICE but previously known as the New York Board of Trade or NYBOT).
QUALITY ARBITRATIONS
The GCA contract stipulates that: Coffee shall be considered accepted as to quality unless within 15 calendar days after discharge of the coffee, or within 15 calendar days after all government clearances have been received, whichever is later, either: Claims are settled by the parties to the contract; or Arbitration procedures have been led by one of the parties in accordance with the provisions of the contract. If neither of the above has been done within the stated period, or if any portion of the coffee has been removed from the point of discharge before representative sealed samples have been drawn by the GCA, in accordance with its rules, sellers responsibility for quality claims ceases for that portion so removed. To initiate a quality arbitration, the claimant must submit a signed and notarized demand for arbitration in triplicate explicitly setting forth the precise complaint(s) in detail on GCA form A-2. This must be accompanied by the original contract, a sampling order to the order of the GCA, and the requisite arbitration fee. When GCA receives the defendants answer it copies it to the claimant, who may either le a reply with GCA or allow the arbitration to proceed in accordance with the original submission. All arbitration forms are available from www.greencoffeeassociation.org.
128
CHAPTER 7 ARBITRATION
On receipt of the arbitration demand, the defendant responds by ling their signed and notarized answer in triplicate on GCA form B-2, together with the requisite fee. This answer must be led with GCA within ve business days from receipt of the arbitration demand if the defendants ofce is located in New York City. If the defendants ofce is not in New York City, the GCA secretary can, at his or her discretion, extend any time requirement beyond that prescribed to give the defendant an equivalent period to that allowed to a resident. If the claimant les an answer to the defendants reply, the defendant can le an additional response or they can allow the arbitration to proceed on the basis of their original answer.
The arbitrators are also required to assess the costs of the arbitration against the unsuccessful party; they can also instruct the parties to share the costs.
Procedure
When the nal answer or reply has been led, or the time when the same is due has expired, the GCA secretary determines the panel of arbitrators to be used. Any arbitrator known to be connected with either party shall be removed from the list. If the arbitration is outside of New York, the secretary shall then supply the list of potential arbitrators to the petitioner and the respondent and ask them each to select one arbitrator. The secretary shall then ask the two arbitrators selected, to choose a third arbitrator from the same list. This is referred to as the Alternate Panel Selection method. If the arbitration location is in New York, and the Alternate Panel Selection method is not specied at time of contract, the GCA secretary will select the panel by lot. If the arbitration location is not specied at time of contract, the arbitration will be in New York with the GCA secretary selecting the panel by lot. Arbitrations involving grade or quality must be held at one physical location acceptable to the arbitrators and the association. GCA prepares an extract of the arbitration papers that have been led, deleting all names and references to the parties, including all marks on the samples to be tested and ensures that all pertinent data and samples are submitted to the arbitrators. This secrecy applies to arbitrations where the GCA chooses the arbitrators. If the alternative selection of arbitrators is invoked, the parties waive their right to anonymity with the arbitrators. The arbitrators shall then make an award within ve business days. The arbitrators independently cup and grade six cups for each chop submitted for arbitration, according to the claimants demand, and make their own conclusions. The arbitrators review their ndings and issue either a unanimous decision, or a majority and a minority decision. GCA noties the parties to the dispute as quickly as possible, but not later than ve business days after the decision on the award is reached.
TECHNICAL ARBITRATIONS
Actions the claimant and the defendant must take. These are the same as for quality arbitrations, but the demand and response must be submitted on GCA forms A-1 and B-1. All relevant papers (shipping documents, correspondence, certicates, statements, etc.) must accompany these forms, which are available from www.greencoffeeassociation.org. Technical arbitration hearings can be held in person at any facility deemed acceptable by the GCA and the arbitrators, or by conference phone call, or Internet meeting site. It is not necessary that arbitrators, parties and their legal representatives, and the GCA secretary be physically present at the same location. The secretary will arrange for a stenographic record of testimony if this is requested by either party.
CHAPTER 7 ARBITRATION
129
Each party has the right to request an oral hearing. If they exercise this right, they may appear with an attorney and witnesses provided the arbitrators and the other party were been given prior notice of this and the arbitrators have not objected. The other party may then also appear with an attorney. The arbitrators always have the option of asking GCA legal counsel to be present. All oral testimony must be made under oath; the entire procedure is recorded. All communications must be addressed to the chairperson of the arbitration panel; no one is permitted to communicate directly with the arbitrators or witnesses, except with the chairpersons approval.
assistance to assure a fair hearing regardless of how far away a respondent may be, but there are certain facts and procedures of which the system assumes all participants have a good understanding. To protect oneself from oversight, it is a simple matter for an exporter to nominate a local importer to appear on their behalf in arbitration. Most importers will perform this service free of charge and the practice is quite common. Local representation helps in a number of ways. First of all, documents and sampling usually move along more efciently. When a piece of paper or a sampling order is misplaced, local people can trace the problem more quickly. Second, local representatives usually have more experience with the arbitration system and can guide the exporter through some of the details. For example, it is clearly stated that blanket contentions are not admissible in quality arbitrations. That is to say, one cannot simply ask for a quality allowance because the coffee is bad. An experienced person would point out that a quality complaint should not only be detailed, but also be all encompassing. There have been quality arbitrations where a claimant has complained only about the grade of the coffee. When reviewing the samples the arbitrators also found cup deciencies, but felt unable to include the cupping problem in their award because the claimant did not claim on the cup. An experienced claimant would make a claim for certain grade defects (e.g. black beans, sour beans or husks) that sometimes reect in the cup quality. The need for local representation in technical arbitrations is more obvious. The details of why and how contractual obligations are determined can be complex. An exporters experience is usually mostly sales oriented, whereas importers (and most technical arbitrators for that matter) have the broader experience of being both buyer and seller in the international coffee market. The nal advantage to having local representation is gaining a better understanding of the award. Most awards are very simple statements like: Based upon the evidence submitted, we award X to the seller [or buyer], and the cost of the arbitration to the buyer [or seller]. It is rare that an award includes any explanation as to why the arbitrators decided the way they did. Because most arbitrators are experienced coffee people, with equal experience as international buyers and sellers of coffee, they understand both sides of the transaction. Those who see the coffee trade from only one side, such as exporters, do not always appreciate why and how certain actions or lack of actions can cause their counterpart to suffer loss or damage, and it is not uncommon for some to feel they have been treated unfairly in the arbitration proceedings. Someone who has not experienced the business from both sides cannot always see how the other party was legitimately hurt by their actions and may sometimes think that the other party won the award because of a bias in the arbitration system.
Procedure
After the nal replies have been received from all parties, the GCA secretary selects a panel of three arbitrators from the associations register of technical arbitrators and ensures that they have no connection with any of the disputants. A mutually satisfactory time and a date are set. The arbitrators may approve a delay of ve days if acceptable reasons are submitted in writing. The arbitrators receive copies of all the documents that have been led and review them independently before the date of the arbitration. They elect their own chairperson to conduct the arbitration and hearings. The arbitrators may request the GCA counsel to attend and act as a legal adviser, but GCA counsel has no voice or vote in any decisions. The arbitrators assess costs on either or both of the parties.
PRACTICAL CONSIDERATIONS
Although the GCA arbitration system is designed so that exporters can use the system directly from source countries, it is advisable to have local representation at the arbitration. The GCA administration will provide all reasonable
130
CHAPTER 7 ARBITRATION
In quality arbitrations the arbitrators do not know who the parties are. They see only the complaint and the defendants reply, without names. After this the coffee does the talking. Therefore, bias in quality arbitrations is virtually impossible. In technical arbitrations, the arbitrators do see the names of the parties, but they are both buyers and sellers of coffee and so understand both sides of the business. Before being appointed they are pre-screened about any personal contacts they may have with the parties to the dispute, and GCA legal counsel monitors the proceedings. A local representative might not know exactly how the arbitration award was decided, but they should have a clear view of the proceedings and be able to explain more or less how an outcome was determined. This is very helpful for an exporter in deciding whether or not to appeal.
When a decision has been rendered by the panel, the arbitrators shall assess the arbitration fee on one or both of the parties as they see t. All other expenses incurred, shall be borne in such manner as xed in the award. Other deposits received are refunded to the parties entitled to them, except for non-member fees or any cancellation fees. All non-members party to an arbitration shall be charged an additional fee for each arbitration or appeal, over and above the scheduled fees charged to members as provided above: US$ 300 on any question solely of grade or quality of coffee; US$ 300 on any other question. The non-member fee when arbitrating against another nonmember is: US$ 500 on any question solely of grade or quality of coffee; US$ 2,000 on any other question. This additional fee is retained by the association regardless of the result. It must be paid, together with the regular arbitration fee charged to members, to the GCA at the time the submission to arbitration, and/or answer thereto is led with the GCA secretary.
CHAPTER 8
FUTURES MARKETS
ABOUT FUTURES MARKETS ............................................................................................................................. 132 ORGANIZATION OF A FUTURES MARKET...................................................................................................... 135 THE PRINCIPAL FUTURES MARKETS FOR COFFEE ...................................................................................... 136 THE NEW YORK ARABICA CONTRACT ........................................................................................................... 136 THE LONDON ROBUSTA CONTRACT .............................................................................................................. 138 BOLSA DE MERCADORIAS & FUTUROS BRAZIL ........................................................................................ 140 SINGAPORE EXCHANGE LTD THE SGX ROBUSTA COFFEE CONTRACT .............................................. 141 VIET NAM TWO EXCHANGES FOR ROBUSTA ............................................................................................ 141 THE MECHANICS OF TRADING IN FUTURES ................................................................................................ 141
132
FUTURES MARKETS
ABOUT FUTURES MARKETS
The extreme volatility of the price of coffee brings drastic price changes over months, weeks or days, or even within the same trading day. Crop prospects vary widely due to unforeseen events, for example drought, frost or disease. High coffee prices encourage production growth, while low prices result in falling output. The balance of supply and demand is subject to many uncertainties that affect price trends and therefore represent price risk. All levels of the coffee industry are exposed to risk from sudden price changes. Coffee futures represent coffee that will become available at some point in the future, based on standard contracts to deliver or accept a pre-determined quantity and quality of coffee at one of a known range of delivery ports. The only points to be agreed when concluding a futures contract are the delivery period and the price. The delivery period is chosen from a pre-set range of calendar months, called the trading positions. Market forces determine the price at the time of dealing. There are two main futures market centres, New York and London, serving the global coffee industry: In New York, the Intercontinental Exchange (NYSE: ICE), for arabica (the New York C Contract market symbol KC) see www.theice.com. In London, the London International Financial Futures and Options Exchange (NYSE Liffe), for robusta (market symbol RC) see www.euronext.com. For ease of reference these markets will from now on mostly be referred to in this guide as New York arabica or New York C Contract and as London robusta, Liffe or LIFFE. Other futures markets trading in coffee are found in Brazil and Singapore, whereas Viet Nam inaugurated two domestic exchanges in 2011. To locate market information on the Internet, it is helpful to understand the market coding systems. Using the symbols mentioned above, LKDX12 would refer to a quote on the London robusta market for the November 2012 delivery period. In the same way, KCZ12 would symbolize a quote on the New York arabica contract for the December 2012 delivery period. Some Internet sites are easier to navigate and read using these ofcial market symbols; other sites spell everything out in plain English. Free access price quotations are subject to a 20 to 30 minute delay. Anyone requiring up-to-the-minute quotations must register with a subscription service, which means paying monthly fees for real-time quotes. There are numerous such subscription services with fees ranging anywhere from US$ 200 to US$ 1,000 per month, depending on what other news and trading services the subscription package includes.
INTERNET ACCESS
The growth of the Internet has made access to price information on the main markets easier than ever before. The exchanges have their own websites, and all the major commodity news services (Reuters, CRB, etc.) supply price quotes for the major coffee futures markets. There are also Internet sites relating specically to the coffee business that provide market quotes. Most sites are easy to navigate and usually include a page with the latest futures price quotations.
The exchange does not set the price. It does not even participate in coffee price determination. The exchange market supports ve basic pricing functions: Price discovery; Price risk transfer; Price dissemination; Price quality; Arbitration.
133
The exchange establishes a visible, free market setting for the trading of futures and options which helps the underlying industry nd a market price (price discovery) for the product and allows the transfer of risk associated with cash price volatility. As price discovery takes place, the exchange provides price dissemination worldwide. Continuous availability of pricing information contributes to wider market participation and to the quality of price. (More buyers and sellers in the marketplace mean better liquidity and therefore, better pricing opportunities.). To ensure the accuracy and efciency of the trading process, the exchange also resolves trading disputes through arbitration.
In addition to its pricing functions, the coffee futures market also serves to establish standards of quality and grade that can be applied throughout the industry.
134
commitments, to hedge the price risks inherent in those physical transactions. More bids to buy and offers to sell in the market at any given time create greater pricing efciency for the participants seeking a price for the commodity. Currently only the New York and London markets provide this exibility on an international scale, while the Brazilian market, although extremely active, is mostly relevant to local interests. Speculators and hedgers competing for price generally means that futures and cash prices move in the same direction over time and as a futures contract approaches delivery, the futures price and the cash price will often converge. Futures prices do not always reect cash market reality though, especially over the very short term when large volumes may be traded for purely speculative reasons. The volume of futures trading and the underlying quantity of physical coffee it represents easily exceed total production of green coffee, or indeed the volume of the physical trade as a whole. The large volumes on the futures markets not only inuence futures prices, but inevitably have an inuence on the price of physical coffee as well. It is important for those involved in the physical coffee business to be aware of the activity of speculators and derivative traders. For that reason, the futures industry regularly examines and publishes the ratio of speculative and hedging activity in the market. Speculators are absolutely necessary to the efcient functioning of a futures market. Speculative activity directly improves liquidity and therefore serves the hedgers longterm interests. During the last 10 years or so, the activity of hedge funds and the development of options on futures markets have both led to an increase in short-term speculative activity. While options on futures provide another speculative opportunity in the futures market, options also represent an important risk management tool that has become very useful in recent years. See also chapter 9, Hedging and other operations. Not all options result in actual futures contracts. However, they do represent potential quantities to be traded on the strike dates should the holders decide to exercise their options rather than simply letting them expire. In any event, the large turnover in actual futures demonstrates the impact of the futures markets on the daily trade in physical coffee. In recent years, physical prices have largely been determined by applying a differential to prices in the futures market; that is, the combination of the differential (plus or minus) and the price of the selected futures position gives the price for the physical coffee. The tables 8.1 and 8.2 demonstrate the huge growth in volume of the trade in options and futures.
Table 8.1
Annual turnover in futures compared with gross world imports, 19802010 (millions of tons) New York 15.2 11.1 17.7 37.3 37.6 33.7 37.4 46.2 54.6 71.3 67.8 75.0 84.6 92.6 72.4 93.9 London 5.5 5.1 5.4 5.5 6.6 7.4 7.7 9.5 11.6 15.3 16.3 17.8 22.2 21.9 25.2 27.9 Total futures 20.7 16.2 23.1 42.8 44.2 41.1 45.1 55.7 66.2 86.6 84.1 92.8 106.8 114.5 97.6 121.8 World imports* 4.1 4.5 4.7 5.3 5.6 6.1 6.2 6.3 6.5 7.0 7.0 7.3 7.6 7.8 7.6 7.9
Year 1980 1985 19851989 19901994 19951999 2000 2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 2007 2008 2009 2010
Table 8.2
Annual turnover in options and futures, 1990 2010 (millions of tons) New York 4.8 12.9 16.9 23.3 15.5 13.6 18.1 22.6 33.5 40.3 47.2 49.5 48.0 24.4 39.2 London 0.2 0.7 0.8 0.9 0.6 0.4 0.7 0.7 1.2 0.8 2.3 3.3 2.8 1.9 4.8 Total options 5.0 13.6 17.7 24.2 16.1 14.0 18.8 23.3 34.7 41.1 49.5 52.8 50.8 26.3 44.0 Options + futures 41.0 56.3 42.1 76.9 57.2 59.1 74.5 89.5 121.3 125.2 142.3 159.6 165.3 123.9 165.8
Year 1990 19901994 19951998 1999 2000 2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 2007 2008 2009 2010
135
VOLATILITY
The extreme volatility of coffee prices can be seen historically in both the size and suddenness of price moves. In April 1994, for example, New York arabica C futures were around 85 cts/lb after frost damage in Brazil they reached 248 cts/lb: a rise of close to 300% in less than three months. Eventually values fell back to around 90 cts/lb, but by May 1997 prices had reached over 300 cts/lb. And by mid 2001 the nearest position on the New York arabica C contract had fallen to below 50 cts/lb: a 30-year low just four years after the 1997 highs. By end 2005 the near position once again stood above 100 cts/lb, reaching the 300 cts/lb level again in the rst half of 2011. www.futures.tradingcharts. com/chart/CF/M offers charts showing the price movements over the last eight to nine years. Modern communications can move markets quickly, ensuring that all events affecting price become known to all market players more or less simultaneously. And when as a result everyone wants to buy or sell, but there are no sellers or buyers, then without any trading the price may jump or fall by as much as 10 cts/lb or more, depending on the starting price level. In times of extreme volatility this gap means a trader can be left with a position they cannot liquidate when they wish to because there is no trade.
136
within 24 hours. In addition, members pay into a permanent guarantee fund, enabling the clearing house to assume nancial responsibility if a member defaults. The clearing house also assigns tenders and re-tenders of deliverable coffee after ensuring each lot meets certain set standards of quality, storage, packing, and so on.
137
September 2013 (U13), December 2013 (Z13), March 2014 (H14) and May 2014 (K14). The rst or nearest month is known as the current or spot month. When months repeat, the further out positions are sometimes referred to as red: in this example the March 2014 and May 2014 positions would be known as red March and red May.
Table 8.3 Tenderable growths and differentials at ICE Deliverable at
The reference to aged avours is not linked to Brazilian arabica, but refers to all growths and is accompanied by simultaneous changes in the age penalties that exchange graded tenderable lots incur after a certain period of storage, also effective with the March 2013 expiration. If a lot is passed, the exchange will issue the certicate, which includes a complete rating on any grade imperfections. One appeal against rejection is possible on each lot with the whole process repeated by ve graders instead of the original three. The appellant has the option to submit a new sample or to run the appeal on the original sample. It is quite normal for coffee that grades well, but has failed on cup to be appealed automatically in the hope that the unsound cup in the rst test was an anomaly. The certicate establishes the basis, or standard, deliverable for these growths. Each growth is allowed a maximum of 23 imperfections (out of 350 grams), with a deduction of 10 points for each full imperfection by which it exceeds the number permitted in the basis. Sample size is 5 lb for parcels up to 300 bags, 8 lb for 301500 bags and 10 lb for more than 500 bags. Exchanges continuously monitor cash market conditions and adjust contracts or create new ones to reect those changes. This reects the fundamental relationship between cash and futures. If the futures market does not accurately represent the cash market, then it cannot perform its primary pricing functions. As an example, in recent years the C contract added Panamanian coffee to its tenderable growths, reduced the discount for a number of other growths and added European delivery points. In addition, new grading procedures as well as changes in bagging standards have been implemented.
Tenderable growths
Basis or contract price Costa Rica, El Salvador, Guatemala, Honduras, Kenya, Mexico, Nicaragua, Panama, Papua New Guinea, Peru, Uganda, United Republic of Tanzania Colombia Burundi, India, Venezuela (Bolivarian Republic of) Rwanda* Dominican Republic, Ecuador Brazil** Plus 200 points per pound Minus 100 points per pound Minus 300 points per pound Minus 400 points per pound Minus 900 points per pound
* Effective with the March 2013 expiration, the differential for Rwanda will be minus 100 points. ** Deliverable effective with the March 2013 delivery expiration.
CERTIFICATION OF DELIVERIES
No coffee can be submitted for tendering without having rst obtained a certicate of grade and quality from the exchange. All coffee submitted for certication is examined by a panel of three licensed graders. The examination is blind, or neutral, as the graders know the country of origin but not who submitted the sample. The quality is determined on the basis of six evaluations and measurements: Green coffee odour (no foreign odours); Screen size (50% over screen 15, no more than 5% below screen 14); Colour (greenish); Grade (defect count); Roast uniformity; Cup (six cups per sample). Brazilian arabica will be deliverable effective with the March 2013 expiration. This means that in future both washed and semi-washed Brazilian arabicas may be tendered, but the exchange has not addressed this directly. Instead it has added a new standard to the rules as follows: Coffee C shall consist of one (1) growth, in sound condition, free from all unwashed and aged avours in the cup, of good roasting quality and of bean size and colour in accordance with criteria established by the Exchange.
138
eCOPS has now replaced the paper delivery trail with electronic versions of warehouse receipts, delivery orders, sampling orders, weight notes, invoices, insurance declarations and a number of other accompanying documents. Other areas such as bills of lading and customs entry documentation will be added as the system grows. For more on eCOPS see also chapter 6 or go to www.theice.com and look for eCOPS.
SUPERVISION BY CFTC
The U.S. Commodity Futures Trading Commission (CFTC) is charged with the supervision of trading in commodity futures. The CFTC reports directly to the United States Congress and its aim is to protect the trading public from possible abuses by the futures industry, such as manipulation of the market and other deceptive practices that might prevent the market from correctly reecting supply and demand factors. It also seeks to ensure that the members of the exchange are nancially viable. Exchange bylaws, rules and regulations are statutory and therefore have the force of law. The provisions of the CFTC Act require every intermediary that deals with members of the public investing in futures to be registered with the National Futures Association, a self-regulatory body created by the Act. The ICE Exchanges, through the use of electronic surveillance and professional personnel, actively monitor trading activity and enforce trading rules and regulations.
139
market works. Price information is also available free of charge at www.euronext.com/trader/priceslistsderivatives/ derivativespriceslists-46171-EN.html, but with a 15 minute time delay.
minimum of 90% over screen 14 round and a minimum of 96% over screen 12 round per 300 g at contract price. Class 2: up to a maximum of 5.0% defects by weight and up to a maximum of 1.0% foreign matter by weight and a minimum of 90% over screen 13 round and a minimum of 96% over screen 12 round per 300 g; at an allowance of US$ 30 discount per ton. Class 3: up to a maximum of 7.5% defects by weight and up to a maximum of 1.0% foreign matter by weight and a minimum of 90% over screen 13 round and a minimum of 96% over screen 12 round per 300 g; at an allowance of US$ 60 discount per ton. Class 4: up to a maximum of 8.0 % defects by weight and up to a maximum of 1.0% foreign matter by weight and a minimum of 90% over screen 12 round per 300 g; at an allowance of US$ 90 discount per ton. Coffee shall not be tenderable if in the opinion of the graders one or more of the following applies: The lot is not robusta coffee; The lot is unsound for any reason other than having the defects listed above; The lot contains more than 8.0% defects by weight per 300 g; The lot contains less than 90% over screen 12 round; The lot contains more than 1.0% by weight of foreign matter per 300 g; The lot has a detectable foreign odour including, but not limited to, mould, fermentation or smoke.
TENDERABLE GROWTHS, PACKING, DIFFERENTIALS AND CERTIFICATION Tenderable growths and packing
Robusta coffee from any country of origin that meets the minimum quality requirements is tenderable, provided it is freely available for exportation. Coffee may be delivered in sound normal bags of maximum 80 kg gross each (bulk shipments must be bagged into tenderable lots), or in sound food grade exible intermediate bulk containers (FIBC or big bags) weighing not less than 900 kg gross and not more than 1,100 kg gross.
Age allowance
US$ 5 discount per ton per calendar month for the period of 13 to 48 months following the date of grading. US$ 10 discount per ton per calendar month for the period of 49 calendar months and onwards following the date of grading.
Certication
Grading samples are examined by three members of the Exchange grading panel, who award a grading certicate based on the screen test, the measuring of both defects and foreign matter by weight, and an olfactory (smell) test the coffee is not liquored (tasted).
Differentials
Premium Class: up to a maximum of 0.5% defects by weight and up to a maximum of 0.2% foreign matter by weight and a minimum of 90% over screen 15 round and a minimum of 96% over screen 13 round per 300 g; at an allowance of US$ 30 premium per ton. Class 1: up to a maximum of 3.0% defects by weight and up to a maximum of 0.5% foreign matter by weight and a
SUPERVISION BY LCH
The London Clearing House (LCH) acts as the central counter party for all trades executed on the LIFFE exchange, and is contractually obliged to ensure the performance of all trades registered by its members.
140
Apart from LIFFEs internal regulations on members nancial resources, staff competency and systems suitability, a considerable body of United Kingdom legislation governs the general trade on futures markets. The Financial Services Act 1986 requires, among other things, every person dealing with the futures-trading public to register with the Securities and Futures Association. This is a self-regulatory body created by the Act (enhanced by the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000) that seeks to assure the nancial viability of all Exchange members. LIFFE now also issues a weekly Commitments of Traders Report.
OPTIONS
Put and call option contracts. These contracts are also traded, based on the BM&F arabica futures contract expiring in the month after the delivery month of the option, also priced in United States dollars. There are seven trading positions: February, April, June, August and November, plus the next two positions in the following year. Buyers may decide to exercise options from the rst business day following the day a position has been initiated up to the last trading day before expiry as follows: Put option. The buyer (holder) of the option may decide to sell, and the seller (issuer) of the option must buy the corresponding position on the arabica futures contract. Call option. The buyer (holder) of the option may decide to buy, and the seller (issuer) must sell the corresponding position on the arabica futures contract. All transactions are at the strike price for which the option was taken and settlement is effected according to all the usual exchange regulations. Options are exercised only if they show a prot otherwise they are simply allowed to expire.
141
capital set by the exchanges clearing division and must post collateral to nance the clearing fund. They are also subject to limits in respect of the trading positions for which they accept liability. Commodity brokers and local traders are in turn bonded to the clearing members for all transactions they execute, from registration to nal settlement. There is no clearing house to take the role of counterpart in all transactions as is the case in New York and London.
142
FLOOR PROCEDURE
In traditional open outcry or oor-based trading, the initiation of a transaction takes place on the oor of the exchange. Exact oor procedures vary from market to market. Exchanges as LIFFE for London robusta (screen only) and ICE for New York arabica (screen only except for options) have moved trading to a screen-based environment and automated the entire process. In both oor and screen-based trading, there is usually some form of open auction during which buyers and sellers make their trades in public. Unlike the physical market, no privately arranged deals are allowed. The transaction is negotiated across the oor, providing all participants an opportunity to respond to the current bids and offers. The negotiation is concluded the moment a buyer and a seller agree with each other and the seller registers the contract as a sale to the clearing house. Thereafter, the two traders are responsible only to the clearing house. In this way, the clearing house is a party to every transaction made by both buyers and sellers. Automated or electronic trading is different, but maintains the transparency of open outcry trading in that all bids and offers can be viewed by all participants. The computer system matches equivalent bids and offers without human intervention. Once the orders are matched, the clearing procedure is exactly the same as the old open outcry system. Futures contracts are standardized in that all terms are given, except the exact date of delivery, the names of the seller and buyer, and the price. The market rules are legally enforceable contract terms and therefore cannot be substantially altered during the period of the contract. Every futures contract species the quantity, quality, and condition of the commodity upon delivery; the steps to be taken in the event of default in delivery; and the terms of nal payment.
actual coffee delivered, while acceptable under the futures contract, may not match the buyers specic quality needs.
OFFSETTING TRANSACTIONS
A trader who buys a futures contract and has no other position on the exchange is long. If this purchase is not eventually offset by an equivalent sale of futures then the buyer will have to take delivery of the actual commodity. Alternatively, a trader who sells a futures contract without an offsetting purchase of futures is said to be short. Traders who have taken either position in the market have two ways of liquidating it. The rst involves the actual delivery or receipt of goods. Most traders choose the second option, which is to cancel an obligation to buy or sell by carrying out a reverse operation, called an offsetting transaction. By buying a matching contract a futures trader in a short position will be released from the obligation to deliver. Similarly, a trader who is long can offset outstanding purchases by selling. Against actuals (AA). It is possible to liquidate futures positions in the spot market privately under a pre-arranged trade. This type of transaction, called an against actuals trade, avoids the complexities of making a physical delivery under a futures contract. However, such AA transactions must take place under the rules of the exchange that supervises the futures contract. Open interest. The total of the clearing houses long or short positions (which are always equal) outstanding at a given moment is called the open interest. At the end of each trading day, the clearing house assumes one side of all open contracts. If a trader has taken a long position, the clearing house takes the short position, and vice versa. The clearing house guarantees the performance of both sides of all open contracts to its members and each trader deals only with the clearing house after initiating a position. In effect, therefore, all obligations to receive or deliver commodities are undertaken with the clearing house and not with other traders.
DELIVERY
Most futures transactions do not result in physical delivery of the commodity. Depending on their strategy, futures traders usually make conscious decisions either to avoid delivery or to accomplish it. That is, they either make an offsetting transaction ahead of the delivery, thereby avoiding physical coffee being tendered to them; or they consciously force the exchange to deliver (tender) physical coffee by allowing the contract to fall due. Delivery must be completed between the rst and the last trading days of the delivery month, although the exact terms vary from one market to the other. While the futures contract can be used for delivery, its terms are not convenient for all parties. For example, the terms of delivery of futures contract provide the seller with the exclusive right to select the point of delivery. This situation can obviously create difculties for the buyer. In addition, the
FUTURES PRICES
Futures prices and spot prices. Futures markets provide a public forum to enable producers, consumers, dealers and speculators to exchange offers and bids until a price is reached which balances the days supply and demand. Remember that only a negligible proportion of the physical coffee trade actually moves through exchange markets. The futures price is intended to reect current and prospective supply and demand conditions whereas the spot price in the physical market refers to the price of a coffee for immediate delivery. In the futures market the spot price normally reects the nearest futures trading position.
143
Carries and inversions. When the quotation for the forward positions stands at a premium to the spot price, the market is said to display a carry (also called forwardation or contango). The price of each successive forward position rises the further away it is from the spot position. In order to provide adequate incentives for traders to carry stocks, the premiums for forward positions must cover at least part of the carrying costs of those who accept ownership. Therefore, when stocks become excessive, the futures market enables operators to enter the market to buy the commodity on a cash basis and to sell futures, thereby carrying it. The carry will eventually rise to a level where the premium covers the full cost of nancing, warehousing and insuring unused coffee stocks. This level of the forward premium is known as the full carry. The holders of surplus coffee are now covered for the full costs of holding these stocks. The size of the forward premium or discount between the various forward trading months quoted at any time reects the fundamentals of the coffee market. When coffee is in short supply, the market nearly always displays an inversion (backwardation), with the forward quotation standing at a discount to the cash price. This inversion encourages the holder of surplus stocks to supply them to the spot market and to earn the inversion by simultaneously purchasing comparable tonnages of forward futures at a discount to the spot price.
is of an acceptable quality can usually be delivered against a short position on the futures market as the buyer can choose the origin and where to make the physical delivery (or tender). This feature makes futures contracts particularly suitable as a hedge against physicals.
TYPES OF ORDERS
Fixed price order for the same day. This means that an Exchange member is asked to buy or sell a given number of lots (contracts) for a particular month at a set price, for instance, two lots of coffee for December at US$ 1.70/lb. The contract must be completed during the day on which the order is given. If possible, the broker will buy (sell) at a lower (higher) price but never at a higher (lower) price. This ensures that the client will get the desired price if a contract is made, but they run the risk of not having a contract made at all if the oor trader cannot execute the order on that day. Fixed price, open order is a similar order, except that the instructions stand for an indenite period of time until the order is satised or cancelled by the client. This type of order is popularly known as good till cancelled. Market order. This is an order that gives the broker more exibility, and allows him to make a contract for the best possible price available at the time. Different orders are often made, subject to certain conditions. For example, a broker may be instructed to make a contract if the price reaches a certain level. Orders that are conditional on specic terms set by the client can also be made. Examples of such orders are those to be carried out only at the opening or closing of the market or those to be carried out within a certain period of time. (Orders have to queue at the opening and closing of the market and are therefore not all lled at the same price, particularly when trading volume is high in an active market. If one stipulates a price then an order may not be executed if that price is not touched, or is exceeded.) Market orders and xed price orders for the same day are the most common, but orders are also made to suit the requirements of clients. Clients who follow exchange movements closely frequently revise their orders in response to changing market conditions. Those less involved in hourly market movements usually place open orders, or orders subject to certain conditions. For example, a stop-loss order which is triggered into action as soon as a predetermined price level is reached limits the clients losses relative to the level at which the order is executed. Placing more general conditions on the order gives the broker greater exibility to react to changes in the market and leaves the nal decision to them.
Positions
Open position. This is the number of contracts registered by the clearing house which are not offset by other contracts or tenders when the contracts become spot (the nearby contract month). For example, a coffee trader may have a
144
position with the clearing house of 30 purchase contracts and 40 sales contracts. Some of the purchases and sales may be for the same delivery month, but the trader may have labelled them as wait for instructions if those contracts represent separate hedging transactions for that trader. This means the trader will enter into additional futures deals to offset them once they unwind the physicals against which the original hedge was taken. In other words, the open position of that particular operator remains 70 lots until some of the contracts are offset or washed out. The clearing house reports only the total of all operator positions, rather than that of any one member, which is left to the broker to report. The CFTCs commitment of traders (COT) report breaks down the total open interest on the New York C contract by category of traders. Large traders are called reportable, while small traders are non-reportable. The COT report then further breaks down the open interest by commercial and non-commercial reportable traders. It is a very handy tool for exporters to get an idea of the long or short positions of the large speculative hedge funds.
Financing margins
Financing margin calls on open contracts can make the use of futures markets very expensive for producers and exporters, partly because variation margins are always paid in cash. This does not apply to trading deposits, which can be covered by securities such as bank guarantees and treasury bills. Any user of futures markets should be aware that unanticipated calls for variation margins can be costly in terms of demands on their cash ow and the interest forgone on cash deposited with the clearing house. Therefore, a user should carefully consider how margin calls will be nanced before entering into any commitments. See also chapter10. An (extreme) example: on 24 June 1994 the C contract closed at 125.50 cts/lb. Just two weeks later the market closed at 245.25 cts/lb owing to frost damage in Brazil. This translated into a variation margin of US$ 45,000 per lot so an exporter with a short of 10 lots against physical stocks would have had to pay US$ 450,000 to meet the margin call and within 24 hours at that. As a result of margin nancing problems the open interest at that time was halved within weeks. Of course, exporters would benet from the increased value of their physical stocks in a situation like this, but might not always nd it easy to convince any but the most experienced commodity nance banks of the validity of this argument. Merchants and brokers are often willing to help producers and exporters to overcome the problems that margin calls can create. In some cases, the broker will nance all the margin costs but in return the broker will expect a higher rate of commission or a discount on physical contracts. Brokers can be particularly useful in solving the additional problems connected with distant futures transactions. Often a high premium can be picked up for forward physicals, but there is no liquidity for such far dates in the futures markets. However, most if not all of todays forward business in physicals is conducted on a price to be xed basis, which has reduced the need to enter into far forward futures deals. For information on price to be xed, or PTBF, see chapter 9. Traders and others who pay their own margins are entitled to receive cash payments of all credit variation margins. Additionally, if they pay the trading deposit in cash, they are entitled to receive interest on that money. Trade houses play an important role in aiding producers, exporters and industry to overcome margin requirements. When a trade house enters into a transaction for physical coffee, either on a price to be xed basis or on an outright price basis, it is usually also the trade house that takes up the obligation and risk of margin nancing. This is of signicant benet to the coffee trade and plays an integral part in establishing long-term delivery contracts. Of course, the trade house itself must have strict nancial and third-party (counter-party) risk controls in place in order to avoid any excess margin calls in times of increased market volatility.
Margins
Trading deposits (margins). These are required upon initiation of a futures trade. Further deposits may be required daily to reect the changes in the price of the contracts, when the market moves against a traders position. If additional funds are required to restore the original margin (ranging from 5%-10% of the contracts nominal value) then variation margins must be paid in unless adequate security, for example treasury bills, had already been deposited when the account was established. Conversely, if the futures price move is favourable to the trader, the gains transferred into the account above the margin requirement level become immediately available to the trader. Clearing house members must maintain specic margins depending upon their net open position with the clearing house. Margins are also needed for members of the trading public who lodge their contracts with members of the exchange. Original margins are normally set at approximately 10% of the market value of a contract and variation margins must be paid in full upon demand. Margin money collected by the exchange member from the public must be deposited in segregated customers accounts. Note that the original margin requirements in this category are minimum gures and that exchange members may require additional security from their clients if they feel the minimum margin is not enough. Original and variation margins are adjusted from time to time for the following reasons: to reect increased or decreased market levels; to add security to volatile positions, particularly in months carrying no limit; and to discourage excessive concentration of trading positions in any one month. Investors should note that margin requirements can be changed without prior notice.
CHAPTER 9
HEDGING THE CONTEXT................................................................................................................................146 TRADING AT PRICE TO BE FIXED .....................................................................................................................149 OPTIONS...............................................................................................................................................................152 HEDGING..............................................................................................................................................................153 HOW TRADE HOUSES USE FUTURES..............................................................................................................154 COMMODITY SPECULATION ............................................................................................................................155 TECHNICAL ANALYSIS OF FUTURES MARKETS ............................................................................................158
146
RISKS
Coffee producers are a natural long in the coffee market. They always have coffee that is subject to price changes. The coffee producers own might be stocks of already harvested coffee, or coffee still on their trees. They also have future coffee production that will be subject to price swings in the market. They might not know the exact quantities of their production in the next or the following year, but experienced coffee producers have a good idea how much a farm will produce in any given crop year. Hence, the next or the following years production must be seen as part of the producers long position. Coffee roasters are a natural short in the market. As long as a roaster stays in business, he or she needs to buy coffee, hence they are short. Inventory and forward purchases might reduce the need to buy coffee nearby, but as business continues, they will roast what they have and will need to buy more at the market price. Price swings can greatly affect their business and while they have a good idea of their futures sales volume, they have no idea of the price they will pay for coffee, unless they hedge. Exporters and importers are true middlemen. They must buy coffee when the producer wants to sell and they must sell coffee when the roaster wants to buy. Exporters and importers can be naturally long or short, depending on whether they have more purchases or sales in their physical (green coffee) position.
147
were totally exposed to any price movements in the coffee market. Another type of pricing is coffee bought or sold on a differential basis. When buying or selling coffee on a differential basis, one is committing to deliver or take delivery of coffee, not at a xed price but at a difference to the futures market. Theoretically one can buy or sell at a difference to any published price in the coffee business (i.e. ICO Indicators), but almost all differential business is done against futures markets. More specically, it is normal that robusta coffee is bought or sold against the London LIFFE Contract and arabica coffee is bought or sold against the New York ICE C Contract. The reason differential contracts are mostly priced against future markets is that the future markets are liquid and prices can be xed anytime these markets are open for trading. Differentials link prices for widely differing types and qualities of green coffee with prices on the futures markets where standard qualities and quantities of coffee are traded. In recent years, increasing activity on the futures markets has translated into more and more severe price volatility, not always linked to changing fundamentals in the coffee market such as supply and demand. As a result, differentials for many individual origins now uctuate not only in response to domestic changes in, for example, quality or availability, but increasingly also because of (sometimes unexpected) movements on the futures markets that are caused by speculative inuences. Historically, it has been quite normal to buy Brazil mid grade arabica at ICE C with a differential of around minus 15 cts per pound FOB whereas Colombian UGQ (usual good quality) might for example trade at ICE C plus 15 cts per pound FOB. While some of the other Milds coffees from Central America and East Africa have tended to trade near equal to or basis with ICE C. It is also normal that the trading or delivery month used for the differential would be the month immediately following the shipment period. For example, June shipment arabicas would be sold as a differential to July ICE C. It is important to note that buying or selling on a differential basis does not eliminate price volatility risk. For example, in 2010 some Colombian coffees which had been trading at around ICE C plus 15 cts/lb, went up to ICE C plus 80 cts/lb. If one had sold Colombian coffee at ICE C plus 15 and were forced to cover the coffee at ICE C plus 80, there would have been a loss of 65 cts/lb on the differential, before the contract itself was even xed. This example is extreme, but it did happen and it will happen again with some quality of coffee. Despite the extreme example just shown, it is safe to say that price differentials are generally less volatile than futures prices. With differential or Price To Be Fixed (PTBF) Contracts, one can reduce the price risk by taking positions, either long or short and avail those positions to all the risk management tools available in the futures and options
markets. But remember, it is impossible to entirely eliminate all of the risk. Nevertheless, most large end-users tend to purchase on PTBF basis and anyone wishing to partake of their business will have to be conversant with trading in this way. More will be discussed about PTBF contracts later in this chapter.
148
Box 9.1
Note for the example above: Most countries in Latin America use bags of 69 kg (152 lb) although bags of 46 kg and 75 kg are also seen. Brazil and most countries in Asia and Africa use 60 kg bags. All ICO statistics are expressed in 60 kg bags equivalent though.
for as far forward as necessary to cover the sale of the roasted coffee. Thus, in covering their needs for green coffee in a general way by purchasing the various forward months on the exchange, the roaster is in a position to buy a specic growth and quantity of physical coffee as and when needed for roasting, to full their spread sale of roasted coffee. Upon purchasing the actual coffee they require, they then either sell out their position on the exchange or tender it as an AA (against actuals) through the exchange with the agreement of the dealer from whom they are purchasing the physicals. The dealer or importer who has entered into a forward sale of up to 12 monthly deliveries to a roaster can purchase the various trading months of the futures contract to protect their sale until they are able to buy the physical coffee to be delivered against the forward sale. Once physical coffee
is purchased, they sell back that part of their long position in futures on the exchange. As in the selling hedge, both parties have protected their price risk, regardless of market uctuations up or down.
149
5 lots (1,250 bags) of March 5 lots (1,250 bags) of May 5 lots (1,250 bags) of July 5 lots (1,250 bags) of September 4 lots (1,000 bags) of December
@ US$ 1.68/lb @ US$ 1.70/lb @ US$ 1.72/lb @ US$ 1.74/lb @ US$ 1.76/lb
than the sellers price for the same contract and the text that follows will show how this can happen. It is necessary to caution that the PTBF contract is a risk management tool. Like any tool, if it is used improperly, it can cause more damage than good. There are numerous examples of how parties enter into PTBF contracts without proper knowledge of how they work. Instead of managing risk, the parties can unknowingly increase their risk beyond their means. There are known examples of exporters xing PTBF contracts without actually having bought the physical green coffee pure speculation. Or, delaying xing until long after the physical green coffee was bought is just more of the same. Yet the fact remains, a well executed PTBF contract will limit price risk to changes in the price differential and does give the ability to x purchase or sale prices whenever future markets are open. However, to take advantage of this last attribute, buyers and sellers of PTBF contracts must have access to trading of coffee futures. Initiating a PTBF contract. A relevant delivery month of the futures market is chosen. Because the quality of the physicals (the green coffee) is worth more or less than the quality on which the futures contract is based, the price stipulation will read (for example) New York C December plus (or minus) 3 cts/lb, or London Robusta November plus (or minus) US$ 30/ton: the plus 3 or plus 30 is the differential. Differentials for Colombians are normally a premium to the C contract while natural Brazil arabica is normally a discount. Viet Nam grade 2 robustas are usually a discount to LIFFE while a good Uganda robusta is normally at a premium. The relevant month of the future market is usually the month traded nearest to the delivery month of the physical coffee. December delivery Colombians would normally trade against December C contract. The number of futures contracts used to x the price of the physical delivery is determined by taking the total quantity of the physical contract and dividing it by the size of each futures contract. If there is fraction of a futures contract involved, the total number of contracts will be rounded up or down. It is important that all these contract terms differential, futures month(s), number of futures contracts are specied at the time of the contract initiation. The contract constitutes a rm agreement to deliver and accept a quantity of physical coffee of a known quality and under established conditions. These conditions are based on the quotation for the specied delivery month of the futures market at the time of xing, plus or minus the agreed differential. The advantage to the buyer and seller is that each has secured a contract for physical coffee, but the price remains open. In other words, the buyer has now separated the operational decision to secure physical coffee (thereby avoiding
i.e. 24 lots (6,000 bags) at an average of 171.83 cts/lb or 1.17 cts/lb below the GBE selling price. With this activity the roaster has immediately hedged most of the price risk involved. They can now deal with the purchase of the physical coffee at their convenience by periodically buying physicals to roast and ship to their customer, while simultaneously selling the corresponding amount of futures. For example, on 1 February, they buy 1,250 bags of spot milds at US$ 1.70/lb, and simultaneously sell the ve lots of March C at US$ 1.70/lb. They apply their prot of 2 cts from the sale of the C to lower the cost of their physical purchase to US$ 1.68/lb. On 1 April, they buy 1,250 bags of spot milds at US$ 1.69/lb and sell the ve lots of May C at US$ 1.69/lb. They apply the 1-cent loss from the C sale to the cost of their physical purchase, resulting in a price of US$ 1.70/lb. And so on. The roaster continues to buy in the approved physicals of their choice as needed, whether 250 bags at a time or 1,250 bags at once, and sells out the equivalent futures. Their hedging objective is to maintain their average differential of 1.17 cts/lb or better on the purchase of their physical coffee compared to their position on the futures market. The example above also shows that large roasters often price green coffee down to two decimal prices which demonstrates the competitiveness of the mainstream coffee business.
150
problems of shortages) from the nancial decision to x the cost of that coffee, which they prefer to postpone. This arrangement provides exibility for both buyer and seller. The obligation to deliver and accept physicals now exists, but as the price remains open.
The next step in the PTBF contract is the establishment of the invoice price. This is commonly called Contract Price Fixation but as we have shown it is a misnomer as it merely establishes the invoice price for delivery of the physical goods. If the contract is sellers call, it is the sellers right to transfer the lots to the buyer, thereby xing the invoice price. If it is buyers call, it is the buyers right to transfer the futures to the seller to establish the invoice price. For purposes of this example, the PTBF contract is sellers call. On 18 November, which happens to be First Notice Day for NYKC December, the seller decides to x the invoice price. December futures are trading that day between 180.00 and 182.00. He asks his FCM to post an AA (Against Actuals) transfer of eight lots short December C to the buyers account at 181.50. By posting an AA within the range of the day, he is assured he will get that price and this is common practice for all Exchanges. Once the transfer is complete the lots move out of the sellers account at 181.50 and move into buyers account at 181.50, xing the invoice price of the PTBF contract at 181.50 less 6.00 cts/lb= 175.50 cts per pound. The seller will receive 175.50 cts/lb when he delivers the coffee but he must subtract the loss in his futures account of 181.50 less 169.50 = 12 cts/lbs. So his sale price is 175.50 less 12.00 = 163.50 cts/lb, the same as his xation of 20 September. The buyer must pay 175.50 cts/ lb when the coffee is delivered but he also lost in his future account. He bought at 189.50 and sold at 181.50 for a loss of 8.00 cts/lb. So he pays 175.50 cts/lb invoice price plus his futures loss of 8.00 cts/lb for total price of 183.50 cts/lb, the same as his xation of 20 October. The example above shows how the PTBF contract should work. The net sales price and the net buying price are different from the invoice price. There are variations to this. If, for example, the seller xes his sales price and makes the futures transfer to the buyer on the same day, the net sales price and the invoice price are the same. This also works for buyers call. If the buyer does his xation at the same time and same price he transfers lots to the seller, his net buying price is the same as the invoice price. However, the example demonstrates the ideal situation, that is to say it assumes that both parties (i) are well-versed in these kinds of transactions, and (ii) have unfettered and easy access to futures trading accounts, either directly or through intermediaries as banks, brokers and others. But this is not necessarily the case in all origin countries or for all exporters.
151
buying coffee without a home for it can be dangerous and many exporters (and their bankers) therefore like to see that such purchases have a potential home. After all, trading coffee requires substantial funds of which most exporters need to borrow at least the major part which requires bank approval of the trading operation (as discussed in chapter 10). But selling forward at a xed price, i.e. without already having the coffee, is equally dangerous. PTBF contracts on the other hand allow one to x the price at a later date, while at the same time providing an assured home for the coffee that will be bought. As explained earlier, the differential risk remains and it is up to each individual operator to determine how much of that risk is acceptable. In its most basic form, PTBF sales contracts should be xed when the physical coffee is purchased, possibly each time a container load has been reached. In this case larger contracts must allow for multiple xations. How much coffee to accumulate before xing is an individual decision, but selling PTBF is a risk management tool and not intended for speculation. Having both the coffee and a xed sales contract means all market risk (price and basis) is eliminated. How to x? The seller has to rely on the buyer to do so on his behalf. When the seller calls for the xation the buyer sells the appropriate amount of futures in the manner that should have been agreed earlier in the contract. For example, at the market opening, midpoint or close. Again, an individual arrangement. The seller has to believe that the buyer will not take advantage of what is after all a conict of interest situation, meaning the parties must know each other and trust each other. This role is played by most trade houses and leading importers who do such trades within the differential. Their objective is, for example, to buy PTBF at plus 5 and sell PTBF at plus 15 and it is they, as intermediaries, who now undertake the entire process outlined in the previous section. Trading PTBF is also risky for the intermediary buyer. What if the exporter/shipper asks for xation without actually owning the coffee? By so doing that exporter becomes fully exposed to market volatility. Should things go badly wrong and the exporter defaults then the importer who arranged the xation will be in serious difculty. He or she would have to cover the entire loss on the futures he or she sold and would still have to full his or her own sales contract for the underlying physical coffee. Some buyers today therefore only allow xing from a certain date, particularly for extended forward contracts.
the buyers costs of arranging the operation. In other words, a PTBF sale is like being a passenger in an elevator without knowing whether it is going up or down, with xing being the oor buttons. If you do not push the button you may end up somewhere unexpected. To avoid falling into the xation trap (an inability to decide), set internal stops to ensure that xing takes place automatically when a certain time has elapsed or a price, up or down, is reached. Fixing orders can be given basis GTC (good till cancelled). But, as explained previously, in a very volatile and fast moving market situation the gap trading phenomenon may make the timely execution of such GTC orders difcult if not impossible. The producer or exporter who has both the coffee and a PTBF sale (i.e. they have the differential but no base price), must appreciate that although they have eliminated the differential risk, a decision not to x leaves them totally exposed to the market or price risk. As already said, this is not very different from straightforward speculation. It is a well known fact that some shipment contracts allow xation to be delayed, at exporters request, sometimes even until after the goods have already been shipped. As has been stressed repeatedly already, PTBF is a trading mechanism that of course can also be used speculatively and it is up to each individual operator to determine what level of risk is acceptable. NB: When xed price sales are not feasible, one simple alternative is to sell PTBF and to x immediately, thereby xing both the futures price and the differential that, together, make up the nal sales price. Concerns such as are we xing too early? or what if the market goes up? can be dealt with by also buying a call option, accepting that the cost of this comes out of the sales price for the physicals.
MARGINS
For sellers to lock in their sale price on a PTBF contract they need to sell futures for their account. For the buyer to lock in his buy price they need to buy futures for his account. The futures account for both parties stays open until the transfer of lots is made offsetting the futures transaction (longs less shorts = 0). While the futures accounts stay open, there are daily margin calls that must be paid. If the market goes up the shorts pay margin. If the market goes down, the longs pay margin. On a PTBF contract, the margins will be recovered when the futures transactions are squared, i.e. when the actual coffee is delivered and invoiced. Remember, however, there can be a long time between xation of price and the actual delivery of the coffee. The parties must have enough cash to nance these margin calls until coffee delivery. Most commodity bankers will follow a margin call and grant additional nancing but only if they are condent that the PTBF contract is properly executed and backed up with real coffee and a real commitment to sell.
152
OPTIONS
PUT AND CALL OPTIONS
Another approach to risk management has also demonstrated a growing usefulness: the purchase or sale of options on futures as price insurance. Obviously this insurance is purchased at some cost, but the strategy enables one to limit potential losses in the futures market without having to pay margin calls whilst still being able to benet from upside price potential. The purchase of options is particularly attractive to small producers who may wish to establish a price oor (above the cost of production) without committing capital to a margin account. Options alone or in combination with futures offer greater exibility for risk managers in the design of their hedging strategies. There are two options around which all option strategies are based: the call and the put. There are also two actions: you can buy or sell options. Buying a call option confers the right, but not the obligation, to buy a futures contract at an agreed price between the date of concluding the contract and the time the option contract expires. If the buyer decides to exercise the option then the seller of the option is obliged to deliver the futures. Buying a put option confers the right, but not the obligation, to sell a futures contract at an agreed price: the seller of the option is obliged to accept the futures if the option is exercised. Of course the option holder will only exercise the option if it makes nancial sense, that is, if the option shows a prot. When one buys an option, the risk is limited to the price premium one pays for the option. If one sells or writes an option, i.e. one that was not previously bought, the risk is potentially unlimited. The main thing to remember about options is that when you purchase an option, you pay a premium and your potential for loss is limited to the amount of that premium. The option can be exercised at any time, no matter how far the market moves, so there is potential for unlimited return less the amount of the premium. Also, you are not required to deposit any margin when purchasing options. Options work rather like insurance; the payment of a premium provides a level of protection against loss. When you sell (or write) options, the reverse is true. The option writer is paid a premium (limited return) and must perform no matter how far the market moves (unlimited risk). Option writers must maintain margin accounts. Because of the potentially unlimited risk, only experienced hedgers and traders should consider selling or writing options.
PRICING OPTIONS
There are two prices quoted for options, the strike price and the premium. The strike price is the price quoted in an option; the price at which the option can be exercised. The premium, or cost of the option, is determined by the option Greeks these are letters from the Greek alphabet used to identify different risks: Option Greek Delta. The amount by which the price of an option changes if the price of the underlying coffee future changes by one. Option Greek Gamma. The sensitivity of an options delta to a change in the price of the underlying entity. In other words, gamma measures the rate of change of delta in relation to the change in the price of the underlying entity. Option Greek Theta. The amount by which the price of an option changes when the time remaining for the expiry date of the option falls by one day. As the time remaining for the expiry date of the option reduces, the price of the option falls. Thus option Greek Theta is always negative. Option Greek Vega. The implied volatility of an underlying stock is one of the most inuential factors in determining the price of an option. Option Greek Vega measures the amount by which the price of the option changes when the implied volatility of the underlying future changes by one. Basically the price for an option is based on three factors: the intrinsic value, the time to expiration (or time value), and the implied volatility. The cost of an option is related to how close the strike price is to the market price ruling at the time the option contract is concluded. As with futures there is an active trade in option contracts. To summarize: The strike price is the price quoted in an option; the price at which the option can be exercised. The intrinsic value of an option is the strike price as a differential to where the market is trading. If this intrinsic value is negative then it is considered to be zero. The time value of the option is also a factor in determining the premium. A longer time until expiration of the option increases the likelihood that the option will be exercised.
153
Out of the money options will not usually be exercised. Out of the money puts are often sold by roasters, as they are always short. Out of the money calls can be sold by producers as they are always long but it should be done cautiously risking a small percentage of an annual crop. Some large producers, for example in Brazil, are comfortable selling call options in spite of the innite risk. This is because producers are always long coffee. They have coffee stocks and future production on the trees. If a future market is above their cost of production, they often sell a small percentage of their production by selling call options. If the call options are struck, they can put their coffee against the struck options pocketing the strike price and the premium. It is the same as selling forward futures but at a premium to the futures market. The downside for the producer is that he must leave the call option percentage of his crop unsold, unhedged and not xed in price until the call options expire. If a producer were to sell everything and the call options outstanding were struck, the producer would be net short, at least until the next crop arrives. Implied volatility, which is based on a mathematical formula, evaluates the premium on the expected price volatility of the underlying futures contract. It is important to realize that the price of an option can change because of time and volatility factors even when the underlying futures price does not move. Option strategies are extremely diverse, and almost any strategy can be developed using options (obviously at a cost and a risk). A variety of names have been attributed to various strategies strangles, condor, calendar spread, buttery, and many others. The scope of option trading is vast and an explanation of all the strategies would take a book in itself. Call options are of little direct interest to producers and exporters. Selling or writing options is only for experienced hedgers and involves potentially unlimited risk. Both therefore fall outside the scope of this publication but more information can be obtained from both IntercontinentalExchange (ICE) in New York and NYSE Liffe in London.
cts/lb put for a premium of 2.5 cts/lb. A put is an option to be short, so there is no intrinsic value in being short at 150 cts/lb in a 154 cts/lb market. Furthermore, the right to be short at 150 cts/lb costs 2.5 cts/lb, so the value of the option is really 147.50 cts/lb. In this scenario, the option holder is guaranteed a price oor at 147.50 cts/lb if the market goes down, but they will still be able to take advantage of any upswing in prices if the market rises.
HEDGING
HEDGING THE ADVANTAGES
Hedging offers denite advantages to commodity producers and costs comparatively little. Hedging with futures allows a producer to lock in a price that reects the producers business goals (a prot). The producer should therefore determine the actual price available in the futures market that will support the cost of production plus a prot. If prices fall, the producer still achieves something near the originally intended pricing goals. If prices rise, the producer foregoes a larger prot margin. The loss of this potential (speculative) extra prot is balanced by the protection afforded against dramatic and damaging declines in the market. There are also other advantages in addition to this price-insurance aspect of hedging. First, hedging offers a exible pricing mechanism. Anyone who feels they have made the wrong decision on the exchange can have an alternative order executed easily and immediately. Second, hedging operations involve only small initial outlays of money. If the price of futures goes up, the producer who has sold futures may be asked to pay additional margins; but the price of their physicals will also have risen. Third, because a futures contract provides considerable price protection, banks and other nancial institutions are more likely to nance producers, exporters and traders who hedge their crops and positions than those who do not. Finally, commodity trade banks and risk solution providers put together different risk mitigation instruments that are tailored to a clients requirements. For example, a put option can be graduated to extend over the usual marketing season by spreading equal portions over two or three futures trading positions, at different strike prices if so wished. Each individual portion can then be exercised individually. Alternatively, a solution provider may simply guarantee a minimum price. For payment of a premium, they undertake to make good any shortfall between the insured price (the minimum price the producer wishes to secure) and the price ruling for the stated futures trading positions (New York or London), either at a given date or based on the average price over a number of trading days. In doing this the producer buys a oor, a guaranteed price minus the cost of the premium.
154
SWAP AGREEMENTS
The straight meaning of the term swap is to barter or exchange and this is very much to the point. For example, producers can swap price risk by giving up the benets from future price rises in exchange for a guaranteed minimum price. Such a swap agreement could even cover more than one crop year, with tonnages and settlement dates set for each quarter. In other words, they are written or tailored to address different, individual requirements. Swaps are often mentioned in commodity market reports but, generally speaking, are of limited interest to exporters. In the case of coffee swaps, the price xing necessary to nalize them would rely on the relevant futures market without actually having to trade futures. This avoids the problems that using futures can cause like having to raise margin calls, particularly when distant positions are to be dealt with. In addition, futures trading or hedging does not always address individual price insurance requirements. Swap agreements are negotiated directly between those wishing to acquire them and solution providers who are prepared to offer or write them. Because such agreements are concluded separately from formal futures trading they are usually known as over-the-counter (OTC) products. Swap agreements are extensively used in nancial and energy markets, but less so in agricultural commodity markets. Yet, demand for them could be on the increase, also because nancial institutions are increasingly risk averse. This is pertinent because one difculty faced by both parties to a swap agreement is performance risk, especially for longer-dated agreements. Different from futures, there is no central clearing mechanism for agricultural swap agreements and, as a result, default is possible. This then limits their attraction as a price insurance vehicle. To address this, in February 2009 ICE in New York introduced a clearing facility for agricultural swap agreements initially for sugar, coffee and cocoa. To quote ICE literature in this respect: 1. Cleared swaps are OTC agreements that are eligible to be cleared by ICE Clear U.S. (the Clearing House), but which are not executed on ICE Futures U.S. (the Exchange), either electronically or on the trading oor. A cleared swap contract is created when the parties to an off-Exchange, OTC transaction agree to extinguish their OTC contracts and replace it with a cleared swap contract. This will provide the same efciencies and benets that centralized clearing offers traders of contracts listed for trading on the Exchange including credit risk intermediation and the ability to offset different positions initiated with different counter parties. 2. This process is accomplished by the submission of each side of an OTC transaction to the Exchange and the acceptance of each side by the Clearing Members
of each party to the swap. Cleared swap contracts will offer eligible OTC market participants in these products the ability to clear transactions through ICE Clear U.S. In addition, Clearing Members will be able to hold the cleared swaps and the margin deposited with respect to them in the same account as they hold position and margin deposited with respect to futures traded on the Exchange. In brief therefore, execution of an OTC product that is turned into a cleared swap contract becomes guaranteed by ICE Clear U.S., just as is the case with Exchange traded futures contracts. It seems logical this should enhance their suitability to be considered as price and credit risk limitation mechanisms. In 2009, NYSE Liffe in London introduced cash-settled futures and options on its Bclear service for cocoa, robusta coffee and white sugar.
155
ARBITRAGE AN EXAMPLE
The carry cost for the NYKC September to December is based upon the following costs: Financing (cost of money); Insurance; Storage; Weight discounts (0.5% after the rst two months of storage, 0.125% for each month stored after that); Age discounts (0.5 cts or 50 points for the rst 150 days, after that 25 points per month for the rst year, 50 points per month for the second year, 75 points per month for the third year, and 100 points per month for coffee over three years). The costs for a simple August shipment of cash market coffee on cash and carry basis, September through December, are all of the above, except for any quality discounts. Depending upon the type of coffee and its actual arrival date, there might be no weight discount. One can take delivery of fresh coffee in September and deliver it on in December without a discount. It is thus possible to arbitrage the cash market cash and carry, which is approximately 2.5 cts/lb, with the futures market cash and carry of approximately 4 cts/lb based upon the average age of the certicates. In this example, a trader can pick up 1.5 cts for every pound of coffee carried from September to December. In August buy fresh coffee at September less 1 ct/lb; Simultaneously sell the same coffee at December less 1 ct/lb; September/December is trading at 4 cts: the cash and carry for the futures market; Effectively the trader bought fresh coffee September delivery at a 4 cts discount to the price they sold December; It costs 2.5 cts/lb to carry the coffee from September to December in the cash market (storage, interest, and insurance only) leaving the remaining 1.5 cts/lb as prot.
positions, that is, make them look better than they really are. Another sign of a good trader is the ability to take a loss. Traders cannot be right all the time. They only need to be right 60% of the time to be protable. The ability to take losses and move on is an essential element in trading, applicable to exporters as well.
COMMODITY SPECULATION
Commodity speculation is the purchase and sale of a commodity in the expectation that the reversal of the purchase or sale will yield a prot as a result of a change in the market value of the commodity. There is a certain amount of pure speculation in commodity futures, although its magnitude is difcult to gauge. Throughout the 1970s, high levels of ination and exchange rate uncertainty were associated with a greater degree of nominal price volatility for primary commodities. This in turn gave a tremendous boost to futures speculation, sometimes referred to as the other side of the exchange. The participation of speculators in the futures market contributes to that markets liquidity, essential for avoiding undue price distortions that can be caused by laying on or lifting hedges. However, excessive speculation can lead to wider price uctuations markets become overdone on the upside and on the downside (prices move to greater extremes than expected) until the excess of either the long or short positions is nally unwound. By virtue of an individual or rms expectations and willingness to take risks, speculators aim to make an uncertain prot from their operations in the market. Speculators may form their price expectations on the basis of the futures prices, the spot price, both spot and futures prices, or perhaps on the basis of the price spread alone, and take positions reecting their expectations in the markets. Certain features of futures exchanges attract speculation. These include the standardization of the futures contract, the relatively low costs of transactions and the comparatively low initial funding required (leverage).
TRADER SPECULATION
When traders say they are fully hedged, it is usually a sign that they have a bad position. In order to cover costs as an importer or trader, one simply must speculate. This speculation is not always outright long or short, but most of the time it is. Traders do, however, play quality and time differentials, and these are a different type of speculation. A good trader is disciplined. Operations are always accounted for as what they are. A good trader will never use a hedge lot to offset a bad speculative trade. Nor will a good trader mix quality arbitrage with spread trading. Keeping the book well dened sounds easy but it is the downfall of many traders that they try to dress up their
156
speculation involves deliberately taking a risk on price movements, up or down, in the hope of obtaining a prot. One of the principles of speculation involves the opportunity for gain that the investor achieves by agreeing to accept some of the risk passed off by the hedger. In other words, the hedger gives up some opportunity in exchange for reduced risk. The speculator acquires opportunity in exchange for taking on risk. Buyers and sellers of coffee who aim to minimize their price risks in the physical market assume opposite positions, or risks, in the futures market. At any moment there will be a number of buying and a number of selling hedge operations. However, it is unlikely that demand for hedges against buying risks will exactly balance demand for hedges against selling risks. The resulting surplus of buying and selling risks that has not been covered by the usual hedgers is taken up by speculators. To absorb the vast amounts of futures entering the coffee exchanges, numerous speculators willing to buy one or two lots are required. Likewise, considerable purchasing pressure occurs when traders or roasters hedge to cover their future needs. Prices would increase unless speculators were willing to step in as sellers. If producers who wish to hedge could always nd counterparts who also wished to do so, there would be no need for speculators. However, this situation is unlikely to occur regularly, partly because the periods in which producers carry out hedging operations normally do not coincide with the periods in which consumers try to hedge. The speculator provides the link between these two different periods and interests. Nevertheless, large speculative positions can push the market either way and producers/ exporters should monitor developments closely since their objective is to lock in protable prices rather than partake of speculative activities.
prices will return to their previous levels. Thus, locals can liquidate their contracts at a prot, although the prot may be quite small. Because the locals receive a benecial commission rate they can repeat this operation several times a day. Commodity and hedge funds provide the greatest source of speculative activity and their nancial power can greatly inuence price movements. Funds operate on a variety of mathematical trigger mechanisms such as moving averages, trends and momentum indicators. Over the years they have become more sophisticated in the complexity of the systems they use and some now incorporate an element of in-depth market research within their strategies. The fund managers generally have a large portfolio of markets to trade and will therefore view coffee as only one facet in their total risk management. A hedge fund could lose in coffee and make prot in other non-related markets (such as bonds or currencies) to return an overall prot. Professional coffee traders do not have the luxury of this diversication or the nancial backing that the funds control, and thus must be aware of the fund positions in the market in order to manage their own coffee books accordingly. Hedge funds normally take longer-term market positions. Speculative funds that trade in coffee have been around for years but in recent years, their volume has grown. Also in the last few years there has been the entry of index funds into the coffee and other markets. These funds are large and have affected the dynamics of the market. While speculative funds move in and out of the market and can create short term changes in supply and demand, index funds enter a market as part of a long-term investment strategy for coffee within a basket of other commodities. They never liquidate their positions and usually only rebalance their positions once a year. This means that once a year, the funds managers may decide to add or subtract a certain quantity of coffee futures in order to balance the fund and adjust the percentage of coffee contracts relative to the other commodities in the index fund. Hence, these funds maintain certain long positions by rolling forward futures contracts. In essence these funds create an additional demand for coffee and this investment demand does inuence prices. In the United States the Commitments of Traders Report documents activities of both speculative funds and index funds. Exporters as well as all industry hedgers should monitor the activity of these funds and accept that real supply and demand for coffee can be affected in both the short and long term. When these funds buy or sell in unison, they create much larger volumes in future trading than the coffee industry can offset and in so doing can move prices. Websites of interest include www.cftc.gov of the U.S. Commodity Futures Trading Commission, www. commitmentoftraders.com, and www.newedge, which offer
TYPES OF SPECULATORS
In any futures market the extent of speculative involvement can be high. The coffee markets are no exception. The New York market attracts the most attention, and longer-term speculative involvement can reach as much as 30% of the open interest. Day traders can account for an extremely large percentage of the daily volume. Day traders are so-called because they always square their position at the end of each trading day they never carry any long or short position overnight. The day traders in coffee are referred to as locals as many operate for themselves. They take short-term positions (for minutes or hours) based on the order ow they see in the market and are well positioned to take advantage of price aberrations caused by other market participants. They will be prepared, for example, to deal at a few points under the market level if they judge that the distortion will be short-lived and that
157
charts and spreadsheets showing the weekly commitments of traders of index funds. High velocity traders have been around for a while in the equity markets but are relatively new to the commodity industry. It has been suggested that 60 % of volume today (end 2011) on the New York Stock Exchange is created by high velocity traders. These funds use proprietary algorithms to electronically buy and sell large quantities of futures, in microseconds, sometimes nanoseconds, in order to make a return on investment. The problem for the coffee industry is that these high velocity traders can also move prices but, unlike speculative funds and index funds, they do not maintain large positions for any length of time. This makes it virtually impossible to see what they are doing to the market. Normally high volume is good for liquidity, but these funds trade so fast and aggressively that the only feature they add to the market is higher volatility. Industry hedgers need to be aware of this.... Professional coffee traders do not have the luxury of this diversication or the nancial backing that the funds control, and thus must be aware of the fund positions in the market in order to manage their own coffee books accordingly. Hedge funds normally take longer-term market positions. Coffee trade houses as well as large non-coffee related speculators take strategic positions in the futures market. Such positions could be to anticipate a directional move or to take advantage of price differences between different market positions for instance a discounted switch structure in the same market or an arbitrage between the New York arabica and London robusta markets. Non-professional speculators operate in commodity markets that are likely to experience sudden changes in price and hence offer a greater prot potential. They tend to be guided by information and comments from secondhand sources such as bulletins published by brokers, daily newspapers and, more recently, information on the Internet. This category of speculators normally involves small investors, many of who rely on the advice of commission houses.
be carried out ruthlessly. Stop-loss instructions are given the moment a trading position is taken, or sometimes even before, so the taking of any position automatically puts them in place. It is also quite customary to employ a trailing stop. For example, if the initial position taken is good and the market trend continues as expected, the stop can be moved accordingly and so trail the trend, thereby locking in increasing amounts of prot. There are several aspects worth considering: rst, the position to be adopted (long or short) as suggested by the market analysis, and the size of the transaction; second, the nancial resources available for the operation; third, the target prot expressed in points; fourth, the loss, also expressed in points, that the speculator is prepared to absorb if the market moves in an unexpected direction; and nally, the changes in the level of the stop-loss orders that will ensure a paper prot. It is important for speculators to decide the maximum loss they are willing to bear before taking a position. Once a position begins to lose points, there is a strong temptation to justify the losses and continue to invest, rather than to accept that the original decision was a mistake. Likewise, speculators should dene the expected prot (in points) and only liquidate their position when the target has been reached. It is just as common to attempt to take the prots before the positions have reached the maximum level as it is to continue to sustain losses even after prices have sunk below reasonable levels. Straddling. This is another method of trading on the commodity markets. It involves simultaneously purchasing one delivery period and selling another delivery period. This can be undertaken in a variety of ways: The transactions can be carried out with two futures positions on the same exchange. This is sometimes referred to as a spread or switch. The two futures positions can be taken on two different exchanges. Positions can be taken on two separate exchanges of related merchandises, for example, arabica in New York and robusta in London. This is also generally called arbitrage. Straddle operations have the advantage of offering lower risks to operators although, not surprisingly, at lower prots. In a sense, a straddle is a form of hedge. Exchanges usually encourage straddling by requiring less deposit than for a single purchase or sale. When operators undertake straddles they are long and short of futures contracts for different months or maturities, usually in the same commodity market. Operators buy one months contract in a product and sell another months contract in the same product or, in some cases, a related product. The purpose of taking two futures positions is to take advantage of a change in price relationships, also called
SPECULATIVE STRATEGIES
Stop-loss order. Just as margin calls protect the clearing house from overexposure to the risk of nancial losses, stoploss orders offer protection to the speculator. Although they are willing to bear some losses from an adverse movement of prices, speculators cannot risk seeing a large proportion of the value of their assets wiped out. Speculators give a stop-loss order in order to moderate their losses. This order is triggered once the price of the stop is reached, at which time the broker seeks to trade at the price given in the order or as close as possible if the market permits the order to be executed. Because the objective of the stoploss order is to get out of a position, such orders have to
158
the spread. The intention is to earn a prot from expected uctuations in the differential between the prices of the two months. If during the interval prices rise, the prot made from the long position will be compensated by the loss on the short position, and vice versa if prices decline. What really matters in a straddle operation, therefore, is the price spread between periods. It is of no consequence in which direction the market moves. If, for example, the price spread between the July and December position seems greater than usual, with the forward position at a premium, it makes sense to buy the near position and sell the forward position. This assumes that the differential will be reduced at a later date, in which case the trader will gain. The spread will narrow if one of the following situations arises: The near position rises while the forward position remains unchanged; The near position rises higher than the forward position; The near position remains unchanged while the forward position falls; The near position falls less than the forward position.
knowledgeable individuals in the trade. However, if charting specialists supply the analysis within a usable period of time, technical analysis can provide useful additional information, particularly for medium-term forecasts. The main tools of technical analysis are past price patterns that are shown in various forms of charts or graphs. The changes in the volume of open positions (i.e. the number of futures or option contracts outstanding on a given commodity) and the total volume of operations in the market are also examined. Charts often use a moving average to record and interpret price trends. In most charts, an average moves with time as the newest price information is incorporated into the average and the oldest price is discarded. For example, a simple three-day moving average of the daily closing price of a commodity changes as follows: on Wednesday, the sum of closing prices on Monday, Tuesday and Wednesday is divided by three; on Thursday, the sum of closing prices for Tuesday, Wednesday and Thursday is divided by three; and so on. Analysts can average prices over a period of hours, days, months or even years, depending on their needs. The value of the moving average always lags behind the current market price. When prices are rising in bull markets, the moving average will fall below the current price. However, the moving average in a bear market will be higher than the current price. When the trend in prices is reversed, the moving average and the current price cross each other. While advocates of charting accept that fundamental factors are the prime determinants of commodity prices, they point out that these factors cannot predict prices. They argue that the graphs incorporate all the fundamental factors that shape prices and also reect the subjective market reaction to these factors. The alternative argument holds that although the price curve and other elements of the graph are real and objective, the interpretation is necessarily subjective. Thus, the same graph can give contradictory signals to different readers. In reality there is likely to be substantial overlap between the fundamental approach and the charting approach. It is common for operators to determine the market trend by studying fundamental factors and to then select the right time to enter the market by referring to the charts. Similarly, chart advocates also study other factors beyond the limit of technical analysis. They may consider the number of marketing days left before a position expires, the amounts notied for delivery on the exchange, the situation of the longs, and the possibility of accepting deliveries on the exchange without adverse results. Many companies specialize in producing charts for various commodities and most have their own websites where it is possible to access charting information such as price history, volumes, open interest and technical studies. In addition, all of the Internet coffee information sites, such as www. theice.com, www.euronext.com, www.coffeenetwork.com,
STRADDLING AN EXAMPLE
A speculator sells New York C December 2012 (KCZ12) and buys March 2013 (KCH13) at 360 points premium March. In abbreviated fashion, they are buying March/December at 360. As December gets closer to the rst notice day and the level of certied stocks is rather high, the market will move out to a full carry estimated by the trade to be 425 points. Our speculator now buys December/March (buys KCZ12 and sells KCH13) at 425, locking in a 65-point prot per lot. At US$ 3.75 per point, the prot is US$ 243.75 per lot. See chapter 8 for more on carries and inversions.
159
www.tradingcharts.com and www.futures.tradingcharts.com have charting ability and analysis. Most of these websites carry not only price, but also volume and open interest, all of which are discussed in other parts of this chapter.
weight of interest in the market and thus of the likelihood of a price rise. A gradual increase in volume during a price upturn could suggest a continuation of the trend. The rise in volume could also result from an anticipation of higher prices in the future, but in fact it may indicate that long or short positions are leaving the market because of a fall in prices. In general, the volume of trade is a good guide to the breadth of the outside support given to a price movement on the market.
OPEN INTEREST
The total of a clearing houses outstanding long or short positions is called the open interest. If a broker who is long in a futures contract sells their position to another trader who wants to be long on futures, the open interest does not change. However, if they sell their position to a trader who is short and is therefore closing out their position, the open interest is reduced. The total size of the open interest indicates the degree of current liquidity on a given market. When considering the open interest, it is important to distinguish between the types of operators entering the exchange. The term strong hands describes those who are able to make margin payments over an extended period of time whereas weak hands are operators who cannot easily meet the substantial variation margins demanded whenever prices move signicantly. In general, strong hands are comparatively resilient to price changes. One type of strong hand is an operator who uses the exchange for hedging purposes. They may want to liquidate a position, not as a result of price movements but because of an opportunity to carry out an operation in physicals. Once the hedging operation has begun they will not be affected by price changes. Another type of strong hand is the speculator who holds large amounts of capital. Such operators can withstand a setback on the market without being forced to sell their positions because they have the nancial resources to cover the margins. Small non-professional speculators who generally operate through a broker are considered weak hands because they are more vulnerable to changes in price. Looking at prices in isolation can give some indication of whether buyers or sellers are dominating the market, but it will not distinguish new purchases from hedging operations. If new purchases are the predominant activity, it is possible to forecast the continuance of the markets upward trend as these purchases signify that new operators are entering the market in the hope that the market will rise. However, if these purchases are largely for hedging purposes to cover short positions, the market is considered weak because once these short positions are covered the buying pressure will subside.
VOLUME OF OPERATIONS
The volume of operations, or turnover, is equivalent to the number of trades in all futures contracts for a particular commodity on a given day. Technical analysts regard volume and open interest as indicators of the number of people or
160
CHARTING
The two most commonly used charts in technical analysis are the bar chart, and the point and gure chart. There are many technical studies that can be added to these charts such as trend lines, moving averages and stochastics (probabilities). Bar charts use a vertical bar to record the high and low range of a price for each market day. The length of the bar indicates the range between the highest and lowest quotations. The vertical line is crossed by a small horizontal line at the closing price level. Therefore, in just one line per day it is possible to show the closing price as well as the minimum and maximum quotations registered for that day. A record is made daily, forming a pattern that may cover several weeks, months or even years. Some chartists insist that a new bar chart should be started as soon as a new futures position is opened. However, it is common to continue the original chart with the new position following the position that has just expired. As the new position may have discounts or premiums in relation to the old position, the chart should be clearly marked to indicate where the new position starts and where the old position ends. Continuous plotting can be done in various ways. One way is to show the rst position until it expires and then to continue with the new rst position. Another way is to show only one position until it expires and then to continue with the same month of the following year. The drawback of the second method is that once a position expires, e.g. in December 2004, and the next position taken is December 2005, prices may have changed signicantly and the chart may therefore show either a large increase or decrease. Trend lines on charts reveal signicant trend changes but obscure subtle changes in supply and demand factors. The trend line is best suited for recording long-term changes in indices or other nancial and economic data. The market registers three types of trends: a bullish trend when prices are rising, a bearish trend when prices are falling, and a steady or lateral trend when prices are neither rising nor falling. A steady trend sustained for a comparatively long period is known as a congestion area. The larger this area, the greater the possibility that the market will begin a denite trend, either bullish or bearish. The simplest patterns to recognize are those formed by the three types of trend lines. These are: the support line, which is drawn to connect the bottom points of a price move; the resistance line, which is drawn across the peaks of a trend; and the channel, which is the area between the support and resistance lines that contains a sustained price move. Point and gure charts differ from the bar charts in two important respects. First, they ignore the passage of time. Unlike a bar chart, where lines are equidistant to mark
distinct time periods, each column of the point and gure chart can represent any length of time. Second, the volume of trade is unimportant as it is thought merely to reect price action and to contain no predictive importance. The measurement of change in price direction alone determines the pattern of the chart. The assumptions underlying the point and gure chart primarily concern the price of a commodity. It is assumed that the price, at any given time, is the commoditys correct valuation up to the instant the contract is closed. This price is the consensus of all buyers and sellers in the world and is the result of all the forces governing the laws of supply and demand. Moreover, no other information needs to be included in this chart because the price is assumed to reect all the essential information on the commodity. Real time and delayed charts can be obtained from various sources, e.g. www.theice.com, www.tradingcharts.com and www.coffeenetwork.com just to mention a few. Daily and monthly coffee price futures charts are offered free of charge by www.futures.tradingcharts.com and are easy to access. See examples on the following page.
161
Figure 9.1 Example of a daily coffee futures price chart (December 2011); Coffee ICE, 4 November 2011
Chart courtesy of TradingCharts.com, Inc., www.futures.tradingcharts.com. MACD: Moving average convergence/divergence. RSI: Relative strength index.
Figure 9.2 Example of a monthly coffee futures price chart; Coffee ICE, 31 October 2011
CHAPTER 10
TYPES OF RISK ...................................................................................................................................................164 IN-HOUSE DISCIPLINE ......................................................................................................................................165 RISK AND CREDIT ..............................................................................................................................................167 TRANSACTION SPECIFIC RISKS......................................................................................................................171 CONDITIONALITIES FOR CREDITS .................................................................................................................171 RISK MANAGEMENT AND CREDIT ..................................................................................................................174 TRADE CREDITS IN PRODUCING COUNTRIES .............................................................................................176 TRADE CREDIT AND ASSOCIATED RISKS .....................................................................................................177 LETTERS OF CREDIT..........................................................................................................................................179 ALL-IN COLLATERAL MANAGEMENT ..............................................................................................................181 TRADE CREDIT AND RISK SMALLHOLDERS ...............................................................................................182
164
165
automatically cancel each other out, leaving just the price settlement. First and second hand. Coffee sold directly from origin (from producing countries) is rst hand there were no intermediate holders. If the foreign buyer then re-offers that same coffee for sale, the market will know it as second hand. But international traders also offer certain coffees for sale independently from origin: in so doing they are going short in the expectation of buying in later at a prot. To achieve such sales they may actually compete with origin by quoting lower prices. Market reports then refer to second hand offers or simply the second hand. Traders can buy and sell matching contracts many times, causing a single shipment to pass through a number of hands before reaching the enduser: a roaster. Such interlinked contracts are known as string contracts. Volume of physicals versus futures and second hand. The volume of physicals is limited by how much coffee is available, but there is no such constraint on the trade in futures or second hand coffee. The huge volume of trade on the futures markets contributes strongly to the volatility of physicals. Futures can cause prices for physicals to move abruptly, sometimes for no immediately obvious reasons. In addition, the volume of trade in some individual coffees regularly exceeds actual production because many second hand or string contracts are either offset (washed out), or are executed through the repeated receiving and passing on of a single set of shipping documents. Producing countries are but a single factor in the daily trade and price movements. The differential. This is the difference, plus or minus, between the price for a given trading position on the futures markets of New York (ICE, trading arabicas) or London (LIFFE, trading robustas), and a particular physical (green) coffee. Briey, the differential takes into account (i) differences between that coffee and the standard quality on which the futures market is based, (ii) the physical availability of that coffee (plentiful or tight), and (iii) the terms and conditions on which it is offered for sale. By combining the ex dock New York or London futures price and the differential, one usually obtains the FOB (free on board) price for the green coffee in question. This enables the market to simply quote, for example, Quality X from Origin Y for October shipment at New York December plus 5 (cts/lb). Traders and importers know the cost of shipping coffee from each origin to Europe, the United States, Japan or wherever, and so can easily recalculate plus 5 into a price landed nal destination. Price to be xed PTBF. Parties may agree to sell physical coffee at a differential (plus or minus) to the price, at an as yet undetermined point in the future, of a specic delivery month on the futures market, for example, New York December plus 5 (cts/lb) or LIFFE July minus 25 (US$/ton). The contract will state when and by whom the nal price will be xed: if by the seller then it is sellers call, if by the buyer then it is buyers call. See chapter 9, Hedging and other operations.
IN-HOUSE DISCIPLINE
AVOID OVER-TRADING
People often associate risk management with price protection, but there are many different types of risk and risk management. Exporters and traders can buy protection against many forms of risk, obviously at a cost. But there are other risks inherent to the trade in coffee that only they can manage. The serious exporters long-term strategic objective is to trade steadily and protably, and to seek regularity of business; not to chase potential windfall situations involving speculative moves with the potential to put the day-to-day business at risk. Solid seller-client relationships are founded on condence and regularity of trade. Regular purchases maintain producer links; regular offers and sales help to convince clients to place at least part of their business with our company. Purely speculative trading has no place in such a strategy, but many an exporter has unwittingly fallen foul of speculative markets. When prices are low, the potential risk of a sudden rise is often high. Conversely, when prices are very high then the potential risk of a sudden fall increases accordingly. This conventional wisdom is reinforced by an old but accurate saying in the coffee trade: When prices are down coffee is never cheap enough, yet when prices are on the up then coffee is never too expensive. In other words, when high prices fall the herd does not buy, yet when low prices rise people buy all the way up and beyond. This often causes price movements to be exaggerated. A speculative long position or stock of physicals, held in expectation of a price rise, needs to be nanced. If one allows such speculation to take up most available working capital and the market turns it falls the competition will be able to buy and offer at the lower levels. The choice is then sell at a loss, or lose business and perhaps lose buyers as well by letting the competition in. The only consolation, perhaps, is that in theory the loss potential of long position holders is limited to their investment. Those with short positions potentially face an open-ended risk as no one knows how high a market may go. Selling physicals short in anticipation of price falls usually does not require any direct investment (as opposed to selling on the futures markets where margin payments have to be put up), but the risk is entirely open ended. Should an unusual event occur, the market may rise beyond all reasonable expectation. In extreme cases it may become impossible to cover the shorts at any price. In a situation where uncovered sales are showing a serious loss one becomes reluctant to make further sales, even though buyers are now prepared to pay more. This again opens the door to the competition to grab both business and clients. Worse, with higher sales prices more can be bid in the local market, thus squeezing the short seller from both sides.
166
Quick turnaround? A trader who decides early enough that the market is denitely turning against them can quickly cover their shorts and go long. Or, in the reverse instance, sell stocks and in addition go short. But only if they can nance all these transactions. If they cannot, if they have overextended themselves by over-trading, then the party is over, at least for that season. Price protection, hedging, options and other risk management tools may be available in theory. But such instruments will not necessarily save those who overextend themselves and do not manage their physical or position risk.
overall long or short position. At rst glance it seems safe to assume that by imposing a volume limit, a maximum permitted volume or tonnage long or short, one avoids traders going overboard and possibly putting the rm at risk. In reality this is not the case. As mentioned above, long or short is the net difference between stocks and sales, but only if both are of the same quality. Therefore, a number of different position reports are required for the full picture to be seen: Tonnage and cost of stocks (including forward purchases) that cannot be offset against existing sales; Tonnage and estimated cost/value of uncovered (open) sales, i.e. sales for which coffee still has to be purchased; Tonnage and cost of stocks (including forward purchases) awaiting allocation against existing contracts, cost of shipments under execution, and total outstanding invoices (receivables).
FINANCIAL LIMIT
A volume limit is meant to avoid excessive risk. However, at a price of US$ 2,000/ton a 500-ton limit long or short represents US$ 1 million, but at US$ 4,000/ton the same 500 tons represents US$ 2 million. So, at US$ 2,000/ton, US$ 1 million is needed to pay for covering a short position of 500 tons; double that amount if the price goes to US$ 4,000/ton. Conversely, at US$ 2,000/ton a long position of 500 tons costs US$ 1 million to nance but US$ 2 million at US$ 4,000/ ton. Clearly, because exporters deal in physical coffee that must be nanced, the volume limit by itself is not enough. A nancial limit is needed as well to ensure the operation, the book, can be nanced. However, the volume limit is equally important. A price change of US$ 200/ton against the exporter means a loss of US$ 100,000 for 500 tons; double that if lower prices had caused their nancial limit to permit a position of 1,000 tons. To take a real-life example, in December 1999 the ICO other milds indicator stood at 124 cts/lb ex dock: by the end of December 2001 the same indicator had fallen below 60 cts/lb and by the end of February 2011 it stood at no less than 296 cts/lb. Both types of limit are needed therefore to protect against drastic price changes. The nancial limit kicks in when prices rise, and the tonnage limit kicks in when prices fall. The objective is to avoid exceeding ones nancing capacity or incurring unsustainable trading losses. By adding the third position category (pending shipments and outstanding invoices) the daily position report will show both the funds applied by category, and the rms total trading exposure. Unfullled contracts, shipments in progress and outstanding invoices should be subdivided to show the total exposure per individual client. The combination of nancial and volume limits is also important for those trading on the futures markets where nancial leverage or gearing may enable traders to turn, for
VOLUME LIMIT
Exporters deal with physical coffee. Unless they have easy access to a suitable futures market, they will always be directly exposed to physical or position risk. And that risk has to be managed by limiting or mitigating it. Any operation, large or small, should establish its exact position at least at the close of business every day. The daily position report will show total stocks, forward purchases, and sales awaiting execution, concluding with an
167
example, a margin investment of US$ 100,000 into a US$ 500,000 coffee position (if they are permitted to trade at the ratio of 5 to 1). In this situation a 1% position prot means a 5% prot on the actual investment; conversely, a 1% position loss means dropping 5% on the investment. (In futures the volume limit would be expressed as a number of contracts.)
Historically, in many coffee producing countries the local currency was more likely to depreciate (exporters ought to prot on stocks bought in local currency) than appreciate (exporters are likely to lose because they will receive less local currency on export). But there have also been numerous examples, especially since the monetary crisis of 2008 and in subsequent years, where local currency movements in coffee producing countries have gone against exporters with their local currency appreciating against the United States dollar. Today, macro shifts in the wealth of nations are changing old currency and interest rate trends and international ows of capital are affecting relative currency rates and therefore the price of coffee. As a result, the supply and demand value of coffee does not always translate into the actual price that is paid. Individual companies and bankers approach currency risk in different ways, but the guiding principle should always be that commodity export and currency speculation do not go together. Exposure to potential currency risk needs to be reported and monitored in exactly the same way as purely coffee trade related risk. In many coffee producing countries currency risk can be hedged, but the complexity of currency markets and trading is beyond the scope of this guide.
CURRENCY RISK
The vast bulk of the world trade in coffee is expressed in United States dollars and coffee is known as a dollar commodity. In many producing countries the local currency is not linked to the United States dollar. Exporters therefore face the risk that the dollar exchange rate will move adversely in relation to their own local currency, affecting both export revenues and internal coffee prices. Usually, the currency risk can be limited by borrowing in the currency of sale, provided local regulations permit such foreign currency advances to be offset against the export proceeds. If advances are immediately converted into local currency that in turn is immediately used to pay for spot goods whose shipment will be invoiced in United States dollars, then the cost of goods is expressed in dollars and not local currency. If the cost of goods represents 80% of the sales value then one could say that exposure to currency risk is limited. But in many countries local banks are not always able to make substantial advances in United States dollars.
168
All the other risks associated with commerce also feature, but a lender can insist on many types of risk insurance against these, ranging from insurance against loss or theft to the hedging of unsold stocks or open positions. But what of the risk that a borrower does not perform that is, someone becomes unable to refund a loan, misrepresents the companys nancial or trading position, misstates the quality of goods nanced, or engages in pure speculation without the knowledge of their nancial backers? What if the suppliers or buyers a borrower depends on default against that borrower? For example, unfavourable price movements cause a supplier to renege on sales contracts, thereby rendering the borrower unable to full their own contractual obligations, through no fault of their own. Each type of trade has its peculiarities and coffee is no exception. An added factor is that a coffees value depends not only on supply and demand, but also on quality. Noone without at least some ability to assess and value quality would be expected to make a success of the physical or green coffee business as a trader, processor, exporter, importer or roaster. But assessing that quality, and therefore a coffees commercial value, is not an exact science. Market analysis is not exact either, with many price movements difcult to anticipate or explain. These uncertainties complicate the business of raising loan nance because banks dislike uncertainty in any shape or form. The risks that attach to monies lent for investment in visible physical assets (i.e. land and buildings) are very different from the risks on monies lent to nance trade in coffee. Commodity trade nance is a highly specialized activity, usually undertaken not by the average retail bank but rather by corporate lending or commodity trade nance banks. The term trade nance is self-explanatory: these banks nance trade, not speculation. Prospective borrowers should understand this from the very beginning. Therefore, before any credit limit or credit line can be agreed, the types of transactions that are to be nanced have to be agreed, to avoid each and every deal having to be individually approved. Usually, but not always, the borrower can then trade freely within the limits that have been agreed and needs to apply for additional approval only if, for example, they wish to increase their credit line. Different risks are attached to nancing the trade in coffee. Some of these could be termed trend risks, in that changing trends in the coffee world can have negative effects on those who borrow trade nance. Other more transaction specic risks attach to the type of coffee trade engaged in. This discussion is limited to the nancing of coffee that has been harvested, i.e. off the tree. On tree or production nancing criteria would also be based on many of the considerations described below, but on many others as well. To discuss those is beyond the scope of this guide.
TREND RISKS
Market risk. World demand for coffee is relatively stable with limited growth potential only. Increasing price transparency means there is not that much scope for expansion of trade protability other than through competition, consolidation, or expansion or diversication of activities. Diversication usually means getting involved with different or with a larger number of commercial counterparts, which can increase performance risk. Margin (protability) risk. The concentration of roaster buying power coupled with the large roasters need for increased transparency in green coffee pricing puts pressure on margins, again potentially affecting trade protability. Meanwhile costs rise because of changing buying patterns and a greater need for risk management (hedging). Having fewer and larger partners also means having larger performance risks. Margins are also likely to be affected as price transparency increases, certainly for the more standardized qualities of coffee. Volatility risk. For many it is becoming more and more difcult to trade back-to-back (make matching purchases and sales simultaneously), and more and more position taking is required. While the general price risk can be hedged (the market as a whole rises or falls), it is impossible to hedge the differential risk or basis risk (the value of the coffee bought or sold rises or falls compared to the underlying futures market). Modern communications provide instant price news worldwide, bringing increased price volatility. Country risk. This is a risk rating applied to all international lending, based on the lenders assessment of the political, social and economic climate in the individual country where the funds are to be employed. Country risk often weighs quite heavily in the total risk assessment attaching to the nancing of trade with coffee producing countries. The more unstable a country or its economy, the poorer the country risk rating will be. Such ratings will also include an assessment of the probability that a country may suddenly introduce or reintroduce exchange controls or other limitations on nancial transactions. Poor country ratings increase the cost of borrowing and may result in banks demanding loan guarantees from sources independent of the country concerned. If banks feel the country risk is unacceptably high they will buy country or credit insurance, the cost of which adds to the lending rate to be charged. What is not always appreciated is that country risk also applies to the buyers country of residence. If an exporter trades with bank-supplied nance then the bank will usually reserve the right to pre-approve the exporters buyers and sometimes even the individual transactions. If a sale is to be made to an unusual destination, country risk will play a role in that approval process. It is easier for an international bank than for an individual exporter to make such judgement calls.
169
Their functions and margins may also be under threat from e-commerce or Internet trading at the retail end. This may not necessarily compete with them, but may limit their ability to maintain adequate margins. If trading margins are inadequate then turnover has to rise or other activities have to be added again factors that can have an impact on risk. If this involves them in more position taking, then their hedging requirements will increase accordingly, accompanied by exposure to margin calls. Smaller operators mostly lack the margin cushion that large houses with direct or indirect exchange membership enjoy. Large operators with direct access to the exchanges usually pay margin calls only over their net open futures position (long minus short). But for many in the industry, margin calls can present particularly unwelcome and difcult swings in liquidity. Perhaps this is one more reason why so much trading has been on a PTBF (price to be xed) basis in recent years. Until such contracts have to be xed, hedging is not necessarily required because the price remains open. See chapter 9 for more on trading PTBF. Unless a transaction is back-to-back, banks usually require outright purchases at xed prices to be hedged immediately, but of course such open hedges (sales or purchases) on the futures exchanges bring exposure to margin calls that need to be nanced. Importers dealing with the strongly growing specialty market need to carry their customers: they must hold green coffee in stock for them, they must stock a range of different green coffees, and more often than not they must provide their clients with credit terms ranging from 30 to perhaps as much as 120 days after the actual delivery takes place. Risk attaches to all of these activities. See below for more on this. Exporters wishing to sell to the specialty market often also have to guarantee a certain minimum availability over a certain period of time. This automatically translates into price risk on the unsold stock holdings that need to be maintained as a result. Exporters wishing to secure a permanent foothold in the specialty market may have to make crop nance advances to certain producers in order to safeguard supplies from future crops, i.e. more risk again. Admittedly longestablished and well-known exporters may be able to offset such transactions against forward sales to importers or roasters who also want to secure longer term supplies of that particular coffee, but not always. Clearly, long-term industry trends require careful monitoring. Most change has an effect one way or another on a risk situation somewhere, sometime. To these points one must add the risks attaching to the actual type of trade to be nanced. These are the operational risks associated with the coffee operations that are to be conducted, and the transaction risks that attach to each and every individual transaction.
170
of buying on the basis of cash against documents on rst presentation, some of the majors buy green coffee on the basis of payment on arrival, thus shifting a substantial nancing burden on to their suppliers. Whilst accepting that major roasters present little or no credit risk, this shift still obliges potential suppliers to nd the additional funding this necessitates. Major operators will nd this easier than will their smaller counterparts, some of who may be unable to compete because they cannot raise the extended nance. Smaller roasters and coffee shops (particularly specialty) are largely serviced by importers/traders and wholesalers. The provision of credit has always been an accepted way of doing business in this segment. This is particularly so in the specialty business where most small roasters expect to receive 30 or more days of credit from the date of delivery. However, when the economic climate worsens, as in 2008, so does the availability of nance. Even medium sized roasters started looking to their suppliers for additional credit by way of later payment, also because their own clients were seeking extended credit terms. Again, larger trade houses may deal with this more easily with this kind of situation, for example by channeling their specialty and smaller client business through separate companies that can afford to take out cover for all their clients. For smaller operators, selling on (extended) credit is not really advisable without credit insurance, whereby the insurance company insures the risk that a buyer will not pay for goods received. This is central to the functioning of almost every retail supply chain, including coffee. Without access to adequate credit insurance many smaller importers/ wholesalers may be unable to trade freely. If credit insurers experience underwriting losses then the likely reaction is to reduce exposure at times by cancelling individual buyer coverage altogether. If that happens an importer may have to retreat from certain types of business and/or clients, irrespective of the availability of bank nance. It is important to note here that credit insurers do not reduce or cancel individual client limits without reason. General reductions may be linked to a deteriorating economic climate in the sector concerned whereas individual reductions may be because of information received or obtained, for example from annual accounts lodged by privately held companies with chambers of commerce or similar institutions.
FACTORING
Providing extended credit of course constrains ones liquidity, i.e. funds that are tied up in credit to buyers cannot be used for new trading. It is important to note here that credit insurance does not improve ones liquidity the insurance only comes into play if a buyer defaults. Factoring is one way around the liquidity problems associated with extending credit. It is the selling at a discount of a companys receivables (outstanding invoices) to a third party, the factor, who advances most (but not all) of the expected proceeds immediately, and pays the balance once the buyer
171
in question has settled the amount due. This is at a cost, but the availability of the released funds for new business, i.e. the improved liquidity that is generated, probably offsets most if not all.
their assessment of the degree of risk presented by each borrower or type of operation plays a role in determining the credit line (the amount of nance to be provided), and what conditions and costs will apply. As well as setting a limit on the amount of nance to be provided, banks will also stipulate under what circumstances and for which purposes funds may be drawn. For example, funds meant for trading coffee may not be used to nance other operations. As a rule, international banks will only nance the trade in coffee in foreign currency (in most cases in United States dollars), and under an agreed set of pre-conditions, including limits on a borrowers total exposure to open and other risks, and a predetermined programme of actual transactions. The exact credit structure will depend to a large extent on an individual borrowers solvency, balance sheet and general standing. As a general rule smaller operators are likely to be subject to more stringent controls than substantial and well-known companies. Banks will also clearly distinguish between, and assess separately, the price (value) risks and the physical (goods) risks inherent in each lending operation. Trade or commodity banks provide short-term credit to nance transactions from the purchase of stocks through to the collection of export or sales proceeds. Usually this means the credit is self-liquidating funds lent for the purchase of a particular tonnage of coffee must be reimbursed when the proceeds are collected. Put differently, credit buys stocks that turn into receivables (invoices on buyers, usually accompanied by documents of title such as shipping documents) that generate incoming funds, which automatically offset the original credit.
TRANSACTION RISKS
It is not always appreciated that lenders and borrowers have the same interest: that the transactions for which the funds are used come to a fruitful and protable conclusion. Many of the average lenders preconditions are no more onerous than those any sensible owner or manager of an operation would apply in-house.
SECURITY STRUCTURE
To safeguard its funds and the underlying transaction ow the lender will establish a security structure. The elements can be summarized as follows. Exporter. Assignment of accounts, mortgages on xed assets, pledges of goods. Assignment of contracts, receivables, insurances. Business experience, track record. Fixed price contracts, risk management or hedging. Monitoring of trading book, independent audit of accounts. Price risk during and after transaction. Agreed transaction structure, hedging tools, in-built margin call nancing. Contract reliability. Pre-approved buyers only; agreed transaction structure; xed price or agreed hedging arrangement. (Who decides when and how price xing takes place? For example, is it the trader or someone else? Are there specic time limits? For example, x no later than so many days after date of contract, or so many days ahead of shipment.)
172
Table 10.1 Operational risks Category International multi-country traders or trade houses Strengths Long-term supply contracts provide buying power and opportunities to add value by offering services. Global sourcing means being able to hedge some or much risk in-house while country risk is mitigated. Usually strong management and nancial strength/backing Local expertise. Can invest upstream in processing and even production. Can add value by tailoring quality for niche markets. Local expertise. Can add value by adding services and servicing niche markets. Specialized products can mean higher margins. Weaknesses Global trade requires complex organization. Multi-location risk centres. Just-in-time commitments may translate into need to carry high stocks. Dependency on large roasters. Must be in the market at all times. Country risk if stability becomes problematic. Supply risk if crops are poor or fail. Often higher nancing costs and competition from international trade houses. New exporter faces all these and also lacks track record and client base. Can face reducing client base because of concentrations of buying power. Services often include holding stocks and providing credit. Supply, quality and price risks on specialized products higher.
Exporters
Importers
Table 10.2 Transaction risks Category of risk Speculative risk and volatility Transaction risks The deal is not fully hedged or not hedged at all. Prices for physicals affected by speculation on futures markets. Differentials move against us. Increasing visibility of prices brings more volatility. Supplier or buyer reneges on contract, for example because prices have moved sharply up or down. Inferior quality or weight is supplied. Coffee is rejected. Non-adherence to contract terms. Exporter presents inaccurate or invalid shipping documents. Documents are delayed or lost. One of the parties is declared insolvent. Potential remedies Strict hedging rules and controls over open positions. Strong management. Knowledgeable staff/brokers/agents. Pre-approved credit line for margin calls. Deal only with well-established reputable parties on approved list. Possibly provide pre-nance. Establish independent quality and weight controls. Strong monitoring and administrative skills. Standardize documentation and documentary processes. Facilitate access to electronic documentation systems. Limit total exposure to any one client or supplier. Monitor changes in behaviour that may point to difculties ahead, for example gradual slowing down of payments. Match currency of purchase, borrowing and sale. Strictly control open positions. Use pre-nance expressed in United States dollars. Use forward cover.
Currency risk
Currencies of purchase and sale are different. Currency rates move against us.
173
Physical stocks. Stored in eligible (approved) warehouses. Properly marked, stored separately and identiably. Commingling with other goods not permitted. Stocks as security. Pledge agreement with title to the goods, i.e. warehouse warrants. (Note that depending on local law, warehouse receipts are not always documents of title in the legal sense and may need a court order to enforce rights.) Take ownership of the goods. Note that this does not protect the lender where export licenses are required, or where local law may require attached collateral to be auctioned locally sometimes within just 14 days after the default is conrmed. How to ensure no other lender, creditor or authority may have prior assignment over the goods? For example, if the national revenue authoritys claims take precedence the goods may remain blocked for long periods. Stock values. Daily verication of market value versus credit outstanding, based on futures exchange values where goods are quoted, or valuation basis to be agreed. Top-up clause in lending agreement in case collateral value becomes inadequate. Monitoring of processing cycles and turnover speed. Collateral management agreement (CMA). External legal opinion on the CMA itself, the duciary transfer of goods and the power of attorney to sell the goods. Due diligence on transport, shipping, warehousing, inspection and collateral management companies. (Due diligence is the thorough analysis of operations, standing, strengths and weaknesses, protability and credit worthiness.) Performance insurance including cover against negligence and fraud by collateral manager. What pre-emptive rights, if any, do warehousemen and collateral managers have over goods under their control? Do their storage and management charges take precedence? Export. Goods must comply with industry, government and contract specications. In case of default, does a bank require any special licence to trade or export the goods? What will be the cost of export taxes, shipment and insurance? When does risk move from performance risk to payment risk? (Meaning at what stage does the lender get possession of actual negotiable shipping documents?) Are funds freely transferable in and out of the country? It is no good collecting local currency against an outstanding amount in foreign currency if that local currency is not convertible or transferable. Buyer. Exposure to price risk and volatility (affects both exporter and importer). Due diligence; pre-approved buyers only. Limit total exposure to any one buyer. Buyer must accept that lender may execute contract in case of exporter default.
All levies, fees and taxes are paid up to date. Legal opinion conrms the rights of the lender and the right to execute these without needing a court order. The borrowers entitlement to enter into the lending agreement is evidenced by, for example, a directors or shareholders resolution. Statements are available showing there are no outstanding or pending claims from tax or other authorities or institutions that could impinge upon the free and unconditional execution by the lender of its rights, or the free and unencumbered movement of the goods. Grading, bagging, inspection and quality certicates are available. The goods are and will be stored separately under the full control and responsibility of an approved collateral manager. Suitable commercial all risks insurance cover is in place, covering storage, in-country transit and loading onboard ship. Suitable political risk insurance cover is in place, covering seizure, conscation, appropriation, exporter default due to export restrictions, riots, looting, war, contract frustration, and so on. Cash deposit or collateral deposit of X%. Usually, the lending agreement will take effect only if: The goods are covered by xed sales contract(s), pledged to the lender. All rights under the sales contract(s) are assigned to the lender with the acknowledgement of the buyer, authorizing the lender to execute the contract in case of default by the borrower. The export proceeds (receivables) under the contract(s) are pledged to the lender. The borrowers export account (escrow account) and other assets with the bank are also pledged to the lender. (An escrow account is an account under a third partys custody or control.) All insurance policies are assigned to the lender with acknowledgement that the lender is the loss payee or beneciary. A collateral management agreement with an eligible and approved collateral manager is in place. The coffee (stock in trade) is pledged to the lender. Weekly stock statements are issued by eligible (approved) warehousing companies under collateral management agreements, or countersigned by an independent collateral manager conrming that the quantity and quality are equivalent to or higher than required for tender against the pledged sales contract(s). All relevant forwarding and shipping documents, issued by eligible (approved) transport, warehousing and shipping companies, are assigned to the lender. The transaction structure and control over the goods is such that there are no obvious gaps in the transfer of title documents.
SPECIFIC CONDITIONALITIES
All or some of the following preconditions, the conditions precedent, must be met before any lending agreement will be considered. The borrower has obtained all necessary authorizations to export.
174
of commodities and markets, usually because at least some of the book was hidden from both top management and the banks. Loss-making deals were kept secret and were rolled over until the loss became too high to manage. But there have also been instances where rogue traders declared insolvency while keeping protable transactions hidden. Most banks will therefore regularly audit the borrowers procedures and administration, including retrospectively checking adherence to position limits and contract disclosure. This may be done as often as once a month. Banks also watch for gradual changes in client behaviour. They will also control as much as possible the use of loan nance, for example by making payment direct to authorized suppliers and by using collateral managers. See later in this chapter for a review of collateral management. In some producing countries local commercial banks have had bad experiences with lending to agriculture and commodity trading. Admittedly this has sometimes been due to government interference. Nevertheless, it has caused some local banks to cease such lending altogether, and others are now extra careful because soft commodity nancing is dangerous and requires intimate knowledge of the trade. The degree to which a bank follows the borrowers operation will vary from case to case. It is not unusual for a bank to price or quantify its risk on a particular borrower on a daily basis. It is important to understand that unsold stocks will be valued at the purchase price or at market value, whichever is the lower. Stocks held against forward contracts that are to be shipped at some later stage, may also be valued on the same basis because they do not constitute receivables. This is because if shipment is subsequently frustrated then it is likely that neither the exporter nor the bank will be able to realize the sales value of the original contract and the goods may have to be disposed of at the then-ruling market price. Cumbersome as all this may seem, the bank is a direct partner in the risk the business entails and as such is entitled to all relevant information. As with buyers, so too with banks: the early and frank disclosure of unexpected events usually leads to solutions being found. Good relationships and optimal support in banking are based on openness. For example, if a bank rules out a particular buyer perhaps the exporter should be grateful rather than annoyed, as the real message being conveyed is watch out.
MONITORING
Monitoring of a borrowers entire operation is vital to avoid the chance that certain transactions are kept hidden an audit trail needs to be established. Even so, it can still be difcult for a bank to determine whether a client is entirely truthful with them, for example when it comes to forward transactions. Other than the exchange of contracts, a forward PTBF sale or purchase for completion six months ahead need not immediately generate visible action or disclosure, and could therefore be kept secret. Differential volatility has also proved to be a risk factor in itself. Unless a deal is back-to-back (the differential on both the purchase and the sale has been xed), the companys position contains an unknown price risk. This is another reason why banks dislike nancing unsold stocks. Similarly, it is not always easy for banks to determine whether someone is speculating. The world has seen spectacular collapses of loss-making speculative operations in a number
175
quite restrictive (specications, timing and nancial requirements). Using futures does not always t the bill for traders or their banks, or simply might not be possible. As a result, more and more off market risk solutions are being created by the banks themselves, tailored to the individual clients requirements. Such individual packages can include facilities for the automatic nancing of margin calls, for example, when an exporter sells PTBF buyers call to an importer or roaster on the banks approved list and wants to hedge (sell futures) to protect their base price. For larger deals and more important clients the main commodity banks often create risk solution packages inhouse. They do not necessarily offset these against the futures markets, but rather do so independently over the counter, sometimes even in-house. This may also be done at the request of the importer or roaster rather than the exporter. This can be important for exporters who otherwise may be unable to trade directly with large roasters who insist on buying PTBF buyers call. The golden rule is that the more the bank is involved in a transaction, for example if it is nancing both the exporter and the receiver, the easier it will be to have access to tailored credit or risk management packages. But banks will never provide such facilities for transactions with unapproved buyers. Should there be a default the banks loss could be double. Obviously all of this comes at a cost, but at the same time it enables exporters at origin to compete on a more equal footing with the international trade. Once they can hedge their price risk, they will also be able to sell directly to roasters who habitually purchase buyers call. The audit trail must always be clear and dependable. Much depends therefore on the quality of the control systems that are in place, their ability to prevent fraud and whether or not the fraud risk is insurable.
the nancing of coffee trading became more risky and less attractive, i.e. less bankable. Add to this some fairly spectacular defaults caused by sudden price changes, over-trading, over-pricing and quality problems, and it is no surprise that many banks consider such business to be long on risks and short on margins. As a result the number of banks willing to lend to commodity producers and traders has been decreasing rather than increasing. But those that remain are more commodityfocused, they see new opportunities and have the expertise to gather the necessary information. Therefore, they have better insight into the actual business. Often such banks nance the entire chain, from roaster or importer back to the exporter, especially where the buyer actively supports the borrowers application. Other initiatives aim to make risk management tools available to individual growers and smallholder groups as an integral part of producer credit. Electronic warehouse receipts will likely play a signicant role in all this eventually. In general, though, modern coffee trade nancing solutions are increasingly coming from specialized foreign banks rather than from banks in coffee producing countries.
176
The receipt is issued by an approved entity (public warehouseman, collateral manager). The goods are identiable, records are maintained, and no commingling is permitted. No superior rights (liens) are held over the goods by the issuer (the warehouseman). The receipt can be transferred by endorsement or assignment (it is negotiable), or it is issued in favour of the lender. The receipt can be used to pledge or sell the underlying goods. Insurance cover against loss or unauthorized release of the underlying goods is adequate. No third party can have superior rights over the underlying goods. Local legislation enables the benecial holder to enforce their rights over the underlying goods, that is, the debt the goods represent can be executed ahead of any claims that others (for example revenue authorities or warehousemen) may have.
177
Fixing the action to determine the futures price that, combined with the differential, will become the contract price for the physical coffee. PTBF sellers call futures price to be called or xed by the seller. PTBF buyers call futures price to be called or xed by the buyer. Price risk or market risk the risk that the coffee price generally moves against us. Basis risk or differential risk the risk that the differential moves against us. Collateral underlying security for advances, for example stocks.
Pre-shipment nance
Pre-shipment nance is usually obtained when the ready goods are lodged for shipment (as pre-shipment nance) or when shipment has been made and the documents become available (as negotiation of documents). The term negotiation of documents is often misunderstood the bank merely makes an advance of all or part of the invoice value against receipt of the shipping documents, which it then presents to the buyer for payment. If the buyer does not pay, the bank has automatic recourse to the exporter because although it negotiated the documents, it did not take over the non-performance risk, that is, the risk that the buyer would not pay. Letters of credit (see later in this chapter) are an option, but not all buyers are willing to establish them.
Pre-nancing
Processors and exporters engage in pre-nancing to secure future supplies of particular coffees. Bank support for such deals depends very much on the track record of the parties concerned, and whether the buyer has a guaranteed sale for that coffee. It is difcult enough to obtain nance for unsold stocks, let alone for promised stocks. This is one of the strengths of the trade houses that engage in long-term supply contracts with large roasters. They usually have a guaranteed outlet for their coffee with little performance risk and they are able to raise funds internationally, often at lower rates than those available in the producing country itself. But the individual exporter who deals with importers and smaller roasters will usually nd that this type of buyer is not interested in providing any kind of nance; they may even be looking for credit themselves.
PHYSICAL RISK
When funds are advanced against stock in trade, the goods so nanced are usually pledged to the lender as guarantee of repayment: they become the security or collateral. Banks do this by taking out a general lien over stocks and collectables (outstanding invoices) through which benecial ownership rests with the bank until all outstanding advances have been refunded in full. In long-established relationships banks may be satised with this. They may leave the management and physical control of the goods to the borrower, especially if general
178
international guarantees are in place, for example from a trade houses parent company. But for smaller operators, and certainly those in new or relatively recent relationships, the banks will want to be satised that checks and balances are in place. These checks could include having the goods stored by public warehousing companies that issue warrants or warehouse receipts in the banks name or hand warrants to the bank endorsed in blank which permits the bank to freely transfer or assume title. The banks lien will extend to the proceeds of any insurance claim that may arise, since all the goods must be insured with an agreed insurer, on conditions acceptable to the bank. Even so, banks may still demand additional security guarantees
NB: Usually (but not always) differentials tend to be lower when futures prices are high, and higher when futures are low. A differential of plus 10 on arabica when the C contract is at 100 cts/lb may change to even money in the producing country when the C for example goes to 150 cts/lb. This is favourable for exporters who need to buy physicals against a PTBF sale because when they x the purchase the physicals will only cost even money. A differential of minus 30 on robusta when LIFFE is at US$ 1,700/ton may perhaps change to even money in the producing country when London goes to US$ 1,500/ton. This is unfavourable for exporters who need to buy physicals against a PTBF sale because when they x the purchase the physicals will cost even money against an open sale of minus 30. Differentials in producing countries may also buck the general market trend, for example because of drought or other production problems.
CURRENCY RISK
When advances in United States dollars are immediately turned into coffee stocks that will later also be sold in United States dollars, then the currency risk can be considered limited and to be mostly of local concern. However, in the past decade changing international capital ows have led to increased volatility between currencies. Coffee is still a dollar commodity, but nowadays coffee prices worldwide are determined not only by supply and demand, but also by the relative value of the United Sates dollar to other world currencies. Major movements in exchange rates, especially for the Brazilian real or the Colombian peso, but also in other coffee producing countries, will affect the price of coffee. In some instances such price or currency changes could put original United States dollar advances at risk.
PERFORMANCE RISK
The rst line of defence against performance risk is a correctly structured transaction. Further safeguards can then be put in place through the use of collateral management, beginning at the point of purchase and ending with the handing over of shipping documents. On the selling side this is more difcult, as it is impossible to know the nancial status and health of all potential importers or roasters. This is why banks will insist that trade is only with authorized buyers companies that are known and in which they have condence. In addition the bank may require that a sales contract is in place before any monies are advanced to buy stocks. In that case selling PTBF facilitates matters. The contractual obligation to supply and accept the goods can be established without the buyer being committed to an actual price long in advance of the actual shipment: only
179
the differential has to be agreed. (Many, if not most, roasters insist on buying PTBF buyers call.) This resolves the performance issue, but still leaves open the questions of price and differential risk. As a general rule, most banks dislike advancing the entire cost of a purchase, often preferring to stick to a percentage of the value, say 80%. This provides reasonable cover against a worst case scenario. The percentage will vary according to the risk rating of the country where the borrower conducts their business, and the banks assessment of the borrower.
The internal control and reporting systems are inadequate. Transactions work when everyone wishes it sudden change (weather, prices, buyer turns nasty and politics) can alter this and result in blameless default. It does not really help a bank to become the owner of the borrowers stocks. If these have to be sold off at a loss (10%20% is not unusual) it may take years of new lending to recoup the money lost. The local legal system may make the realization of collateral or debt recovery difcult. If so, local collateral in whatever form, including warehouse receipts, may be (almost) without value.
LETTERS OF CREDIT
Letters of credit can serve a dual purpose: A guarantee of payment once shipment has been made, to reduce the exporters credit risk; A means of advancing credit to an exporter, enabling goods to be bought and shipped. In the rst instance the exporter is paid against submission of the complete and correct set of shipping documents as stipulated in the letter of credit (L/C): the documentary
Table 10.3 What a borrower must show Advances at each stage 1. Document negotiation Borrower must show Real function, i.e. adds value. Track record. (Defaults are most likely to occur in the rst three to ve years of new operations.) Quality management. Understanding of the coffee business. Deals are correctly structured. Appropriate business plan and reporting systems. In-house nancial and volume limits. Clear document ows, proper stock rotation. Own capital. Visible, permanent and pledgeable assets. Adequate warehousing and insurance. Access to collateral management. Ratio and cost of advance Ratio or percentage of advance: highest. Interest rate: lowest. Conditions Sold to approved buyer. Documents and/or payment via bank. Financing of margin calls Exposure has been hedged, or PTBF sale has been xed.
2. Pre-shipment
3. Export processing
Ratio: lower again. Cost: higher again. Ratio: lowest or even nil. Cost: highest.
Pre-sold to approved buyer or hedged. Collateral manager. Pre-sold to approved buyer or hedged. Collateral manager.
Depending on package and borrowers book. Depending on package and borrowers book.
4. Interior buying
180
credit. This is a guarantee of payment once shipment has been made. It is not a specically designed instrument to enable one to raise credit, although occasionally banks may accept documentary credits as a form of collateral. Documentary credits include: Sight letter of credit: payable on rst sight (presentation) of the documents to the bank. Usance or time letter of credit: payable after a certain period has elapsed. In addition there is the performance credit or bid letter of credit, whose value is forfeited if the party concerned fails to perform (i.e. does not deliver, or does not establish the requisite documentary letter of credit). These are sometimes used for large, long-term supply contracts or in conjunction with tenders (a form of bid bond). For more on using documentary letters of credit see also chapter 4, Contracts.
181
For a buyer to be under an obligation to open a letter of credit governed by the UCP 600, the sales contract needs to include an express condition imposing such an obligation on the buyer. Only with such a condition in place can the seller object if the buyer were to open a letter of credit that is not governed by the UCP e.g. Payment by irrevocable letter of , credit, incorporating UCP 600. However, buyers may still stipulate in the credit that certain aspects of the UCP rules are excluded, provided this was laid down in the sales contract. The major advantage of incorporating UCP 600 in the sales contract for a seller is that where the UCP 600 rules are incorporated, he or she will know in advance the criteria against which the banks will examine the shipping documents in deciding whether or not to pay under the credit. The major advantage for a buyer is that he or she will know in advance the criteria against which the price for the goods will be paid against tender of documents. For a more detailed overview of UCP 600, see chapter 4, Contracts.
Lending bank is named as loss payee (beneciary). Premiums are paid up to date. Premises and goods are adequately described. Verication of premises: The premises are secure, safe and t for storage. Tally-in and weighing: Bags received are counted. Bags are weighed and stacked. Verication of quality: The goods are what they are supposed to be. Goods can be monitored from farm gate to ships hold. Issue or certication of warehouse receipts: Certifying receipt of the goods. Providing proof of existence, which is collateral for funding. Stock administration and control: Goods are properly accounted for. Goods cannot be dispatched independently. Goods are stored separately, they can be readily identied and no commingling is permitted at any time. Export process: Supervision of export processing; quality control; goods match the sales contract. Goods are handed over against approved waybills, receipts or bills of lading. Waybills, receipts and bills of lading stipulate the bank as benecial owner and are handled and dispatched correctly. The stage at which the CM leaves the process depends on the bank. The banks back ofce will have monitored the entire process and the CMs role often ends when the goods are handed over for shipment with the bank assuming title through the issue of bills of lading in the banks name rather than the exporters.
182
provides security over the export documentation process, thus eliminating all unsecured gaps. In other words, they are in the business of moving collateral. As such they can play an essential role in the nancing of coffee traders and processors or exporters, especially where the same bank is nancing both the end-user and the exporter. Some international CMs provide complete packages, linking customers with lending institutions on the strength of the CMs performance guarantee, based on standard packages and procedures which they apply worldwide. Should the coffee trade in future move into paperless trade with electronic documents of title and so on, then the role of the CM will take on more importance.
The risk principles are the same, although the detail may be different. Performance: Will the crop be delivered as agreed? Price: Will the value cover the outstanding credit? Value: Will the quality be acceptable and t for sale? Collateral: Can any collateral be provided, and if it is, can it be realized? Obviously it is difcult, if not entirely impossible, for the average commercial bank to evaluate performance risk, let alone potential quality and value, on an individual basis for thousands of smallholders.
GUARANTEES
Banks need the guarantee that warehouse receipts will become receivables, that is, commercial invoices backed by negotiable bills of lading or other relevant documents of title to the goods. All the gaps and risks in the process from the rst purchase to this point need to be quantied and covered. For CMs the risk is enormous. Cases of quality fraud, physical theft and document falsication do occur. Therefore, if their guarantees are to be truly solid then they need to be backed by delity (indemnity) and liability insurance of a quality and level that is acceptable to banks. To be readily enforceable, the insurance policy, and if possible the underlying collateral management contract, must be based on an acceptable jurisdiction, for example English law. If a CMs overseas parent company provides the guarantees, then it could be said that the collateral manager takes at least part of the country risk on board. This makes it easier for banks to approve certain lending operations, especially when the total credit and risk management package encompasses both the end-user and the producer or exporter. Coupled with the total credit and risk management packages offered by commodity banks, modern all in collateral management has become an essential component of credit. The increased collateral and transaction security it offers facilitates access to credit, and can help to bring smaller producers and exporters closer to buyers and endusers in consuming countries.
183
commercial and socially oriented lenders, development focused NGOs, and other sustainable trade players. FASTs members are committed to promoting sustainable production and trade within their respective capacities. FASTs mission is to facilitate a global collaborative effort among its members to ensure continued growth of the sustainable trade sector. This is done through increasing the number of producers in developing countries who can successfully access affordable trade nance and longerterm loans for infrastructure, tailored to their business needs as they enter sustainable markets and grow their businesses. SMEs often face the problem that they are too small to benet from infrastructural nance programmes and at the same time they are too big to qualify for micro-nancing. This is where FAST comes in. See www.fastinternational.org/ en/node/733 where a substantial number of resources is available. FAST also requires detailed information from potential borrowers such as: overview of the SME, amount required, certication, credit history, production and sales; business plan, organizational chart and nancial statements (balance sheet and income statement for three years cash ow projection for one year). See www.fastinternational.org/en/ node/681
Agri Fund obtains security by using sales contracts with pre-approved buyers as collateral, leaving the borrowers xed assets free to be used as collateral for other nancing requirements. Agri Fund will issue (partial) credit guarantees and provide other nancial products as a risk-mitigating instrument in favour of local nancial intermediaries. This in turn allows these intermediaries to offer commercial nance for the production and export of agricultural produce at better pricing and conditions than would be possible without such risk mitigating instruments. Fundamental is that the risk mitigating instrument will be decreased on a step-by-step basis, phasing out during a period of three to four years. This means that the nancial intermediary is expected to increase its share in the risk (phasing in), but in such a way that the conditions for the borrower will not deteriorate. Go to www.rabobank.com/guaranteefund for more information and download the SAGF brochure from there or directly at www.rabobank.com/content/images/G5334%20 RI_MVO_fund-LR_tcm43-50951.pdf.
184
Note also that the World Bank offers price risk management training courses, both on CD-ROM and in workshop settings. Visit www.agrisktraining.org for more on this.
185
MICROFINANCE
Micronance is of particular importance to many smallholders in the coffee industry. Most of the worlds coffee is produced by smallholders, but they often lack access to reasonably priced credit, particularly women coffee growers. (NB: the denition of smallholder varies from country to country.) Many institutions today provide micro nancing such as commercial banks, micro deposit taking institutions, NGOs and NGO-like micronance institutions. However, these are generally slanted towards the more urban areas and the nancing of commercial activities. Cooperatives and village banks as well as self-help groups usually have a greater rural outreach, but often their means and institutional capacities to nance the coffee sector are quite limited, not least also because of the remoteness of the areas many operate in. A detailed review of micronance is beyond the scope of this guide, but the following websites provide a good overview of on-line information sources, including downloadable training materials and links (not inclusive) to some of the better-known micronance institutions.
MicroRate, www.microrate.com, was the rst agency to specialize in the evaluation of micronance institutions that allows lenders and investors to measure the risk and the return on investment in micronance. MFTransparency, www.mftransparency.org, presents information on credit products and their prices for a number of MFIs and publishes country reports.
CHAPTER 11
COFFEE QUALITY
TWO SPECIES AND TWO PROCESSING METHODS .................................................................................... 188 QUALITY SEGMENTATION FOUR CATEGORIES ........................................................................................ 190 QUALITY AND PRODUCTION ........................................................................................................................... 191 HIGH QUALITY ARABICA .................................................................................................................................. 192 ROBUSTA ............................................................................................................................................................. 203
188
COFFEE QUALITY
TWO SPECIES AND TWO PROCESSING METHODS
Coffee (Coffea) is the major genus of the Rubiaceae family, which includes well over 500 genera and over 6,000 species. The genus Coffea itself comprises numerous species. Only two of them are currently of real economic importance: Coffea arabica, referred to in the trade as arabica and accounting for 60%-70% of world productio; Coffea canephora (or coffea robusta) called robusta in the trade and making up 30%-40% of world production. Two other species are traded to a very limited extent: Coffea liberica (liberica), and coffea excelsa (excelsa). The share of arabica fell from about 80% of world production in the 1960s to around 60% by the turn of the century. Initially this was because of strong growth of robusta production in Brazil and parts of Africa, but more recently because of the emergence of Asia as the worlds leading robusta producing region. The original arabica strains generally produce good liquors with acidity and avour, but they are susceptible to pests and diseases. This has led to the development of a number of different varieties that show better tolerance. Some quality purists consider that some of these varieties lack the quality characteristics that created coffees popularity. Others argue that the bottom line for many producers simply does not permit them to concentrate on just the traditional or original varieties. There are two main primary processing methods: the unwashed or dry process, which produces naturals, and the washed or wet process, which produces washed coffees. In the dry process the ripe cherries are dried in their entirety after which they are mechanically decorticated to produce the green bean. In the washed or wet process the ripe cherries are pulped and fermented to remove the sticky sugary coating called mucilage that adheres to the beans (this can also be done mechanically), and the beans are then washed and dried. There is a third process in which the ripe cherry is pulped and dried as is with the mucilage still adhering to the parchment skin. Originally called semi-washed in Africa, this process is gaining considerable importance in Brazil where it occupies a place in-between the dry and wet processes and is simply called pulped natural. In other countries, for example in the Great Lakes region of Central Africa, semiwashed coffee has been laboriously produced for many decades using small hand pulpers. In all procedures the parchment skin is later removed mechanically after drying.
189
WET PROCESS Delivers washed coffee Greens etc. to sun drying Floaters to sun drying Water to recycling Pulp to composting Cherry reception/sorting Flotation wet feed (or dry feed) Pregrader/pulper Pregrading channel Fermentation tanks Water to waste Water to recyling Washing Grading channel
Heavies and lights separately to
DRY PROCESS Delivers natural coffee or naturals Rubbish to waste Rubbish to waste Lights to repass pulper Cherry reception/sorting Flotation and skin dry (optional) Sun drying and raking
Skin drying = remove all free/excess water Sort out pods/skins Sun and/or mechanical drying Storage and conditioning, minimum 2 weeks
MILLING PROCESS
Rubbish/stones etc. to waste Husk to composting pods to repass Dust to waste shells/ears to bagging off
Dust to waste shells/ears to bagging off Grading by bean size (screening) Grading by bean density (gravity table) Manual or machine sorting Quality evaluation and classification Bagging off for shipment in bags or to silo for shipment in bulk Remove rejects and foreign matter
190
Quality discussions are further complicated when one separates coffee by species or by type of processing. There are arabicas and robustas, both wet and dry processed, and each with different quality aspects. Then there is also the question of whether the coffee will be sold as whole bean, as roast and ground, or as soluble. Appearances can also cause some confusion. It would be a mistake to think that quality means only exceptionally good looking (visually perfect), bold beans. Small bean coffees can also show excellent quality. Conversely, visually perfect, bold beans could in fact hide very unpleasant cup characteristics. The pursuit of quality is therefore not restricted to top or exemplary coffee. This is probably just as well, because not everyone is capable of producing exemplary quality. In reality there is a market for almost everything, from expensive top quality to qualities at the other end of the spectrum. There is room in the marketplace for just about anyone who honours their contractual obligations and who adequately satises the markets quality expectations for the type of coffee they produce. Different markets have different preferences. Producers and exporters should therefore know where their coffee is likely to receive the best response and, as far as possible, tailor the quality to the requirements of the buyer.
a decent, clean but not necessarily impressive cup. Many robustas are included in this category. It is estimated that mainstream qualities account for 85%-90% of world coffee consumption, while the share of exemplary and high quality coffee is less than 15% of the world market. Mainstream qualities are often traded on description. Descriptions can be fairly loosely written in the contracts, but usually there is some degree of quality understanding. That means seller and buyer have jointly established the quality parameters which the seller is expected to respect, for shipment after shipment. It is to be hoped that buyers will take this into consideration when talking price. The advantage to the buyer is that they are virtually certain that the coffee will do for them what they expect from it, and the seller knows the buyer will come back time and again for more of the same, irrespective of whether the market is up or down. This is one of the main factors that work towards creating market security. Although given how easily interchangeable they are, for most of the more mundane coffees, price will always play the major role. Note that no roaster will accept a coffee without tasting it rst, regardless of how it was described, which means that no exporter should ship any coffee without having done the same. Quality descriptions without an accompanying understanding between buyer and seller as to quality can lead to problems. For example, fair average quality (FAQ), or simply specifying the screen size and defect count together with guaranteed clean cup or sound merchantable quality, all leave much to the imagination. Such descriptions say the absolute minimum about a coffees quality and therefore the quality often uctuates within a fairly wide range. Deliveries can be good, mediocre or really disappointing. Although the buyer has a quality requirement, they are likely to be modest in their expectations of coffees bought on a relatively vague description. Usually, this is reected in the price that is offered.
UNDERGRADES OR LOWGRADES
Finally, there are the undergrades or lowgrades, which are basically everything that does not t into any of the earlier descriptions. There has traditionally been an active trade in undergrade coffees because there was a denite demand for them. Not everyone always knows the price for such coffees, which can make trading them very opportunistic. For the United States market, undergrade coffee is any type of coffee that grades below GCA type 6 (120 defects per 370 grams). In mid-2002, United States Customs regulations prohibited the importation of coffee below GCA type 8 (610 defects per 370 grams) with suggestions from some quarters that this should be raised to type 7 (240 defects per 370 grams). Other importing markets do not normally specify that particular grades of coffee should not be imported, relying instead on general food and hygiene regulations.
HIGH QUALITY
High-quality coffees are good cupping coffees, well presented, but not necessarily visually perfect. They are retailed both as straight origins and as blends. This category includes good quality, well-prepared organic coffees, and washed as well as superior quality natural robustas. The market for this quality band is much broader and includes a good percentage of todays specialty coffee.
MAINSTREAM QUALITY
Mainstream quality coffee is fair average quality, reasonably well presented, but certainly not visually perfect. It will offer
191
The ICO has introduced a set of worldwide minimum export standards in an attempt to remove the lowest coffees from the market altogether. The higher risk of mould and therefore OTA, a mycotoxin occurring in lowgrades is also likely to reduce the demand for such coffee. See also chapter 12. As a result, it may be that over time lowgrades and rejects will lose some or most of their commercial value, thereby becoming part of the producers or exporters cost calculation rather than representing an exportable coffee.
192
and some Ethiopian Harars, but the largest group of natural arabicas comes from Brazil, with the best originating from areas where the cherry matures and dries quickly.
to 10 hectares, to just a few hundred trees in all, sometimes even less than that. The worlds main resource of original coffees, and their future, probably lies within the smallholder sector. Ironically, because of the heterogeneity of most of these coffees (a single shipment is made up from many small growers), they often fail to get into the exemplary segment of the specialty market because they lack visual perfection, or they are unknown and it is easier to market well-known coffees. On the other hand, their availability is also not always adequate or regular enough to match expectation, which limits their scope in the marketplace.
193
to clean up the appearance of their usual standard coffee by some regrading and additional sorting. Expertise is sometimes lacking, not only at the producing end but also at the consuming end. Large quantities of so-called quality coffee are traded which show no quality at all. This is regrettable because, in the end, indifferent quality causes consumers to lose interest, as happened for example in the United States after the World War II, with devastating consequences for consumption there. Fortunately, in recent years the market share of the United States specialty or gourmet segment has been growing strongly, which has helped to reverse that trend. Accepting that not every grower, region or even country can produce absolute top quality, or visually perfect coffee, then the alternative must be to present the best possible coffee for those markets that show appreciation for that quality by rewarding the effort that goes into producing it. Without reward, growers cannot afford to invest the time and energy required to produce quality. The words present the best possible coffee are used here because it is not the intention of this guide to praise or condemn any one cultivar or variety. Preferences in different markets vary, and so do the prospects of different varieties, types and qualities of coffee. Other than the wild, extremely bitter tasting Mascarocoffea (found wild in the forest on Madagascar), inherently bad tasting coffee does not exist. Even the poor Mascaro has a selling point it is entirely free of caffeine but apparently it is also sterile when crossed. True, certain new cultivars may not deliver the quality characteristics of the original lines and this disappoints many coffee enthusiasts. But there is no inherently bad coffee, at least not when it is still on the tree. What happens to degrade the quality from then onwards is nearly always caused by human intervention. When discussing quality from the production perspective it is well to remember that someone, somewhere, is expected to drink the coffee. When recommending planting or replanting with disease-resistant or high-yielding hybrid varieties, one should ensure that the growers are exposed to all relevant information. So also, what is the expected quality and marketability of the coffee? What are the experiences with that coffee in the potential growers own environment? The decision to change the variety one plants has to be an informed decision, one that includes an assessment of the quality and marketing potential.
takes into account when judging your coffee, you can relate this to your entire production process and see where you need to take corrective or supportive action. The rst impression can make or break a coffees prospects. The rst impression a potential buyer gets of any coffee is when a sample of the green coffee is put in front of them. If the green immediately creates a negative impression then the least that will happen is that the coffee will be subject to bias from then onwards. The worst scenario is that the sample is not even tasted and is simply thrown away. Many exporters complain of getting no response to samples they send out, but green coffee buyers are usually very busy people. Getting them to take time out to taste a new coffee is not always easy, especially if their rst impression is not very positive. Hence, the need to target ones markets. It is not just costly, but almost pointless to send samples to all and sundry in the hope of achieving the odd hit.
HIGH QUALITY ARABICA (GREEN) The aspect (or style) and the colour should be even
The green beans should be of compatible shape or style, colour and size. They, and the roasted beans or the roast must give an impression of being reasonably even. This is most important for coffee that is to be retailed as roasted whole beans. Buyers know the green bean aspects that affect the liquor negatively and they consider these when evaluating any sample, irrespective of how they might use the coffee. Buyers dislike uneven greens because they can pose problems during roasting. The resulting uneven roasts do not appeal to consumers and in any case tend to produce lower liquor quality than do even roasts. Usually, uneven colour indicates the mixed harvesting of immature and ripe cherry, which also reects negatively in the cup. The bean shape or style can vary with the cultivar. Usually coffee from the same cultivar will not show great variation in terms of shape and style, whereas uniformity of size is determined by the degree of size grading which takes place. But mixing different cultivars within a single consignment can produce uneven looking coffees, even if all the beans conform to the same screen size. This is especially so if coffee from different cultivars that produce solid and softish beans respectively are mixed into the same batch. Softish beans usually have quite a different shape and style from solid beans; this will be especially evident in the roast. If different cultivars have been interplanted, as could be the case on a smallholding where there might be no room to separate them, then there is little to be done at the harvest stage. An estate with blocks of different cultivars on the other hand could harvest and process them on different days, and hold them separately for example by colour coding each batch.
DEFINING QUALITY
Who denes quality? Behind every successful importer and roaster stands a satised body of consumers. But the nal judge for growers is, simply put, the importer (or roaster) who pays a satisfactory price for a coffee and who does so on a sustained basis. Once you know what this person
194
If coffee is collected commercially from different geographical production areas, care should be taken to verify its compatibility before mixing it, if necessary by making small trial blends by hand in proportion to the quantities to be mixed (bulked).
Mechanical drying is often used if the climate or the tonnage to be handled do not allow one to depend entirely on sun drying, that is, if the weather is too unreliable during the harvest season, or the quantities of cherry to be handled are simply too big. For washed robusta it is also a means of avoiding (secondary) fermentation. Collectors (those who buy parchment or dried coffee in cherry from small farmers) often use mechanical drying to bring the moisture content down to acceptable levels. Subsequent storage or conditioning in bulk bins with airow capability then evens out the moisture content throughout the entire parcel or stack. Brownish tinges in arabica greens can result from the harvesting of overripe cherries, or from allowing too many skins to enter the fermentation tanks. The use of dirty water, under-fermentation, insufcient washing after natural fermentation, or the mechanical removal of mucilage are other contributing causes. In washed arabicas foxy beans (where the silver-skin has turned reddish-brown) are usually due to the harvesting of overripe cherry, or keeping cherries overnight before pulping. Fading is an indication of problems. A generally bleached or fading colour suggests that the coffee is ageing, or that it was over-dried, especially so in arabica. When the fading is more pronounced around the edges of the beans (which turn whitish) then this suggests the coffee was taken off the drying racks or grounds too early, or it was stored in moist, humid conditions, without adequate air circulation. If some of the beans are also generally softish and whitish then the experienced buyer knows such a coffee will never make it to the specialty market, let alone the roasted whole bean segment. Such a sample may nd its way directly to the waste bin because such coffee has already lost its fresh taste and will denitely show a dull (bland) and common (ordinary) liquor. Prolonged storage can be another cause of loss of colour (and quality). In this respect the Mesoamerican Development Institute rst carried out experiments in 2005 in Costa Rica, storing green coffee in airtight cocoons and comparing quality against coffee from the same batch stored in the conventional manner. The two-piece hermetic storage cocoon consisted of a top cover and bottom oor that are joined with a PVC tongue and groove zipper, similar to those used to close environmental safety suits. Coffee stored in this manner was found to have retained colour, avour and quality much better, also over prolonged periods and without risk of infestation by insects or fungi. Later experiments have conrmed this and advanced hermetic storage technology is now gaining considerable ground in both the storage and transportation of green coffee. Details of the original research and subsequent applications are available on www. mesoamerican.org and www.grainpro.com.
195
over-dried. Some modern (and quite simple) dryers use ambient air circulation, which minimizes such problems. Their suitability also depends on the prevailing climatic conditions. For arabica coffee, try combining mechanical and sun drying, with the initial drying done mechanically followed by a nishing-off period of exposure to sunlight. This improves the colour generally and appears to reduce the effect on colour of the mechanical drying. Some at bed dryers and pan dryers incorporate a sliding roof which permits managed exposure to sunlight. When sun drying, do not spread drying coffee, cherry and parchment, thicker than one hands width. Use an even drying surface and spread the coffee evenly, with no hills and valleys. Stir or turn the coffee regularly to ensure even drying. Cover parchment coffee during the hottest time of the day to avoid it cracking open and creating mottled beans. Cover all coffee during rain and at night. For smallholders, drying trays are an excellent drying method: easily taken out and returned to store. If they are used under plastic roong, then one simultaneously achieves good air circulation, heat retention and cover against rain.
and its potential consequences. This and other food safety issues are reviewed in detail in chapter 12. To repeat once more: many receivers stipulate a maximum permissible moisture content on both shipment and arrival. Producers and exporters need to develop appropriate moisture content management techniques if they are to cope with this. Over-drying costs money. This makes it as serious as under-drying: not only is weight, and therefore money, lost unnecessarily, but the accompanying loss of colour also translates directly into lower liquor quality. When moisture drops below 10%, aroma, acidity and freshness begin to fade away and at 8% or below they have completely disappeared. For this reason the ICO wants to see shipments of coffee below 8% moisture content prohibited. Like under-dried coffee, over-dried coffee should not be mixed with correctly dried coffee. The two are not compatible. Remember also that climatic conditions in many storage sheds are not ideal: they may be keeping the coffee dry but they are certainly not keeping it cool and the coffee may therefore continue drying out. Quality loss due to over-drying cannot be reversed, and is unacceptable. Over-dried coffee also breaks up more easily during milling. This increases the percentage of ears, shells and broken beans, which further reduces both the quality and the value. Finally, do everything possible to avoid letting coffee sit around endlessly after it has been containerized for export. This can be especially problematic for landlocked countries from where coffee must travel long distances to the port of shipment. If containers are kept in the open, exposed to open sun in holding grounds, on railway atcars or trucks it could lead to overheating and condensation. See also chapter 5. Over-drying also affects the way a coffee roasts. Coffees with a moisture content as low as 8% may certainly take the average specialty roaster by surprise. This is because such coffees tend to roast to completion much faster than these roasters expect. Smaller specialty roasters do not always have moisture meters, and they can and do get into trouble with such coffees. Quite apart from the reduction in acidity and avour that over-drying causes, the end-user may also be embarrassed all good reasons never to buy that coffee again.
196
rejected or why some buyers simply do not respond to them at all. Coated. Silver-skin has adhered to more than half a beans surface. The immediate consequence is that the green appearance suffers because the silver-skin obscures the beans surface and true colour. Too much coatedness does not look good. The roaster also knows that the silver-skin tends to burn off during roasting and the resultant chaff can pose problems. Coated beans are caused by drought and by trees overbearing. Both of these tend to affect the cherry in similar ways, and the coffees style and general aspect are usually not impressive. General coatedness can also result from under-fermentation. Beans that are entirely coated may originate from unripe cherry. Coffees with pronounced coatedness often produce common, ordinary liquors. The experienced coffee buyer will tend to instinctively discriminate against such coffees, also because the roast will usually contain ragged, soft and sometimes pale beans. If possible one should not mix coffee from drought-affected trees with that of others. However, many coated beans will lose their silver-skin during hulling (or polishing, where this is installed). Very coated beans are usually also ragged and smaller or lighter than the norm and may be removed during grading and sorting. Before rushing into polishing to remove the silver-skin, rst establish whether the coatedness of your coffee is a problem and, if so, what the cause might be. Dry polishing as such adds nothing to coffee quality, but does improve the colour and overall appearance (unless the polisher has excessively heated the beans, which has the opposite effect). Correct (i.e. cool) polishing may make a coffee more easily saleable. Some robustas are (wet) polished as a matter of course, but for arabica it is advisable to rst verify whether polishing makes commercial sense. Ragged or uneven. Ragged refers to drought-affected and misshapen beans that give the green an uneven aspect. Too many ragged beans in a coffee suggest less than optimal quality in that neither green nor roast are pleasing to the eye and such coffee is not usually suitable for sale as whole roasted bean. Ragged coffees often produce mediocre liquors, but one cannot generalize because some soughtafter original coffees show beans with naturally meandering centre cuts as a matter of course. Great care must be taken therefore to distinguish between the visual or cosmetic aspects of different coffees and the quality. An uneven green can also be the result of mixing different coffees, for example a roundish bean (Bourbon) with a attish bean (Typica), or a boat-shaped (Ethiopian) variety. Where possible it is probably best to leave decisions on the mixing of different cultivars and types to the buyer. The fundamental causes of raggedness can be addressed only in the eld. All processing can do is: separate light
and heavy cherry before pulping (by grading or otation: smallholders can even do this using a simple bucket or basin); systematic washing and grading after pulping; and intensive size and especially density separation during dry (export) processing. The most useful tool in this respect is without any doubt the gravity table (table densimtrique in French). Properly set and supervised, this machine will eliminate many, if not most, ragged beans. Pulper-nipped beans are the result of incorrectly set pulpers. They are very difcult to remove during export grading and sorting. If those beans are discoloured as well they can also cause fermented, foul or unclean cups as described in the next paragraph. Experienced buyers will notice pulper-nipped beans and the risk message they convey.
197
correctly operated washing stations are an important quality control tool, at the very start of the processing chain.
Bean size
Below-size and light beans in a consignment are a direct consequence of inadequate size and density separation, partly during primary processing but mostly during dry or export processing. Not only do too many smalls and lights spoil the coffees green appearance, but large and small, or heavy and light beans, also do not roast well together. This is because smalls and lights will over-roast during the time it takes for the roasting of the larger, heavier beans to be completed. There are strict limits to the proportion of smalls and lights roasters may tolerate in whole bean coffee; if a coffee exceeds their in-house tolerance for smalls and lights, then out it goes. Not all size grading is accurate. Opinions differ on the accuracy of different size grading techniques (vibratory or atbed versus rotary or cylinder graders for example). But, often, when operated at full design capacity, graders do not necessarily produce accurate separation, so the throughput must be regulated. This can be especially troublesome if a grader is directly auto-fed by a preceding processing unit, or if the product quality is quite variable. It is always advisable therefore to have a manufacturer commission any new milling, grading and sorting equipment, using the actual product that is to be handled. Regulating the intake ow by placing a buffer silo or feed hopper ahead of the grader can improve grading accuracy quite considerably, but constant supervision will always be necessary. The grading accuracy should be veried regularly, using hand or sample screens that should be kept handy, near the grader.
When grading whole bean type coffee, bear in mind that some very large beans may not be particularly attractive as they are often soft or misshapen. Such beans become especially noticeable in the roast appearance. They can be easily removed by the insertion of a large size screen (number 20 screen for example) ahead of the regular screens. This is also helpful when elephant beans are present (beans which have become inter-twined in the cherry and which nearly always break up, if not during milling then during roasting). One easy way to quickly verify whether a shipment corresponds to the selling sample is to check the coffees size and density composition. Pass 100 g or 200 g of the original sample and the shipment sample over the appropriate size screens and compare the percentages. Do the same with the lights by counting them. Many shipments appear visually to be a match, but turn out not to be when this simple test is applied. Buyers know this, and so should the exporter.
Bean density
Lights, shells or ears, and brokens are all beans or parts of beans that are notably lighter in weight (i.e. less dense) than the average bean in a particular size grade. Note this distinction: although a small but solid bean will weigh less than a large one, it does not automatically follow that it is a light bean. Lights usually have natural causes such as drought, stress, or picking of immature cherry. All of these result in misshapen, shrivelled and soft beans. The breaking up of beans during hulling and other processing actions (including over-drying) results in shells, ears, brokens, chips and so on. Such beans and bits and pieces detract from the green appearance. They cause similar roasting problems to smalls in large bean grades, and they very denitely depress the cup quality.
198
Not only do light and broken beans reduce the avour, acidity and body of a coffee, but they often also introduce a attish, common or ordinary taste. They can turn a potentially ne cup into a mediocre one. Proper density separation is therefore of extreme importance, especially when the coffee beans to be dealt with are also somewhat heterogeneous (uneven) by nature. Lights and brokens are removed pneumatically using strong airows (catador), or by a uidization process (gravity table). Both separate coffee by density but catadors are usually less accurate than gravity tables. Catadors are most useful for the initial clean-up of a coffee, directly after hulling (and polishing if installed). The strong air current removes most chips and small lights that would otherwise complicate or slow the subsequent processing. However, gravity tables are at their most efcient when the coffee has already been size graded. This is because the size grader will have removed most of the remaining smalls, and the product to be separated is therefore already of reasonably uniform density. Catador and gravity table settings must be based on the type and quality of the coffee under process and on the desired result. Constant, well-informed supervision is essential, especially if the product is not homogeneous, for example if there has been no prior size grading. Again, an intermediate buffer silo or feed hopper permitting variable feed can ensure that the intake ow is correctly set. This is essential if optimal results are to be achieved. This applies to all grades of coffee, not only whole bean grades, because the value of the small bean coffees that are an inevitable by-product of the larger, whole bean, grades must also be maximized. Small lights, ears and chips in a grade of whole but small beans (C grade, peaberry, screen 15 and even screen 14) cause exactly the same problems: they make the coffee awkward to roast and degrade the liquor quality. There are good markets for decent grinders (used for roast and ground only) if the coffee is homogeneous and properly graded.
affect the cup quality. The buyer of quality coffees will not tolerate such beans. Modern sorting equipment is capable of many and extremely varied tasks. The most recent developments use laser technology. Such equipment can be quite costly though whereas in some countries sorting by hand is an important source of otherwise scarce employment. Deciding whether to hand or machine sort depends on individual circumstances, the tonnages to be sorted, and the cost of labour. Smaller producers of specialty coffee usually give their coffee at least a quick going over by hand, especially if labour is relatively cheap. Some expend much time and care on sorting, depending on their target market. Individual countries and operators have different ideas, systems and methods when it comes to sorting green coffee and there is no point in discussing these here because different circumstances pose their own particular requirements and problems. But there are two general principles which are important. Know your sorting capabilities. When preparing advance samples for dispatch abroad, ensure that your expectations of your sorting capacity do not exceed reality. It is only human to remove more rather than fewer defects from an advance sample as the coffee will be properly sorted in any case. It is exceedingly annoying for the buyer to nd later that the coffee is almost but not quite as well sorted as the advance sample. A good working environment and decent lighting is necessary for people to sort coffee efciently and correctly. Many manual sorting processes still consist of people sitting on the oor in dark and dingy warehouses, each facing a heap of coffee. The sorters closest to the door can see the best the remainder have to make do. This will never do for the preparation of quality coffee, whether arabica or robusta, because the sorting will be neither optimal nor even. This kind of operation is best kept hidden from visiting buyers altogether. If sorting belts are too expensive, then at least invest in sorting tables and benches. These are easily made up by any competent carpenter. Such tables speed up the sorting process, which then is also more easily supervised. Sorting belts are moving conveyor belts, usually with auto-feed and auto-advance, providing room for 12 or 24 sorters to sit on either side. Sorting tables are tables with a uorescent light over them, seating six or eight people. The tabletop is divided into squares with raised edges. A small hole in each square allows sorted coffee to fall into a bag attached underneath; rejects go into receptacles xed to the tables edge.
Sorting
Bleached, mottled, whitish, blotchy, soapy and discoloured beans generally cannot be removed by size or density grading but there is no place for them in quality coffee (although there is probably some tolerance for them in the lower priced segment of the general market). Nearly all such beans are caused by moisture and drying problems, but discolouring can also be due to oxidization, contact with soil, metal, dirty water and so on. The gravity table can help, but in the end the only effective way to remove these beans is through manual or electronic sorting. Not only do such beans effectively ruin the coffees green appearance but they also show up in the roast as softs or quakers, pales, mottled beans and so on, and they denitely
Sampling
The golden rule of quality coffee is to do the best possible within ones capabilities. This means demonstrating rst of all through the green appearance that a certain amount of care has gone into the coffees preparation. Such care will automatically come through in the roast and in the liquor. If
199
potential buyers do not see such signs of care in a green coffee sample they may discard it without even tasting it. The liquor will always show a coffees real character, however exciting or dull that may be, but at least the liquor should never show any of the obvious defects mentioned earlier. If it does, do not send the sample to someone who you know buys only quality. Apart from the rejection that will follow, you may inadvertently ruin any chance of future business with that buyer because you have demonstrated an obvious lack of expertise. Samples must be representative. When you send a sample be sure that it is fully representative of the actual coffee or, if you do not have the coffee in stock, be sure that you can match the quality. It is useful to note the following sampling denitions: Stocklot samples are samples of the actual coffee that will be shipped if a contract is concluded. Approval samples are sent for coffees sold subject approval of sample. Such samples must be drawn from the actual parcel intend for shipment. Remember, a sale subject to approval is not really a sale until the buyer approves the sample. Type samples represent a quality agreed with the buyer, expected to be matched in all respects. If you cannot match the sample quality in some respect, tell your buyer sooner rather than later. Indication samples are an indication of what you expect to be able to ship, usually followed later by an approval sample which shows what you actually propose to ship. Shipment or outturn samples are fully representative samples of the coffee that has actually been shipped.
The potential causes and remedies for many individual roast defects have been identied earlier. The following therefore deals with more general roast defects that are under the control of producers and exporters. An even roast is all-important. In an even roast almost all the beans have roasted to about the same colour and brightness, with a white or whitish centre-cut that is not too irregular. There should be few obvious defects, preferably none. Wet-processed coffees usually produce the best roasts, especially when the parchment has been properly sun-dried. Brilliant roasts with white centre-cuts are a hallmark of wellprepared and well-dried coffee. Under-drying, on the other hand, produces dull roasts. The centre-cuts in particular are indicative of the care taken during the processing and drying of washed and semi-washed coffee. Naturals (dried in the cherry) usually show dullish roasts with brownish centrecuts and this makes it difcult to present most of them as whole bean. Unless well managed, mechanical drying using hot air may also dull the roast appearance. A brilliant or bright roast almost shines up at the viewer. It has a well dened, white to brilliantly white centre-cut and the beans are usually fairly hard or solid. When considering mixing or blending, one should always consider the roast of each individual component: mixing bright, solid roasts with dull and usually softer roasts may well result in an unattractive overall view that renders the coffee less suitable for presentation as whole bean. Dull and dullish roasts lack lustre and brightness. This is usually caused by under-drying, or sometimes by mechanical drying. Over-fermentation and the picking of overripe cherry can also cause dull roasts and will especially affect the colour of the centre-cut. In washed coffee, brownish centre-cuts or no centre-cuts are suggestive of overripes, over-fermentation, use of dirty water or the presence of too many skins in the fermentation tanks. But naturals usually tend towards duller roasts, and brownish or almost no centre-cuts as a matter of course.
Uneven roasts
There are many potential causes of uneven roasts. They include: the picking of immature or droughted cherry; uneven fermentation, including the mixing of different batches of washed or semi-washed coffee, which have not necessarily been fermented or washed to the same degree; too rapid or uneven drying; and insufcient separation of light coffee during primary and/or export processing. Incomplete fermentation causes dull roasts, and when mixed with brighter roasting coffee, gives an aspect of general unevenness. Immature cherry usually translates into pales or semi-pales in the roast (beans which are yellowish to yellow in colour). But bleached or colourless green beans, including yellow beans or ambers, also cause pales in the roast. Not only do (bright) pales ruin the roast appearance and cause clearly
200
visible yellow particles in ground coffee, they also introduce commonness into the liquor. Mottled and blotchy beans are caused by uneven drying. The end consumer may not necessarily notice them as a defect, but their appearance in the roast suggests to examiners that the quality of the coffee is likely to deteriorate rather quickly. This may cause them to reject it altogether.
colour of different roast types. The system consists of eight numbered colour disks against which one matches a sample of nely ground, roasted coffee, usually pressed into a laboratory petri dish. In this way one assigns the roast an approximate number on what is commonly called the Agtron Gourmet Scale, ranging from #95 (lightest roast) at intervals of 10 down to #25 (the darkest common roast). This helpful tool enables producers and roasters to speak the same language when discussing the roast of a coffee. It is available from the SCAAs resource centre in Long Beach, California see www.scaa.org.
201
Liquoring is also important for other reasons. A seller who cannot properly evaluate the quality of their own coffee also cannot value it against the price at which the competition or other origins are selling. Without liquoring it is nearly impossible to judge whether ones asking price, for example, is too high or too low.
knows where the coffee came from, how it was brought to the quality the buyer approved, and that within reason the seller can repeat the exercise in future. Of course, like wine, no coffee is exactly the same from season to season. There are good years, and then there are less good to sometimes even bad years. Experienced buyers know this and will never hold such variations against a seller. Buyers hate exporters who knowingly ship coffee whose quality is not up to standard. If unforeseen circumstances mean one has difculty in fullling a contract then the best and, really, the only option is always to inform your buyer as soon as you become aware of the problem. The buyer may be able to assist you by granting an extension to the shipping period, or may agree to take a slightly different quality (perhaps against a reduction in price), or may agree to release you from the contract. But the buyer will rightly be furious if the exporter simply ships a slightly different coffee hoping to get away with it. This can cause real and serious trouble, as shipping the wrong coffee disrupts the buyers supply pipeline. Roasters buy coffee for a specic objective. If on arrival it does not suit, it becomes virtually useless to them. It is no good then to offer a price allowance or discount to try and settle the matter. After all, if the roaster could have used a lower quality he or she would presumably have bought that in the rst place. Continuity and mutual trust mean both parties understand what is important in the coffee, that within reason they will continue to offer and buy that coffee, and that they can rely on each other to respect their obligations in every respect. Not all obligations are specied in the contract. For example, keeping buyers informed about the status of pending contracts is an unwritten obligation, whether the news to be passed on is good or not so good.
202
Most buyers would also consider sour and onion liquors as totally unacceptable, arguing that both are just a step away from ferment. This is a persuasive argument because sour and oniony liquors are caused by late pulping of cherry, and poor processing or drying techniques. Coffee does not naturally come off the tree with such taints. Remember that fermentation starts as soon as the cherry is picked. But there are clever blenders who know how to use such coffees in combination with other specic taste characteristics, and in so doing arrive at an acceptable nal result. The real issue may therefore be whether such a coffee is over the top or not. In any case, as far as the quality market is concerned one is best advised to stay well clear of such coffees. Musty or mouldy is a very unpleasant coarse harsh avour caused by the storage of under-dried coffee, or the re-wetting of coffee after it has already been dried. This avour also suggests potential mould problems (see also chapter 12). Earthy is a close relative. Contact with bare earth or dust are the main causes, which also imply poor drying arrangements, and the possibility of mustiness and mouldiness. Very strong taints will also render a coffee virtually unusable: contact with petrol for example. Unclean can refer to any offensive off-avour or taint. It can also be taken to indicate that an unspecied off-avour is present. Most of these taste defects tend to intensify with ageing. The common thread linking them all is that they are not to be tolerated in reasonably decent coffee. NB: The information on mycotoxins (see also chapter 12, Quality control) in this guide has been drawn from industry experts, from the ndings of the ICO/FAO project The enhancement of coffee quality by prevention of mould growth, and from the book Coffee Futures: A Source Book of Some Critical Issues Confronting the Coffee Industry, published by CABI Commodities (2001 ISBN 958-332356X) www.cabi.org.
transforms them into rather different, intense and sometimes outright unpleasant tastes. So these tastes can be viewed as positive or negative it all depends on the intensity and on the buyers judgement. See also chapter 12. Ordinary, common or coarse tastes are strictly speaking not off-avours. Just as there is a market for vin ordinaire, so there is one for caf ordinaire. These avour characteristics are usually caused by problems such as drought, serious stress or insect damage, or by processing or drying errors. Such liquors are therefore unlikely to nd much favour in the quality market. But there are also disease resistant or highyielding cultivars that present rather common liquors even though the coffee may be of attractive appearance and style. Sometimes such coffees may be upgraded through blending, perhaps by adding another coffee with an oniony, fruity or winey avour. The result may not be a candidate for the exemplary market, but perhaps not a candidate for outright rejection either. A woody or aged taste is not unsimilar and is the direct result of the ageing of a coffee, usually accompanied by loss of colour. It is not at all uncommon to nd woody tasting coffee at the retail end of the specialty business because it sometimes takes months before coffees are roasted. Poorly dried coffees age more quickly than do well prepared ones, and lose colour more rapidly as well. The coffee fades quickly. For 99 out of 100 offer samples from origin, a woody taste or fading appearance suggests a risk of premature ageing during shipment and the time spent awaiting nal sale. Grassy is a greenish taste that tends to obscure the liquors ner aspects such as avour or aroma. This taste is reminiscent of hay and is mostly found in early season coffee. Under-drying tends to accentuate grassiness. Bricky is a close relative in that it also reduces avour and acidity. Usually this commonish taste is associated with (slight) under-fermentation.
203
To satisfy their long-term delivery commitments for roasted coffee, roasters also enter into long-term purchase contracts, usually on the basis price to be xed buyers call (see also chapter 9, Hedging). Such long-term commitments almost inevitably mean the coffee trade sells such coffees short and expects to cover their sales later. Selling short is risky by itself but, as discussed in chapter 9, most of the risk can be hedged. But selling a single origin short (in quantity and over an extended period) is exceedingly risky in case of later supply difculties in that origin, so the trade instead sells a basket of acceptable coffees from a number of different origins. For example, Guatemala, Prime Washed, and/or El Salvador, Central Standard, and/or Costa Rica, Hard Bean, against the appropriate delivery months of the New York arabica contract, the C. Or, Uganda, Standard Grade, and/or Cte dIvoire, Grade 2, against the LIFFE robusta contract. The baskets represent coffees that are acceptable for the same purpose in many blends of roasted coffee. Suppliers can full their delivery commitments by providing one of the specied types. Each individual shipment is still subject to the roasters nal approval of quality on arrival. By coupling the use of these baskets with just-in-time delivery and the often imposed requirement that any coffee not approved on arrival be substituted immediately, one could say that the large roasters have taken most surprises out of the procurement process. All except price; but even here their main objective is not to pay more than their competitors, rather than to look for bargains or play the market. Exporters must understand that there is no place for emotion in these buying processes. All that counts is price and performance.
generally also well known so the only way for an exporter to beat the competition is to be more efcient, more reliable, more consistent and more exible. Some accuse the large-scale roasting sector of gradually lowering the quality of retail coffee through technical innovation and product changes such as high-speed, highyield roasting, steaming of robustas, the introduction of liquid coffee, etc. Germany is sometimes quoted as an example of shifting quality preferences. In 1990, Colombian mild arabicas and Other mild arabicas accounted for 73% of green bean imports, with Colombia as top supplier. By 2010 Colombian mild arabicas and Other mild arabicas were only 26%. Indeed, Viet Nam alone provided almost 18% or 3.4 million bags against just 0.3 million bags or less than 2% from Colombia. Others would argue that there simply is not enough quality coffee in the world to permit todays mega-roasters to raise the quality of standard blends without creating serious price distortions, although other agro-industrial products such as wine appear to cope easily enough with a widely segmented price structure. Also, the demand pattern in some countries is shifting, as in Germany where acidic coffees are now in less demand. Wherever the truth may lie, smaller origins and exporters cannot easily compete for what has become pure bulk commodity business. They have no competitive advantages and lack the economies of scale of larger players. It is impossible for them to add value because only large quantities of standard products are wanted. Mega-roasters have neither the time nor the inclination to deal with small quantities of exemplary coffees. Some do participate indirectly in the specialty business, but through separate business units. Despite the excitement of the specialty market, never overlook the fact that the mainstream business represents 85% or more of world coffee imports and should not be ignored.
Consequences of standardization
Interestingly, this standardization of mainstream quality not only means that below par coffees are not acceptable. It also means that coffees of better quality or better bean size are not wanted and no premiums will be paid. The primary requirements are that the coffee must do for the blend what the roaster expects, and that every shipment is the same. There can be no question of accepting differences in quality, or of settling such differences through payment of allowances or through arbitration. If the coffee is not right then it will be rejected. Not only must the quality of each delivery be comparable to the previous one, it must also be uniform throughout the entire parcel, from bag to bag and from container to container. Consistency is the key. All that has been said previously concerning respect for quality applies equally to mainstream or standard grades as well. Clearly, the quality of such coffees is not as exciting; it would be fair to say that as a rule standard type coffees are not particularly inspiring and offer easily matched cup quality. For standard quality, price is a much more important business factor than it is for exemplary or specialty coffee, where quality holds the key. Prices for standard quality are
ROBUSTA
Robusta the species
Coffea canephora, popularly known as robusta because of the hardy nature of the plant, was rst discovered in the former Belgian Congo in the 1800s. It is also known to be indigenous to the tropical forests around the Lake Victoria crescent in Uganda. It was introduced into Southeast Asia in 1900, after coffee rust disease wiped out all arabica cultivation in Ceylon in 1869 and destroyed most low altitude plantations in Java in 1876. Currently, it represents between 30% and 40% of world production. It is grown in West and Central Africa, throughout Southeast Asia, and in
204
parts of South America including Brazil, where it is known as Conillon. The robusta plant grows as a shrub or as a small tree up to 10 m in height. Generally, it is planted at lower densities than arabica because of the larger plant size. Robusta exists in many different forms and varieties in the wild. The crossbred strains of this variety of coffee are often hard to identify, but two main types are generally recognized: Erecta, or upright forms, and Nganda, or spreading forms. Robusta is a diploid species. It is a larger bush than the arabica plant, and with robust growth. The root system of robusta, though large, is rather shallow compared to arabica, with the mass of feeder roots being conned to the upper layers of the soil. The leaves are broad, large and pale green in colour. Flowers are white and fragrant, and are borne in larger clusters than in arabica. The owers open on the seventh or eighth day after receiving rain. Unlike arabica, robusta is self-sterile, that is, its ovule cannot be fertilized with its own pollen and hence cross-pollination is necessary. The cherries are small, but larger in number per node than arabica, varying from 40 to 60 or more. They mature in about 10 to 11 months and are generally ready for harvest two months later than arabica. Robusta beans are smaller than arabica beans. Depending on the plant strain, the bean shape is round, oval or elliptical with pointed tips. The colour of the beans depends on the method of processing grey when washed and golden brown when prepared by the dry cherry or natural method of preparation. The caffeine content of robusta beans is nearly twice as high as that of arabica beans (2% to 2.5% versus 1.1% to 1.5%). Under normal conditions robusta coffee possesses several useful characteristics such as high tolerance to leaf rust pathogen, white stem borer and nematode invasion, and the potential to give consistent yields. For these reasons, the cost of robusta cultivation is relatively low compared to the arabica variety. Inability to endure long drought conditions, late cropping, late stabilization of yields and somewhat less attractive quality compared to arabica, are some of the negative attributes of robusta coffee. In general, robusta is harder than arabica and grows well at low altitudes, in open humid conditions, with the cost of production being lower than the arabica variety. In some countries (Uganda and India, for example) robusta is also cultivated at fairly high altitudes (above 1,200 m) and under shade. These features have helped in the production of dense beans, with better cupping characteristics than those normally expected in the robusta cup, which could aid in the preparation of specialty and possibly exemplary coffees.
in the cup, unlike the thick robust notes that are observed in the average robusta cup. In a number of import markets, quality washed robusta has replaced a percentage of washed arabica in coffee blends. Such robustas have not only provided the froth and bubbles for the much sought after espresso, but have also helped in reducing the price of such blends. Robusta beans with robust but clean notes of strength and fruitiness (but not fermented, i.e. with a neutral liquor) also nd ready acceptance in the preparation of soluble coffee. Note, however, that the wet processing of robusta is riskier and more difcult because the mucilage in robusta coffee is thicker and stickier than it is in arabica. In some cases fermentation may not be complete even after 72 hours and, considering the high temperatures at the low altitude at which most robusta is grown, the process requires extremely careful monitoring to avoid over-fermentation. Such lengthy fermentation periods also require much more tank space than the average processing facility can economically operate, whereas large-scale friction (aqua) pulpers to strip mucilage are costly in terms of water and power use. However, the development of small and sometimes mobile motorized processing units that combine depulping and frictional mucilage removal with minimal water use is creating new opportunities for smaller growers and smallholders to benet from the growing demand for wet processed robustas. Some are combined with mechanical drying units to ensure rapid and uniform drying, thus avoiding the risk of secondary fermentation or off avours. For information on such types of machines, also called eco-pulpers, visit for example www.penagos.com and www.pinhalense.com.br. Defectives and off-tastes found in robusta, and their causes, do not differ markedly from those covered in the preceding section. All the concerns and limitations concerning quality and moisture content already stated are equally valid for robusta coffee, both dry and wet processed. Nevertheless it is appropriate to review some of them in the context of robusta production.
205
harvesting should also be carefully checked. Cherries collected in fertilizer bags or in bags previously used for chemicals could absorb an off-taste, especially when such bags are tightly tied and left unattended for a length of time or directly exposed to strong sunshine. The raw/green off-taste in robusta coffee has been attributed to incorrect harvesting techniques. For economic reasons, selective picking may not be practised. This results in unripe cherries being pulped or dried along with ripe cherries. The green or immature beans present among the unripe cherries give a raw or green off-taste to the cup. On the other hand, the presence of brown beans and an off-taste of overripe could occur when the cherries have been picked in an overripe or even already dried condition. Where feasible, growers are advised to sort the cherry after picking, to ensure that the coffee to be pulped (or dried in the cherry for natural preparation) does not contain unripe or overripe cherries that lower the cup quality. Fermented and so-called medicinal off-tastes have been observed in natural (dry processed) robusta. The cause for these could be delays in spreading the cherries for drying or the deterioration of overripe cherry. (Late harvesting means general over-ripeness, resulting in poor cups.) Causes of pulper-nipped beans/cuts, stinkers, putrid/ rotting off-taste. Invariably, not all coffee cherries will be the same size. If they are not sorted on size, with the help of mechanical cherry sorters, hand sieves or otation, it is very likely that the beans will be cut during pulping. This can also happen if the pulper has not been suitably adjusted or tted with exible chops. Micro-organisms can enter pulpernipped beans through the injury and cause the formation of stinkers or black beans, adversely affecting quality. Causes of earthy, fruity and fermented off-tastes. The water used for washing, as for all the stages of processing, should be clean to ensure the quality of the end product. Unclean water or water contaminated with ne silt, and recirculated water with a high solid content, could cause earthy, fruity or fermented and other off-tastes. Causes of mouldy and faded beans and impact of improper drying and storage: During the preparation of natural robusta, spreading the cherries in thick layers with no or inadequate stirring and raking could result in mould formation. This can adversely affect the visual appearance and the cup quality of the cherry beans. Lack of protection from rain and night dew during drying can also cause mould growth. For more on this go to chapter 12, Quality control issues. The fading (of the colour) of coffee and the cup being described as stale could be the result of inadequate drying facilities, storage of beans with a high moisture content, or the storage of well dried coffee in improperly ventilated warehouses. Stale cups can also be caused by improper storage on the farm, at the curing factory or at warehouses awaiting sale. Storage of coffee on the drying yards, inadequate covering of coffee
stacks, poorly ventilated warehouses, or stacking coffee in a haphazard manner up to the ceiling of the warehouse can all cause a stale off-taste to develop in the cup. Spicy and chemical off-tastes could be due to packaging in poor quality bags or bags in which spices or fertilizers have been packed earlier. Storing coffee with spices, chemicals, fertilizers or fungicides could also cause these off-tastes. Remember that coffee beans readily absorb taints and odours that could lower their aromatic quality and, therefore, value.
206
Fine and special, where the liquor quality is soft, smooth and buttery, with good body, hardly any bitterness, and clean. This quality can be seen in robusta coffees which are washed and processed with care, in robusta beans grown at high altitudes and under shade, and in plant strains with the inherent characteristics of lower caffeine content, softness and mellow avour notes. Good, where the liquor quality could be described as good body, neutral, light bitterness and clean, with a hint of chocolate notes. Average, with a cup quality of fair body, fair neutrality, average bitterness and clean. Below average, where the liquor, though of fair body, has harsh notes of the robusta fruit, is bitter though clean, and is at with no avour notes. Poor, a cup which is unclean, having medicinal, phenolic or rioy off-notes, or strong harsh robusta notes, with or without body, bitter and unpleasant to the taste. What has been said above is not a universal methodology followed by all robusta producing origins. It is only a means to explain the quality attributes that could be encountered in a robusta cup and the manner in which these attributes could be classied. Individual buyers have their own classication and evaluation methods, but usually the attributes and ratings will be comparable to those above. See also chapter 1, World coffee trade.
Bean size could, to an extent, inuence the price that is paid for a consignment of coffee. Large sized beans roast well and could have a better cup prole, provided the processing has been carried out carefully and correctly. Broken beans, on the other hand, could result not only in a high roasting loss, but also in charring of the beans and a poor cup quality. Many robusta producing origins sell their coffee based on the size of the beans and a permissible tolerance to defects, with a classication of AA or grade/ type I and so on, each grade denoting the size of the beans and a measured tolerance of certain imperfections. The defect count is the measured presence or absence of defects such as blacks, browns, greens, faded and bleached beans, insect damaged beans, pulper cuts, stinkers, sour beans and extraneous matter such as twigs, sticks or stones. The presence of defects could lower the value of coffee; their absence could result in a premium. Cupping or cup quality would be the nal determining factor for purchase or rejection of a consignment and for determining the price. The presence of defects could result in an unclean cup and thus lower the cup quality and price.
Steam cleaning
The steam treatment of coffee was developed by Professor Karl Lendrich, and was patented in Germany in 1933. Briey, the process was developed with the objective to make coffee more acceptable to certain consumers who were reporting varying degrees of stomach discomfort when drinking regular coffee. The discussion as to exactly which chemical components of the coffee bean were/are responsible for this is ongoing, but mild or stomachfriendly coffees have been a regular feature of the German market ever since. Germany is the typical and possibly only signicant market for this kind of product. The original procedure consists of a relatively gentle steamtreatment lasting between 30 and 60 minutes during which the beans undergo chemical and physical changes. It is mostly, if not only, used on arabica where it reduces certain acids and also causes certain taste changes. In recent years, steam treatment has increasingly been used to treat robusta because it was found that steam-treated robusta coffees were milder and could even develop some acidity. This rst became of interest during periods of high coffee prices when the price difference between arabica and robusta made it attractive to include a certain percentage of steam treated robusta in a blend. However, this type of steam treatment is more severe in that higher temperatures are applied for longer periods. The end result of the harsher treatment results in a different taste experience and it is unlikely such coffees will be used to any great extent in high quality blends. It is difcult to estimate the extent to which steam treated coffees are being used except to say that the never ending
207
quest to reduce costs will certainly keep this process under the spotlight, especially when coffee prices are high. There are no statistics available as to actual usage, but trade sources suggest it is growing. It is worth noting as well that further research has shown that certain phenolic compounds (causing off-avours or taints) can also be reduced or eliminated through steamtreatment or steam cleaning. This then makes it possible to clean coffees that otherwise would not have been useable, to a useable standard. Therefore, if for example the price difference between arabica and robusta was to narrow substantially, then the steam cleaning of certain arabicas could also become a regular feature.
bereiding or WIB (West Indian preparation, or pulped)], have been very popular. Some have earned the status of being described as exemplary coffees. Increasing consumer awareness of the attractions of top quality robustas will in itself also help to promote such coffees. Quality robusta can be used in the preparation of todays coffee beverages. Clean and fresh, strong bodied, neutral, with hardly any acidity and with an undercurrent of chocolate and malt notes, unwashed robustas can be used in the making of espresso, canned or liquid coffee, and regular or lter coffees. Well washed, soft robustas provide the aromatic crema for strong espresso, provided they do not show fresh or fruity tastes that can be unpleasantly accentuated by the espresso extraction process. High-quality washed robusta coffees are excellent for fortication of milk-based drinks such as cappuccino and caf latte, and as a component of high caffeine blends. However, there are different tasting requirements when using arabica or robusta in espresso. The concentrated espresso cup exaggerates certain sensory aspects, not always positively. Only well-matured and absolutely clean cupping coffees can be considered, and their suitability can only denitively be established by submitting the sample to actual espresso extraction. See also chapter 12.
208
Additionally the Coffee Quality Institute (CQI www. coffeeinstitute.org) has since early 2010 been working on the proling of specialty robusta coffee (or ne robustas), thus providing further proof of the renewed interest in premium robusta coffees. To date, the projects main conclusion has been that selectively harvested and correctly processed robustas, both washed and natural, offer taste proles that can be differentiated by their country and area of origin. Provided such coffees are correctly roasted (the robusta bean is harder than arabica, making the roasting process more difcult to manage) the cupping characteristics can yield scores of 80+ points on a 100-point scale. The main taste difference between premium and commercial grade robustas is that premium robustas have a high sweet aspect (versus a low bitter aspect), whereas commercial grade robusta usually shows the exact opposite. The main obstacle to improved robusta quality, and therefore pricing, is the presence of defects that so often debase the cup quality to the minimum acceptable, which is the commercial grade product. Quality standards and quality controls for premium robustas therefore have to be of the same level as required for premium arabicas. See also chapter 12. Bringing about fundamental change in the way the market perceives premium robustas requires both a radically different approach to robusta quality by producers, and high-level promotion of ne robusta to the market at large. This has been done since 1999 for specialty arabicas through the Cup of Excellence initiative. Details at www.cupofexcellence.org.
CHAPTER 12
QUALITY CONTROL
QUALITY CONTROL ISSUES .............................................................................................................................210 ICO MINIMUM EXPORT STANDARDS...............................................................................................................210 ISO QUALITY SYSTEMS .....................................................................................................................................210 HAZARD ANALYSIS CRITICAL CONTROL POINTS WHAT IS IT? ...............................................................211 HACCP: HOW TO MANAGE?..............................................................................................................................212 HACCP AND THE UNITED STATES: FOOD SAFETY AND BIOTERRORISM .................................................212 POTENTIAL HAZARDS ........................................................................................................................................213 MOULD PREVENTION OTA..............................................................................................................................215 COFFEE TASTING (LIQUORING).......................................................................................................................218 CLASSIFICATION TERMS...................................................................................................................................223
210
QUALITY CONTROL
QUALITY CONTROL ISSUES
Quality control is essential, not only because of pricing considerations (better quality equals better price), but also to ensure that exports conform to food safety legislation in major import markets. It also helps to reduce waste and loss during the harvesting, processing and drying of coffee, and plays a role in the general move towards more sustainability in the coffee industry. Quality control at the primary (farm gate) level can assume different forms: Government or coffee authorities attempt to police harvesting, on-farm processing and drying. This is costly in terms of qualied staff and does not have a good track record. Penalties are imposed for lower than average quality. This is passive quality control: it does nothing to encourage better than minimal or average quality. Premiums are offered for better than average quality. This is active quality control: it rewards and encourages the production of better quality. It can be combined with a refusal to purchase lower quality but this does leave open the question of what then happens to such coffees. Different producing countries have differing quality control systems and attach differing values to certain aspects of quality. General information on coffee quality standards can be found at www.iso.org (for instance, ISO 10470, a draft defect chart, but there are also many other ISO standards of interest to coffee exporters, including one detailing correct sampling procedures look under ICS 67.140.20 Coffee and coffee substitutes). Information is also available from coffee authorities in producing countries. When setting quality limits one should recognize that without active quality control, such as paying premiums for better quality, the maximum permissible limit (on defects, for instance) quickly becomes the new standard. And when setting export taxes, care should be taken not to penalize producers of better quality who manage to obtain premium prices as a result of their effort. brought calls for the lowest qualities to be eliminated from the market altogether, and the ICO Council passed a resolution to this effect. Resolution 407 introduced mandatory minimum standards for coffee exports in February 2002, but this proved to be unenforceable so it was subsequently amended by Resolution 420 (May 2004), which recommends voluntary targets for the minimum quality export standards for both arabica and robusta. The objective remains to halt the export of substandard beans, thereby tightening supply lines in the expectation this will help lift prices. The ICOs Coffee Quality-Improvement Programme calls on producing members to endeavour to restrict the export of arabica coffee with more than 86 defects per 300 g sample or robusta coffee with more than 150 defects per 300 g. The programme also asks members to endeavour not to allow arabica or robusta of any grade to be exported whose moisture content is below 8% or above 12.5%, with the proviso that this should not affect established, good and accepted commercial practice. Thus, where moisture percentages below 12.5% are currently being achieved, exporters should endeavour to maintain or decrease these. It is accepted that specialty coffees that traditionally have a high moisture content, such as Indian monsooned coffees, are exempt, but Resolution 420 of 21 May 2004 (see www. ico.org) requires all producers to clearly identify on the Certicate of Origin any coffee which does not come up to the recommended standard. For the rst six months of 2011 the ICO reported that 23 exporting members, accounting for nearly 40 million bags or over 72% of all exports during that period, provided information on the quality of the coffee they exported. Of these exports nearly 36 million bags (90%) were classied as being within the resolutions defects and moisture targets. The split was 92% arabica and 8% robusta.
211
When an organizations quality management system complies with ISO 9001 and when the coffee is processed in accordance with these procedures, then the quality management system (not the product) can be ISO 9001 certied. During cultivation too many variables (weather, diseases, pests) are beyond the control of the producer. This is why in the case of green coffee the process in the ISO system starts when the cherry is picked, and ends when the container is delivered to the ships side. This can work for estate coffee that is exported under its own name, but is less easy to apply to smallholder coffee because numerous small deliveries to collection points or washing stations automatically lose their identity. And blended coffee shipped in bulk gains an identity only upon loading. Nevertheless, good harvesting and processing standards are essential to maintain quality, and ISO 9001 provides those who process their own coffee for export with identication and traceability for all the coffee produced. The batch number can lead back to the day of picking, where on the farm, what the weather was then, how long it took to dry the coffee, how well it was dried, and a number of other variables all useful information in determining the cause of any quality problems that may subsequently arise. Perhaps none of this provides any immediate or direct economic advantage, but estate growers using the system say they have become better processors and are better able to provide the sort of quality guarantees that the larger commercial roasters demand. For current details go to www.iso.org and look for ISO 9001. However, by themselves these ICO and ISO objectives do not provide answers to the ever more stringent food safety legislation being introduced at the consumer end, and the potential impact of this on coffee exporters. But ISO 22000 incorporates the requirements of the hazard analysis critical control points (HACCP) system developed by the Codex Alimentarius Commission. HACCP has increasingly become a mandatory requirement in the markets of various countries since the 1990s, most notably for non-farm food businesses in the EU since January 2006. As ISO 22000 is an auditable standard, certied companies can demonstrate their compliance to HACCP Certication to ISO 22000 could . facilitate acceptance by global food retailers, as it also covers the requirements of key standards developed by various global food retailer systems. Tools on ISO 22000 and ISO 9001 have been developed by the International Trade Centre and are available on the Internet: see www.intracen.org/eqm and go to quality management. HB 17 ISO 22000 Food Safety Management Systems An easy-to-use checklist for small business Are you ready? is a software-based self-diagnostic tool on ISO 22000 (published in 2007). The tool helps small businesses operating in the food chain to understand the regulatory requirements for food safety and to make an assessment of their readiness to implement ISO 22000 and obtain some preliminary guidance on applying the standard.
212
3. Establish preventative measures with critical limits (values) for each control point, such as a minimum drying time to ensure mould growth cannot progress. 4. Establish procedures to monitor the critical control points (e.g. how to ensure that adequate drying occurs). 5. Establish corrective actions to be taken when monitoring shows that a critical limit has not been met, such as disposing of potentially contaminated cherry. 6. Establish procedures to verify that the system is working properly. For example, test drying facilities for leaks or contamination. 7. Establish effective record keeping for documenting the HACCP system, such as records of hazards and control methods, the monitoring of safety requirements and actions taken to correct potential problems.
tries to make all-round improvements. GAP is easier to set up but does not necessarily zero in on the most important steps that inuence the occurrence or avoidance of toxins in coffee. See www.fda.gov and search under Food H HACCP for a good introduction to the subject. See also under Resources at www.coffee-ota.org for presentations on HACCP in the coffee chain with particular reference to the prevention of OTA. The two processes are complimentary in that GAP will improve coffee quality, whereas HACCP will provide the type of disciplined monitoring and control that supermarket chains and food manufacturers increasingly demand. More importantly, it is only through the HACCP process that one can establish where OTA enters the system and where the fungi causing OTA rst appear. This is essential if one is to meet EU and presumably in due course also United States requirements for the reduction and prevention of OTA contamination. The World Trade Organization (WTO) offers a searchable database of member governments measures related to the Sanitary and Phytosanitary (SPS) Agreement, thus making it easier to nd out about other countries food safety requirements and alerts. The SPS Information Management System (SPS IMS) allows users to search and obtain information on measures that member governments have submitted to the WTO. These include notications concerning new export and food safety requirements, specic trade concerns that governments have raised, documents of the WTOs sanitary and phytosanitary measures committee, details of the authorities who handle notications and, particularly useful for those seeking information, member governments national enquiry contacts. The SPS Information Management System is available at http://spsims.wto.org. The site also offers a gateway into the SPS portal itself. The International Portal on Food Safety, Animal and Plant Health IPFSAPH is an alternative source. With over 35,000 records, the data sets incorporated into www.ipfsaph. org include WTOs SPS Information Management System (containing all WTO trade notications and concerns) and IAEAs Clearance of Irradiated Foods Database.
213
exposure to insect infestation in the eld, and be free of all chemical and other contamination including mould and live insects. Insect damage by itself, pinholes for example, exceeding 10% may also lead to rejection. The Green Coffee Association (GCA) contracts routinely contain the clause no pass no sale, which puts the responsibility for passing the FDA inspection rmly on the exporter. Different events have in recent years catapulted both domestic and imported food security into top priority in the United States, with consequent strengthening of FDA surveillance of imported foods. This is visibly demonstrated by much stricter FDA and customs inspection of coffee containers and even coffee samples, and the distribution of an FDA Food Security Preventative Measures Guidance circular to food importing operations. These measures also include a large track and trace element. For more information on all this and FDA coffee regulations go to www.fda.gov and look for the New FDA Food Safety Modernization Act (FSMA) that was signed into law on 4 January 2011. Also, ask for the information booklet, Health, Safety and Security in the Importation of Green Coffee into the United States from the National Coffee Association of USA, Inc. www. ncausa.org. The Public Health Security and Bioterrorism Preparedness and Response Act requires all facilities engaged in the manufacturing, processing, packing or holding food for consumption in the United States to be registered with the FDA. This includes all exporters of coffee or for that matter any other primary commodity exporting to the United States and some processing plants. This information needs to be updated each time there is a change. The regulations and much related information can be found on www.fda.gov/ Food/FoodDefense/Bioterrorism. The main point at issue here is that food shipments from unregistered suppliers are subject to refusal of admission into the United States. This includes coffee! A fact sheet is available at www.ncausa.org whereas related information (on shipping security) is also available in chapter 5.
HACCP system it is recommended to envisage measures for mycotoxins in general. Information on mycotoxins has been drawn from industry experts, from the ndings of the ICO-FAO project The enhancement of coffee quality by prevention of mould growth, and the 2001 book Coffee Futures published by CABI Commodities, ISBN 958-332356-X. The initial contamination of coffee with OTA takes place through spores in the air and in the ground. These spores may produce a mould, but only if the right circumstances (humidity and temperature) prevail. The importance of proper moisture management throughout the entire processing and supply chain cannot be overemphasized. Farmers, middlemen and exporters should also be aware that in a shipment of coffee OTA contamination (mould) may be very localized, making sampling extremely complex. Careful inspection of visual appearance and any mouldy or earthy smells can be a useful tool for checking. Pesticide residues in coffee have only very rarely exceeded the limit values so far, but this does not mean that their monitoring is not a vital aspect of an HACCP system. It is absolutely essential that coffee growers maintain chemical registers that detail, in chronological order, the type and quantities of all chemicals used and the timing of their application. Only chemicals that have been approved for use on coffee may be used and then only within the withholding limits specied by the manufacturers. Exporters and shipping lines must ensure only clean containers are used, thus avoiding cross-contamination by previous cargoes. Go to www.fao.org and search for the Draft Code of Hygienic Practice for the Transport of Foodstuffs in Bulk and Semi-Packed Foodstuffs of the Codex Alimentarius Commission. Hydrocarbon contamination is usually caused by jute coffee bags because of the batching oil used to soften the jute bres before spinning. There have been instances of contaminated oil being used (old engine oil for example). The International Jute Organization has established specications (IJO Standard 98/01) for the manufacture of jute bags to be used in the food industry see www.jute.org. Analytical criteria. Ingredients used as batching oils must be non-toxic and approved for use in packaging materials that will come into contact with food. Batching oils must not contain compounds that could produce offavours or off-tastes in food packed in jute or sisal bags. Chemical criteria. The amount of unsaponiable compounds (which cannot be converted into soap by boiling with alkali) shall be less than 1,250 mg/kg. The method described in British Standard 3845:1990 is recommended for the determination of the added oil content of jute yarn, rove and fabric. Method 2.401 of the International Union of Pure and Applied Chemistry (IUPAC) is recommended for determining unsaponiable matter.
POTENTIAL HAZARDS
MYCOTOXINS, RESIDUES, CONTAMINATION
Mycotoxins are caused by contamination by some naturally occurring moulds. Not every type of mould produces mycotoxins. Mycotoxins are selective in the sense that a given type of mycotoxin occurs in specic foodstuffs: aatoxins in peanuts, grains and milk; patulin in apple juice; OTA in grains, grapes and derived products, beans and pulses, cocoa, coffee and others. OTA is the most relevant mycotoxin for coffee, but in the framework of an
214
Organoleptic criteria. Jute bags shall be analysed for their olfactory qualities. No undesirable odours, or odour untypical of jute, shall be present. No unacceptable odours shall develop after articial ageing of the sacks. The ageing procedure to be followed shall be the one described in European Standard EN 766 for use on sacks for the transport of food. To read the EU Packaging and Packaging Waste Directive (PPWD) go to www.eur-lex.europa.eu and search for Directive 62 of 1994 (94/62/EC). Subsequent changes and a consolidated version dated 20 April 2009 are found under the Bibliographic Notice. Organizations and private companies in India and Bangladesh have developed a hydrocarbon-free lubricant, based on vegetable oil, to soften the jute bre. It is a nontoxic, biodegradable oil, and bags made with it can be classied as food grade bags. However, the fact that vegetable oil is used for batching is in itself not sufcient. The oil used must be stable and may not turn rancid.
look for product reference 0620000 for the list of MRLs currently applicable to coffee beans. The website also provides the latest updates to the MRL database. Other information sites are: www.ec.europa.eu/food/plant/ protection/pesticides/index_en.htm and www.ec.europa.eu/ food/plant/protection/pesticides/legislation_en.htm. See also the site of the European Food Safety Authority at www.efsa. europa.eu. EU regulations quote permissible MRLs per kilogram whereas other countries/systems may express such limits in terms of, for example, parts per million or per billion. The comparison below is provided for ease of reference.
A mass concentration of A mass concentration of 2 mg/kg = 2 ppm 2 g/kg = 2 ppb
mg = milligram; g = microgram; ppb = parts per billion; ppm = parts per million.
OBSOLETE PESTICIDES
When developed countries prohibit the use of dangerous chemicals a logical question arises: what to do about existing stocks in developing countries? Over time stocks have accumulated worldwide of banned chemicals and pesticides, some of which are Persistent Organic Pollutants or POPs. Banning apart, these substances also become obsolete through ageing, rendering them less effective (past sell-by date) but no less unsafe. They may be left over from pest control campaigns or simply stay around because they are not wanted anymore.
The condition of obsolete pesticide stocks and waste can vary from well-stored products that could still be used, to products leaking from corroded drums and other containers into the soil. Disposal is sometimes attempted by dumping in pits or burning and covering with soil. Over time severe environmental harm in the form of soil and water pollution often permanent may occur. Storage sites are often unsupervised and pose severe health risks, particularly to children. Previous WHO estimates have suggested as many as 3 million people are poisoned by pesticides annually, most of them in developing countries.
215
There is also the risk that without formal cleanup and prevention measures, obsolete pesticides may be repackaged and reappear in the market under different names. Many are very persistent which, health and environmental hazards aside, also makes them effective as pesticides for long periods and renders them attractive for illegal resale. Safe disposal requires sophisticated technology that, mostly, is not available in poorer developing countries. The quantities to be disposed of may however not warrant the establishment of such facilities in individual countries. In many cases this then leaves export to approved disposal facilities elsewhere as the best option. Not only are the costs of this extremely high, ranging from US$ 3,000/ton to US$ 5,000/ton, but the material to be disposed of is not homogeneous. There is therefore no blanket solution for the disposal of obsolete pesticides. It is clear though that unless the issue is properly addressed, future generations in affected countries will continue to suffer the consequences of illegal disposal of these substances, many of which are used in agriculture. Coffee producing countries worldwide are not immune from this. Different products may have been used in the past that are now prohibited and whose safe disposal presents not only safety and logistical problems, but is also very expensive. Illegal repackaging and resale could cause enormous problems whereas contamination into export crops is a real possibility. Condemnation of a countrys green coffee exports for containing residues of such substances would have very serious, long-term economic consequences. In Africa alone it is estimated that there could be as much as 50,000 tons of obsolete pesticides. In response to requests for assistance from many African countries, the Africa Stockpiles Programme (ASP) was therefore created to help address issues around the identication, safeguarding, removal and safe disposal of obsolete pesticides, and to prevent future accumulation. Initially targeted at seven priority countries (as of early 2009) with more countries to be added in due course. Some of the international organizations partnering with developing country governments in ASP include the Food and Agricultural Organization of the UN, the World Bank, The World Wide Fund for Nature, the Global Environment Facility, the African Development Bank, the Pesticides Action Network (PAN UK), and CropLife International. To note that some trade pesticide products do not necessarily indicate the active ingredients by name, making it difcult to identify them correctly. However, a useful comparison table of Pesticides Prohibited and Restricted in Coffee Standards was prepared by PAN UK in 2011 and is available on request from the 4C Coffee Association www.4c-coffeeassociation. org. The table lists a number of products by their active ingredient. See also www.africastockpiles.net and agriculture/crops/obsolete_pesticides/en/. www.fao.org/
216
The destination has been agreed with the feed or food business operator responsible for the consignment; The feed or food business operator has rst informed the competent authority of the third country of origin or third country of destination, if different, of the reasons and circumstances preventing the placing on the market of the feed or food concerned within the Community; When the third country of destination is not the country of origin, the competent authority of the third country of destination has notied the competent authority of its preparedness to accept the consignment. Logically then, failure or inability to re-export will result in destruction of a rejected consignment. Hence it is entirely possible that in time the well-known United States contract condition no pass no sale could also be introduced for coffees shipped to Europe and elsewhere. To note also that it is prohibited to mix foodstuffs complying with the maximum levels with foodstuffs exceeding these maximum limits. This does not affect green coffee for which there are no maximum limits, but would mean that it would not be permissible to mix equal volumes of, for example, roasted coffee containing 7 ppb of OTA with roasted coffee containing 2 ppb to achieve an average of 4.5 ppb. Visit www.ecf-coffee.org and look under publications for extensive, practical information on OTA as an issue in the production and trading of green coffee, including details of relevant legislation on OTA in the European Union. Visit www.coffee-ota.org for more extensive coverage and click on Training Tool for presentations on HACCP and the prevention of OTA along the coffee chain, including a CD-ROM version. For an overview of European Food Law generally go to www. ec.europa.eu/food/food/foodlaw/index_en.htm. In the United States the presence of OTA in agricultural products is one of a number of food safety aspects that receive routine attention at the FDA. Although the FDA monitors for contaminants, including mould, based on a risk assessment analysis no specic guidelines exist concerning OTA levels in coffee products.
Studies have shown that the most important sources of OTA contamination in green coffee are (i) inadequate sun drying of cherries leading to OTA formation in the pods and parchment husks, and (ii) defectives (including black beans), pods and husks (and dust). The drying stage is the most favourable time for the development of OTA. Adequate drying to uniformly low moisture levels and avoiding local wet spots, caused for example by uneven drying, rewetting or condensation, is crucial in prevention. Simple and cheap devices for solar drying of coffee can be of great help in improving drying practices, including prevention of rewetting by rain or dew. Tests have also shown that the presence of an earthy/mouldy smell in green coffee is an early indicator of the presence of mould damage. Not every mould is OTA-forming, but an earthy smell (or cup) should trigger further investigation. Similarly, visually clean coffees that show no visible damage (rewetted bags/beans, broken beans, insect-damaged beans) are very much less likely to be signicantly contaminated. The use of green coffee with a higher contamination level than 15 ppb is not recommended. Given a reduction of OTA contamination through processing of 2/3rd (this is a conservative gure, used to be on the safe side as the actual reduction may be higher), green coffee with a contamination level of less than 15 ppb can reasonably be expected not to present any problem in the nished coffee. The preventative steps listed in this section apply as much to wet processed coffees as they do to dry processed (natural) arabica and robusta. Good housekeeping is essential. Prevention is currently the only available effective way at farm level to combat OTA, although it should be noted that the removal of mouldy cherry, or the reprocessing of mouldy coffee, does not guarantee that the clean bean will be free from micro particles or spores. Visit www.coffee-ota.org for an overview of research work done and in progress. Visit also www.ecf-coffee.org and look under Publications for extensive, practical information on OTA as an issue in the production and trading of green coffee.
OTA IN COFFEE
In coffee OTA is produced by fungi of the Aspergillus genus (A. ochraceus, A. carbonarius, A. niger). It is mostly concentrated in the husk, which suggests that naturals (coffees dried in the cherry) are most at risk of contamination. Identied factors affecting mycotoxin levels in the coffee chain include: Environmental factors: temperature, moisture, mechanical injury (insect or bird damage, micro-organisms); Harvesting factors: crop maturity, temperature, moisture; Primary processing: drying, removal of defects; Storage: temperature, moisture; Distribution and processing: condensation.
217
Do not buy or process wet coffee. If you must, then keep it separate and dry it immediately and correctly. Keep equipment and buildings clean. Do not allow dust and husk to accumulate and so contaminate clean (green) coffee. Ensure clean coffee contains no husk; more than 90% of mould originates from the husk of sun-dried cherry. Remove also dust, mouldy beans, unhulled cherries (pods) and so forth. Avoid adding husk or pods on purpose (in order to reach a maximum permitted defect level in the specication). Use only clean, dry bags for storage. Always keep cleaned coffee in a separate area, well closed off from the hulling area and the waste husk disposal site. Ideally moisture content should be even throughout. Use correctly calibrated moisture meters and ensure all meters are recalibrated at the start of each season, preferably more often. See also chapter 11. The risk of fungi growth is at its strongest when coffee is stored with a moisture content of over 12.5% (ISO 6673) and at high temperatures (over 25 C). Cover bags during transport to avoid any chance of rewetting. Load and ofoad only during dry weather or under cover. Store in well-ventilated, leak-proof warehouses. Always store away from walls and on pallets to allow ventilation and avoid storm water damage. Obvious indicators of potential OTA presence in green coffee include wet or mouldy bags or beans, the presence of husks and pods, an earthy or mouldy smell, and earthy notes in the cup itself. But, OTA has also been found in completely clean coffee. The ICO agreed method of moisture content analysis is ISO standard 6673; heating at 105 C during 16 hours, or moisture measuring equipment calibrated to the same standard. The sampling method referred to in ISO 6673 is ISO 4072. For details go to www.iso.org or www.ecf-coffee. org publications. Websites where information on moisture meters can be obtained include www.sinar.co.uk, www.farmcomp./index. php?id=56, www.enercorp.com, www.agric.gov.ab.ca/ index.html (search for moisture meters), www.decagon. com/aqualab/ and www.aqua-boy.co.uk. www.coffee-ota.org has extensive coverage on all aspects of the OTA issue.
218
fungi growth occurring becomes unacceptably high. Under ICO minimum export standards, the only exceptions could be specialty coffees that traditionally have a high moisture content, such as Indian monsooned coffees. This is not to suggest that a moisture content of 12.5% is commercially acceptable for all coffee for certain coffees, certain origins and certain buyers it is denitely not. The gure of 12.5% simply represents a known technical point at which the risk of damage from condensation and growth of mould during storage and transport becomes unacceptably high. Shippers who normally ship their coffee at moisture percentages below 12.5% should denitely continue to do so. An increasing number of buyers now include a maximum permissible moisture content in purchasing contracts. Increasing preoccupations with food health and hygiene in consuming countries suggest strongly that exporters will be well advised to acquaint themselves with their buyers requirements in this regard.
Experience shows that most of the condensation problems encountered during maritime transport are caused at origin (containers are stuffed too early ahead of actual shipment, or not properly lined), or immediately after ofoading (particularly for containers arriving in winter). It is therefore of utmost importance to limit both transit times and the dwell or intermediate storage periods and land legs of the transit as much as possible.
BLENDING
Most roasted coffee sold is blended. Usually only specialty coffee roasters offer straight coffees, i.e. exclusively from individual origins and mostly at very high prices. However, the authors do not share the belief held by some that blended coffees are necessarily always inferior to straight origin coffees; it all depends on what the blend consists of,
219
and at which market segment it is aimed. There are blended coffees that easily outclass some of the straight origin coffees one nds on the average retail shelf. To clarify the practice of blending it is important to note again that the global market for coffee consists of three broad quality segments: Exemplary quality: Coffees with a high intrinsic value because of their ne or unique cup quality (taste). Usually of quite limited availability and mostly retailed under straight origin or estate names. Because by their nature exemplary coffees are of limited availability their adherents usually know this and accept that their favourite coffee may not always be available, and may not taste exactly the same from year to year. Limited availability translates into high prices, i.e. a marketing advantage. High quality or premium brands: Good tasting coffees well presented but not necessarily visually perfect. Retailed both as straight origins and as blends. This quality band is much broader and includes a good number of todays specialty coffees. It is also produced by leading multinational coffee companies and marketed through supermarkets. High-quality or premium brands are expected to be available always, and to taste the same, also always. Therefore, for such a coffee to be marketed as a straight origin, the supply must be large enough to be offered throughout the year. If not, then the only option is to create the required quality from the mixing, the blending of a number of compatible coffees that, between them, can offer year-round availability. Mainstream quality: Coffees of average quality, reasonably well presented, but certainly not imperfect. It offers an average taste experience and probably accounts for over 90% of the world market. Mainstream coffees are produced, traded and roasted in large quantities. Most are blends for two main reasons: large roasters cannot rely on just one or two origins for security of supply, and more often than not, consumer tastes in different markets cannot be satised by just a single origin in any case. To summarize: Blending a number of compatible coffees creates a taste or avour prole that can be maintained, also when individual origin availability changes. If subsequently a particular coffee is not available then it is replaced by another (or others), always maintaining an unchanged taste prole. Blending broadens the roasters choice of raw material and so enhances supply security; availability does not depend on a single origin only. Also, coffee is available when needed. Blending aims to maintain the preferred taste or avour prole at the lowest possible cost. This means that coffees are interchanged, not only on the basis of quality but also on the basis of their cost. The more exible the blend the greater the money saving possibilities, a fact that unfortunately at times clashes with the quality requirements, especially in the lower end of the market.
220
the scale we nd the erosion of blend quality, for example when quality is sacriced because of higher prices or lack of availability. Whatever the market, for an exporter the most important point to bear in mind is that having established a prole that a particular buyer accepts and uses, each and every subsequent delivery should be a full match. If at some stage this proves to be impossible then advise the buyer of the problem, openly and honestly. Never simply ship such a coffee and hope to get away with it.
different origins separately and then to combine them afterwards. Strong growth in the specialty and whole bean segments of the consumer market has rekindled the emphasis on a coffees roast appearance, and at the retail end the roast is perhaps the rst thing the consumer really looks at.
THE ROAST
Coffee quality is assessed in terms of the green appearance, the roast appearance and by taste (cup or liquor). The green appearance is discussed extensively in chapter 11. Coffee quality is greatly inuenced by the roasting process. Dark roasts tend to obscure the ner aspects but enhance the body. Light roasts emphasize acidity but result in a weaker brew. See chapter 11 for the Agtron system of roast colour measurements. The degree of roasting depends therefore on ones marketing objectives. From the professional tasters point of view, it is easier to detect quality and any off-avours when coffee is roasted lighter rather than darker. A light roast also makes it easier to spot immature and green beans, which tend to show up as yellowish pale in colour rather than brown when roasted. All pales affect the cup quality, but extreme cases of pales (bright yellow beans) spoil the cup by giving it a quakery or peanut taste. The roast of naturals (sun-dried coffees) tends to lack the bright whitish centre cuts of wet-processed arabicas. In general, dull roasts also suggest imperfectly processed or aged coffees, whereas bright roasts indicate freshness and good processing. The following descriptions are commonly used: Fine roast. Bright, brilliant, uniform and even, no pales. Good to ne. Bright, uniform, even, no pales. Good roast. Bright to dullish, reasonably even, occasional pale, no other defects such as ears or brokens. Good to fair. Dullish, slightly uneven, mottled, a few pales and other defects, can be soft and open. Fair to poor. Dull and uneven, a number of pales and other defects, generally soft and open, often containing many brokens. Poor. Anything below fair to poor. Uneven bean size produces uneven roasts because small, broken and light beans roast faster than whole and solid beans. Very small pieces or chips may even burn up altogether. Some roasters prefer to roast coffees from
221
tend to combine good body with a sweeter cup than is found in traditional Brazils that are dried in the cherry. These coffees are making inroads into the traditional market for secondary mild arabicas.
a correct evaluation of a coffees suitability for use as espresso. The steps before tasting the liquid coffee are always the same (examining the green and the roast, smelling the ground coffee and so on). For traditional tasting, about 10 g of ground coffee is brewed in cups containing about 230 g of boiling water. This is not a scientic process: the water temperature may vary, the weight is not always exactly 10 g and the water measure may not always be exactly right. The temperature of the water changes as the cups are poured and so on. But experienced cup testers know all this and so will taste more than a single cup per sample. They may also taste the sample various times. In the end it is the cup testers personal assessment of all the different factors and sensations that determines what they will do with the sample in question. In real life consumers do not use a scientic process to prepare or evaluate their coffee either. They like it or they do not, and it is the cup testers job to make sure they do. But this method does not work for espresso. The espresso cup is a concentrated beverage, which can be said to exaggerate all the aromas, and fragrances found in the coffee bean. Unlike the traditional coffee served in many bars and hotels, espresso must always be fresh. It can only be made on demand. The customer has to wait for the coffee, not the other way around. It was the desire to supply many cups of fresh coffee quickly and efciently that led to a major innovation for traditional brewing systems. Italian inventors introduced the use of water pressure to speed up the extraction process. Today, making espresso is a mixture of art and science. Italy is home to a large and fast-growing manufacturing and export business not only of espresso machines and all the accompanying accessories, but also of espresso coffee roasted and packed in Italy. Names such as Illy and Lavazza are but two of many found all over the world; they are even found in producing countries. The introduction of the espresso pod (pre-packed dosages of coffee ready for use as is in the espresso machine), the growth of specialty coffee chains such as Starbucks, and increasingly efcient mini espresso machines for home use have all contributed to Italys spectacular growth as a coffee processing and exporting centre.
222
acidity turns into bitterness, freshness or slight fruitiness turns into sourness and fruity turns into fermented because all the avour components are extracted. And this is not all; espresso is nearly always sugared, and the interaction of sugar and these intense avours can again alter the nal taste palette the taster encounters. Some avours benet, others are turned and become negative. For example, a pleasant tasting coffee that is slightly winey may be eminently suitable for sale as an exemplary quality in a niche market. But it will probably never make the grade for espresso, because once concentrated, the same winey avour may turn into something quite unpleasant. The other aspect to bear in mind is the foam or crema that is always present in every well made cup of espresso. Briey, the machine pressure is allowed to drop, which permits the cup to be lled. The drop in pressure releases dissolved gases into the cup and this is what produces the foam. The foam must survive at least a few minutes before breaking up and starting to show the dark surface of the liquid itself. A perfect espresso looks as good as it tastes. Some coffees produce excellent foam; others do not. Most espresso coffee is therefore a blend of different coffees that together produce the desired combination of both taste and cup appearance. Green coffee exporters wanting to supply the important espresso market on a sustained basis must familiarize themselves with the differences between their traditional cupping and the basics of espresso liquoring. Better still, they should practice espresso liquoring alongside their traditional cupping by acquiring the necessary equipment.
information to communicate quality to customers and consumers, fostering their interest in the coffee you offer. On the basis that sustainability begins with economic viability, the promoters of the Q Coffee System argue that it takes a market-based approach to economic viability, and therefore sustainability, by giving producers a tool to improve their incomes. The Q Coffee System also places roasters in a proactive position regarding responsible sourcing as opposed to a defensive one. Thus, the Q is a valuable component of corporate social responsibility programmes and an ideal complement to social and environmental certications. Only with quality and cooperation can sustainability truly become a reality. The Q Coffee System is presented visually below, reproduced courtesy of the Coffee Quality Institute from whom more information can be obtained see www.coffeeinstitute.org.
223
Blackish beans: Pulper-nipped beans which have partly oxidized. Bleached beans: Colourless beans, often caused by drying too rapidly or over-drying. Also known as soapy and faded beans, usually associated with mechanical drying. Blotchy beans: The result of uneven drying. Broca-damaged beans: Beans partially eaten away by an insect (Stephanoderes hampei) which bores galleries through the bean. Brown beans: Brown in colour. May be caused by faulty fermentation, improper washing or over drying see also foxy. Coated beans: Beans to which the silverskin adheres. Caused by drought, over-bearing or harvesting of unripe cherries (see also chapter 11). Crushed beans: Pulper-damaged beans, which often split and fade. Also caused by manual pounding of dry cherry to separate beans from husk (pilonnage in French). Discoloured beans: Often pulper-damaged. Other causes are contact with earth, metal and foul water as well as damage after drying and beans left over in fermenting tanks (see also stinkers). Drought-affected beans: Either coated or misshapen, pale and light in weight. Dull, unnatural coloured beans: Due to faulty drying, often associated with metal contamination. Ears: Part of a broken elephant bean. Earthy beans: Smell of earth, caused by collecting beans fallen on bare ground. Elephant beans: A generic aberration resulting in two beans being joined together usually deformed and likely to break up during processing/roasting (see also ears, above). Faded beans: Beans from old crop or dried too rapidly. Flaky beans: Usually very thin, light and ragged (see also drought-affected, lights and ragged). Floats or oaters/lights: Under-developed, hollow beans the fruit will oat in water and is oated off during wet processing. In washed coffee a sign of inadequate grading during wet processing. Foxy beans: Rust or reddish coloured, a result either of harvesting overripe, sometimes yellow, cherries, delays in pulping, improper fermentation or faulty washing. Green, water-damaged: Self-explanatory usually brought about by dry parchment or hulled coffee becoming wet. Hail-damaged beans: Show blackish circular marks on the oval side of the bean. Light bean: Bean the specic weight of which is below normal caused by drought or die-back.
How the Q Coffee System works: Quality is dened, measured and standardized through internationally recognized protocols. Highly-skilled coffee cuppers (licenced Q graders) are utilized throughout origin and consuming countries. In-country partners are established at origin to manage and oversee coffee grading. Coffees are graded by three licenced Q graders, scores are averaged and provided in the form of a Q Certicate or technical report. Building on the experience gained with creating the Q Coffee System in arabica, the Coffee Quality Institute has also developed a protocol and cupping form for ne robusta and commenced the training and licensing of R graders. For more information contact the CQI at www.coffeeinstitute.org.
CLASSIFICATION TERMS
GLOSSARY GREEN OR RAW COFFEE
Ambers: Smooth yellowish beans caused by soil conditions. Antestia-damaged: Beans damaged by the Antestia bug, resulting in black depressions on the bean, which is often completely shrivelled. Black beans: Caused by harvesting immature beans or gathering them after they have dropped to the ground. Blacks are often taken as the yardstick for rating a defect count.
224
Mottled beans: Are blotched, spotty or stained. Usually due to uneven drying. Musty (mouldy) beans: Partial or wholly discoloured, whitish fur-like colour and texture (see also chapter 11). Show mould growth visible by the naked eye or evidence of mould attack. Overripe: Brownish-yellow appearance; also known as foxy. Peaberry: A single oblong or ovaloid roundish bean a result of only one bean developing in a cherry instead of the usual two. Pulper-nipped: Bean damaged by incorrect setting of the pulping knives can become discoloured through oxidation during fermentation and may produce off-avours. Quakers: Blighted and undeveloped beans show up as roast defects. Ragged: This description often refers to drought-affected beans harvesting a mixture of mature and immature cherries results in beans having a ragged appearance. Stinkers: Beans which are over-fermented owing to improper cleaning of pulpers, fermenting tanks and washing channels. Three-cornered beans: Semi-peaberry in character. Withered: Light and shrivelled beans caused by drought or poor husbandry. NB: The exporters/traders/roasters technical vocabulary contains many more terms such as sticks, stones, pods (cherry), parchment, under-dried, under-fermented, etc. These are, however, all self-explanatory.
Balanced or round: Acidity and body are both present to the right extent. Bitter: When strong, an unpleasant, sharp taste; biting like quinine. Similar to acidity, but lacking smoothness. Bland or neutral: Tasting smooth and avourless, lacking coffee avour and characteristics. However, this is not necessarily always a negative comment. Body: A taste sensation or mouth feeling of more viscosity, used to describe the mouth feel of a drink corresponding to a certain consistency or an apparent viscosity, but not an increase in true viscosity. Sought after in most if not all coffees. Carbolic, chemical: Self-explanatory. Workers who have had wounds on legs treated with disinfectant and have then worked in tanks can cause this type of avour. Certain emulsions in the manufacture of sacks are also a problem. Carmelized: Burnt-like avour; carmelized sugar avour. Usually associated with spray-dried instant coffee, but sometimes found in roasted coffee. Common, commonish: Poor liquor, lacking acidity but with full body. Usually associated with coated raw beans and softs and pales in roast. Earthy: Self-explanatory. Not to be confused with grassy. Fermented: Chemical avour caused by enzymes on the green coffee sugars. Very unpleasant odour and taste. In its strongest form sometimes referred to as hidey referring to smell of untreated animal hides. Foul: Objectionable liquor often similar to rotten coffee pulp. Sometimes the most advanced stage of fruity and sour coffees. Causes are mostly bad factory preparation or the use of polluted water. It must be noted that one badly discoloured bean is sufcient to give a foul cup to an otherwise good liquor. Fruity: First stage of sourness. Caused by overripe and yellow cherry or by fermentation with too many skins. Grassy: A very pronounced green avour can be most unpleasant. Green, greenish: Flavour suggestive of hay. More common in early pickings. In some coffees this avour is lost a few weeks after curing. Seldom found in coffees which have been thoroughly dried. Harsh: A harshness of body. Coffee of immature raw appearance (but not necessarily from green cherry) frequently has a harsh taste. Drought-stricken or over-bearing trees producing mottled cherry frequently give this avour. Musty or mouldy: Self-explanatory. Caused by piling or bagging very wet parchment or by dry parchment getting wet. (See musty, under Green or raw coffee, above.) Natural: Natural characteristic is the full body, slight bitterness indicative of natural processed coffee. It is a negative characteristic of a fully washed coffee. Neutral: No predominant characteristics can make a good base for blending.
225
Onion avour: Often bordering on foul. Associated with the use of badly polluted and stagnant water. Pungent: A taste sensation of overall bitterness of brew. A prickly, stinging, or piercing sensation not necessarily unpleasant. Quakery: A peanutty taste, usually associated with pales in the roast. Rioy or Phenolic: A taste with medicinal odour and off notes, slightly iodized phenolic or carbolic. Cannot be hidden by blending always returns. Rubbery: Odour and taste of rubber. Usually present in fresh robustas. Sour, sourish: Unpleasant avour, suggestive of rotting coffee pulp. Caused by faulty factory work, improper fermentation resulting in a continuation of the fermentation process during early stages of drying, overripe and yellow cherry, or delayed drying causing a heating of the coffee, excess fermentation with many skins. Discoloured pulpernipped beans are a frequent cause (see also chapter 11). Strong: Unbalanced liquor where body predominates to the point of being tainted. Taint: A term used to denote the presence of avours that are foreign to good clean liquor, but which cannot be clearly dened or placed in any category. It is often described as an offtaste or peculiar avour for lack of a clear denition. Where the foreign avour can be dened it is, of course, named accordingly. Thin: Lacking body. Twisty: A liquor which, although not directly unclean, is suspect and may become unclean. Unclean: Self-explanatory. A coffee which has an undened unclean taste. Winey: A fruity taste similar to fresh wine. Not necessarily unpleasant when the taste is in the background. Woody: A coarse common avour peculiar to old crop coffee. Coffee stored at low altitudes with high temperatures and humidity (as in many ports of shipment) tends to become woody rather quickly. Storage at higher altitudes where feasible or in temperate climates is therefore recommended for long-term warehousing. All coffees, however, become woody if stored for too long.
the chemical composition of the bean. Such beans cannot be detected by visual inspection, nor is there any recognized method for combating their occurrence. Different sources offer differing causes, but it should be understood that not everyone understands the same by phenolic taste. For example, some cuppers wrongly identify certain types of over-fermentation as phenolic taste. Others believe it can be caused by poor sanitation or mould infestation during wet processing or drying but, although these may be variations on the same taste theme, the causes are not necessarily the same. See also chapter 11. True phenolic beans, according to some, are more likely to be produced by drought and heat-affected trees. That is to say, the beans chemical composition changes as a result of extreme growing conditions and so does the taste. If so, then the chemical change might in fact represent some kind of natural reaction, in response to the unfavourable environment. This appears to be entirely logical because healthy, vigorous trees always produce better quality than stressed trees. The most likely remedy would therefore appear to be the application of at least a minimal level of irrigation, assuming of course this resource is available. Other beans that cause equally unpleasant off-tastes include what is known as invisible stinkers; beans that have been affected by chemical substances as carbolic acid for example; or beans that have suffered bacterial infection during the growing stage. These off-tastes may in some cases be mistaken for phenolic taste but it is important to recognize that the cause is different. Invisible stinkers are beans that have been over-fermented during wet processing, but not to the point where actual decomposition sets in, i.e. they maintain a bluish-green appearance and are hard to spot. Or, the beans have suffered insect stings or minute cracks that allow fermentation water to enter and so continue the process. Beans that have been affected by unsanitary conditions or mould infestation during processing and drying are also invisible stinkers. Bacterial infections can occur when coffee cherries are stung by insects while on the tree, with the sting damage allowing bacterial infection to take place, for example producing potato avour or peasiness. This is fairly prevalent in certain countries. These three groups of off-beans share one common trait: their chemical composition is different from that of sound beans. In most instances, they can only be recognized and removed through ultraviolet sorting. The question of why beans of good green appearance nevertheless sometimes produce off-tastes has always been of interest because such beans can cause unexpected problems for roasters. This is particularly so for gourmet/ specialty roasters who normally roast smallish batches that offer little chance of the offending bean being dispersed over a large quantity.
Phenolic taste
Synonyms for phenol include carbolic acid and hydroxybenzene. As far as is known the occurrence of phenolic taste, like a number of other off-tastes, is linked to
226
Already in June 1975, at the 7th International Scientic Colloquium on Coffee in Hamburg, the East African Industrial Research Organization in Nairobi presented a paper dealing with the identication of over-fermented beans (stinkers) through exposure to ultraviolet light that made such beans uoresce because their chemical composition was different from that of sound beans. Yet, such beans were often unrecognizable with the naked eye, which is an important nding. Note though that as coffee ages, its chemical composition changes as well. The resultant woody or old taste is in fact the result of chemical change. This means that as the beans age, so most or all of them begin to uoresce. This makes it impossible to select the offending beans that were the original target. Therefore, as we understand it, for the ultraviolet sorting process to work well it should only be used for fresh coffee, promptly after milling. Also, the coffee should not be overly coated, i.e. not too much silver skin remains attached to the beans. Within these limitations we estimate that for certain producers ultraviolet sorting (or UV sorting) equipment may be of interest. For further information we suggest to visit www.Satake-USA.com. Some success has also been achieved using near infrared sorting to detect those infected beans not picked by ultra violet but this method remains experimental and only worthwhile in specic instances. For more scientic questions and discussion we suggest visiting www.asic-cafe.org to make contact with the Association scientique internationale du caf (ASIC).
woody, corky, cereal, iodine-like, phenolic; and tasting of bitterness, burned, rubbery, rioy, phenolic, acrid, pungent, earthy, corky, musty, stale and medicinal. In some countries Rio avour is considered equivalent to phenolic, but there is an important difference. Phenolic taste is close in that when cupping phenolic beans separately one encounters a medicinal taste that is similar to Rio. However, true phenolic beans (the result of climatic conditions) can occur sporadically in a parcel (hence the earlier reference to UV sorting). However, Rio is usually encountered much more generally, making sorting more or less impossible. The two, Rio (or Rioy) and phenolic, have in common that the taste cannot be hidden through blending, i.e. cannot be diluted through mixing with other coffees. The difference is that Rio avour usually occurs as a general taste aspect, whereas true phenolic beans occur only sporadically and, under certain circumstances, can be identied through ultraviolet or UV sorting. Fermented or over-fermented is quite different. Ferment covers a range of objectionable off-tastes, best described as being associated with decay. In its early stages ferment can present itself as a sweetish, overripe, fruity/oniony taste that for some (not many) can still be acceptable. In its worst stage one can encounter a totally putrid, foul taste that is most off-putting. In between these extremes is found a quite a range of varying taste sensations. Note that for most roasters there is no such thing as just a little ferment. See also chapter 11. As a broad generalization one could perhaps briey classify the causes of these different off-tastes as follows: Rio avour: very high humidity during the growing season. Phenolic avour: very hot and dry conditions during the growing season. Natural fermentation: overripe cherry left for some time on the tree. Fermentation/contamination: overripe cherry left for some time on the ground. Over-fermentation: poor management control during wet processing.
CHAPTER 13
RISING TEMPERATURES CONSEQUENCES AND CHALLENGES ............................................................228 POSSIBLE INTERVENTIONS AND SUPPORT MEASURES .............................................................................230 FROM STRATEGY TO ACTUAL RESPONSES .................................................................................................234 CARBON CREDITS .............................................................................................................................................237 ADDITIONAL RELEVANT WEBSITES ................................................................................................................240
228
SOME CONSIDERATIONS
New scientic evidence suggests that climate change is accelerating at a much faster pace than previously thought and that important tipping points, leading to irreversible changes in major Earth systems and ecosystems, may already have been reached or even overtaken. (Text taken from the foreword by Mr. Ban Ki-moon, UN Secretary-General, to the Climate Change Science Compendium 2009, published by the United Nations Environment Programme.) Human beings depend for their livelihood on agriculture more than on any other economic activity. This is particularly
229
Yield: If climatic events such as overly high temperatures occur during sensitive periods of the life of the crop, for example during owering or fruit setting, then yields will be adversely affected, particularly if accompanied by reduced rainfall. Pests and diseases: Higher temperatures will not only favour the proliferation of certain pests and diseases, but will also result in these spreading to regions where they were not normally present. Research suggest that the incidence of pests and diseases such as coffee berry borer, leaf miner, nematodes, coffee rust and others will increase as future temperatures rise. The consequent need for more control will make coffee production both more complicated and expensive. Irrigation: Areas currently not requiring this may do so in the future due to increased evaporation that reduces the soils moisture content. Other areas may experience increases in both rainfall and the variability thereof. Erratic rains: Unseasonal rain during owering affects fruit set, whereas rain during the harvest season will complicate the sun drying of coffee and affect quality. As already mentioned, complexity and uncertainty make it hard to be precise. Nevertheless, there is a real possibility that fewer parts of the world will be suitable for growing coffee. If so, then the already evident growth in the concentration of production could become even more pronounced. This in turn could make global production more prone to high uctuations, as any severe disruption in output from one of the major producers would drastically curtail global output. The cost of production will increase more than would have been the case without global warming and thirdly, competition from other crops for available arable land may increase. In the context of this brief review perhaps the most important point to note is that to date initiatives to reduce the extent of global warming are mostly aimed at limiting further warming, not to reverse it rapidly. This means everyone in the coffee value chain needs to adapt by taking actions to minimize and cope with the seemingly inevitable effects. Events of recent years have shown the veracity of the foregoing paragraphs. Both oods and droughts are on the increase in a number of coffee producing countries, whereas there are widespread reports of pests and diseases moving into areas where previously they did not exist. Individual farmers in different countries complain of unseasonal rainfall affecting owering and fruit set, with others cite drying and quality problems due to rain during the harvest season.
Quality: As temperature rises, coffee ripens more quickly leading to a fall in inherent quality. This statement is supported by the fact that low-grown arabica from tropical areas with higher temperatures mostly shows less quality in the cup compared to the same coffee grown at higher altitudes. The beans are softer and may well be larger but, lack that quality. In this regard it is estimated that if by the end of this century temperatures rise by 3 C (some experts believe an increase of up to 5 C is possible), then the lower altitude limit for growing good quality arabica may rise by some 15 ft (5 m) per annum, meaning that over time areas that are currently too cold for coffee could become suitable. But it is uncertain whether land at higher altitudes would in fact become available (or be rendered suitable) for coffee production.
230
major determinants of erosion, likely leading to reduced soil capacity to hold water. This is of particular importance to crop production in semi-arid and arid areas, particularly if coupled with rising temperatures. Water availability: In a warmer world, the hydrological cycle is expected to become more intense, likely to result in very wet and very dry areas compared to past measurements. Globally, the number of people exposed to extreme droughts at any one time is also expected to increase as a result of climate change. Extreme events: These can inuence agriculture quite heavily, but projecting their impact is hard. Probably the best known such event is the El Nio phenomenon that happens irregularly but dramatically affects the weather in many parts of the world. The term El Nio refers to the largescale warming of surface waters of the Pacic Ocean every three to six years, which usually lasts for 912 months, but may continue for up to 18 months and dramatically affect the weather worldwide. Predicting the occurrence of El Nio events (but not their impact on agriculture) has only been possible since the 1980s when computing power became large enough to do so. The impact of El Nio on coffee production has been closely studied in Colombia. During its occurrence in the Andean region of Colombia, rainfall decreases while sun intensity and temperatures increase. This causes production to fall in some regions, particularly in low-lying areas where rainfall is less than 1,500 mm/year and there is low retention of moisture and high exposure of the crop to sunlight. Lack of water during the critical stages of fruit development also brings about a high risk of black beans, small beans and other defects, as well as increased incidence of pests such as coffee berry borer.
Changing agricultural practices; Creating social organization; Participating in new market strategies. Strategic support areas include: Improving access to information; Establishing nancial mechanisms; Investing in social capital.
231
This is conrmed by previous surveys in the Mesoamerican region (the joint name for the Central American region and Mexico) that ranked ve potential areas of intervention as follows: More important: (i) changes in agricultural practices and (ii) social organization. Important: (iii) participation in new marketing strategies. Less important: (iv) new economic activities, and (v) new cash crops.
exploit the social and environmental value of their farming activities. Although considerable preparatory progress has been made in the development of both methodologies and tools, it is obvious that the industry as a whole is still in the preliminary stages of trying to transform strategy into widespread action.
CARBON CREDITS
Agricultural carbon credits, i.e. credits generated through agricultural practices like coffee production, are not eligible under the mandatory carbon market, including the Clean Development Mechanism (CDM). Therefore, marketable carbon credits do not yet feature in coffee production and by mid-2011 only one CDM project (the Coopeagri Forestry Project in Costa Rica) listed coffee growers among its indirect beneciaries. For more information on all categories of CDM projects, visit www.cdm.unfccc.int/Projects/index. html. There is more scope for land-use based projects under the smaller voluntary carbon offset market this is discussed later in this chapter. Given the complexities surrounding CDM the general consensus among researchers appears to be that the voluntary carbon markets system presents the better option for coffee growers. Examples include the CarbonFix Standard AdapCC initiated Sierra Piura reforestation project in Peru, run by the CEPICAFE cooperative www.carbonx. info/RSP, and the Scolel T project in Mexico www. planvivo.org/projects/registeredprojects/scolel-te-mexico. Nevertheless, by late 2011 there were no obvious signs yet of any full-scale application in the coffee sector. Meanwhile the retail end of the industry is increasingly looking across the supply chain to reduce the carbon footprint of products, including coffee, but so far measuring coffees Product Carbon Footprint (PCF) has been costly and complex, whereas the calculating and reporting of PCFs is not always consistent. Nevertheless, for coffee an encouraging start has been made through a study sponsored by the major German roaster Tchibo, covering coffee produced in the United Republic of Tanzania and consumed in Germany also mentioned later in this chapter. For more on soil carbon methodology see also www.v-c-s. org/methodologies/adoption-sustainable-agricultural-landmanagement-salm. Developing carbon projects is both complicated and time consuming, whereas credible carbon monitoring methodologies for coffee farms have only recently come to the fore. But, a number of tools are now available and different initiatives are conducting or planning pilot projects that in due course should facilitate extending carbon projects to the majority of coffee producing countries. See for example the Cool Farm Tool, www.sustainablefood.org/projects/ climate and the Sustainable Agriculture Initiative, www. saiplatform.org/activities/alias/climate-change. Provided the
Strategic recommendations include, in addition to recognizing the value of human capital, i.e. the collective farming knowledge that already exists in the smallholder sector: Improving access to information, including market information, farming technology, etc., and developing the ability to interpret such information; Establishing nancial mechanisms, including climate insurance, access to micro-credit to facilitate adaptation, i.e. organic, substitute crops, new varieties, shading, etc.; Investing in social capital, i.e. building structures that enable smallholders to access the resources necessary to adapt to climate change, access new markets and
232
necessary capacity building and legislative support in those countries is forthcoming, it may be assumed that progress will accelerate from 2011 onwards.
TERMINOLOGY
The debate over climate change has generated a host of terminology that is not always clear to the average reader.The United Nations Framework Convention on Climate Change (UNFCC) has therefore published a detailed Glossary of climate change acronyms that can be accessed at www. unfccc.int/essential_background/glossary/items/3666.php. The United Nations Food and Agricultural Organization offers a similar but possibly somewhat more agriculture related glossary. Visit www.fao.org/climatechange/en and in particular www.fao.org/climatechange/65923/en.
233
Rainfall must be well distributed throughout most of the year because the robusta tree has a relatively shallow root system. The optimum temperature ranges from 22 to 26 C and the species is less tolerant of very high as well as very low temperatures than arabica.
Evaluating available adaptation techniques, such as shade management systems. Although originally a shade tree, coffee also prospers without shade in zones with adequate climate and soils. However, shade management is highly advisable when coffee is grown in less desirable areas, or in areas that will become affected by climate change. The main effects are decreasing air temperatures (as much as 34 C), decreasing wind speeds and increasing air humidity. Shading also helps avoid large reductions in night temperatures at high elevations, or in high latitudes such as Parana State in Brazil. High-density planting, vegetated soils and irrigation. All these aim at maintaining and/or increasing organic matter and soil water retention capacity, thereby enhancing the viability of cultivation under adverse climatic conditions. Genetic breeding. The main objectives under this concept are the development of higher yields, better quality and strength, and longevity. However, it is equally important that genetic improvement based on selective breeding contributes to the long-term sustainability of coffee cultivation in lands potentially affected by climate change. Research on varieties that are less water demanding is equally important. Some research has focused on developing varieties that could cope with higher temperatures and remain highly productive at the same time.
234
including nancing of climate change mitigation and adaptation. www.undp.org/climatechange/adapt United Nations Development Programme (UNDP). Provides resources in respect of the programming of climate change adaptation projects and their integration into mainstream development. Also offers an Adaptation Learning Mechanism (ALM). A global knowledge sharing platform, mapping good practices and information on climate adaptation. www.fao.org/climatechange/en/ Food and Agricultural Organization of the United Nations (FAO). Information and resources related to climate change with particular emphasis on food security and agriculture. Extensive glossary of climate change terminology. www.odi.org.uk/themes/climate-change-environment/default. asp Overseas Development Institute (ODI). Independent think tank on development issues, active in research on climate change issues in developing countries. www.solutions-site.org The Horizon Solutions Site is a collaborative program with UNDP UNEP UNFPA, UNICEF, the , , IDRC, Yale and Horizons colleagues at Harvard that presents answers to problems in environment, health, population and development, in case-studies (peer-reviewed), articles and exhibits. www.sustainablecommodities.org The Sustainable Commodity Initiative (a joint venture by IISD and UNCTAD) aims to promote sustainable practices in commodity production and trade. Site links into FAST (Finance Alliance for Sustainable Trade), SCAN (Sustainable Commodity Assistance Network), SSI (Reporting: State of Sustainability Initiatives) and COSA (Committee on Sustainability Analysis). www.un.org/wcm/content/site/climatechange/gateway. This United Nations site offers a gateway to the work of over 30 UN organizations in the eld of climate change, including a link to the World Meteorological Organizations Global Climate Observing System (www.wmo.ch/pages/prog/gcos/ index.php?name=about). www.climatehotmap.org/index.html is an initiative by a number of concerned NGOs, including the World Wildlife Fund, and offers an inter-active Early Warning Signs map, detailing a number of potential global warming effects by region. w w w. s d w e b x . w o r l d b a n k . o r g / c l i m a t e p o r t a l / h o m e . cfm?page=globlemap The World Banks Climate Change Data Portal. Provides information on climate change and a number of tools. www.adaptationlearning.net The United Nations Development Programmes Adaptation Learning Mechanism is a knowledge-sharing platform on climate change. www.isealalliance.org The International Social and Environmental Accreditation and Labelling Alliance (ISEAL) is the global association for social and environmental standards systems. Site includes the complete output and documents
of the Social Accountability in Sustainable Agriculture project (SASA) and is of interest to coffee growers generally. www.cgiar.org The Consultative Group on International Agricultural Research (CGIAR) is a strategic partnership whose 64 members support 15 international research centres for which links and contact details are provided. www.iwmi.cgiar.org The International Water Management Institute (IWMI) is one of the 15 CGIAR-linked research centres. Its mission is to improve the management of land and water resources for food, livelihoods and nature. Look for its Water Policy Brief at www.iwmi.cgiar.org/Publications/ Water_Policy_Briefs/PDF/WPB31.pdf. www.ifpri.org The International Food Policy Research Institute (IFPRI) is another of the CGIAR-linked research centres and concentrates on food security issues. Their report entitled Climate change: Impact on agriculture and costs of adaptation presents research results that quantify climate-change impacts, assesses the consequences for food security, and estimates the investments that would offset the negative consequences for human well-being. Although not directly coffee-related, this analysis brings together, for the rst time, detailed modelling of crop growth under climate change with insights from an extremely detailed global agriculture model, using two climate scenarios to simulate future climate. http://www.wbcsd.org The World Business Council for Sustainable Development (WBCSD) is a global business initiative. Although not directly relevant to coffee the site nevertheless offers interesting information, for example on water and forest products. http://climatechange.worldbank.org The World Bank offers the entire text of its report Development and Climate Change 2010.
235
NB. This brief discussion is limited to the coffee sector and as such no reference will be made to the debate on climate change between industrialized and developing countries. Not all views on how to go forward concur, but it would seem reasonable to argue that there are three main areas for action to be undertaken as suggested in Adaptation for Smallholders to Climate Change by Mario Donga and Kathleen Jhrmann www.adapcc.org/en/downloads.htm a joint project of Cafdirect and German International Cooperation (GIZ). Action areas include: Short-term technical solutions for adapting coffee production and processing to current climate variability, aimed at producers; Measures to reduce GHG and so contribute to climate protection and carbon credit generation, aimed at all participants in the value chain; Long-term strategies to improve framework conditions for adaptation to future climate risks and to build the necessary capacities aimed at all in the value chain, but mostly producers. Short-term technical solutions will vary from country to country and between areas in a single coffee producing country. Farmers are already experiencing climate change, they know their circumstances better than anyone and many have innovative ideas on how to combat at least some of the effects. In other words, external assistance is needed, but to be successful it should combine with local stakeholders to jointly develop adaptation and mitigation processes. Measures to reduce GHG are equally important, but it is proving difcult for farmers to gain carbon offset credits, mostly because projects to reduce GHG emissions must demonstrate their additionality. That is to say, they must show an additional/added value effect in the GHG scenario. Under this concept coffee farms have to prove that they create GHG savings that are additional to anything that might happen anyway. Ironically, it is technically probably easier for other partners in the value chain to generate carbon offsets than it is for the grower. This is demonstrated by the fact that to date agri-based offsets are not widespread. Long-term strategies at the production level are essential and require major industry support and supporting legislation. Many of these are identied and discussed in the ICOs paper on Climate Change and Coffee referred to earlier in this chapter. Sufce it here to add that the March 2009 Coffee Issues Management Forum (organized by the National Coffee Association of USA) identied producer sustainability as the prime priority issue with adaptation to climate change listed as the most important sub-issue under this heading. In the meantime, however, coffee producers require mostly short-term solutions to try and help them cope as things move along in the world of climate. To a limited extent, progress towards mitigating the effects of climate change is assisted by adhering to Good Agricultural Practices or GAP further aligned to coffee production through , observance of one or more of the different certication or
verication standards that are active. But, it is obvious that climate change itself cannot be adequately addressed at the individual farm level. The reduction and trapping of GHG by coffee growers will very likely, if not automatically, also help towards mitigating at least some of the effects of climate change they are already experiencing. While it is not possible to sell coffee or shade trees, it is possible to work towards producing carbon credits that can be traded, either through the mandatory CDM process, or through voluntary arrangements. For individual smallholders CDM type coffee carbon credits may be very difcult to achieve. For them the better route is probably through umbrella projects that encompass larger areas and take a holistic approach to the issue as described later in this chapter.
236
Surveys that were conducted ranked ve potential areas of intervention as follows: More important: (i) changes in agricultural practices and (ii) social organization; Important: (iii) participation in new marketing strategies; Less important: (iv) new economic activities, and (v) new cash crops. In addition to recognizing the value of human capital, i.e. the collective farming knowledge that already exists in the smallholder sector, strategic recommendations include: Improving access to information, including market information, farming technology etc., and developing the ability to interpret such information. Establishing nancial mechanisms, including climate insurance, access to micro-credit to facilitate adaptation, i.e. organic, substitute crops, new varieties, shading, etc. Investing in social capital, i.e. build structures that enable smallholders to access the resources necessary to adapt to climate change, access new markets and exploit the social and environmental value of their farming activities. A number of projects elsewhere in the world have conducted or are conducting similar surveys. The indications are that the results may not be all that different.
Make better use of dry milling by-products (fuel, charcoal briquettes, board). Longer-term options Strengthening institutions; Improving access to climate data; Mapping potential climate change impact on coffee areas; Improving soil fertility; Examining different production models, for example high density planting; Developing/planting disease and drought resistant varieties; Shifting production to more suitable areas where feasible; Developing nance mechanisms to facilitate all or some of these. Examples of climate mapping can be found at www.ciat. cgiar.org, Centro Internacional de Agricultura Tropical or International Center for Tropical Agriculture in Colombia, and at www.iac.sp.gov.br, Instituto Agronmico de Campinas (IAC) in Brazil. Carbon sequestration and sinks Calculating and reducing the on-farm carbon footprint; Determine the feasibility of creating marketable carbon sinks; Linking smallholders to carbon markets to exploit carbon footprint opportunities. The list above is obviously not exhaustive. Many if not all of the options are of course also promoted by the different certication and verication standards as Organic, Rainforest Alliance, Utz Certied, 4C Association and corporate standards as the Nespressos AAA program, the Starbucks Coffee Company initiated C.A.F.E. (Coffee and Farmer Equity) Practices, and others. The 4C Climate Code is an example of the work being done by a number of organizations to bring climate change adaptation and mitigation closer to the coffee producer. The (voluntary) add-on module identies 15 principles and provides accompanying step by step indicators to measure progress from red (unacceptable) to green (compliant) in four main areas: Enabling Environment; Natural Resource Management; Soil and Crop Management; and GHG Emissions and Stocks. Although the module is subject to further renement, it nevertheless represents a practical roadmap for growers wishing to implement climate change adaptation and mitigation measures. The module is largely based on work done by a three-year public-private partnership in Kenya by Sangana Commodities Ltd and German International Cooperation. Further partners were the 4C Association, Tchibo GmbH and the World Banks Bio-Carbon Fund.
Shading to mitigate increased solar brilliance, reduce temperature variations and help retain moisture. Processing Reduce water usage with eco-friendly pulpers; Improve wastewater management and disposal; Make effective use of all compostable materials; Use solar energy, i.e. sun drying where feasible; Use renewable energy sources for mechanical drying;
237
The module, training manuals and further information, also on climate change generally, are available at www.4ccoffeeassociation.org/en/work-on-climate-change-php.
CARBON CREDITS
ORIGIN AND LIMITATIONS
A frequently encountered assumption is that coffee growers can (easily) benet from what is called the carbon offset or carbon credit market. This because supermarket chains, other retailers and consumer organizations are, sometimes publicly so, asking the coffee distribution chain (importers, roasters, others) to move to what is called a carbon neutral product footprint. This is a situation wherein the carbon emissions (carbon-dioxide or CO2) that the coffee chain produces are offset by carbon reducing activities. And yes, in principle coffee growing offers potential for this but it must be stressed that agri-based offsets are not widespread as yet for reasons that are explained below. It is important to have in mind that different ecosystems each have a distinct potential to trap carbon atoms. A tropical forest will isolate more carbon than a temperate forest, grasslands or an agricultural ecosystem. In the same way, different agricultural coffee systems have distinct potential to trap carbon atoms: forest coffee, smallholder plots, commercial plantations, coffee with or without shade, with or without intercropping, etc. But, whereas coffee production is often assumed not to contribute to GHG emissions, the fact is that auditing of an entire farming operation will reveal GHG leakages, the most obvious of which are the use of tractors, vehicles, electric motors, burning of rewood and the like that contribute to GHG emissions. The Kyoto Protocol referred to at the beginning of this chapter created what is known as the Clean Development Mechanism (CDM). This allows developed countries to invest in projects in developing countries to reduce GHG emissions, and to promote sustainable development through structured projects that can result in the selling of Certied Emission Reductions (CER). CDM projects must demonstrate their additionality, i.e. they have an additional/added value effect in the GHG scenario. Under the additionality concept, coffee farms would have to prove that they create GHG savings that are additional to anything that might happen anyway. The additionality margin is always confronted against a baseline that is traced comparing the farms with and without the CDM Project.
avenues towards earning carbon credits, provided net GHG gains can be shown. New activities such as the introduction of intercropping with suitable GHG absorbing plants, the planting of additional shade trees and the rehabilitation of degraded lands and hillsides can count. This could include the planting of additional coffee and shade trees, but only if it can be proven that the land in question had previously been in a prolonged state of degradation. The calculations to determine the net result of different activities are complex and the nal result may only justify the effort if larger areas are covered. This makes it difcult if not impossible for individual smallholders to participate directly in carbon offsets. The advantage of the CDM process is that it results in certied carbon credits that offer the traceability and credibility as set out in the Kyoto Protocol procedures. These credits can be traded on established, formal markets with transparent pricing procedures. In practical terms, however, the CDM approach may not be the best suited for smallholder coffee because of the difculty to measure the different coffee production processes accurately in terms of GHG impact.
238
prices are risk-driven; more risk for the seller means higher price whereas more risk for the buyer means lower price. Voluntary market standards try to dene quality by setting criteria; the stricter these are the better the quality of the certicate and, therefore, the higher the potential price. There are two distinct types of carbon credits: Carbon Offset Credits (COCs): generated by clean forms of energy production, wind, solar, hydro and bio fuels. Carbon Reduction Credits (CRCs): generated by the collection and storage of carbon from the atmosphere through bio-sequestration (reforestation, forestation), ocean and soil collection and storage efforts. Both approaches are recognized as effective ways to reduce the global carbon emissions crisis.
of a very high standard and more conventional production systems may produce different results. The authors also comment that in many instances it is difcult to trace individual coffees back to their original production site given that so much coffee is mixed at origin and is shipped overseas in bulk. They recommend the coffee industry should develop harmonized standards for compensation methods within the coffee chain and stress the importance of ensuring both transparency and credibility when it comes to making public statements regarding PCF. Without consistency in the methods for calculation and reporting of PCF it can be difcult to compare published footprints. See www.carbontrust.co.uk for more. To note here that the Carbon Disclosure Project at www. cdproject.net collects information on the carbon footprint of some 2,500 large companies worldwide, including the worlds leading multinational roasting companies. Participants measure and disclose their greenhouse gas emissions and climate change strategies through the project in order that they can set reduction targets and make performance improvements. To access these reports one has to register with the project. Of course there are many initiatives that deal with PCF reduction in industry generally, not limited to coffee. Slower vessel speeds, more efcient use of transport, using recycled packaging material, cleaner fuels and reduced energy use, but these are not within the scope of this discussion.
239
Also of interest to coffee producers is the Forest Carbon Partnership Facility (FCPF) at www.forestcarbonpartnership. org/fcp. It has information on ways to reduce emissions from deforestation and forest degradation (called REDD) by providing value to standing forests. The majority of CDM projects appear to go to Asia and Latin America, in particular China, India and Brazil. As a result, the Carbon Finance Assist facility was created to promote a more widespread ow of CDM projects by offering assistance with the identication and creation of CDM projects. Visit www. go.worldbank.org/T93VFJSRL0. But for many coffee growers the CDM route is unfortunately still too cumbersome and may be out of reach.
CarbonFix, www.carbonx.info, whose CarbonFix Standard was developed for climate forestation projects. The Chicago Climate Exchange, www.theice.com/ccx. jhtml, maintains an Offsets Registry Program to register veried emission reductions based on a comprehensive set of established protocols, including Forestry Carbon Sequestration. See also Making Sense of the Voluntary Carbon Market: A Comparison of Carbon Offset Standards at www. co2offsetresearch.org. The Climate, Community and Biodiversity Alliance Standards, www.climate-standards.org, include three kinds of credits: Approved, Silver and Gold depending on the ndings of the audit process. However, if veried carbon credits are to be issued they must be veried by one of the other voluntary standards.
ENVIRONMENTAL SERVICES
A particularly interesting discussion, potentially of great importance for the coffee sector, is whether maintaining shaded coffee farms, i.e. conserve existing shade trees and their carbon stocks, should count towards earning carbon credits. After all, coffee farms under shade conserve more carbon than coffee grown in direct sunlight, but at the cost of lower yields. There is therefore potentially an opportunity cost to adopting such conservation measures over sun grown coffee. Although in some cases this can be compensated for if linked to premium prices like for organic, the lack of
240
incentives for farmers to provide environmental services in this way is evident. Furthermore, should farmers not be rewarded for conserving existing shade grown coffee as is proposed for forests under REDD (Reduce Emissions from Deforestation and Forest Degradation in Developing Countries)? The current requirement is that farmers growing shade coffee plant additional trees before they may qualify for any carbon credits. In effect that means that the environmental services they already provide are being ignored.
Creating and testing a credible carbon monitoring methodology for Coffee Farms with the objective to combat climate change while promoting reforestation; enable farmers to sell the carbon these incremental trees take out of the atmosphere; avoid the high transaction costs usually associated with carbon offset projects; and develop methodology that can be used in other regions and sectors. A project outline is available at www. rainforest-alliance.org/climate.cfm?id=carbon_coffee with an update at www.eco-index.org/search/results. cfm?ProjectID=1476. NB. See also The Global Forest and Trade Network at www. gftn.panda.org. GFTN is a WWF Global initiative and offers information, contacts and tools in respect of sustainable forest management and forest certication.
241
by creating a trusted and tradable voluntary offset credit, the Veried Carbon Unit (VCU). VCS provides much information on standards for the reduction of GHG, project regulations and certication, and the marketing of Certicates of Emission Reduction or CER. www.climatestandards.org The Climate, Community and Biodiversity Alliance (CCB) is a private sector-civil society partnership. It aims at setting standards to be used for the identication of projects that simultaneously address climate change, support local communities and conserve biodiversity. www.co2offsetresearch.org The Carbon Offset Research and Education Initiative (CORE) is a project of the Stockholm Environment Institute and provides an analysis and synthesis of the most inuential offset programmes and activities. www.carbontrust.co.uk/Pages/Default.aspx The Carbon Trust is a United Kingdom Government initiative to accelerate the move towards a low carbon economy. It offers advice on reducing carbon footprints and helps develop low carbon methodologies and products. In particular look for the report entitled The Carbon Trust three stage approach to developing a robust offsetting strategy. www.cdmgoldstandard.org The Gold Standard Foundation is a civil society initiative that operates a certication service for premium carbon credits. Apart from the Gold Standard the site also lists accredited service providers in different elds, including project development nancing. www.carbonneutral.com The Carbon Neutral Company is a private sector carbon offset and management business. www.carbonfootprint.com Carbon Footprint Ltd is a carbon management and offset consultancy. Site includes calculator and management tools. www.ieta.org The International Emissions Trading Association aims to develop a functional international framework for trading in GHG emission reductions. The site offers a number of publications and explanations. www.chicagoclimatex.com and www.ecx.eu are formal exchanges for the pricing and trading of carbon offsets. They offer information on how and by who this can be done. www.ecosystemmarketplace.com The Ecosystem Marketplace, a private initiative of Forest Trends, is a leading source of news, data, and analytics on markets, prices and payments for ecosystem services such as water quality, carbon sequestration and biodiversity. The site offers wideranging information on environmental markets, ecosystem markets and carbon markets and a comprehensive glossary. It also offers a number of tools. Finally, a very useful listing of a large number of annotated and thematically sorted links to websites focusing on climate protection and development is available from the
German International Cooperation (GIZ, previously GTZ) website. Go to www.gtz.de and in particular www.gtz.de/en/ themen/umwelt-infrastruktur/umweltpolitik/4859.htm. Note: With the change from GTZ to GIZ existing GTZ website links are likely to change. Acknowledgement: Several parts of this chapter are based on the report Climate Change and Coffee published by the International Coffee Organization (ICO) in September 2009. The full report, including a list of selected organizations that are funding mitigation and adaptation to climate change initiatives, is available on the ICO website. See www.dev. ico.org/documents/icc-103-6-r1e-climate-change.pdf. The ICOs permission to make use of this report is gratefully acknowledged.
CHAPTER 14
244
245
Send a sample. A sample (500 g) is better than a thousand words (just like a picture). A sample suggests you understand the importance of quality, that you know your quality and that you have condence in it. But be sure you send the right sample. It should be fully representative of what you can supply and drawn from a parcel of coffee that itself is fully homogeneous. Understand that the buyer takes a risk when making a rst purchase if the coffee that arrives is no good, what can he do? Propose that shipments can be checked by a third party, both as regards quality and weight. Ask for comments on the quality and suitability of your coffee. What is the buyers preferred method of doing business? If you can, propose setting up appointments to visit buyers. This demonstrates your seriousness and will go a long way to establishing interest. Get samples to them before you arrive so that you can cup your samples (and others that may compete against you) together. Do not make generalized statements about what you can do. Instead be precise and factual. Show that you understand the importance of correct contract execution, the absolute need to ship precisely the quality that was sold, the need for documentation to be in order, etc. Buyers need convincing that you understand these issues and that you are capable of satisfying their requirements. Do not make promises you cannot keep. If necessary explain you are a novice but that you are keen to learn. Do not make claims you know not to be true. Not only will a buyer quickly pick this up but bear in mind that buyers also talk to each other. Remember that many roasters, for example in the United States, are not keen to deal direct and prefer to buy through exporters/importers. Therefore, do not concentrate on one sector only, but investigate what will be your best options in each individual market. Recognize the importance of intermediaries. Futures markets, language barriers, different time zones, the risk of default on both sides, etc., all support the need for exporters, importers, local agents, traders and brokers. Match your client to yourself. If you are producing 80 tons annually, do not go to one of the majors like Kraft, Sara Lee or Nestl. But also do not spend a fortune wooing a roaster who only needs 40 bags a year. Posted 19 July 2005 Related chapter(s): 03 Niche markets, environment and social aspects; 02 The markets for coffee Related Q&A: QA 029
246
Credit risk (the roaster does not pay please see Q&A 018 and 035 that deal with precisely this); Quality risk (the goods are rejected on arrival, either by customs or by the roaster). For the roaster importing direct some of the major risks will be: Performance risk (the goods are not shipped), and again; Quality risk (the goods are rejected by customs, or the quality is not what had been agreed). These are typical examples of the risk-taking function exporters and importers assume as a matter of course. Other examples include: Currency risk (coffee bought in one currency, sold in another); Shipping risk (goods are delayed or damaged en route); Provision of extended credit and so on. In our view there are basically no unnecessary functions in the value chain. But of course there are additional margins that could accrue to growers if they are prepared to extend the number of functions they carry out themselves, for example, by exporting themselves. However, contrary to popular belief, the major costs and margins are not incurred by exporters and importers as evidenced by the example on the next page of a value chain for Kenya specialty coffee to the United States. Although the calculations in the example were made when coffee prices were quite low, the ndings are corroborated by a further study (ERR-38 March 2007) released by the Economic Research Service of the United States Department of Agriculture. This study found that, on average, a 10-cent increase in the cost of a pound of green coffee beans in a given quarter results in a 2-cent increase in manufacturer and retail prices in the current quarter. If a cost change persists for several quarters, it will be incorporated into manufacturer prices approximately cent-for-cent with the commodity cost change. Given the substantial xed costs and markups involved in coffee manufacturing, this translates into about a 3% change in retail prices for a 10% change in commodity prices. The study also noted that cross-sectional price differences were substantially larger at the retail level than at the wholesale level. In our example some 87% of the retail cost of roasted coffee is incurred at the roaster and retailer level whereas the grower price represents around 7% of the retail value. However, this assumes a straightforward transaction, but many smaller roasters regularly require importers to hold stocks on their behalf. Delivery then has to be spread over a number of months, at xed prices and at extended credit terms, thereby of course increasing the middlemans costs.
247
US$/kg US$/kg green R&G coffee Retail price per kg roasted coffee Retail costs and margin Wholesale price Roaster prot (gross) Roaster overheads Roaster marketing/ advertising Roasting/packaging/ distribution In-plant cost to roaster per kg roasted In-plant cost to roaster per kg green Transport to roaster Insurance/nancing (incl. hedging) Warehousing Traders' margin Port charges CIF landed cost per kg roasted CIF landed cost per kg green Freight and shipping costs FOB price per kg roasted FOB price per kg green Exporter costs and margin Levies Marketing agent and milling* Cooperative primary processing Grower price per kg roasted Grower price per kg green 1.47 2.38 0.21 0.09 0.17 0.43 1.75 2.50 0.12 2.83 2.72 0.02 0.11 0.04 0.04 0.02 2.97 24.36 8.05 16.31 1.74 1.22 4.09 6.04 3.23
A similar calculation for mainstream coffee to Germany concluded that 84% of the roast and ground retail value accrued to the roasting and retail segments. About 6% went to processing cum export costs and intermediaries, leaving about 10% of the R&G retail value for the grower. Posted 23 March 2007 Related chapter(s): 01 World coffee trade; 03 Niche markets, environment and social aspects; 02 The markets for coffee Related Q&A: Q&A 018, 032, 035, 046, 065, 079, 083, 090, 094
1.0%
0.5%
Source: Various reports and ITC's own estimates. * Current legislation in Kenya requires growers wishing to sell direct (i.e. bypassing the auction system) to employ a marketing agent. The need for this link between grower and exporter is not entirely clear. Note: Percentages do not add up due to rounding; Conversion green/ roasted ratio of 1.19 as per ICO rules.
Exporting smaller quantities (less than a container load) is also quite difcult. This is one of the reasons why roasters taking part in Cup of Excellence auctions (www. cupofexcellence.org) rely on exporters and importers to ship/import their purchases. Further proof that for many growers the number of middleman functions they can assume is, in fact, quite limited.
A free PDF of this publication is available on ITCs website at: www.intracen.org/publications Printed copies of ITC publications can be purchased from ITCs website: www.intracen.org/eshop and from:
FSC is an independent, non-governmental, not for prot organization established to promote the responsible management of the worlds forests. Production by Phoenix Design Aid A/S, Denmark. ISO 14001/ ISO 9001 certied and approved CO2 neutral company. Printed on environmentally friendly paper (without chlorine) with vegetable-based inks. The printed matter is recyclable.
United Nations Publications Sales and Marketing 300 E 42nd Street 9th Floor, IN-919J New York, NY 10017 United States of America https://unp.un.org Tel: 1-800-253-9646 Fax: 212-963-3489 E-mail: publications@un.org